SBR BPP WB 2020-21
SBR BPP WB 2020-21
SBR BPP WB 2020-21
Workbook
For exams in September 2020,
December 2020, March 2021
and June 2021
TT2020
British Library Cataloguing-in-Publication Data Your market-leading BPP books, course materials and e-
A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library learning materials do not write and update themselves.
People write them on their own behalf or as employees of
an organisation that invests in this activity. Copyright law
Published by
protects their livelihoods. It does so by creating rights over
BPP Learning Media Ltd the use of the content.
BPP House, Aldine Place Breach of copyright is a form of theft – as well as being a
142–144 Uxbridge Road criminal offence in some jurisdictions, it is potentially a
London W12 8AA serious breach of professional ethics.
www.bpp.com/learningmedia With current technology, things might seem a bit hazy but,
basically, without the express permission of BPP Learning
Printed in the United Kingdom Media:
Your learning materials, published by BPP Learning Media Photocopying our materials is a breach of copyright
Ltd, are printed on paper obtained from traceable
Scanning, ripcasting or conversion of our digital
sustainable sources.
materials into different file formats, uploading them
to Facebook or e-mailing them to your friends is a
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be breach of copyright
reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any
You can, of course, sell your books, in the form in which
form or by any means, electronic, mechanical,
you have bought them – once you have finished with
photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior
them. (Is this fair to your fellow students? We update for a
written permission of BPP Learning Media.
reason.) Please note the e-products are sold on a single
The contents of this course material are intended as a guide user licence basis: we do not supply 'unlock' codes to
and not professional advice. Although every effort has been people who have bought them secondhand.
made to ensure that the contents of this course material are And what about outside the UK? BPP Learning Media
correct at the time of going to press, BPP Learning Media strives to make our materials available at prices students
makes no warranty that the information in this course can afford by local printing arrangements, pricing policies
material is accurate or complete and accept no liability for and partnerships which are clearly listed on our website.
any loss or damage suffered by any person acting or A tiny minority ignore this and indulge in criminal activity
refraining from acting as a result of the material in this by illegally photocopying our material or supporting
course material. organisations that do. If they act illegally and unethically
in one area, can you really trust them?
We are grateful to the Association of Chartered Certified
Accountants for permission to reproduce past Copyright © IFRS Foundation
examination questions and extracts from the syllabus. All rights reserved. Reproduction and use rights are strictly
The suggested solutions in the practice answer bank have limited. No part of this publication may be translated,
been prepared by BPP Learning Media Ltd, except where reprinted or reproduced or utilised in any form either in
otherwise stated. whole or in part or by any electronic, mechanical or other
means, now known or hereafter invented, including
BPP Learning Media is grateful to the IASB for permission to photocopying and recording, or in any information
reproduce extracts from the International Financial Reporting storage and retrieval system, without prior permission in
Standards including all International Accounting Standards, writing from the IFRS Foundation. Contact the IFRS
SIC and IFRIC Interpretations (the Standards). The Standards Foundation for further details.
together with their accompanying documents are issued by:
The IFRS Foundation logo, the IASB logo, the IFRS for
The International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) 30 SMEs logo, the “Hexagon Device”, “IFRS Foundation”,
Cannon Street, London, EC4M 6XH, United Kingdom. “eIFRS”, “IAS”, “IASB”, “IFRS for SMEs”, “IASs”, “IFRS”,
“IFRSs”, “International Accounting Standards” and
Email: [email protected] Web: www.ifrs.org “International Financial Reporting Standards”, “IFRIC”
“SIC” and “IFRS Taxonomy” are Trade Marks of the
Disclaimer: The IASB, the International Financial Reporting
IFRS Foundation.
Standards (IFRS) Foundation, the authors and the publishers
do not accept responsibility for any loss caused by acting or Further details of the Trade Marks including details of
refraining from acting in reliance on the material in this countries where the Trade Marks are registered or applied
publication, whether such loss is caused by negligence or for are available from the Licensor on request.
otherwise to the maximum extent permitted by law.
©
BPP Learning Media Ltd
2020
ii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Contents
Contents
Page
Helping you to pass iv
Essential Reading vi
Introduction to Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) viii
Essential skills xv
1 The financial reporting framework 1
2 Professional and ethical duty of the accountant 19
3 Revenue 39
4 Non-current assets 55
5 Employee benefits 83
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 1: Approaching ethical issues 103
6 Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period 119
7 Income taxes 133
8 Financial instruments 159
9 Leases 193
10 Share-based payment 215
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 2: Resolving financial reporting issues 243
11 Basic groups 261
12 Changes in group structures: step acquisitions 293
13 Changes in group structures: disposals and group reorganisations 313
14 Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations 335
15 Joint arrangements and group disclosures 351
16 Foreign transactions and entities 363
17 Group statements of cash flows 385
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 3: Applying good consolidation techniques 413
18 Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders 431
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 4: Interpreting financial statements 467
19 Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities 487
20 The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation 501
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 5: Creating effective discussion 519
Appendix 1 – Activity answers 537
Appendix 2 – Essential reading* 593
Further question practice and solutions* 693
Glossary* 787
Bibliography 797
Mathematical tables 799
Index 801
*Note. Sections marked with an asterisk are available in the digital eBook version of the
Workbook, accessed via the Exam Success Site (see inside cover for details).
TT2020
iii iii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
iv
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
Chapter features
Studying can be a daunting prospect, particularly when you have lots of other commitments. This
Workbook is full of useful features, explained in the key below, designed to help you to get the most
out of your studies and maximise your chances of exam success.
Key to icons
Key term
Central concepts are highlighted and clearly defined in the Key terms feature.
Key term
Key terms are also listed in bold in the Index, for quick and easy reference.
PER alert
PER alert
This feature identifies when something you are reading will also be useful for
your PER requirement (see 'The PER alert' section above for more details).
Stakeholder perspective
In the SBR exam, you may be asked to tackle an issue from the perspective of a
Stakeholder
perspective stakeholder, such as an investor, preparer or lender. This feature highlights
areas in each chapter which may be of particular interest to stakeholders.
Illustration
Illustrations walk through how to apply key knowledge and techniques step by
step.
Activity
Activities give you essential practice of techniques covered in the chapter.
Exercise
Exercises suggest tasks which can be done to further your understanding.
Essential reading
Links to the Essential reading are given throughout the chapter. The Essential
reading is included in the free eBook, accessed via the Exam Success Site
(see inside cover for details on how to access this).
Knowledge diagnostic
Summary of the key learning points from the chapter.
At the end of each chapter you will find a Further study guidance section. This contains suggestions
for ways in which you can continue your learning and enhance your understanding. This can
include: recommendations for question practice from the Further question practice and solutions, to
test your understanding of the topics in the chapter; suggestions for further reading which can be
done, such as technical articles, and ideas for your own research.
TT2020
v
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
vi
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
19 Reporting Further detail on the background to and consequences of the IFRS for
requirements of SMEs
small and
medium-sized
entities
TT2020
vii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
SBR UK Supplement
This Workbook is based on International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) only. Students sitting
the UK GAAP variant of the SBR exam can access an additional free online UK supplement which
covers UK accounting standards, providing relevant illustrations and examples, and should be used
in conjunction with the IFRS Workbook. The Supplement can be found on the Exam Success Site; for
details of how to access this, see the inside cover of the Workbook.
The syllabus
The broad syllabus headings are:
viii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
Main capabilities
On successful completion of this exam, you should be able to:
A Apply fundamental ethical and professional principles to ethical dilemmas and discuss
the consequences of unethical behaviour
B Evaluate the appropriateness of the financial reporting framework and critically discuss
changes in accounting regulation
C Apply professional judgement in the reporting of the financial performance of a range
of entities
Note. The learning outcomes in Section C of the syllabus can apply to single entities,
groups, public sector entities and not-for-profit entities (where appropriate).
D Prepare the financial statements of groups of entities
E Interpret financial statements for different stakeholders
F Communicate the impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation on
financial reporting
Financial
Reporting (FR)
Financial
Accounting (FA)
The diagram shows where direct (solid line arrows) and indirect (dashed line arrows) links exist
between this exam and other exams preceding or following it.
The SBR syllabus assumes knowledge acquired in Financial Accounting and Financial Reporting and
develops and applies this further and in greater depth.
TT2020
ix
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
C1 Revenue Chapter 3
C4 Leases Chapter 9
The complete syllabus and study guide can be found by visiting the exam resource finder on the
ACCA website: www.accaglobal.com
x
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
The exam
Computer-based exams
With effect from the March 2020 sitting, ACCA has commenced the launch of computer-based
exams (CBEs) for this exam with the aim of rolling out into all markets internationally over a short
period. Paper-based examinations (PBE) will be run in parallel while the CBEs are phased in. BPP
materials have been designed to support you, whichever exam option you choose. For more
information on these changes, when they will be implemented and to access Specimen Exams in the
Strategic Professional CBE software, please visit the ACCA website. Please note that the Strategic
Professional CBE software has more functionality than you will have seen in the Applied Skills exams.
https://www.accaglobal.com/gb/en/student/exam-support-resources/strategic-professional-
specimen-exams-cbe.html
TT2020
xi
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
100
Current issues
The current issues element of the syllabus (Syllabus area F) may be examined in Section A or B but
will not be a full question. It is more likely to form part of another question.
xii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
Covered in
Workbook Specimen Specimen Sept Dec
chapter exam 1 exam 2 2018 2018
3 Revenue B B A
4 Non-current assets A, B A, B A, B
8 Financial instruments A A
9 Leases B A
5 Employee benefits A
7 Income taxes A B
10 Share-based payment
TT2020
xiii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
Covered in
Workbook Specimen Specimen Sept Dec
chapter exam 1 exam 2 2018 2018
IMPORTANT! The table above gives a broad idea of how frequently major topics in the syllabus are
examined. It should not be used to question spot and predict, for example, that Topic X will not be
examined because it came up two sittings ago. The examining team's reports indicate that they are
well aware that some students try to question spot. They avoid predictable patterns and may, for
example, examine the same topic two sittings in a row, particularly if there has been a recent change
in legislation.
xiv
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
aging information
Man
An
sw
er
pl
t
en
manag ime
an
em
t
nin
Approaching Resolving financial Exam Success Skills
Good
g
Specific SBR Skills
Applying good
re q r p re t a t i o n
consolidation
Creating effective techniques
m e nts
discussion
Eff d p
an
u ire
o f t i n te
Interpreting
e c re
e
ti v
financial statements
se w ri
c
r re
nt tin
ati g
Co
on
l
Efficient numerica
analysis
STEP 1 Work out how many minutes you have to answer the question.
STEP 3 Read the scenario, identify which IAS or IFRS may be relevant, whether the
proposed accounting treatment complies with that IAS or IFRS, and any threats to
the fundamental ethical principles.
STEP 4 Prepare an answer plan using key words from the requirements as headings.
Ensure your plan makes use of the information given in the scenario.
STEP 5 Write up your answer using key words from the requirements as headings.
Skills Checkpoint 1 covers this technique in detail through application to an exam-standard question.
TT2020
xv
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
STEP 1 Work out how many minutes you have to answer the question.
STEP 3 Read the scenario, identifying relevant IFRSs (and/or parts of the Conceptual
Framework) and how they should be applied to the scenario.
STEP 4 Prepare an answer plan ensuring that you cover each of the issues raised in the
scenario.
STEP 5 Write up your answer, using separate headings for each item in the scenario.
Skills Checkpoint 2 covers this technique in detail through application to an exam-standard question.
STEP 1 Work out how many minutes you have to answer the question.
STEP 2 Read the requirement for each part of the question and analyse it, identifying
sub-requirements.
STEP 3 Read the scenario, identify exactly what information has been provided and what
you need to do with this information. Identify which consolidation
workings/adjustments may be required.
STEP 5 Write up your answer using key words from the requirements as headings
(if preparing narrative). Perform calculations first, then explain.
There are many more marks available in the SBR exam for discussion and explanation of calculations
rather than the calculations themselves. Please refer to the ACCA marking guides released along with
the past exam questions and suggested solutions (available on the ACCA website) which show the
number of marks available for both calculations and discussions.
See Skills Checkpoint 3 to see how Skill 3 is applied to an exam-standard question.
xvi
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
STEP 1 Work out how many minutes you have to answer the question.
Skills Checkpoint 4 covers this technique in detail through application to an exam-standard question.
TT2020
xvii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
Managing information
Questions in the exam will present you with a lot of information. The skill is how you handle this
information to make the best use of your time. The key is determining how you will approach the
exam and then actively reading the questions.
xviii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
It is particularly important to pay attention to any dates you are given in requirements. This is
especially the case when, for example, discussing an accounting treatment up to a particular date.
No marks will be awarded for discussing the treatment at a different date than that asked for in the
requirement.
Exam success skill 3
TT2020
xix
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
xx
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
Question practice
Question practice is a core part of learning new topic areas. When you practice questions, you
should focus on improving the Exam success skills – personal to your needs – by obtaining feedback
or through a process of self-assessment.
TT2020
xxi
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Introduction
xxii
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The financial
reporting framework
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss the importance of the Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting in B1(a)
underpinning the production of accounting standards.
Discuss the nature of the qualitative characteristics of useful financial information. B1(c)
Explain the roles of prudence and substance over form in financial reporting. B1(d)
Discuss the high level of measurement uncertainty that can make financial B1(e)
information less relevant.
Critically discuss and apply the definitions of the elements of financial statements B1(g)
and the reporting of items in the statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income.
Discuss the impact of current issues in corporate reporting including. The F1(c)
following examples are relevant to the current syllabus:
1. The revised Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting
Exam context
The IASB's Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting underpins International Financial
Reporting Standards and is fundamental to the SBR exam. You are expected to be able to apply the
principles in the Conceptual Framework to accounting issues, such as an accounting issue where no
IFRS currently exists.
TT2020
1
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
2
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Essential reading
For revision of the principles in IAS 1 see Chapter 1 of the Essential Reading (available in Appendix 2
of the digital edition of the Workbook).
2.3 Purpose
The purpose of the Conceptual Framework is to (para. SP1.1):
Assist the IASB to develop IFRS Standards that are based on consistent concepts;
Assist preparers of accounts to develop accounting policies in cases where there is no
IFRS applicable to a particular transaction, or where a choice of accounting policy
exists; and
Assist all parties to understand and interpret IFRS Standards.
The instances in which a preparer will use the Conceptual Framework to develop an accounting
policy are expected to be rare. Therefore the Conceptual Framework will primarily be used by the
IASB to develop IFRS Standards.
TT2020
3
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.4 Content
Chapters 1 and 2
The Conceptual Framework is divided into chapters: discuss information
provided in general
Chapter 1 The objective of general purpose financial reporting purpose financial
Chapter 2 Qualitative characteristics of useful financial information reports
Objective of To provide financial information about the reporting entity that is useful
general purpose to existing and potential investors, lenders and other creditors in
financial reporting making decisions about providing resources to the entity (para. 1.2)
Existing and potential investors, lenders and other creditors are referred to as the 'primary users'
of financial statements (para. 1.5).
The economic resources of the entity, claims against the entity and
To make decisions, changes in those resources and claims
primary users
need information Management's stewardship: how efficiently and effectively
about: the entity's management and governing board have discharged
their responsibilities to use the entity's economic resources
(para. 1.4)
Three aspects are relevant to users of financial statements (paras. 1.17–1.21):
Financial performance reflected by accrual accounting
Financial performance reflected by past cash flows
Changes in economic resources and claims not resulting from financial
performance, eg a share issue
4
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Prudence is the exercise of caution when making judgements under conditions of uncertainty.
Sometimes the most relevant information may have such a high level of measurement
uncertainty that, instead, the most useful information is that which is slightly less relevant, but is
subject to lower measurement uncertainty.
2.6.2 Enhancing qualitative characteristics (paras. 2.23–2.38)
The enhancing qualitative characteristics are
Comparability
Verifiability
Timeliness
Understandability
The usefulness of information is enhanced if these characteristics are maximised.
Enhancing qualitative characteristics cannot make information useful if the information is irrelevant or
if it is not a faithful representation.
Providing information is subject to the cost constraint: the benefits of reporting information should
justify the costs incurred in reporting it.
Comparability
Comparability: The qualitative characteristic that enables users to identify and understand
similarities in, and differences among, items (para. 2.25).
Key term
The disclosure of accounting policies is particularly important here. Users must be able to
distinguish between different accounting policies in order to be able to make a valid comparison of
similar items in the accounts of different entities.
TT2020
5
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
When an entity changes an accounting policy, the change is applied retrospectively so that the
results from one period to the next can still be usefully compared.
Comparability is not the same as uniformity. Accounting policies should be changed if the change
will result in information that is reliable and more relevant, or where the change is required by an IFRS.
Verifiability
Verifiability: Helps assure users that information faithfully represents the economic phenomena it
purports to represent. Verifiability means that different knowledgeable and independent observers
Key term
could reach consensus, although not necessarily complete agreement, that a particular depiction is a
faithful representation (para. 2.30).
Financial reports are prepared for users who have a reasonable knowledge of business and
economic activities and who review and analyse the information diligently (para. 2.36).
Illustration 1
On 30 November 20X8, Sykes failed to make an interest payment to SB Bank and consequently
breached the conditions of a long-term loan agreement. Under the terms of the loan agreement, the
loan became immediately repayable. On 3 December 20X8, SB Bank agreed that provided Sykes
made the interest payment by 30 April 20X9, it would not demand immediate repayment of the loan.
At the reporting date of 31 December 20X8, Sykes classified the loan as a non-current liability. The
loan is for a large sum of money that is material to the financial statements of Sykes.
Required
Discuss whether the classification of the loan as a non-current liability provides useful information to
investors.
Solution
According to the Conceptual Framework, the objective of financial reporting is to provide financial
information about the entity that is useful to investors (and certain other stakeholders) in making
decisions about providing resources to the entity.
Reporting the loan as non-current is not useful to investors as it is misleading. If Sykes does not make
the interest payment by 30 April 20X9, the loan would become repayable immediately. Given the
size of the loan, this could affect Sykes's ability to continue as a going concern.
6
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
(paras. 3.4–3.7)
2.7.2 The reporting entity (paras. 3.10–3.14)
2.8.1 Assets
Asset: A present economic resource controlled by the entity as a result of past events (Conceptual
Framework: para. 4.2).
Key term
Economic resource: A right that has the potential to produce economic benefits (Conceptual
Framework: para. 4.2).
TT2020
7
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.8.2 Liabilities
Liability: A present obligation of the entity to transfer an economic resource as a result of past
events (Conceptual Framework: para. 4.2).
Key term
An essential characteristic of a liability is that the entity has an obligation. An obligation is 'a duty
or responsibility that the entity has no practical ability to avoid' (para. 4.29).
Illustration 2
IFRS 16 Leases requires a lessee to recognise a right-of-use asset for each lease they enter into (with
limited exceptions). A right-of-use asset is consistent with the definition of an asset in the Conceptual
Framework: as a result of entering into the lease agreement (past event), the lessee can direct the use
of the leased asset (control) in the course of business in order to directly or indirectly generate
economic benefits.
IFRS 16 also requires the recognition of a lease liability, equivalent to the present value of future
lease payments. The lease liability meets the Conceptual Framework definition of a liability: the
lessee has a responsibility (present obligation) as a result of entering into the lease agreement (past
event) to pay the lease rentals (transfer of economic benefits) as they become due.
2.8.3 Equity
Equity: The residual interest in the assets of the entity after deducting all its liabilities (Conceptual
Framework: para. 4.2).
Key term
Income: Increases in assets, or decreases in liabilities, that result in increases in equity, other than
those relating to contributions from holders of equity claims (Conceptual Framework: para. 4.2).
Key term
Expenses: Decreases in assets, or increases in liabilities, that result in decreases in equity, other
than those relating to distributions to holders of equity claims (Conceptual Framework: para. 4.2).
Note that contributions from owners are not income and distributions to owners are not expenses.
Recognition: The process of capturing for inclusion in the statement of financial position or the
statement(s) of financial performance an item that meets the definition of one of the elements of
Key term
financial statements—an asset, a liability, equity, income or expenses (para. 5.1).
8
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Recognising one item requires the recognition or derecognition of one or more other items.
Eg
Recognise at the same time Derecognise or Recognise
an expense an asset a liability
(a) The item meets the definition of an element (asset, liability, income, expense or equity); and
(b) Recognition of that element provides users of the financial statements with information that is
useful, ie with:
Illustration 3
The previous Conceptual Framework required an element to be recognised if:
(a) The inflow or outflow of future economic benefits was probable; and
(b) The item could be measured with reliability.
However, these criteria were not applied consistently within IFRS Standards. For example, different
standards use different levels of probability in determining when elements should be recognised.
Under IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets, one of the criteria for
recognising a provision is that outflows should be probable. However, contingent consideration (in
respect of a business combination under IFRS 3 Business Combinations) is recognised whether or not
it is probable. Instead the level of uncertainty is taken into account in the measure of fair value.
IAS 37 also requires a provision to be reliably measurable before it can be recognised. Some parts
of IAS 19 Employee Benefits also include the reliable measurement criterion. However, other IFRS
Standards do not include this criterion.
The revised Conceptual Framework recognition criteria removes the probability and reliability criteria
and replaces it with recognition of an element if that recognition provides users with relevant
information that is a faithful representation of that element. While this will not remove the
inconsistencies in recognition criteria that currently exist across IFRS Standards, it does provide a
basis for both the IASB to consider when developing new standards and revising existing standards
and for preparers to consider when developing accounting policies for which no accounting
standard exists.
TT2020
9
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.9.3 Derecognition
Derecognition normally occurs when the element no longer meets the definition of an element (para.
5.26):
• For an asset – when control is lost (derecognise part of a recognised asset if control of that
part is lost)
• For a liability – when there is no longer a present obligation
The requirements for derecognition aim to faithfully represent both (para. 5.27):
(a) Any assets and liabilities retained after derecognition; and
(b) The change in the entity’s assets and liabilities as a result of derecognition.
Current value uses information available at the reporting date to update the carrying amounts of
assets and liabilities.
Fair value: The price that would be received to sell an asset, or paid to transfer a liability, in an
orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (para. 6.12 and IFRS 13:
Key terms
Appendix A).
Value in use: The present value of the cash flows, or other economic benefits, that an entity
expects to derive from the use of an asset and from its ultimate disposal (para. 6.17).
10
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Fulfilment value: The present value of the cash, or other economic resources, that an entity
expects to be obliged to transfer as it fulfils a liability (para. 6.17).
Current cost of an asset: The cost of an equivalent asset at the measurement date, comprising
the consideration that would be paid at the measurement date plus the transaction costs that would
be incurred at that date (para. 6.21).
Current cost of a liability: The consideration that would be received for an equivalent liability at
the measurement date minus the transaction costs that would be incurred at that date (para. 6.21).
Current cost and historical cost are both entry values, they 'reflect prices in the market in which
the entity would acquire the asset or would incur the liability' (para. 6.21). Fair value, value in
use and fulfilment value are exit values.
Fair value reflects the perspective of market participants, whereas value in use and fulfilment
value reflect entity-specific assumptions (para. 6.19).
2.10.2 Factors to consider in selecting a measurement basis
(1) Nature of information provided (paras. 6.23–6.42)
Different information is produced by applying a different measurement basis to the same asset
(or other element). So it is important to consider what information is produced by a
measurement basis in both the statement of financial position and the statement of profit or
loss. Which one is more important will depend on the particular circumstances.
TT2020
11
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(3) Other factors
Cost constraint: do the benefits of the information provided by the selected
measurement basis justify the costs? (para. 6.64)
Enhancing qualitative characteristics: eg consistently using the same
measurement basis aids comparability, verifiability is enhanced by using measures that
can be independently corroborated (paras. 6.65, 6.68).
12
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Framework does go some way to address these issues, however, it does not define the concepts of
profit or loss so some of these questions remain unanswered.
TT2020
13
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Ethics note
Ethics is a key aspect of the syllabus for this exam. Ethical issues will always be examined in
Question 2 of the exam. A revision of ethical principles from ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct is
covered in Chapter 2 – Professional and ethical duty of the accountant. You need to be alert for
accounting treatments that may be being used to achieve a particular accounting effect (such as
overstating revenue, profit or assets).
Some potential ethical issues that could come up include:
Misuse of 'true and fair override' (IAS 1) when it is not appropriate to use it
Application of Conceptual Framework principles which result in a different accounting
treatment to that required by an IFRS Standard (the Standard always takes precedence)
14
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Chapter summary
Purpose of the Conceptual Framework 3. Financial statements and the reporting entity
• Assist IASB to develop IFRS Standards that are based • Objective of financial statements: 'To provide
on consistent concepts financial information about the reporting entity’s
• Assist preparers to develop accounting policies in assets, liabilities, equity, income and expenses that
cases where there is no applicable IFRS or where a is useful to users of financial statements in
choice of policy exists; and assessing the prospects for future net cash inflows
• Assist all in the understanding and interpretation of to the reporting entity and in assessing
IFRS Standards management’s stewardship of the entity’s
economic resources'
• Going concern is assumed
1. The objective of general purpose financial reporting • Reporting entity can be part of an entity, a single
'To provide financial information about the reporting entity or a group of entities
entity that is useful to existing and potential investors,
lenders and other creditors in making decisions about
providing resources to the entity' 4. The elements of financial statements
• Asset: 'a present economic resource controlled by
the entity as a result of past events'
2. Qualitative characteristics of useful financial • Liability: 'a present obligation of the entity to
information transfer an economic resource as a result of
• Fundamental qualitative characteristics: relevance past events'
and faithful representation • Economic resource: 'a right that has the potential
• Enhancing qualitative characteristics: to produce economic benefits'
comparability, verifiability, timeliness, • Income: 'Increases in assets, or decreases in
understandability liabilities, that result in increases in equity, other
• Subject to cost constraint than those relating to contributions from holders of
equity claims'
• Expenses: 'Decreases in assets, or increases in
liabilities, that result in decreases in equity, other
than those relating to distributions to holders of
equity claims'
TT2020
15
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting continued
16
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Knowledge diagnostic
TT2020
17
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Further reading
You should make time to read the following articles which were written by a member of the SBR
examining team. They are available in the study support resources section of the ACCA website:
The Conceptual Framework
Profit, loss and other comprehensive income
Concepts of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
Bin the clutter (Reducing disclosures)
Measurement
www.accaglobal.com
18
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Professional and
ethical duty of the
accountant
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Appraise and discuss the ethical and professional issues in advising on corporate A1(a)
reporting.
Assess the relevance and importance of ethical and professional issues in A1(b)
complying with accounting standards.
Assess the consequences of not upholding ethical principles in the preparation of A2(b)
corporate reports.
Identify related parties and assess the implications of related party relationships in A2(c)
the preparation of corporate reports.
Discuss and apply the judgements required in selecting and applying accounting C11(d)
policies, accounting for changes in estimates and reflecting corrections of prior
period errors.
Exam context
Ethical issues will always be tested in Section A Question 2 of the exam. Two professional marks are
allocated to this question.
IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures aims to improve the quality of information provided by published
accounts and also to strengthen their stewardship roles. Related parties could also come up outside
the context of ethics as part of a Section B scenario question.
IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors was covered in your earlier
studies. However, given the importance of ethics to the SBR exam, we set it in the context of ethical
dilemmas in financial reporting.
TT2020
19
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Related parties
20
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
Principle Explanation
Objectivity Not to allow bias, conflict of interest or undue influence of others to override
professional or business judgements
Professional To maintain professional knowledge and skill at the level required to ensure
competence and that a client or employer receives competent professional service based on
due care current developments in practice, legislation and techniques and act diligently
and in accordance with applicable technical and professional standards
Professional To comply with relevant laws and regulations and avoid any action that
behaviour discredits the profession
Threat Explanation
Self-review The accountant will not appropriately evaluate the results of a previous judgement
made or service performed by themselves or others within their firm, on which the
accountant will rely when forming a judgement as part of providing a current
service.
Advocacy A threat that the accountant promotes a client's or employer's position to the point
that their objectivity is compromised.
Familiarity Due to a long or close relationship with a client or employer, the accountant will
be too sympathetic to their interests or too accepting of their work.
Intimidation The accountant will be deterred from acting objectively because of actual or
perceived pressures, including attempts to exercise undue influence over the
accountant.
TT2020
21
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Where the above threats exist, appropriate safeguards must be put in place to eliminate or reduce
them to an acceptable level. Safeguards against breach of compliance with the ACCA Code include:
(a) Safeguards created by the profession, legislation or regulation (eg corporate governance)
(b) Safeguards within the client/the accountancy firm's own systems and procedures
(c) Educational training and experience requirements for entry into the profession, together with
continuing professional development
22
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
TT2020
23
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 1
Ethical issues
ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct identifies a number of threats to its fundamental ethical
principles.
Jake has been put under significant pressure by his manager to change the conclusion of a report he
has written which reflects badly on the manager's performance.
Required
(a) Which ethical threat is Jake facing?
(b) Which of the following might (or might be thought to) affect the objectivity of providers of
professional accounting services?
Solution
(a) The answer is intimidation, as indicated by 'significant pressure'.
(b)
A personal financial interest in the client's affairs will affect objectivity. Failure to keep up to
date on continuing professional development is an issue of professional competence, while
providing inaccurate information reflects upon professional integrity.
Performance objective 1 of the PER requires you to act with integrity, objectivity, professional
competence and due care and confidentiality. You can apply the knowledge you gain in this chapter
PER alert
to help you fulfil this objective.
24
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
Illustration 2
Takeover
Your Finance Director has asked you to join a team that is planning a takeover of one of your
company's suppliers. An old school friend works as an accountant for the supplier. The Finance
Director knows this, and has asked you to try and find out 'anything that might help the takeover
succeed, but it must remain secret'.
Solution
There are three issues here.
First, you have a conflict of interest as the Finance Director wants you to keep the takeover a secret,
but you probably feel that you should tell your friend what is happening as it may affect their job.
Second, the Finance Director is asking you to deceive your friend. Deception is unprofessional
behaviour and is in breach of your ethical guidelines. The situation is presenting you with two
conflicting demands. It is worth remembering that no employer can ask you to break your ethical rules.
Finally, the request to break your own ethical guidelines constitutes unprofessional behaviour by the
Finance Director. You should weigh up whether blowing the whistle internally would prove effective;
if not, consider reporting them to their relevant professional body.
2 Related parties
2.1 Related parties
Related party relationships and transactions are a normal feature of business. However, there is a
general presumption that transactions reflected in financial statements have been carried out on an
arm's length basis, unless disclosed otherwise.
Arm's length means on the same terms as could have been negotiated with an external party, in
which each side bargained knowledgeably and freely, unaffected by any relationship between them.
26
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
Related party (IAS 24): A person or entity that is related to the entity that is preparing its
financial statements (the 'reporting entity').
Key term
(a) A person or a close member of that person's family is related to a reporting entity if that
person:
(i) Has control or joint control over the reporting entity;
(ii) Has significant influence over the reporting entity; or
(iii) Is a member of the key management personnel of the reporting entity or of a
parent of the reporting entity.
(b) An entity is related to a reporting entity if any of the following conditions apply:
(i) The entity and the reporting entity are members of the same group (which means
that each parent, subsidiary and fellow subsidiary is related to the others).
(ii) One entity is an associate* or joint venture* of the other entity (or an associate or
joint venture of a member of a group of which the other entity is a member).
(iii) Both entities are joint ventures* of the same third party.
(iv) One entity is a joint venture* of a third entity and the other entity is an
associate of the third entity.
(v) The entity is a post-employment benefit plan for the benefit of employees of either
the reporting entity or an entity related to the reporting entity.
(vi) The entity is controlled or jointly controlled by a person identified in (a).
(vii) A person identified in (a)(i) has significant influence over the entity or is a member
of the key management personnel of the entity (or of a parent of the entity).
(viii) The entity, or any member of a group of which it is a part, provides key
management personnel services to the reporting entity or the parent of the
reporting entity.
*including subsidiaries of the associate or joint venture
(IAS 24: para. 9)
Close members of the family of a person are defined (IAS 24: para. 9) as "those family
members who may be expected to influence, or be influenced by, that person in their dealings with
the entity and include:
That person's children and spouse or domestic partner;
Children of that person's spouse or domestic partner; and
Dependants of that person or that person's spouse or domestic partner."
In considering each possible related party relationship, attention is directed to the substance of the
relationship, and not merely the legal form.
TT2020
27
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(iii) Public utilities; and
(iv) Departments and agencies of a government;
simply by virtue of their normal dealings with an entity (even though they may affect the
freedom of action of an entity or participate in its decision-making process); and
(d) A customer, supplier, franchisor, distributor, or general agent with whom an entity transacts a
significant volume of business, simply by virtue of the resulting economic dependence.
2.3 Disclosure
IAS 24 requires an entity to disclose the following:
(a) The name of its parent and, if different, the ultimate controlling party irrespective of
whether there have been any transactions.
(b) Total key management personnel compensation (broken down by category)
(c) If the entity has had related party transactions:
(i) Nature of the related party relationship
(ii) Information about the transactions and outstanding balances, including
commitments and bad and doubtful debts necessary for users to understand
the potential effect of the relationship on the financial statements
No disclosure is required of intragroup related party transactions in the consolidated financial
statements.
Items of a similar nature may be disclosed in aggregate except where separate disclosure is
necessary for understanding purposes.
Stakeholder perspective
IFRS Practice Statement 2 Making Materiality Judgements makes it clear that disclosure is not
Stakeholder
perspective required if the information provided by that disclosure is not material. That is, it will not influence
the decisions made by primary users on the basis of information provided in the financial statements.
Determining whether information is material involves judgement. Practice Statement 2 provides
guidance for preparers of financial statements in making this judgement, which includes assessing
both quantitative and qualitative factors and the interaction between them.
This guidance is applicable to all IFRS Standards, including those that provide a list of 'minimum
disclosures', such as IAS 24. See Chapter 20 for further details and examples.
28
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
TT2020
29
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b) On 1 July 20X9, RP sold a wholly owned subsidiary, X, a limited company, to Z, a public
limited company. During the year RP supplied X with second-hand office equipment and X
leased its factory from RP. The transactions were all contracted for at market rates.
(c) The post-employment benefit plan of RP is managed by another merchant bank. An investment
manager of the RP post-employment benefit plan is also a non-executive director of the RP
Group and received an annual fee for his services of $25,000. RP pays $16 million per
annum into the plan and occasionally transfers assets into the plan. In 20X9, property, plant
and equipment of $10 million were transferred into the plan and a recharge of administrative
costs of $3 million was made.
Solution
Accounting policies: The specific principles, bases, conventions, rules and practices applied by
an entity in preparing and presenting financial statements (IAS 8: para. 5).
Key term
An entity should select its accounting policies by applying the relevant IFRS (IAS 8: para. 7). Some
standards permit a choice of accounting policies (eg cost and revaluation models). If there is no
IFRS Standard covering a specific transaction or condition, management should use judgement to
develop an accounting policy, giving consideration to (IAS 8: para. 10):
1. IFRS Standards dealing with similar and related issues;
2. The Conceptual Framework definitions of elements of the financial statements and recognition
criteria; and
30
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
3. The most recent pronouncements of other national GAAPs based on a similar conceptual
framework and accepted industry practice (providing the treatment does not conflict with
extant IFRS Standards or the Conceptual Framework).
A change in accounting policy is only permitted if the change (IAS 8: para. 14):
Is required by an IFRS; or
Results in financial statements providing reliable and more relevant information.
A change in accounting policy should be accounted for retrospectively (unless the transitional
provisions of an IFRS Standard specify otherwise):
Adjust the opening balance of each affected component of equity
Restate comparatives
Prior period errors: Omissions from, and misstatements in, the entity's financial statements for one or
more prior periods arising from a failure to use, or misuse of, reliable information that:
Key term
(a) Was available when the financial statements for those periods were authorised for issue; and
(b) Could reasonably be expected to have been obtained and taken into account in the
preparation and presentation of those financial statements. (IAS 8: para. 5)
TT2020
31
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.4 Creative accounting
While still following IFRS, there is scope in choice of accounting policy and use of judgement in
accounting estimates to select the accounting treatment that presents the financial statements in the best
light rather than focusing on the most relevant and reliable accounting policy or estimate.
Timing of transactions may be delayed/speeded up to improve results
Profit smoothing through choice of accounting policy eg inventory valuation
Classification of items eg expenses versus non-current assets
Revenue recognition policies eg through adopting an aggressive accounting policy of
early recognition
When the directors select and adopt the accounting policies and estimates of an entity, they need to
apply the principles in ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct.
3.5.1 Background
The IFRS Interpretations Committee considers issues raised by stakeholders relating to the application
of IFRS Standards. After considering an issue, the IFRS Interpretations Committee often publishes an
'agenda decision' with explanatory material regarding the issue.
The aim of the explanatory material is to facilitate consistency in the application of an IFRS. As
agenda decisions are not authoritative, entities are not required to change their accounting
policies in response, but can do so voluntarily.
3.5.2 Amendment
IAS 8 currently specifies that a change in accounting policy should be applied retrospectively, as if it
had always been in place, except where it is impracticable to do so. Retrospective application can
be a time-consuming and difficult task. Therefore to encourage voluntary changes in accounting
policy as a result of an agenda decision, the IASB proposes that retrospective application need
not be applied, subject to a cost-benefit analysis.
Therefore, for a change in accounting policy due to an agenda decision, if the cost of retrospective
application outweighs the benefit, the new policy must be applied prospectively.
3.5.3 Issues
Potential issues with the proposed amendments include the following.
(a) Although agenda decisions have non-mandatory status, in practice they are treated as
mandatory. Many securities regulators view an accounting policy which is not in agreement
with an agenda decision as no longer acceptable. The proposed amendments may
exacerbate this situation.
(b) A fundamental issue with agenda decisions is that they are viewed as immediately effective.
This presents significant problems if an agenda decision is published close to an entity's
reporting date. The proposed amendments do not address this issue.
(c) There is no conceptual basis for treating voluntary changes in accounting policy resulting from
agenda decisions differently to other voluntary changes in accounting policy.
(d) Conducting a cost-benefit analysis is potentially as onerous as applying an accounting policy
retrospectively and is inherently subjective.
32
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
A common view among stakeholders* in responding to the ED is that instead of amending IAS 8, the
IASB should address the underlying issue of the status and effective date of agenda
decisions.
*See IFRS.org Exposure Draft and comment letters – Accounting policy changes (IAS 8)
Ethics note
This chapter introduced the concept of ethical principles and illustrated some of the ethical dilemmas
you could come across in your exam and in practice. You are likely to meet ethics in the context of
manipulation of financial statements. Whereas in this chapter the issues were mainly limited to topics
you have covered in your earlier studies, you will come across ethical issues in connection with more
advanced topics, such as foreign subsidiaries.
The common thread running through each ethical dilemma is generally that someone with power, for
example a company director, wants you to deviate from IFRS in order to present the financial
statements in a more favourable light. The answer will always be that this should be resisted, but in
each case, it must be argued with reference to the detail of the IFRS in question, not just in terms of
general principles.
TT2020
33
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
34
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
Related parties
TT2020
35
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors
36
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2: Professional and ethical duty of the accountant
Knowledge diagnostic
TT2020
37
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the questions below from the Further question practice bank.
Q2 Fundamental Principles
Q3 Ace
Further reading
The CPD section of the ACCA website contains articles relating to topics in this chapter which you should
read:
Finding the ethics path through the digital jungle (October 2017)
A look at the standards for transactions with related parties (July 2016)
www.accaglobal.com
38
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Revenue
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the five step model relating to revenue earned from a contract C1(b)
with a customer.
Discuss and apply the recognition and measurement of revenue including C1(d)
performance obligations satisfied over time, sale with a right of return, warranties,
variable consideration, principal versus agent considerations and non-refundable
upfront fees.
Exam context
You have seen IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers in Financial Reporting; however, it
will be examined in more depth in SBR. Questions on IFRS 15 will require application of your
knowledge to the scenario. Very few marks, if any, will be available for stating knowledge without
application.
TT2020
39
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Revenue
40
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
Income: Increases in economic benefits during the accounting period in the form of inflows or
enhancements of assets or decreases of liabilities that result in an increase in equity, other than those
Key terms
relating to contributions from equity participants.
Revenue: Income arising in the course of an entity's ordinary activities.
Contract: An agreement between two or more parties that creates enforceable rights and
obligations.
Contract asset: An entity's right to consideration in exchange for goods or services that the entity
has transferred to a customer when that right is conditioned on something other than the passage of
time (for example the entity's future performance).
Receivable: An entity's right to consideration that is unconditional – ie only the passage of time is
required before payment is due.
Contract liability: An entity's obligation to transfer goods or services to a customer for which the
entity has received consideration (or the amount is due) from the customer.
Customer: A party that has contracted with an entity to obtain goods or services that are an output
of the entity's ordinary activities in exchange for consideration.
Performance obligation: A promise in a contract with a customer to transfer to the customer
either:
(a) A good or service (or a bundle of goods or services) that is distinct; or
(b) A series of distinct goods or services that are substantially the same and that have the same
pattern of transfer to the customer.
Stand-alone selling price: The price at which an entity would sell a promised good or service
separately to a customer.
Transaction price: The amount of consideration to which an entity expects to be entitled in
exchange for transferring promised goods or services to a customer, excluding amounts collected on
behalf of third parties.
(IFRS 15: Appendix A)
TT2020
41
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.3 Approach to revenue recognition
The approach to recognising revenue in IFRS 15 can be summarised in five steps.
5 Recognise revenue when (or as) the performance obligations are satisfied
42
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
TT2020
43
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.5 Identify performance obligations
At contract inception, an entity should assess the goods and services promised in a contract with a
customer and should identify as a performance obligation each promise to transfer to the
customer either (para. 22):
A good or service (or a bundle of goods or services) that is distinct (ie the customer can
benefit from good or service on its own or together with other readily available resources and
the entity's promise is separately identifiable from other promises in the contract); or
A series of distinct goods or services that are substantially the same and that have the
same pattern of transfer to the customer.
If a promised good or service is not distinct, an entity should combine that good or service with other
promised goods and services until it identifies a bundle of goods or services that is distinct (para. 30).
Illustration 1
Identifying separate performance obligations
Office Solutions, a limited company, has developed a communications software package called
CommSoft. Office Solutions has entered into a contract with Logisticity to supply the following:
(a) Licence to use CommSoft
(b) Installation service – this may require an upgrade to the computer operating system, but the
software package does not need to be customised
(c) Technical support for three years
(d) Three years of updates for CommSoft
Office Solutions is not the only company able to install CommSoft, and the technical support can also
be provided by other companies. The software can function without the updates and technical
support.
Required
Explain whether the goods or services provided to Logisticity are distinct in accordance with IFRS 15.
Solution
CommSoft was delivered before the other goods or services and remains functional without the
updates and the technical support. It may be concluded that Logisticity can benefit from each of the
goods and services either on their own or together with the other goods and services that are readily
available.
The promises to transfer each good and service to the customer are separately identifiable. In
particular, the installation service does not significantly modify the software itself and, as such, the
software and the installation service are separate outputs promised by Office Solutions rather than
inputs used to produce a combined output.
In conclusion, the goods and services are distinct and amount to four performance obligations in the
contract under IFRS 15, and revenue from each would be recognised as each performance
obligation is satisfied.
44
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
Note. You should assume that both contracts meet the requirements in IFRS 15 for the revenue
recognition model to be applied.
TT2020
45
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
Illustration 1
Allocating transaction price to multiple deliverables
A company sells a car including servicing for two years for $21,000. The car is sold without
servicing for $20,520 and annual servicing is sold for $540.
Required
How is the transaction price split over the different performance obligations?
Ignore discounting.
Solution
Performance obligation Stand-alone selling price % of total Revenue allocated
Car $20,520 95% $19,950 (21,000 × 95%)
Servicing ($540 × 2) $1,080 5% $1,050 (21,000 × 5%)
Total $21,600 100% $21,000
46
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
TT2020
47
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
48
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
1.11 Presentation
When either party to a contract has performed, an entity shall present the contract in the statement of
financial position as a contract asset (eg if entity transfers goods or services before customer pays)
or as a contract liability (eg if customer pays before entity transfers goods or services) (para. 105).
Any unconditional rights to consideration should be shown separately as a receivable (para. 105).
Principal versus If the entity controls the specified goods or service before transfer to a
agent customer, it is a principal (para. B35)
Revenue = gross amount of consideration
If the entity arranges for goods or services to be provided by
the other party, it is an agent (para. B36)
Revenue = fee or commission
Indicators that an entity controls the goods or services before transfer and
therefore is a principal include (para. B37):
(a) The entity is primarily responsible for fulfilling the promise to provide
the specified good or service;
(b) The entity has inventory risk; and
(c) The entity has discretion in establishing the price for the specified
good or service.
TT2020
49
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 3
Principal vs agent considerations
(This example is adapted from IFRS 15: illustrative example 45.)
Fancy Goods Co (FG) operates a website that enables customers to purchase goods from a range of
suppliers. The suppliers set the price that is to be charged and deliver directly to the customers, who
have paid in advance. FG's website facilitates payment by customers and the entity is entitled to
commission of 5% of the sales price.
FG has no further obligation to the customer after arranging for the products to be supplied.
Required
Discuss whether FG is a principal or an agent.
Solution
The following points are relevant:
The supplier is primarily responsible for fulfilling a customer order rather than FG; FG is not
obliged to provide goods if the supplier fails to deliver to the customer.
FG does not have inventory risk at any time, as it does not deal with inventories at all.
FG does not establish prices.
FG is therefore acting as an agent and should recognise revenue equal to the amounts received as
commission.
50
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
Ethics note
Ethics is a key aspect of the syllabus for this exam. Ethical issues will always be examined in the
second question of Section A of the exam. Therefore you need to be alert to any threats to the
fundamental principles of ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct when approaching every question.
For example, pressure to achieve a particular revenue figure could lead to deliberate attempts to
manipulate revenue by:
Recognising revenue too early, eg by recognising revenue over time when it should be
recognised at a point in time
Recognising deposits from customers as revenue when they are not entitled to until the related
performance obligation is satisfied
Recognising revenue from sales with a right of return before the right of return has expired
Recognising gross revenue rather than commission when acting as an agent
Sales contracts can be complex. Time pressure and/or lack of training and experience could
therefore lead to errors in the accounting.
TT2020
51
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Revenue
(1) Identify contract with customer • Sale with right of return – recognise revenue for
Contract = an agreement that creates amount of consideration that entity expects to be
enforceable rights and obligations entitled to (exclude goods expected to be
(2) Identify performance obligation(s) returned), a refund liability and an asset for right
For distinct goods or services (ie can benefit on to recover products on settling refund liability
own or with other readily available resources) • Warranties:
(3) Determine transaction price (1) Treat as separate performance obligation if
Amount to which entity expects to customer has option to purchase warranty
be entitled separately
– Discount to PV (not required if < 1 year) (2) Account for warranty in accordance with IAS 37
– Include variable consideration if highly probable if customer does not have option to purchase
significant reversal will not arise warranty separately
(probability-weighted expected value or most (3) If warranty provides customer with service in
likely amount) addition to complying with specifications,
(4) Allocate transaction price to performance promised service is a performance obligation
obligations • Principal versus agent
Based on stand-alone selling prices (1) If entity controls goods or service before
(5) Recognise revenue when (or as) performance transfer to customer, entity = principal (revenue
obligation satisfied = gross amount of consideration)
When good/service transferred (= when/as (2) If entity arranges for goods or services to be
customer obtains control) provided by another party, entity = agent
↓ (revenue = fee or commission)
• Satisfaction of a performance obligation over time: • Non-refundable fees – if it is an advance payment
(a) The customer simultaneously receives for future goods and services, recognise revenue
and consumes the benefits provided; or when future goods and
(b) The performance creates/enhances an asset
that the customer controls as it is
created/enhanced; or
(c) The performance does not create an
asset with an alternative use and the entity has
an enforceable right to payment for
performance completed.
• Satisfaction of a performance obligation at a point
in time:
– Indicators of transfer of control of an asset:
(a) Entity has a present right to payment
(b) Customer has legal title to the asset
(c) Entity has transferred physical possession
(d) Customer has the significant risks and
rewards of ownership
(e) The customer has accepted the asset
↓
• Incremental costs of obtaining a contract:
– Recognised as asset if expected to be recovered
• Costs to fulfil a contract:
– Recognised as an asset and amortised if costs:
◦ Can be specifically identified;
◦ Generate/enhance resources used to satisfy
performance obligation; and
◦ Are expected to be recovered.
52
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3: Revenue
Knowledge diagnostic
TT2020
53
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q1 Revenue Recognition
Further reading
You should make time to read the following articles which were written by a member of the SBR
examining team. They are available in the study support resources section of the ACCA website:
Revenue revisited – Parts 1 and 2
www.accaglobal.com
54
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Non-current assets
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the accounting treatment of investment properties including C2(c)
classification, recognition, measurement and change of use.
Discuss and apply the accounting treatment of intangible assets including the C2(d)
criteria for recognition and measurement subsequent to acquisition.
Discuss and apply the accounting treatment for borrowing costs. C2(e)
Discuss and apply the definitions of 'fair value' measurement and 'active C9(a)
market'.
Discuss and apply the principles of highest and best use, most advantageous C9(c)
and principal market.
Explain the circumstances where an entity may use a valuation technique. C9(d)
Discuss and apply the accounting for, and disclosure of, government grants and C11(a)
other forms of government assistance.
Discuss and apply the principles behind the initial recognition and subsequent C11(b)
measurement of a biological asset or agricultural produce.
Exam context
Non-current assets could be tested in any part of the SBR exam. This chapter builds on the
knowledge of the standards relevant to non-current assets that you have already seen in your earlier
studies. However, questions on non-current assets in the SBR exam will be much more challenging
than those seen in your earlier studies and you will need to think critically and in-depth about the
application of the standards to the scenario.
TT2020
55
Non-current assets
56
(a) Held by an entity for use in the production or supply of goods or services, for rental to others,
or for administrative purposes
(b) Expected to be used during more than one period
1.1 Recognition
Recognition depends on two criteria (IAS 16: para. 7):
(a) It is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the entity
(b) The cost of the item can be measured reliably
These recognition criteria apply to subsequent expenditure as well as costs incurred initially.
IAS 16 provides additional guidance as follows (IAS 16: paras. 12–14):
• Smaller items such as tools may be classified as consumables and expensed rather than
capitalised. Where they are capitalised, they are usually aggregated and treated as one.
• Large and complex assets should be broken down into composite parts and each
depreciated separately, if the parts have differing patterns of benefits and the cost of
each is significant. Expenditure to renew individual parts can then be capitalised.
TT2020 57
Cost model Carry asset at cost less depreciation and any accumulated impairment
losses
Revaluation model Carry asset at revalued amount, ie fair value less subsequent
accumulated depreciation and any accumulated impairment losses
1.4 Revaluations
If the revaluation model is applied (IAS 16: para. 36):
(a) Revaluations must be carried out regularly, depending on volatility.
(b) The asset should be revalued to fair value, using the fair value hierarchy in IFRS 13.
(c) If one asset is revalued, so must be the whole of the rest of the class of assets at the same time.
(d) An increase in value is credited to other comprehensive income (OCI) (and the revaluation
surplus in equity).
(e) A decrease is an expense in profit or loss after cancelling a previous revaluation surplus.
1.5 Depreciation
An item of property, plant or equipment should be depreciated (IAS 16: para. 42).
(a) Depreciation is based on the carrying amount in the statement of financial position. It must be
determined separately for each significant part of an item.
(b) Excess over historical cost depreciation can be transferred to realised earnings through
reserves.
58
(c) The residual value and useful life of an asset, as well as the depreciation method, must be
reviewed at least at each financial year end. Changes are treated as changes in accounting
estimates and are accounted for prospectively as adjustments to future depreciation.
(d) Depreciation of an item does not cease when it becomes temporarily idle or is retired from
active use and held for disposal, unless it is classified as held for sale under IFRS 5.
1.6 Derecognition
An item of PPE should be derecognised on disposal of the item or when no future economic benefits
are expected from its use or disposal.
Essential reading
See Chapter 4 section 1 of the Essential Reading, available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of
the Workbook, for further discussion of the requirements in IAS 16 relating to componentisation and
reconditioning of assets.
2.1 Scope
IAS 36 applies to impairment of all assets other than (IAS 36: para. 2):
Inventories
Deferred tax assets
Employee benefit assets
Financial assets
Investment property held under the fair value model
Biological assets held at fair value less costs to sell
Non-current assets held for sale
TT2020 59
External Internal
(a) Observable indications that the (a) Evidence of obsolescence or
asset's value has declined during physical damage
the period significantly more than
(b) Significant changes with an
expected due to the passage of
adverse effect on the entity*:
time or normal use
(i) The asset becomes idle
(b) Significant changes with an
adverse effect on the entity in the (ii) Plans to
technological or market discontinue/restructure the
environment, or in the economic or operation to which the asset
legal environment belongs
(c) Increased market interest rates or (iii) Plans to dispose of an asset
other market rates of return before the previously
affecting discount rates and thus expected date
reducing value in use (iv) Reassessing an asset's useful
(d) Carrying amount of net assets of life as finite rather than
the entity exceeds market indefinite
capitalisation. (c) Internal evidence available that
asset performance will be worse
than expected
*Once the asset meets the criteria to be classified as 'held for sale', it is excluded from the scope of
IAS 36 and accounted for under IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations.
Annual impairment tests, irrespective of whether there are indications of impairment, are
required for:
Intangible assets with an indefinite useful life/not yet available for use
Goodwill acquired in a business combination.
Recoverable Amount
= Higher of
If the carrying amount of an asset is higher than its recoverable amount, the asset is impaired and
should be written down to its recoverable amount. The difference between the carrying amount of the
impaired asset and its recoverable amount is known as an impairment loss.
60
Illustration 1
Impairment loss
A company that extracts natural gas and oil has a drilling platform in the Caspian Sea.
The company is carrying out an exercise to establish whether there has been an impairment of the
platform.
(a) Its carrying amount in the statement of financial position is $3 million.
(b) The company has received an offer of $2.8 million for the platform from another oil company.
(c) The present value of the estimated cash flows from the platform's continued use is $2.7 million.
Required
What should be the carrying amount of the drilling platform in the statement of financial position,
and what, if anything, is the impairment loss?
Solution
The carrying amount should be reduced to $2.8 million.
Fair value less costs of disposal = $2.8m
Value in use = $2.7m
Recoverable amount = Higher of these two amounts, ie $2.8m
Carrying amount = $3m
Impairment loss = $0.2m
Fair value less costs of disposal: The price that would be received to sell the asset in an
Key term
orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (IFRS 13 definition of fair
value), less the direct incremental costs attributable to the disposal of the asset (IAS 36:
para. 6).
Examples of costs of disposal are legal costs, stamp duty and similar transaction taxes, costs of
removing the asset, and direct incremental costs to bring an asset into condition for its sale. They
exclude finance costs and income tax expense.
Value in use of an asset: Measured as the present value of estimated future cash flows (inflows
Key term
minus outflows) generated by the asset, including its estimated net disposal value (if any) at the end
of its expected useful life. (IAS 36: para. 6)
Cash flow projections are based on the most recent management-approved budgets/forecasts. They
should cover a maximum period of five years, unless a longer period can be justified. (IAS 36:
paras. 33–35).
The cash flows should include (IAS 36: para. 50):
(a) Projections of cash inflows from continuing use of the asset
(b) Projections of cash outflows necessarily incurred to generate the cash inflows from continuing
use of the asset
(c) Net cash flows, if any, for the disposal of the asset at the end of its useful life
(d) Future overheads that can be directly attributed, or allocated on a reasonable and consistent
basis
TT2020 61
Cash-generating unit: The smallest identifiable group of assets that generates cash inflows that
Key term
are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or groups of assets (IAS 36: para. 6).
Illustration 2
Allocating goodwill to CGUs
Goodwill on P Goodwill on
acquisition acquisition
= $60m = $50m
'Group of
S1 S2 CGUs'
62
On acquisition of S2, the nature of the CGUs and their risks is different such that the goodwill cannot
be allocated on a non-arbitrary basis. Instead, it is allocated to the group of CGUs to which it relates
and is tested for impairment as part of that group of CGUs (here, S2).
The amount of the impairment loss that would otherwise have been allocated to the asset is allocated
to the other assets on a pro rata basis. It is usually assumed that current assets are already stated at
their recoverable amount.
TT2020 63
The Satchell Group is made up of two cash-generating units (as a result of a combination of various
past 100% acquisitions), plus a head office, which was not allocated to any given cash-generating
unit as it supports both divisions.
Due to falling sales as a result of an economic crisis, an impairment test was conducted at the year
end. The consolidated statement of financial position showed the following net assets at that date.
The recoverable amounts (including net current assets) at the year end were as follows:
$m
Division A 1,000
Division B 720
Group as a whole 1,825 (including head office PPE at fair value less costs of disposal
of $85m)
The recoverable amounts of the two divisions were based on value in use. The fair value less costs of
disposal of any individual item was substantially below this.
Required
Discuss, with suitable computations showing the allocation of any impairment losses, the accounting
treatment of the impairment test. Use the proforma below to help you with your answer.
Solution
Discussion:
64
Workings
Carrying amount
Recoverable amount
Impairment loss
Allocated to:
Goodwill
Other assets in the scope of IAS 36
Recoverable amount
Impairment loss
Allocated to:
Unallocated goodwill
TT2020 65
However, the carrying amount of an asset is not increased above the lower of (para. 117):
The reversal is recognised in profit or loss, except where reversing a loss recognised on assets
carried at revalued amounts, which are treated in accordance with the applicable IFRS.
For example, an impairment loss reversal on revalued property, plant and equipment reverses the
loss recorded in profit or loss and any remainder is credited to OCI (reinstating the revaluation
surplus) (IAS 36: para. 120).
2.10.1 Goodwill
Once recognised, impairment losses on goodwill are not reversed (para. 124).
It applies to all IFRS Standards where a fair value measurement is required except (para. 6):
Fair value: The price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an
Key term
orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. (IFRS 13: para 9)
Fair value measurements are based on an asset or a liability's unit of account, which is specified
by each IFRS where a fair value measurement is required. For most assets and liabilities, the unit of
account is the individual asset or liability, but in some instances may be a group of assets or
liabilities (para. 13).
Illustration 3
Fair value
A premium or discount on a large holding of the same shares (because the market's normal daily
trading volume is not sufficient to absorb the quantity held by the entity) is not considered when
measuring fair value: the quoted price per share in an active market is used.
However, a control premium is considered when measuring the fair value of a controlling interest,
because the unit of account is the controlling interest. Similarly, any non-controlling interest discount
is considered where measuring a non-controlling interest.
66
3.1 Measurement
Fair value is a market-based measure, not an entity-specific one. Therefore, valuation
techniques used to measure fair value maximise the use of relevant observable inputs and minimise
the use of unobservable inputs.
To increase consistency and compatibility in fair value measurements and related disclosures,
IFRS 13 establishes a fair value hierarchy that categorises the inputs to valuation
techniques into three levels:
Level 1 inputs Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities
that the entity can access at the measurement date (IFRS 13: para. 76).
Level 2 inputs Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable
for the asset or liability, either directly (ie prices) or indirectly (ie derived
from prices). For example quoted prices for similar assets in active markets
or for identical or similar assets in non-active markets or use of quoted
interest rates for valuation purposes (IFRS 13: para. 81–82).
Level 3 inputs Unobservable inputs for the asset or liability, eg discounting estimates of
future cash flows (IFRS 13: para. 86).
Level 3 inputs are only used where relevant observable inputs are not
available or where the entity determines that transaction price or quoted
price does not represent fair value.
Active market: A market in which transactions for the asset or liability take place with sufficient
Key term
frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis. (IFRS 13: Appendix A)
A fair value measurement assumes that the transaction takes place either:
The fair value should be measured using the assumptions that market participants would
use when pricing the asset or liability, assuming that market participants act in their best economic
interest.
Illustration 4
TT2020 67
The fair value of the asset is therefore $48 per item, ie the price after taking into account transport
costs in the principal market for the asset.
If, however, neither market were the principal market, the fair value would be measured
using the price in the most advantageous market. The most advantageous market is the
European market after considering both transaction and transport costs ($47 in European market v
$46 in the North American market) and so the fair value measure would be $50 per item (as fair
value is measured before transaction costs).
For non-financial assets, the fair value measurement is the value for using the asset in its
highest and best use (the use that would maximise its value) or by selling it to another market
participant that would use it in its highest and best use (IFRS 13: paras. 27–29).
The highest and best use of a non-financial asset takes into account the use that is physically
possible, legally permissible and financially feasible.
Illustration 5
The local government zoning rules also now permit construction of residential properties in this area,
subject to planning permission being granted. Apartment buildings have recently been constructed in
the area with the support of the local government.
The fair value of the land is $28 million ($30m – $2m) as this is its highest and best use because
market participants would take into account the site's development potential when pricing the land.
The measurement of the fair value of a liability assumes that the liability remains
outstanding and the market participant transferee would be required to fulfil the obligation, rather
than it being extinguished (IFRS 13: para. 34). The fair value of a liability also reflects the effect of
non-performance risk (the risk that an entity will not fulfil an obligation), which includes, but may
not be limited to, an entity's own credit risk (ie risk of non-payment) (IFRS 13: para. 42).
68
Third party contractors typically add a 20% mark-up in the industry and expect a premium of 5% of
the expected cash flows (after including the effect of inflation) to take into account risk that cash flows
may be more than expected.
Inflation is expected to be 3% annually on average over the ten years.
The risk-free interest rate for a ten year maturity is 4%.
An appropriate adjustment to the risk-free rate for Energy Co's non-performance risk is 2% (giving an
entity-specific discount rate of 4% + 2% = 6%).
Calculation of the fair value of the decommissioning liability:
$m
Expected cash flow [(6 × 40%) + (8 × 50%) + (10 × 10%)] 7.400
Third party contractor mark-up (7.4 × 20%) 1.480
8.880
Inflation adjustment ((8.88 × 1.0310) – 8.88) 3.054
11.934
Risk premium (11.934 × 5%) 0.597
12.531
Fair value (present value of expected cash flow
adjusted for market risk 12.531 × 1/1.0610) 6.997
TT2020 69
Intangible asset: An identifiable non-monetary asset without physical substance. The asset
Key term
must be:
(a) It is separable; or
(b) It arises from contractual/legal rights.
4.1 Recognition
Recognition depends on two criteria (IAS 38: para. 18):
(a) It is probable that future economic benefits that are attributable to the asset will flow to the
entity.
(b) The cost of the asset can be measured reliably.
Acquired as Internally
Internally generated Acquired by
Separate part of a
generated intangible government
acquisition business
goodwill asset grant
combination
Cost, which is Fair value as per Not recognised Recognised when Asset and grant
purchase price IFRS 3 Business 'PIRATE' criteria at fair value, or
Combinations met (see section nominal amount
4.3) plus expenditure
directly attributable
to preparation for use
70
Similarly, start-up, training, advertising, promotional, relocation and reorganisation costs are all
recognised as expenses.
Cost model Carry asset at cost less accumulated amortisation and impairment losses
(para. 74)
Revaluation model Carry asset at revalued amount, fair value amount less subsequent
accumulated amortisation and impairment losses (para. 75)
(a) Fair value must be able to be measured reliably with reference to an active market.
(b) The entire class of intangible assets of that type must be revalued at the same time.
(c) If an intangible asset in a class of revalued intangible assets cannot be revalued because there
is no active market for this asset, the asset should be carried at its cost less any
accumulated amortisation and impairment losses.
(d) Revaluations should be made with such regularity that the carrying amount does not differ
from that which would be determined using fair value at the year end.
TT2020 71
4.5 Amortisation
An intangible asset with a finite useful life should be amortised over its expected useful life.
(a) The depreciable amount (cost/revalued amount – residual value) is allocated on a systematic
basis over the useful life.
(b) The residual value is normally assumed to be zero.
(c) Amortisation begins when the asset is available for use (ie when it is in the location and
condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management).
(d) The useful life and amortisation method must be reviewed at least at each financial year
end and adjusted where necessary.
An intangible asset with an indefinite useful life should not be amortised. IAS 36 requires
that such an asset is tested for impairment at least annually.
Essential reading
For further detail on acceptable amortisation methods, refer to Chapter 4 section 2.1 of the Essential
Reading. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
4.6 Disclosure
The disclosure requirements in IAS 38 are extensive. They include a reconciliation of the carrying
amount of intangible assets at the beginning and end of the reporting period, the amortisation
methods used for assets with a finite useful life, the amount of research and development recognised
as an expense and a description areas of judgement such as the reasons supporting the assessment
of indefinite useful lives.
Stakeholder perspective
Intangible assets can be a significant balance in the statement of financial position of some entities,
Stakeholder
perspective particularly for those entities that have undertaken a business combination. Disclosure is therefore
very important. However, entities often fail to give adequate disclosure making it difficult, for
example, to assess from the entity's disclosed accounting policies how research has been
distinguished from development expenditure and how the capitalisation criteria for development have
been applied. This issue here is not that the requirements in IAS 38 are lacking, but that some
preparers of financial statements are not appropriately applying those requirements.
Investment property: Property (land or building – or part of a building – or both) held (by the
Key term
owner or by the lessee as a right-of-use asset) to earn rentals or for capital appreciation or
both, rather than for:
(a) Use in the production or supply of goods or services or for administrative purposes; or
(b) Sale in the ordinary course of business. (IAS 40: para 5)
72
The following are not investment property (IAS 40: para. 9):
(a) Property held for sale in the ordinary course of business or in the process of construction or
development for such sale
(b) Owner-occupied property, including property held for future use as owner-occupied property,
property held for future development and subsequent use as owner-occupied property,
property occupied by employees and owner-occupied property awaiting disposal
(c) Property leased to another entity under a finance lease
5.1 Recognition
Investment property is recognised when it is probable that future economic benefits will flow to the
entity and the cost can be measured reliably.
Fair value model Any change in fair value reported in profit or loss, not depreciated
Cost model As cost model of IAS 16 – unless held for sale (IFRS 5) or leased
(IFRS 16)
A change in use occurs when the property meets, or ceases to meet, the definition of investment
property and there is evidence of the change in use (IAS 40: para. 57). For example, owner
occupation commences so the investment property will be treated under IAS 16 as an
owner-occupied property.
In isolation, a change in management's intentions for the use of a property does not provide
evidence of a change in use (IAS 40: para. 57).
TT2020 73
5.5 Disposals
Any gain or loss on disposal of investment property is the difference between the net disposal
proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset. It should be recognised as income or expense
in profit or loss (unless IFRS 16 requires otherwise on a sale and leaseback).
Tutorial note
IAS 20 Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance is a fairly
straightforward standard that you have seen before. The main points are summarised below.
(a) Grants are not recognised until there is reasonable assurance that the conditions will be
complied with and the grant will be received (IAS 20: para. 7).
(b) Government grants are recognised in profit or loss so as to match them with the related costs
they are intended to compensate on a systematic basis (IAS 20: para. 12).
(c) Government grants relating to assets can be presented either as deferred income or by
deducting the grant in calculating the carrying amount of the asset (IAS 20:
para. 25).
(d) Grants relating to income may either be shown separately or as part of 'other income' or
alternatively deducted from the related expense (IAS 20: para. 29).
(e) A government grant that becomes repayable is accounted for as a change in accounting
estimate in accordance with IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and
Errors (IAS 20: para. 32).
(i) Repayments of grants relating to income are applied first against any unamortised
deferred credit and then in profit or loss.
(ii) Repayments of grants relating to assets are recorded by increasing the carrying amount
of the asset or reducing the deferred income balance. Any resultant cumulative extra
depreciation is recognised in profit or loss immediately.
74
A qualifying asset is one that necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its
intended use or sale (IAS 23: para. 5).
IAS 41 IAS 2
Time
Biological transformation
Planting/ Harvest/ Sale
birth slaughter
Bearer plants, which are plants that are used to grow crops but are not themselves consumed (eg
grapevines), are excluded from the scope of IAS 41. Instead they are accounted for under IAS 16
using either the cost or revaluation model.
TT2020 75
8.1 Recognition
As with other non-financial assets under the Conceptual Framework, a biological asset or agricultural
produce is recognised when (IAS 41: para. 10):
8.2 Measurement
Biological assets are measured both on initial recognition and at the end of each reporting period
at fair value less costs to sell (IAS 41: para. 12).
Agricultural produce at the point of harvest is also measured at fair value less costs to
sell (IAS 41: para. 13).
The fair value less costs to sell of agricultural produce harvested becomes its cost under IAS 2. After
harvest, the agricultural produce is measured at the lower of cost and net realisable value in
accordance with IAS 2.
Changes in fair value less costs to sell are recognised in profit or loss (IAS 41: para. 26).
Where fair value cannot be measured reliably, biological assets are measured at cost less
accumulated depreciation and impairment losses (IAS 41: para. 30).
Ethics note
Ethics will feature in Question 2 of every SBR exam. Make sure you are alert to threats to the
fundamental principles of ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct when approaching this question.
For the topics covered in this chapter, ethical issues could arise through, for example, deliberate
attempts to improve profits through:
Incorrect capitalisation of development expenditure when it does not meet the IAS 38 criteria
in order to reduce development costs charged to profit or loss
Incorrect capitalisation of more interest than permitted by IAS 23 in order to reduce finance costs
Time pressure at the year end or inexperience/lack of training of the reporting accountant could lead
to errors when complex procedures are required, for example in testing CGUs for impairment, or
where significant judgement is required, for example in the capitalisation of intangible assets.
76
Performance objective 7 of the PER requires you to demonstrate that you can contribute to the
PER alert
drafting or reviewing of primary financial statements according to accounting standards and
legislation. The Standards covered in this chapter will help you to do this for a business's non-current
assets.
TT2020 77
Non-current assets
• Tangible items: held for use in • External impairment indicators • 'The price that would be
production/supply of goods or – Significant fall in market received to sell an asset or paid
services, for rental to others, or value to transfer a liability in an
for administrative purposes – Significant external adverse orderly transaction between
and are expected to be used changes market participants at the
during more than one period – Increase in market interest measurement date'
• Recognise when: rates • Fair value is after transport
– Probable that future – Net assets > market costs, but before transaction
economic benefits will flow capitalisation costs
to the entity • Internal impairment indicators • Market-based measure (ie
– The cost of the asset can be – Obsolescence/damage use assumptions market
measured reliably – Significant internal adverse participants would use), not
• Initial recognition at cost changes entity specific
– Components of assets: – Performance worse than • Hierarchy for inputs to
recognised separately if expected valuation techniques:
expected to generate • Impairment loss where: (1) Unadjusted quoted prices
different patterns of benefits recoverable amount (RA) < (active market) for identical
• Subsequent measurement, carrying amount items
choice of • RA = higher of: (2) Inputs other than quoted
– Cost model: Cost less FV less costs Value in use prices that can be
accumulated depreciation/ of disposal CF DF PV observed directly (prices)
impairment losses 1/ or indirectly (derived
X (1+r) X
from prices)
– Revaluation model: Revalued X 1/(1+r)2 X
amount less subsequent (3) Unobservable inputs
etc
accumulated depreciation/ X • Multiple markets, use FV in:
impairment losses (entire (1) Principal market (if there
class), fair value (FV) (using • CGUs: is one)
FV hierarchy in IFRS 13) (1) Test individual CGUs (2) Most advantageous market
– Depreciate on systematic (2) Test group of CGUs (ie the best one after both
basis over useful life including: transaction and transport
– Review useful – Unallocated goodwill costs)
life/depreciation – Unallocated corporate • Non-financial assets: highest
method/residual value at assets and best use that is physically
least each year end Imp
possible, legally permissible
– Impairment: charge first to Before loss After
and financially feasible
OCI (for any revaluation Goodwill X (X) X • FV of a liability (example):
surplus) then profit or loss Other assets X (X) After
X
Expected value of cash flows
(P/L) X (X) X
Third-party contractor
– Exchanges of items of PPE − mark-up X
measured at fair value
X
Inflation adjustment X
X
flows) X
X
Discount to PV X
78
TT2020 79
80
Knowledge diagnostic
Property, plant and equipment can be accounted for under the cost model (depreciated) or
revaluation model (depreciated revalued amounts, gains recognised in other
comprehensive income).
Impairment losses occur where the carrying amount of an asset is above its recoverable
amount.
Impairment losses are charged first to other comprehensive income (re any revaluation
surplus relating to the asset) and then to profit or loss.
Where cash flows cannot be measured separately, the impairment losses are calculated by
reference to the cash-generating unit. Resulting impairment losses are allocated first
against any goodwill and then pro-rata to other assets.
IFRS 13 treats all assets, liabilities and an entity's own equity instruments in a
consistent way. A fair value hierarchy is used to establish fair value, using observable
inputs as far as possible as fair value is a market-based measure.
Intangible assets can also be accounted for under the cost model or revaluation model,
but only intangibles with an active market can be revalued.
Intangible assets are amortised over their useful lives (normally to a zero residual value)
unless they have an indefinite useful life (annual impairment tests required).
Investment property can be accounted for under the cost model or the fair value model
(not depreciated, gains and losses recognised in profit or loss).
Borrowing costs relating to qualifying assets (those which necessarily take a substantial
period of time to be ready for use/sale) must be capitalised. This includes both specific and
general borrowings of the company.
Biological assets and agricultural produce at the point of harvest are measured at fair value
less costs to sell, with changes reported in profit or loss.
TT2020 81
Question practice
Now try the questions below from the Further question practice bank:
Q4 Camel Telecom
Q5 Acquirer
Q6 Lambda
Q7 Kalesh
Q8 Burdock
Q9 Epsilon
Q10 Zenzi
Further reading
There are articles on the ACCA website, written by the SBR examining team, which are relevant to the
topics studied in this chapter and which you should read:
82
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the accounting treatment of short-term and long-term employee C5(a)
benefits and defined contribution and defined benefit plans.
Account for the 'Asset Ceiling' test and the reporting of actuarial (remeasurement) C5(c)
gains and losses.
Discuss the impact of current issues in corporate reporting. The following F1(c)
examples are relevant to the current syllabus:
4. Defined benefit plan amendments, curtailment or settlement
Exam context
Employee benefits include short-term benefits such as salaries, and long-term benefits such as
pensions. This topic is not covered in Financial Reporting and so will be new to you at this level.
In the SBR exam, employee benefits could feature in any section, and may be a whole or part-
question.
TT2020
83
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
84
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
1 Short-term benefits
1.1 Introduction to employee benefits
Employee
benefits
IAS 19 Employee Benefits covers four distinct types of employee benefit. However, only short-term
and post-employment benefits are examinable.
Accounting for short-term employee benefit costs tends to be quite straightforward, because
they are simply recognised as an expense in the employer's financial statements of the current
period. Accounting for the cost of deferred employee benefits is much more difficult because of
the large amounts involved, as well as the long timescale, complicated estimates and uncertainties.
Employee benefits: All forms of consideration given by an entity in exchange for service
rendered by employees or for the termination of employment.
Key terms
Short-term benefits: Employee benefits (other than termination benefits) that are expected to be
settled wholly before 12 months after the end of the annual reporting period in which the employees
render the related service.
(IAS 19: para. 8)
TT2020
85
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Non-accumulating paid absences
Non-accumulating absences cannot be carried forward (eg maternity leave or military service).
Therefore they are only recognised as an expense when the absence occurs (IAS 19: para. 11).
86
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Illustration 1
Profit-sharing plan
Mooro Co runs a profit sharing plan under which it pays 3% of its net profit for the year to its
employees if none have left during the year. Mooro Co estimates that this will be reduced by staff
turnover to 2.5% in 20X9.
Required
Which costs should be recognised by Mooro Co for the profit share?
Solution
Mooro Co should recognise a liability and an expense of 2.5% of net profit.
Post-employment
benefits
Final salary
Eg annual pension = × years worked
60
Future pension depends on final salary and years worked
The accounting for the two different types of plan are very different. It is important that you decide on
the nature of the plan before attempting to account for it.
TT2020
87
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
A pension plan will normally be held in a form of trust separate from the sponsoring employer. Although
the directors of the sponsoring company may also be trustees of the pension plan, the sponsoring
company and the pension plan are separate legal entities that are accounted for separately.
Sponsoring
employer
Pays contributions
Pensioners
Essential reading
See Chapter 5 section 1 of the Essential Reading for a further exploration of the conceptual differences
between defined contribution and defined benefit plans, further definitions, and for a discussion of
multi-employer plans. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
88
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Required
Calculate the total profit or loss expense for post-employment benefits for the year and the accrual
which will appear in the statement of financial position at 31 December 20X9.
Solution
Defined benefit plans: Post-employment benefit plans other than defined contribution plans.
(IAS 19: para. 8)
Key term
3.1 Introduction
Typically, a separate plan is established into which the company makes regular payments, as
advised by an actuary. This fund needs to ensure that it has enough assets to pay future pensions to
pensioners. The entity records the pension plan assets (at fair value) and liabilities (at present value)
in its own books as it bears the pension plan's risks and benefits, so in substance, if not in legal form,
it owns the assets and owes the liabilities.
3.2 Complexity
Accounting for defined benefit plans is much more complex than for defined contribution plans
because:
(a) The future benefits (arising from employee service in the current or prior years) cannot be
measured exactly, but whatever they are, the employer will have to pay them, and the liability
should therefore be recognised now. To measure these future obligations, it is necessary to use
actuarial assumptions.
(b) The obligations payable in future years should be valued, by discounting, on a present value
basis. This is because the obligations may be settled in many years' time.
(c) If actuarial assumptions change, the amount of required contributions to the fund will change,
and there may be actuarial (remeasurement) gains or losses. A contribution into a fund in any
period will not equal the expense for that period, due to remeasurement gains or losses.
TT2020
89
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.3.2 Actuarial assumptions
Actuarial assumptions are needed to estimate the size of the future (post-employment)
benefits that will be payable under a defined benefits scheme. The main categories of actuarial
assumptions are:
Demographic assumptions, eg mortality rates before and after retirement, the rate of
employee turnover, early retirement
Financial assumptions, eg future salary rises
Actuarial assumptions made should be unbiased and based on market expectations.
(IAS 19: paras. 75–76)
3.3.3 Discounting – current service cost
The benefits earned must be discounted to arrive at the present value of the defined benefit
obligation. The increase during the year in this obligation is called the current service cost which is
shown as an expense in profit or loss.
In effect, the current service cost is the increase in total pensions payable as a result of continuing to
employ your staff for another year.
The discount rate used is determined by reference to market yields at the end of the reporting
period on high quality corporate bonds (or government bonds for currencies for which no deep
market in high quality corporate bonds exists). The term of the bonds should be consistent with that of
the post-employment benefit obligations.
(IAS 19: para. 120)
3.3.4 Compounding – interest cost
The obligation must be compounded back up each year reflecting the fact that the benefits are
one period closer to settlement. This increase in the obligation is called interest cost and is also
shown as an expense in profit or loss.
Discount
Current Increase in
service cost annual pension
Service
performed DEBIT Current service cost (P/L) payments
CREDIT Present value of obligation
Year
Now Retirement Death
end
Compound:
90
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
TT2020
91
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.5 Past service cost
Past service cost is the increase or decrease in the present value of the defined benefit obligation for
employee service in prior periods, resulting from:
(a) A plan amendment (the introduction or withdrawal of, or changes to, a defined benefit
plan); or
(b) A curtailment (a significant reduction by the entity in the number of employees covered by
the plan).
Past service cost is recognised as an adjustment to the obligation and as an expense (or income) at
the earlier of the following dates:
(a) When the plan amendment or curtailment occurs; or
(b) When the entity recognises related restructuring costs (in accordance with IAS 37) or
termination benefits. (IAS 19: para. 99)
For example:
(a) An amendment is made to the plan which improves benefits for plan members.
An increase to the obligation (and expense) is recognised when the amendment occurs:
(b) Discontinuance of an operation, so that employees' services are terminated earlier than
expected.
A reduction in the obligation (and income) is recognised at the same time as the termination
benefits are recognised:
Item Recognition
92
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Item Recognition
Contributions
Into the plan by the company DEBIT Plan assets (SOFP)
As advised by actuary CREDIT Company cash
Remeasurements
Arising from annual valuations of obligation
and assets
On obligation, differences between actuarial Recognise all changes due to
assumptions and actual experience during the remeasurements in other comprehensive
period, or changes in actuarial assumptions income
On assets, differences between actual return on
plan assets and amounts included in net
interest
TT2020
93
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 2
Defined benefit plan
Angus operates a defined benefit scheme for its employees but has yet to record anything for the
current year except to expense the cash contributions which were $18 million. The opening position
was a net liability of $45 million which is included in the non-current liabilities of Angus in its draft
financial statements. Current service costs for the year were $15 million and interest rates on good
quality corporate bonds fell from 8% at the start of the year to 6% by 31 March 20X8. In addition,
a payment of $9 million was made out of the cash of the pension scheme in relation to employees
who left the scheme. The reduction in the pension scheme liability as a result of the curtailment
was $12 million. The actuary has assessed that the scheme is in deficit by $51 million as at
31 March 20X8.
Required
Calculate the gain/loss on remeasurement of the defined benefit pension net liability of Angus as at
31 March 20X8, and state how this should be treated.
Solution
The loss on remeasurement is calculated as $8.4 million (W) and should be recognised in other
comprehensive income for the year.
Working: Net liability
$m
Opening net liability 45.0
Net interest cost ($45m × 8%) 3.6
Current service cost 15.0
Gain on curtailment ($12m – $9m) (3.0)
Cash contributions into the scheme (18.0)
42.6
Loss on remeasurement ( ) 8.4
Closing net liability 51.0
94
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Required
Prepare the required notes to the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income and
statement of financial position for the year ended 31 December 20X7.
Assume the contributions and benefits were paid on 31 December 20X7.
Solution
Notes to the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
Defined benefit expense recognised in profit or loss
$m
Current service cost
Past service cost
Net interest costs
Other comprehensive income (items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss):
Remeasurements of defined benefit plans
$m
Remeasurement gain/(loss) on defined benefit obligation
Return on plan assets (excluding amounts in net interest)
TT2020
95
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Changes in the fair value of plan assets
$m
Opening fair value of plan assets
Essential reading
Although questions frequently ask you to assume that contributions and benefits are paid at the year
end, this is not invariably the case. See Chapter 5 section 3 of the Essential Reading for a
comprehensive example in which contributions are paid at the start of the period and benefits paid
in two instalments across the period. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the
Workbook.
3.7 Settlements
A settlement is a transaction that eliminates all further legal or constructive obligations
for part or all of the benefits provided under a defined benefit plan (other than a payment of benefits
to, or on behalf of, employees that is set out in the terms of the plan and included in the actuarial
assumptions).
Example: a lump-sum cash payment made in exchange for rights to receive post-employment
benefits.
The gain or loss on a settlement is recognised in profit or loss when the settlement occurs (IAS
19: para. 99):
Essential reading
See Chapter 5 section 2 of the Essential Reading for an illustration of the asset ceiling test. This is
available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
96
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
3.9 Disclosure
IAS 19 requires risk-based disclosures, including detail on investments, future cash requirements
and information about risks to which the plan exposes the company (paras. 135–147).
The IAS 19 disclosure requirements are generally seen as an opportunity for entities to explain their
pension plan risks and, crucially, how such risks are being managed.
The entity should:
Explain the characteristics of, and risks associated with, the entity's defined benefit plans,
focusing on unusual, entity-specific or plan-specific risks, or risks that arise from a
concentration of investments in one particular area (para. 139);
Identify and explain the amounts in the entity's financial statements arising from its defined
benefit plans (paras. 141–144); and
Explain how the defined benefit plans may affect the entity's future cash flows, including a
sensitivity analysis which shows the potential impact of changes in actuarial assumptions.
Disclosure is required as to the funding arrangements and commitments from the company to
make contributions to the plan (paras. 145–147).
Possible risks to which a defined benefit pension plan exposes an entity include:
Investment risk
Interest risk
Salary risk
Longevity risk (this is the risk that pensioners might live longer on average than anticipated,
and therefore the cost to the entity of providing the pension is higher than expected)
As with all disclosure, there needs to be a balance between providing enough relevant information to allow
users to understand the risks, without disclosing so much information that they cannot see what is relevant.
Stakeholder perspective
Investors need to understand the risks associated with an entity's defined benefit plans and how the
Stakeholder entity is managing those risks so the potential effect on future cash flows can be assessed. Sensitivity
perspective
analysis is fundamentally important to this understanding.
The extract below shows the sensitivity analysis provided by ITV plc in a previous annual report (ITV,
p136). ITV plc has explained the reason for performing the sensitivity analysis using simple terms.
This explanation is not required under IFRS, but would be useful to users in understanding the
information presented.
TT2020
97
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exercise 1: Pension disclosure
The financial statements of Sainsbury's plc include disclosures relating to its defined benefit
obligation. Sainsbury's is a listed company in the UK which has been subject to media attention in
respect of its significant pension deficit.
Take a look at the pension disclosure in Sainsbury's Annual Report available at:
www.about.sainsburys.co.uk/investors
Then, using companies that you are familiar with, research the pension disclosures given in their
financial statements.
98
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Ethics note
In general, the ethical dilemmas that are likely to be tested in the Strategic Business Reporting (SBR)
exam occur in the context of manipulation of financial statements, with someone in authority, such as
a managing director, wishing to present the financial statements in a more favourable light.
The SBR exam will be the first time you will be tested on employee benefits. It could form the basis of
part of an ethical question. One area such a question might focus on could be the difference
between defined benefit and defined contribution pension plans. The main difference between the
two types of plans lies in who bears the risk: if the employer bears the risk, even in a small way by
guaranteeing or specifying the return, the plan is a defined benefit plan. A defined contribution
scheme must give a benefit formula based solely on the amount of the contributions, and therefore no
guarantee is offered by the employer.
A defined benefit scheme may be created even if there is no legal obligation, if an employer has a
practice of guaranteeing the benefits payable.
There could, in consequence, be an incentive for a company director to argue that a plan is a
defined contribution plan, especially where the legal position is in conflict with the substance. That
way, assets and liabilities are not shown in the statement of financial position, and in particular, a
net liability, which could affect loan covenants, is not shown.
TT2020
99
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
• Recognised as a liability as employee renders • An entity pays fixed contributions into a separate
service (ie accruals basis) entity (a fund) and will have no legal or constructive
• Not discounted obligation to pay further contributions if the fund
• Accrue for short-term compensated absences (eg does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee
holiday pay) that can be carried benefits relating to employee service in the current
or prior periods
• Company's only obligation is agreed contribution,
eg 5% × salary
• Accounted for on accruals basis
100
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Short-term benefits
Short-term benefits are accounted for on an accruals basis and not discounted.
Post-employment benefits are arrangements that provide for pensions on retirement.
They can be divided into defined contribution and defined benefit plans.
2. Defined contribution plans
Also known as 'money purchase' schemes. The employer accounts for the agreed cost to
the company on an accruals basis. The employee bears the risk of the pension's value.
3. Defined benefit plans
Also known as 'final salary' schemes. The employer guarantees the employee an annual
pension based on final salary and number of years worked.
The projected unit credit method is used to accrue costs. These include current
service cost and net interest cost (or income) on the net defined benefit liability (or
asset). Remeasurement differences between the year-end values of the assets and
obligation and the book amounts are recognised in other comprehensive income.
Past service costs on plan amendments or curtailments are recognised in profit or
loss.
The effects of settlements are recognised in profit or loss.
'Asset ceiling' test: Defined benefit pension assets are limited to the lower of the net
defined benefit asset (FV of plan assets less PV of obligation) and the present value of any
refunds/contribution reductions available.
Risk-based disclosure is required: explain risks and how they are being managed.
4. Criticisms of IAS 19 and current developments
Several issues exist with IAS 19 including: not all plans fit easily into the definitions of
defined benefit/defined contribution, the projected unit credit method required by IAS 19
arguably does not comply with the Conceptual Framework, and criticism over the use of
P/L vs OCI.
IAS 19 was amended in 2018 to clarify that when the net defined benefit liability/asset is
remeasured as a result of a plan amendment, curtailment or settlement, updated actuarial
assumptions should be used to determine current service cost and net interest for the
remainder of the reporting period.
TT2020
101
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q11 Radost
Further reading
There are articles on the CPD section of the ACCA website, written by the SBR examining team, which are
relevant to the topics studied in this chapter and which you should read:
Pension posers (2015)
IAS 19 Employee Benefits (2010)
www.accaglobal.com
102
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 1
Approaching ethical issues
aging information
Man
aging information
Man
An
sw
er
Approaching pl
t
en
manag ime
an
em
financial
t
nin
Approaching Exam Success Skills
Good
uirereq rpretation
Specific SBR Skills
e m e nts
Applying good
req of rprineteation
consolidation
Creating effective techniques
m eunirts
discussion
Eff d p
of t inteect
an
Interpreting
e c re
c rr
r re Co
e
ti v
financial statements
se w ri
nt tin
ati g
Co
on
l
Efficient numerica
analysis
Introduction
Section A of the Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam will consist of two scenario based
questions that will total 50 marks. The second of these questions will require candidates to
consider the reporting implications and the ethical implications of specific events in a given
scenario.
Given that ethics will feature in every exam, it is essential that you have mastered the
appropriate technique for approaching ethical issues in order to maximise your marks in the
exam.
As a reminder, the detailed syllabus learning outcomes for ethics are:
A Fundamental ethical and professional principles
1. Professional behaviour and compliance with accounting standards
2. Ethical requirements of corporate reporting and the consequences of unethical behaviours
TT2020
103
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1: Approaching ethical issues
STEP 1:
Look at the mark allocation of the question
and work out how many minutes you have to
answer the question (based on 1.95 minutes
a mark).
STEP 2:
Read the requirement and analyse it. Highlight
each sub-requirement separately, identify the verb(s)
and ask yourself what each sub-requirement means.
STEP 3:
Read the scenario, asking yourself for each
paragraph which IFRS Standards may be relevant
and whether the proposed accounting treatment
complies with IFRS Standard. Identify which
fundamental principles from the ACCA Code of
Ethics and Conduct (the ACCA Code) are relevant
and whether there are any threats to these
principles.
STEP 4:
Prepare an answer plan using key words from the
requirements as headings. You could use a mind
map, a bullet-pointed list or simply annotate the
question. Try and come up with separate points for
each paragraph in the scenario. Make sure you
generate enough points for the marks available –
the ACCA marking guides typically allocate 1 mark
per relevant well-explained point.
STEP 5:
Write up your answer using key words from the
requirements as headings. Create a separate sub-
heading for each key paragraph in the scenario.
Write in full sentences and clearly explain each
point.
104
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
TT2020
105
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skill Activity
STEP 1 Look at the mark allocation of the following question and work out
how many minutes you have to answer the question. It is a 20 mark
question and at 1.95 minutes a mark, it should take 39 minutes. On
the basis of spending approximately a third to a quarter of your time
reading and planning, this time should be split approximately as
follows:
Reading the question – 5 minutes
Planning your answer – 5 minutes
Writing up your answer – 29 minutes
Within each of these phases, your time should be split roughly equally
between the two sub-requirements (ethical implications and accounting
implications).
Required
Discuss the ethical and accounting implications of the above situations from the
perspective of the Finance Director. (18 marks)
STEP 2 Read the requirement for the following question and analyse it.
Highlight each sub-requirement, identify the verb(s) and ask yourself
what each sub-requirement means.
Required
Discuss the ethical and accounting implications of the above situations from the
perspective of the Finance Director. (20 marks)
Note whose
viewpoint your
answer should be
from
Your verb is 'discuss'. This is defined by the ACCA as 'Consider and debate/argue
about the pros and cons of an issue. Examine in detail by using arguments in favour or
against'.
106
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
Ethical implications
Consider the ACCA Code. The fundamental principle of professional
competence is going to be the most important in an SBR question because
an ACCA accountant must prepare financial statements in accordance with
IFRS Standards. Therefore, if the accountant is associated with any
accounting treatment that does not comply with IFRS Standards, they will be
breaching the principle of professional competence. Other fundamental
principles may also be relevant (objectivity, integrity, confidentiality,
professional behaviour). Watch out for threats in the questions to any of
these principles. Reminders of these threats have been included below:
TT2020
107
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Threat Explanation
108
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
Range has two main revenue streams. Firstly, the company earns
When is the
revenue from the sale of office furniture to corporate performance
obligation satisfied?
clients. Secondly, the company offers an installation service in (Accounting)
exchange for a fee. The Managing Director would like to revise the
Recognise revenue revenue recognition policy so that revenue is recognised when the
and profit earlier.
(Accounting and customer signs the contract rather than on delivery and over the
Ethics)
period of installation of the furniture respectively.
Finally, the Managing Director has noticed that in the past year,
Does this evidence
there has been a decrease in the percentage of furniture support the proposed
change? (Accounting
returned by customers for repair under warranty. He would and Ethics)
IAS 37 Provisions,
Contingent Liabilities like to reduce the provision for warranties in the forthcoming year.
and Contingent Assets
(Accounting)
As the Managing Director was leaving the meeting, he mentioned to
the Finance Director that now he had reached the age of 65, he
would like to retire and sell the business in one year's time.
Required
Incentive to change
accounting policies and
estimates to increase Discuss the ethical and accounting implications of the above situations
profits and maximise the
price he could sell his from the perspective of the Finance Director. (18 marks)
shares for on retirement
(Ethics)
Professional marks will be awarded in this question for the application
of ethical principles. (2 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
TT2020
109
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
STEP 4 Prepare an answer plan using key words from the requirements as
headings (accounting implications). You could use a mind map
similar to the one shown below. Alternatively you could use a
bullet-pointed list or simply annotate the question.
Try and come up with separate points for each of the three
proposed changes in accounting policies or estimates in the
scenario.
Make sure you generate enough points for the marks available –
there are 18 marks available, so on the basis of 1 mark per
relevant well-explained point, to achieve a comfortable pass, you
should aim to generate 14–15 points for this 18-mark question.
Accounting
implications
110
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
Ethical
implications
STEP 5 Write up your answer using key words from the requirements as
headings. Create a separate sub-heading for each key paragraph
in the scenario. Write in full sentences and clearly explain each
point, ensuring that you use professional language. For the
accounting implications, structure your answer for each of the three
items as follows:
Rule/principle per IFRS Standard (state very briefly as it is
unlikely that marks will be awarded for this)
Apply rule/principle to the scenario (correct accounting
treatment and why)
Conclude
For the ethical implications, take the following approach:
Should the FD accept the proposed change? Why/why not?
Would the change result in a breach of any of the ethical
principles? If so, which and why?
Are there any additional threats to the ethical principles?
What action should the FD take next?
From the point of view of
the Finance Director as
this was asked for in the
Suggested solution requirement.
Make sure you write in As an ACCA qualified accountant, the Finance Director (FD) is bound
full sentences. This will
help you to obtain the by the ACCA Code of Ethics and Conduct (the ACCA Code). This
two professional skills With the verb ‘discuss' in
marks. means adhering to its fundamental principles, one of which is the requirement, it is
useful to have a short
professional competence. This requires the FD to ensure the accounts opening paragraph
explaining the basis of
comply with IFRS Standards. Therefore, the FD should only accept the your discussion.
TT2020
111
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
In ethics questions, you
should also look out for
The FD should also be aware of threats to the ACCA Code's threats to the ACCA
Code's fundamental
fundamental principles. Here the self-interest threat is that the principles in the scenario
and mention them in your
Managing Director (MD) wishes to retire and sell his shares in one answer.
A change in accounting estimate is only required when changes occur State relevant
rule/principle from
in the circumstances on which the estimate was based or as a result of IAS or IFRS very briefly
(you do not need to
new information or more experience. state IAS/IFRS number)
Apply rule/principle
Extending the useful life of manufacturing machinery to scenario.
IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment requires the useful life of an
asset to be reviewed at least each financial year end, and, if
Rule/principle
expectations differ from previous estimates, the change should be
accounted for prospectively as a change in accounting estimate.
The MD wishes to double the useful life of the machinery. This would
Apply reduce the amount of depreciation charged each year on machinery
significantly, thereby increasing profit.
However, there does not appear to be any evidence that the useful life
of machinery should be increased given there have been minimal
Apply profits or losses on disposal in the past which suggests that the current
useful life of five years is appropriate. If the useful life of the
machinery were underestimated to the extent the MD is suggesting,
this would have resulted in substantial profits on disposal.
The useful life of the machinery should remain at five years in the
Conclude with your
absence of any evidence to suggest that its utility to Range will
opinion
increase to 10 years.
112
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
Conclude with your recognise it when the customer signs the contract would contravene
opinion
IFRS 15 and not be permitted.
It is worth noting that the MD's proposed changes would both result in
earlier recognition of revenue and therefore profit.
TT2020
113
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
estimate, a provision should be made for the best estimate of the
expenditure required to settle the obligation.
Ethical implications
In ethics questions, you There are possible advocacy and intimidation threats here if the FD
should also look out for
threats to the ACCA feels pressured to act in the MD's best interests. There is also a
Code's fundamental
principles in the familiarity threat if the FD were inclined to accept the changes out of
scenario and mention
them in your answer. friendship. Either way, if the FD were to accept the change to the Issues (1)(2): Would
there be a breach of
useful life of the machinery and the change in revenue recognition, any ethical principles?
If so, which and why?
this would be a breach of the ACCA Code's fundamental principles of
professional competence (due to non-compliance with IFRS),
objectivity (giving in to pressure from the FD) and integrity (if they did
so knowingly, with the sole motivation of maximising the exit price for
the MD).
Issue (3): Should the FD The proposed decrease in the warranty provision appears potentially
accept the proposed
change? justifiable due to the decrease in furniture returned under warranty.
Why/why not?
However, if on further investigation there is insufficient evidence to
Issue (3): Would there
be a breach of any
justify the decrease in provision and the sole motivation is to boost
ethical principles? If so,
which and why?
profits and maximise the MD's exit price, this change would not be
permitted.
114
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
TT2020
115
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam success skills diagnostic
Every time you complete a question, use the diagnostic below to assess how effectively you
demonstrated the exam success skills in answering the question. The table has been
completed below for the Range activity to give you an idea of how to complete the
diagnostic.
Managing information Did you identify the relevant IFRS Standard for each
proposed change in accounting policy or estimate?
Did you spot that the Finance Director is ACCA qualified so
is bound by the ACCA's Code but the Managing Director is
unlikely to have detailed knowledge of accounting
standards?
Did you identify the threat to the ACCA Code's ethical
principles in the scenario from the Managing Director
planning to retire and sell his shares in one year's time?
Correct interpretation Did you understand what was meant by the verb 'discuss'?
of requirements
Did you spot the two sub-requirements (ethical implications
and accounting implications)?
Did you understand what each sub-requirement meant?
Answer planning Did you draw up an answer plan using your preferred
approach (eg mind map, bullet-pointed list or annotated
question paper)?
Did your plan address both the ethical and accounting
implications?
Did your plan address each of the three proposed changes
to accounting policies and estimates in the question?
116
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 1
Effective writing and Did you use underlined headings (key words from
presentation requirements) and sub-headings (one for each proposed
change in accounting policy or estimate)?
Did you address both sub-requirements and all three
proposed changes in accounting policy or estimate?
Did you use full sentences?
Summary
In the SBR exam, the ethical issues will typically be closely linked with accounting
issues – whether following a certain accounting treatment would have any ethical
implications. Remember that an ACCA accountant must demonstrate the fundamental
principle of professional competence through financial statements that comply with
IFRS Standards. Therefore, the first step in a question is to consider whether the
accounting treatment in the scenario complies with IFRS Standards and, if not, identify
what the ethical implications may be by identifying the relevant ethical principles and
any threats to them. Your answer should conclude with practical advice on next steps
to be taken by the individual concerned.
TT2020
117
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
118
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Provisions, contingencies
and events after the
reporting period
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the recognition, de-recognition and measurement of provisions, C7(a)
contingent liabilities and contingent assets including environmental provisions and
restructuring provisions.
Discuss and apply the accounting for events after the reporting date. C7(b)
Exam context
This chapter is almost entirely revision as you have encountered provisions and events after the
reporting period in Financial Reporting. However, both topics are highly examinable, and questions
are likely to be more technically challenging than those you met in Financial Reporting.
In the SBR exam, both topics are likely to feature as parts of questions, rather than as a whole
question itself. For example, in Section A, you may be required to spot that an issue has occurred
after the reporting date, and then work out the effect of the issue on the financial statements. You also
need to be able to discuss the consistency of IAS 37 with the Conceptual Framework.
TT2020
119
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
120
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6: Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period
1.1 Recognition
A provision is recognised when (IAS 37: para. 14):
(a) An entity has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event;
(b) It is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be
required to settle the obligation; and
(c) A reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.
Illustration 1
Transfer of economic benefits
If a company has entered into a warranty obligation then the probability of an outflow of resources
embodying economic benefits (transfer of economic benefits) may well be extremely small in respect
of one specific item. However, when considering the population as a whole the probability of some
transfer of economic benefits is quite likely to be much higher. If there is a greater than 50%
probability of some transfer of economic benefits then a provision should be made for the
expected amount.
TT2020
121
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.2 Measurement
1.2.1 General rule
The amount recognised is the best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the present
obligation at the end of the reporting period (IAS 37: para. 36).
1.3 Reimbursements
Some or all of the expenditure needed to settle a provision may be expected to be recovered from a
third party, eg an insurer. This reimbursement should be recognised only when it is virtually
certain that reimbursement will be received if the entity settles the obligation (IAS 37: para. 53).
1.5 Derecognition
If it is no longer probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required
to settle the obligation, the provision should be reversed (IAS 37: para. 59).
122
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6: Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period
An example may be a fixed price supply contract related to a particular product that, due to
inflation, now costs more to manufacture than the fixed sale price agreed in the contract.
If an entity has a contract that is onerous, the present obligation under the contract must be
recognised and measured as a provision (IAS 37: para. 66).
A lease agreement that becomes onerous is only within the scope of IAS 37, and therefore results
in the creation of a provision, if simplified accounting is applied, so that no lease liability has been
recognised. This is only the case where a lease is short-term or for an asset with a low value.
2.3 Restructuring
Restructuring is a programme that is planned and is controlled by management and materially
changes either the scope of a business undertaken by an entity, or the manner in which that
business is conducted (IAS 37: para. 10).
Examples of restructuring include (IAS 37: para. 70):
The sale or termination of a line of business
The closure of business locations or the relocation of business activities
Changes in management structure
Fundamental reorganisations that have a material effect on the nature and focus of the entity's
operations
One of the main purposes of IAS 37 was to target abuses of provisions for restructuring by
introducing strict criteria about when such a provision can be made.
A provision for restructuring is recognised only when the entity has a constructive obligation to
restructure. Such an obligation only arises where an entity:
(a) Has a detailed formal plan for the restructuring; and
(b) Has raised a valid expectation in those affected that it will carry out the restructuring by
starting to implement that plan or announcing its main features to those affected by it.
Where the restructuring involves the sale of an operation, no obligation arises until the entity has
entered into a binding sale agreement.
TT2020
123
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.3.1 Restructuring costs
A restructuring provision includes only the direct expenditures arising from the restructuring,
which are those that are both (IAS 37: para. 80):
(a) Necessarily entailed by the restructuring; and
(b) Not associated with the ongoing activities of the entity.
The provision should not include (IAS 37: para. 81):
Retraining or relocating continuing staff
Marketing
Investment in new systems and distribution networks
Activity 1: Restructuring
Trailer, a public limited company, operates in the manufacturing sector. During the year ended
31 May 20X5, Trailer announced two major restructuring plans. The first plan is to reduce its
capacity by the closure of some of its smaller factories, which have already been identified. This will
lead to the redundancy of 500 employees, who have all individually been selected and
communicated with. The costs of this plan are $9 million in redundancy costs, $4 million in retraining
costs and $5 million in lease termination costs. The second plan is to re-organise the finance and
information technology department over a one-year period but it does not commence for two years.
The plan results in 20% of finance staff losing their jobs during the restructuring. The costs of this plan
are $10 million in redundancy costs, $6 million in retraining costs and $7 million in equipment lease
termination costs.
Required
Discuss the treatment of each of the above restructuring plans in the financial statements of Trailer for
the year ended 31 May 20X5.
Solution
124
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6: Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period
31 December 20X3, the estimated cost of the restoration work was $10 million, and this estimate did
not change by 31 December 20X4. An additional cost of $500,000 per annum the quarry is
operated (at 31 December 20X4 prices) will also be incurred at the end of the licence period to
clean up further progressive environmental damage that will arise through the extraction of the
limestone.
An appropriate discount rate reflecting market assessments of the time value of money and risks
specific to the operation is 8%.
Required
Explain the treatment of the cost of the assets and associated obligation relating to the quarry:
(a) As at 31 December 20X3
(b) For the year ended 31 December 20X4
Work to the nearest $1,000.
Solution
TT2020
125
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(i) It is not probable that an outflow of economic benefit will be required to settle the
obligation; or
(ii) The amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability.
(IAS 37: para. 10)
Contingent liabilities should not be recognised in financial statements, but should be disclosed
unless the possibility of an outflow of economic benefits is remote (IAS 37: paras. 27–28).
For each class of contingent liability, an entity must disclose the following (IAS 37: para. 86):
(a) The nature of the contingent liability
(b) An estimate of its financial effect
(c) An indication of the uncertainties relating to the amount or timing of any outflow
(d) The possibility of any reimbursement
A contingent asset should not be recognised, but should be disclosed where an inflow of
economic benefits is probable (IAS 37: para 34).
A brief description of the contingent asset should be provided along with an estimate of its likely
financial effect (IAS 37: para. 89).
Events after the reporting period: Those events, both favourable and unfavourable, that occur
between the year end and the date on which the financial statements are authorised for issue (IAS
Key term
10: para. 3).
126
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6: Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period
5.3 Disclosure
(a) An entity discloses the date when the financial statements were authorised for issue and who
gave the authorisation (IAS 10: para 17).
(b) If non-adjusting events after the reporting period are material, non-disclosure could influence
the decisions of users taken on the basis of the financial statements. Accordingly, the following
is disclosed for each material category of non-adjusting event after the reporting period:
(i) The nature of the event; and
(ii) An estimate of its financial effect, or statement that such an estimate cannot be made.
(IAS 10: para 21)
Ethics note
Ethics will feature in Question 2 of every exam. Therefore you need to be alert to any threats to the
fundamental principles of the ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct when approaching each topic.
For example, pressure to achieve a particular profit figure could lead to deliberate attempts to
manipulate profits through making provisions that are not necessary in years of high profits, in order
to release those provisions in future periods when profits are lower. Although the rules in IAS 37 are
meant to prevent this situation, the Standard is not perfect and manipulation is possible.
Another example that could arise is pressure to obtain financing, which requires the presentation of a
healthy financial position. This could, for example, lead directors to ignore information received after
the reporting date that should result in a write down of receivables.
Performance objective 7 of the PER requires you to review financial statements and account for or
disclose events after the reporting period. The financial reporting requirements for events after the
PER alert
reporting period covered in this chapter will help you with this objective.
128
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6: Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period
Chapter summary
Environmental provisions
• Make a provision where there
is a legal or constructive
obligation to clean up/
decommission
– Provision is discounted to
present value
– DR Asset (depreciate over UL)
CR Provision
• Indication of uncertainties
• Possibility of reimbursement
TT2020
129
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Provisions
Provisions are recognised when the Conceptual Framework definition of a liability and
recognition criteria are met.
2. Specific types of provision
Provisions are not made for future operating losses as there is no obligation to incur
them.
Where a contract is onerous a provision is made for the unavoidable cost. Restructuring
provisions are only recognised when certain criteria are met.
3. Contingent liabilities
Contingent liabilities are not recognised because they are possible rather than present
obligations, the outflow is not probable or the liability cannot be reliably measured.
Contingent liabilities are disclosed.
4. Contingent assets
Contingent assets are disclosed, but only where an inflow of economic benefits is probable.
5. Events after the reporting period (IAS 10)
Adjusting events are adjusted in the financial statements as they provide evidence of
conditions existing at the end of the reporting period.
Non-adjusting events are disclosed if material, as, while important, they do not affect the
financial statement figures.
130
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6: Provisions, contingencies and events after the reporting period
Question practice
Now try the following question from the Further question practice bank:
Q12 Cleanex
Q34 Restructuring
Further reading
There are articles on the CPD section of the ACCA website, which have been written by a member of the
SBR examining team and which you should read:
The shortcomings of IAS 37 (2016)
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
131
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
132
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Income taxes
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the recognition and measurement of deferred tax liabilities and C6(a)
deferred tax assets.
Discuss and apply the recognition of current and deferred tax as income or C6(b)
expense.
Discuss and apply the treatment of deferred taxation on a business combination. C6(c)
Exam context
You have encountered income taxes in your earlier studies in Financial Reporting; however, in SBR,
this topic is examined at a much higher level. Deferred tax is most likely to feature as part of a
consolidation question in Section A, but it could also be tested as a whole question in Section B.
TT2020
133
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Income taxes
134
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
1 Current tax
Current tax: The amount of income taxes payable (or recoverable) in respect of taxable profit (or
loss) for a period. (IAS 12: para. 5)
Key term
Current tax unpaid for current and prior periods is recognised as a liability (IAS 12: para. 12).
Amounts paid in excess of amounts due are shown as an asset (IAS 12: para. 12).
The benefit relating to a tax loss that can be carried back to recover current tax of a previous period
is recognised as an asset (IAS 12: para. 13).
Stakeholder perspective
Tax is a significant cost to businesses, with corporation tax rates of over 30% of profits in some
Stakeholder
perspective
countries. However, the tax expense shown in the financial statements is rarely equal to the current tax
rate applied to accounting profit. Investors need to know why this is the case so that they can
understand historical tax cash flows and liabilities, as well as predict future tax cash flows and
liabilities.
IAS 12 therefore requires entities to explain the relationship between the tax expense and the tax that
would be expected by applying the current tax rate to accounting profit. This explanation can be
presented as a reconciliation of amounts of tax or a reconciliation of the rate of tax, as shown in
Illustration 1 below.
Illustration 1
Extract from Rightmove plc Annual Report December 2018 – note 10: Income tax
expense
TT2020
135
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.1.1 Issue
When a company recognises an asset or liability, it expects to recover or settle the carrying amount
of that asset or liability. In other words, it expects to sell or use up assets, and to pay off liabilities.
What happens if that recovery or settlement is likely to make future tax payments larger (or smaller)
than they would otherwise have been if the recovery or settlement had no tax consequences?
Similarly, some items of income or expense are included in accounting profit in one period, but
included in taxable profit in a different period (IAS 12: para. 17). This is because the accounting
profit is determined by applying the principles of IFRS, whereas taxable profit is determined by
applying the tax rules established by the tax authorities. Without some form of adjustment, this
difference may cause the tax charge in the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive
income to be misleading.
In both of these circumstances, IAS 12 requires companies to recognise a deferred tax liability (or
deferred tax asset) (IAS 12: paras. 15 and 24).
Tax base of an asset or liability: The amount attributed to that asset or liability for tax
purposes. (IAS 12: para. 5)
Key term
Tax payable by an entity is calculated by the tax authorities using a tax computation. A tax
computation is similar to a statement of profit or loss, except that it is constructed using tax rules
instead of IFRS. Now imagine the tax authorities drawing up a statement of financial position for the
same entity, but using tax rules instead of IFRS. In these 'tax accounts', assets and liabilities will be
stated at their carrying amount for tax purposes, which is their tax base.
Different tax jurisdictions may have different tax rules. The tax rules determine the tax base.
136
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
The table below gives some examples of tax rules and the resulting tax base.
Carrying amount
in the statement of Tax base (amount in
Item financial position Tax rule 'tax accounts')
Nil
Remember this is the carrying
Chargeable for tax on a value in the tax accounts. As
cash basis, ie when the cash has not been
Included in financial
received received, the income is not
statements on an
Accrued income yet included in the tax
accruals basis ie when
accounts, so the tax base is
receivable
nil.
Chargeable for tax on
Same as carrying amount in
an accruals basis, ie
statement of financial position
when receivable
Nil
When the cash is For revenue received in
received, it will be advance, the tax base of the
Chargeable for tax on a
Income received in included in the resulting liability is its
cash basis, ie when
advance financial statements as carrying amount, less any
received
deferred income ie a amount of the revenue that
liability will not be taxable in future
periods.
Illustration 2
Concepts underlying deferred tax
Suppose Barton, a supplier of gas and electricity, recorded accrued income of $100,000 in its
financial statements for the year ended 31 December 20X5. The accrued income related to gas and
electricity supplied but not yet invoiced during December 20X5. In January 20X6, Barton invoiced its
customers and was paid $100,000 in relation to the accrued income. In the jurisdiction in which
Barton operates, income is taxed on a cash receipts basis and the rate of tax is 20%.
TT2020
137
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Extracts from Barton's tax computation and financial statements are shown below.
Tax computation
20X5 20X6
$'000 $'000
Income 0 100
Tax payable at 20% 0 (20)
Income is taxed on a cash receipts basis, so there is no tax to pay in 20X5 and $20,000 to pay in
20X6. This creates a mismatch in the financial statements as the income and the related tax payable
are recorded in different periods. To resolve this mismatch, a deferred tax adjustment is calculated
and recorded in the financial statements, as follows.
138
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
TT2020
139
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Deferred tax is the tax attributable to temporary differences.
Temporary differences: Differences between the carrying amount of an asset or liability in the
statement of financial position (eg value from an accounting perspective) and its tax base (eg value
Key term
from a tax perspective). (IAS 12: para. 5)
If an item is never taxable or tax deductible, its tax base is deemed to be its carrying amount so there
is no temporary difference and no related deferred tax.
There are two types of temporary difference (IAS 12: paras. 15, 24).
Financial statements treatment The asset is depreciated over its useful life as per IAS 16 and
is carried at cost less accumulated depreciation.
Tax base Tax written down value = cost – cumulative tax depreciation
140
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Financial statements treatment The accrued income or accrued expense is included in the
financial statements when the item is accrued.
Financial statements treatment A provision is included in the financial statements when the
criteria in IAS 37 are met.
A doubtful debt allowance is recognised in accordance with
IFRS 9.
TT2020
141
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Provisions and allowances for doubtful debts
Illustration 3
Revision of deferred tax
The information given below has been extracted from the financial statements of Carlton at
31 December:
20X2 20X1
$ $
Property, plant and equipment (cost $100,000 on 1 Jan 20X1)
– carrying amount 80,000 90,000
Accrued income 25,000 –
Provision (5,000) –
Profit before depreciation, accrued income and provision 100,000 90,000
20X2 20X1
$ $
Property, plant & equipment – tax written down value 49,000 70,000
The provision is allowed for tax when the associated expense is paid. Tax is charged on the accrued
income when that income is received. The rate of tax is 30%.
Calculation of deferred tax temporary differences and deferred tax liability at
31.12.X2
Accounting Temporary
Item carrying Tax base difference
The tax base
amount
will always be
$ $ $ zero if the item
Property, plant and equipment 80,000 49,000 31,000 is taxed on a
(PPE) cash receipts
Accrued income basis. The tax
25,000 0 25,000
base of PPE is
Provision (5,000) 0 (5,000) its tax written
51,000 down value.
142
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
The deferred tax liability represents net tax that will be payable on these items in the future. The
deferred tax charge to profit or loss for the year ended 31 December 20X2 is the movement on
the deferred tax liability:
$
Deferred tax liability at 31 December 20X1 6,000
Charge to profit or loss 9,300
Deferred tax liability at 31 December 20X2 15,300
Deferred tax assets are only recognised to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be
available against which the deductible temporary difference can be utilised (IAS 12: para. 24).
Deferred tax is recognised in the same section of the statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income as the transaction was recognised (IAS 12: paras. 58, 61a).
Illustration 4
Recognition of deferred tax
Charlton revalued a property from a carrying amount of $2 million to its fair value of $2.5 million
during the reporting period. The property cost $2.2 million and its tax base is $1.8 million. The tax
rate is 30%.
Required
Explain the deferred tax implications of the above information in Charlton's financial statements at
the end of the reporting period.
Solution
The tax base is $1.8 million and the carrying amount is $2.5 million (being the historical carrying
amount of $2 million plus a revaluation surplus of $500,000).
Therefore a taxable temporary difference of $700,000 exists, giving rise to a deferred tax liability of
$210,000 (30% × $700,000).
TT2020
143
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Of the taxable temporary difference:
$200,000 ($2m – $1.8m) arises due to the accelerated tax depreciation granted on the asset;
and
$500,000 arises due to the revaluation.
Therefore deferred tax of $150,000 (30% × $500,000) should be charged to other comprehensive
income, as this is where the revaluation gain is recognised, and the remainder should be charged to
profit or loss.
144
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
4.2 No discounting
Deferred tax assets and liabilities should not be discounted because the complexities and
difficulties involved will affect reliability (IAS 12: paras. 53, 54). Note that this is inconsistent with
IAS 37 which requires discounting if the effect is material.
There are some temporary differences which only arise in a business combination. This is because,
on consolidation, adjustments are made to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities that are not
always reflected in the tax base of those assets and liabilities.
The tax bases of assets and liabilities in the consolidated financial statements are determined by
reference to the applicable tax rules. Usually tax authorities calculate tax on the profits of the
individual entities, so the relevant tax bases to use will be those of the individual entities (IAS 12:
para. 11).
Deferred tax calculation
Carrying amount in
consolidated
$
statement of financial
position
Carrying amount of asset/liability X/(X)
(consolidated statement of financial position)
Tax base depends on tax
Tax base (usually subsidiary's tax base) (X)/X rules. Usually tax is
charged on individual
Temporary difference X/(X) entity profits, not
group profits.
Deferred tax (liability)/asset (X)/X
TT2020
145
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5.1 Fair value adjustments on consolidation
IFRS 3 requires assets acquired and liabilities assumed on acquisition of a subsidiary to be brought
into the consolidated financial statements at their fair value rather than their carrying amount.
However, this change in fair value is not usually reflected in the tax base, and so a temporary
difference arises (IAS 12: para. 19).
The accounting entries to record the resulting deferred tax are:
(a) Deferred tax liability due to fair value gain: reduces the fair value of the net assets of the
subsidiary and therefore increases goodwill:
DEBIT Goodwill X
CREDIT Deferred tax liability X
(b) Deferred tax asset due to fair value loss: increases the fair value of the net assets of the
subsidiary and therefore reduces goodwill:
DEBIT Deferred tax asset X
CREDIT Goodwill X
146
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Illustration 5
Undistributed profits of subsidiary
Carrol has one subsidiary, Anchor. The retained earnings of Anchor at acquisition were $2 million.
The directors of Carrol have decided that over the next three years, they will realise earnings through
future dividend payments from Anchor amounting to $500,000 per year.
Tax is payable on any remittance of dividends and no dividends have been declared for the current
year.
Required
Discuss the deferred tax implications of the above information for the Carrol Group.
Solution
Deferred tax should be recognised on the unremitted earnings of subsidiaries unless the parent is
able to control the timing of dividend payments and it is unlikely that dividends will be paid for the
foreseeable future. Carrol controls the dividend policy of Anchor and this means that there would
normally be no need to recognise a deferred tax liability in respect of unremitted profits. However,
the profits of Anchor will be distributed to Carrol over the next few years and tax will be payable on
the dividends received. Therefore a deferred tax liability should be shown.
TT2020
147
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 6
Unrealised profits on intragroup trading
P sells goods costing $150 to its overseas subsidiary S for $200. At the year end, S still holds the
inventories. In the jurisdictions in which P and S operate, tax is charged on individual entity profits.
P's rate of tax is 40%, whereas S's rate of tax is 50%.
P pays tax of $20 ($50 × 40%) on the profit generated by the sale.
S is entitled to a future tax deduction for the $200 paid for the inventories. The tax base of the
inventories is therefore $200 from S's perspective.
From the perspective of the P group, the profit of $50 generated by the sale is unrealised. In the
consolidated financial statements, the unrealised profit is eliminated, so the carrying amount of the
inventories from the group perspective is $150.
Deferred tax is calculated as:
$
Carrying amount (in the group financial statements) 150
Tax base (cost of inventories to S) (200)
Temporary difference (group unrealised profit) (50)
Deferred tax asset (50 × 50% (S's tax rate)) 25
S's tax rate is used to calculate the deferred tax asset because S will receive the future tax deduction
related to the inventories.
In the consolidated financial statements a deferred tax asset of $25 should be recognised:
DEBIT Deferred tax asset (in consolidated statement of financial position) $25
CREDIT Deferred tax (in consolidated statement of profit or loss) $25
148
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Illustration 7
Gains or losses on financial assets
On 1 October 20X2, Kalle purchased an equity investment for $200,000. Kalle has made the
irrevocable election to carry the investment at fair value through other comprehensive income.
On 30 September 20X3, the fair value of the investment was $240,000. In the tax jurisdiction in
which Kalle operates, unrealised gains and losses arising on the revaluation of investments of this
nature are not taxable unless the investment is sold. The rate of income tax in the jurisdiction in which
Kalle operates is 25%.
Required
Explain how the deferred tax consequences of this transaction would be reported in the financial
statements of Kalle for the year ended 30 September 20X3.
Solution
Since the unrealised fair value gain on the equity investment is not taxable until the investment is sold,
the tax base of the investment is unchanged by the fair value gain and remains as $200,000.
The fair value gain creates a taxable temporary difference of $40,000 (carrying amount $240,000
– tax base $200,000).
This results in a deferred tax liability of $10,000 ($40,000 × 25%).
Because the unrealised gain is reported in other comprehensive income, the related deferred tax
expense is also reported in other comprehensive income.
TT2020
149
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6.2 Unused tax losses and unused tax credits
Tax losses and tax credits may result in a tax saving if they can be carried forward to reduce future
tax payments.
A deferred tax asset is recognised for the carry forward of unused tax losses or credits to the extent
that it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses
and credits can be used (IAS 12: para. 34).
Illustration 8
Tax losses
Lambda, a wholly owned subsidiary of Epsilon, made a loss adjusted for tax purposes of $3 million
in the year ended 31 March 20X4. Lambda is unable to utilise this loss against previous tax liabilities
and local tax legislation does not allow Lambda to transfer the tax loss to other group companies.
Local legislation does allow Lambda to carry the loss forward and utilise it against its own future
taxable profits. The directors of Epsilon do not consider that Lambda will make taxable profits in the
foreseeable future.
Required
Explain the deferred tax implications of the above in the consolidated statement of financial position
of the Epsilon group at 31 March 20X4.
Solution
The tax loss creates a potential deferred tax asset for the Epsilon group since its carrying amount is
nil and its tax base is $3 million.
However, no deferred tax asset can be recognised because there is no prospect of being able to
reduce tax liabilities in the foreseeable future as no taxable profits are anticipated.
150
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Solution
6.4 Leases
Deferred tax related to leases is covered in Chapter 9.
Nyman, a public limited company, has three 100% owned subsidiaries, Glass, Waddesdon, and
Winsten SA, a foreign subsidiary.
(a) The following details relate to Glass:
(i) Nyman acquired its interest in Glass on 1 January 20X3. The fair values of the assets
and liabilities acquired were considered to be equal to their carrying amounts, with the
exception of freehold property which had a fair value of $32 million and a tax base of
$31 million. The directors have no intention of selling the property.
(ii) Glass has sold goods at a price of $6 million to Nyman since acquisition and made
a profit of $2 million on the transaction. The inventories of these goods recorded in
Nyman's statement of financial position at the year-end, 30 September 20X3, was
$3.6 million.
(b) Waddesdon undertakes various projects from debt factoring to investing in property and
commodities. The following details relate to Waddesdon for the year ended 30 September
20X3:
(i) Waddesdon has a portfolio of readily marketable government securities which are held
as current assets for financial trading purposes. These investments are stated at market
value in the statement of financial position with any gain or loss taken to profit or loss.
These gains and losses are taxed when the investments are sold. Currently the
accumulated unrealised gains are $8 million.
(ii) Waddesdon has calculated it requires an allowance for credit losses of $2 million
against its total loan portfolio. Tax relief is available when the specific loan is written
off.
(c) Winsten SA has unremitted earnings of €20 million which would give rise to additional tax
payable of $2 million if remitted to Nyman's tax regime. Nyman intends to leave the earnings
within Winsten for reinvestment.
(d) Nyman has unrelieved trading losses as at 30 September 20X3 of $10 million.
Current tax is calculated based on the individual company's financial statements (adjusted for tax
purposes) in the tax regime in which Nyman operates. Assume an income tax rate of 30% for
Nyman and 25% for its subsidiaries.
TT2020
151
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Required
Explain the deferred tax implications of the above information for the Nyman group of companies for
the year ended 30 September 20X3.
Solution
152
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Background
When an entity first accounts, for example, for a lease transaction, it recognises both an asset (a
right-of-use asset) and a liability (a lease liability). There is no effect on accounting profit or taxable
profit when the lease is first accounted for. Should the entity recognise deferred tax related to this
transaction?
At present, it is not clear in IAS 12 whether or not the initial recognition exemption applies, so
divergence in practice has arisen.
Proposed amendments
The proposed amendments clarify that the recognition exemption does not apply to assets
and liabilities that arise from a single transaction.
Therefore, for a lease, an entity should first assess whether any temporary differences result from the
initial recognition of the right-of-use asset and/or the lease liability. If a temporary difference(s) does
arise, the entity should recognise the associated deferred tax.
The amendments apply to all similar transactions that result in the recognition of an asset and
liability. For example, the initial recognition of a decommissioning liability in which a non-current
asset and an associated decommissioning provision would be recognised.
Ethics note
Ethical issues will feature in Question 2 of every exam. You need to be alert to any threats to the
fundamental principles of ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct when approaching each topic.
Deferred tax is difficult to understand and therefore a threat arises if the reporting accountant is not
adequately trained or experienced in this area. This could result in errors being made in the
recognition or measurement of deferred tax assets or liabilities.
Recognising deferred tax assets for the carry forward of unused tax losses requires judgement of
whether it is probable that future taxable profit will be available for offset. As such, a director under
pressure may be tempted to say that future taxable profits are probable, when in fact they are not, in
order to recognise a deferred tax asset.
Performance objective 7 of the PER requires you to demonstrate that you can contribute to the
drafting or reviewing of primary financial statements according to accounting standards and
PER alert
legislation. This chapter will help you with the drafting and reviewing of the tax aspects of the
financial statements.
TT2020
153
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Income taxes
• DT is recognised for all • Tax rates expected to apply • Fair value adjustments
temporary differences, except when asset realised/liability – DTL on FV increases
(initial recognition exemption): settled, based on tax rates/ (& higher goodwill)
– Initial recognition of goodwill laws: – DTA on FV decreases
– Initial recognition of an asset – Enacted; or (& lower goodwill)
or liability in a transaction – Substantively enacted by • Undistributed profits of
that is end of reporting period subsidiary/associate/joint
(i) Not a business • Cannot be discounted venture
combination, and (inconsistency with IAS 37 – DTL recognised unless:
(ii) At that time, does not which requires discounting if (i) Parent is able to control
affect accounting nor material) timing of reversal, and
taxable profit (ii) Probable will not reverse
• DT recognised in same section in foreseeable future
of SPLOCI as transaction • Unrealised profit on intragroup
trading
– DTA recognised at receiving
company's tax rate
154
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Key
A/c CA = accounting carrying amount
DT = deferred tax
DTA = deferred tax asset
DTL = deferred tax liability
FV = fair value
OCI = other comprehensive income
SOFP = statement of financial position
SPLOCI = statement of profit or loss and
other comprehensive income
Tax WDV = tax written down value
TT2020
155
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Current tax
Current tax is the tax charged by the tax authority.
Unpaid amounts are shown as a liability. Any tax losses that can be carried back
are shown as an asset.
An explanation, in the form of a reconciliation, is required as to the difference
between the expected tax expense and the actual tax expense for the period.
2. Deferred tax principles: revision
Deferred tax is the tax attributable to temporary differences, ie temporary differences
in timing of recognition of income and expense between IFRS accounting and tax
calculations.
They are measured as the difference between the accounting carrying amount of
an asset or liability and its tax base (ie tax value).
Temporary differences are used to measure deferred tax from a statement of financial
position angle (consistent with the Conceptual Framework).
Taxable temporary differences arise where the accounting carrying amount exceeds
the tax base. They result in deferred tax liabilities, representing the fact that current
tax will not be charged until the future, and so an accrual is made.
Deductible temporary differences arise when the accounting carrying amount is less
than the tax base. They result in deferred tax assets, representing the fact that the
tax authorities will only give a tax deduction in the future (eg when a provision is paid). A
deferred tax credit reduces the tax charge as the item has already been deducted for
accounting purposes.
3. Deferred tax: recognition
Deferred tax is provided for under IAS 12 for all temporary differences except those to
which the recognition exemption applies.
Deferred tax is recognised in the same section of statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income as the related transaction.
4. Deferred tax: measurement
Deferred tax = temporary difference × tax rate
The tax rate is that which is expected to apply when the asset is realised or liability
settled (based on rates enacted/substantively enacted by the end of the
reporting period).
5. Deferred tax: group financial statements
In group financial statements, deferred tax may arise on fair value adjustments,
undistributed profits of subsidiaries and unrealised profits.
A deferred tax asset is created for unused tax losses and credits, providing it is probable
that there will be future taxable profit against which they can be used.
6. Deferred tax: other temporary differences
Development costs: tax base is nil if costs are fully tax deductible as incurred
Impairment (and inventory) losses: tax base does not change if loss not tax deductible until
sold
156
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7: Income taxes
Financial assets: if gains or losses are not taxable/deductible until the instrument is sold, a
temporary difference arises
Unused tax losses/credits: deferred tax asset is recognised only if probable future taxable
profit is available for offset.
7. Deferred tax: presentation
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are shown separately from each other (consistent
with the IAS 1 'no offset' principle) unless the entity has a legally enforceable right to
offset current tax assets and liabilities and the deferred tax assets and liabilities relate
to the same taxation authority.
8. Deferred tax: current issues
Proposed amendments to IAS 12 to clarify that the initial recognition exemption in IAS 12
does not apply to assets and liabilities arising from a single transaction (eg leases,
decommissioning liabilities).
TT2020
157
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q12 DT Group
Further reading
There are articles in the CPD section of the ACCA website, written by the SBR examining team, which are
relevant to the topics studied in this chapter:
IAS 12 Income Taxes (2011)
Recovery Position (2015)
www.accaglobal.com
158
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Financial instruments
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the initial recognition and measurement of financial instruments. C3(a)
Discuss and apply the subsequent measurement of financial assets and financial C3(b)
liabilities.
Discuss and apply the derecognition of financial assets and financial liabilities. C3(c)
Account for derivative financial instruments, and simple embedded derivatives. C3(e)
Outline and apply the qualifying criteria for hedge accounting and account for C3(f)
fair value hedges and cash flow hedges including hedge effectiveness.
Discuss and apply the general approach to impairment of financial instruments C3(g)
including the basis for estimating expected credit losses.
Discuss and apply the treatment of purchased or originated credit impaired C3(i)
financial assets.
Exam context
Financial instruments is a very important topic for Strategic Business Reporting (SBR), and is likely to
be examined often and in depth. It is also one of the more challenging areas of the syllabus, so it is
an area to which you need to dedicate a fair amount of time.
TT2020
159
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Financial instruments
Financial assets
Financial liabilities
160
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
1 Standards
The dynamic nature of international financial markets has resulted in the widespread use of a variety
of financial instruments. Prior to the issue of IAS 32 and IAS 39 (the forerunner of IFRS 9), many
financial instruments were 'off balance sheet', being neither recognised nor disclosed in the financial
statements while still exposing the shareholders to significant risks.
The IASB has developed the following standards in relation to financial instruments:
Accounting for
financial
instruments
Financial
instruments
Compound instruments
TT2020
161
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(1) Financial instrument: Any contract that gives rise to both a financial asset of one entity
and a financial liability or equity instrument of another entity (IAS 32: para. 11).
Key terms
(2) Financial asset (IAS 32: para. 11): Any asset that is:
(a) Cash;
(b) An equity instrument of another entity;
(c) A contractual right:
(i) To receive cash or another financial asset from another entity; or
(ii) To exchange financial assets or financial liabilities with another entity under
conditions that are potentially favourable to the entity; or
(d) A contract that will or may be settled in the entity's own equity instruments.
Examples:
Trade receivables
Options
Shares (as an investment)
(3) Financial liability (IAS 32: para. 11): Any liability that is:
(a) A contractual obligation:
(i) To deliver cash or another financial asset to another entity; or
(ii) To exchange financial assets or financial liabilities with another entity under
conditions that are potentially unfavourable to the entity; or
(b) A contract that will or may be settled in an entity's own equity instruments.
Examples:
Trade payables
Debenture loans (payable)
Mandatorily redeemable preference shares
Forward contracts standing at a loss
(4) Equity instrument: Any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of an entity
after deducting all of its liabilities (IAS 32: para. 11).
Examples:
An entity's own ordinary shares
Warrants
Non-cumulative irredeemable preference shares
(5) Derivative: A derivative has three characteristics (IFRS 9: Appendix A):
(a) Its value changes in response to an underlying variable (eg share price, commodity
price, foreign exchange rate or interest rate);
(b) It requires no initial net investment or an initial net investment that is smaller than would
be required for other types of contracts that would be expected to have a similar
response to changes in market factors; and
(c) It is settled at a future date.
Examples:
Foreign currency forward contracts
Interest rate swaps
Options
162
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Essential reading
Chapter 8 section 1 of the Essential Reading contains further detail on these definitions. This is
available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Illustration 1
Many entities issue preference shares which must be redeemed by the issuer for a fixed (or
determinable) amount at a fixed (or determinable) future date.
In such cases, the issuer has a contractual obligation to deliver cash. Therefore, the instrument is a
financial liability and should be classified as a liability in the statement of financial position.
Stakeholder perspective
When an entity issues a financial instrument, the entity classifies it as either a financial liability or as
Stakeholder
perspective
equity:
Classification as a financial liability will result in increased gearing and reduced reported
profit (as distributions are classified as finance cost).
Classification as equity will decrease gearing and have no effect on reported profit (as
distributions are charged to equity).
Classification therefore affects how the financial position and performance of the entity are depicted,
and subsequently, how investors and other stakeholders assess the potential for future cash flows and
risk associated with the entity.
Getting the classification right is therefore very important. IAS 32 strives to follow a substance-based
approach to give the most realistic presentation of items that behave like debt or equity.
Essential reading
See Chapter 8 section 2 of the Essential Reading for further discussion of the issues surrounding
classification as debt versus equity.
TT2020
163
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Financial instruments can only be classified as equity if they have neither of these features.
The table below summarises the proposed approach.
Obligation to transfer
cash or another financial
Liability
asset at a specified time Liability
(eg shares redeemable
other than at liquidation (eg simple bonds)
at fair value)
(such as scheduled
cash payments)
164
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Illustration 2 (revision)
Karaiskos SA issues 1,000 convertible bonds on 1 January 20X1 at par. Each bond is redeemable
in three years' time at its par value of $2,000 per bond. Alternatively, each bond can be converted
at the maturity date into 125 $1 shares.
The bonds pay interest annually in arrears at an interest rate (based on nominal value) of 6%.
The prevailing market interest rate for three-year bonds that have no right of conversion is 9%.
Required
Show the presentation of the compound instrument in the financial statements at inception.
3-year discount factors: Simple Cumulative
6% 0.840 2.673
9% 0.772 2.531
Solution
The convertible bonds are compound financial instruments and must be split into two components:
(a) A financial liability (measured first), representing the contractual obligation to make a cash
payment at a future date;
(b) An equity component (measured as a residual), representing what has been received by the
company for the option to convert the instrument into shares at a future date. This is sometimes
called a 'warrant'.
Presentation
Non-current liabilities $
Financial liability component of convertible bond (Working) 1,847,720
Equity
Equity component of convertible bond (2,000,000 – 1,847,720 (Working)) 152,280
TT2020
165
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 3
An entity acquired 10,000 of its own $1 shares, which had previously been issued at $1.50 each,
for $1.80 each. The entity is undecided as to whether to cancel the shares or reissue them at a later
date.
Analysis
These are treasury shares and are presented as a deduction from equity:
Equity $
Share capital X
Share premium X
Treasury shares (10,000 × $1.80) (18,000)
If the shares are subsequently cancelled, the $1.50 will be debited to share capital ($1) and share
premium ($0.50), and the excess ($0.30) recognised in retained earnings rather than in profit or
loss, as it is a transaction with the owners of the business in their capacity as owners.
3 Recognition (IFRS 9)
Financial assets and liabilities are required to be recognised in the statement of financial position
when the entity becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument (IFRS 9:
para. 3.1.1).
Illustration 4
Derivatives (eg a forward contract) are recognised in the financial statements at inception even
though there may have been no cash flow, and disclosures about them are made in accordance with
IFRS 7.
Illustration 5
A forward contract to purchase cocoa beans for use in making chocolate is an executory contract
which is outside the scope of IFRS 9.
The purchase is not accounted for until the cocoa beans are actually delivered.
166
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
4 Derecognition (IFRS 9)
Derecognition is the removal of a previously recognised financial instrument from an entity's
statement of financial position. Derecognition happens:
Financial assets: – When the contractual rights to the cash flows expire (eg because a
customer has paid their debt or an option has expired worthless)
(IFRS 9: para. 3.2.3(a)); or
– The financial asset is transferred (eg sold), based on whether the
entity has transferred substantially all the risks and rewards of
ownership of the financial asset (IFRS 9: para. 3.2.3(b)).
Financial liabilities: – When it is extinguished, ie when the obligation is discharged (eg
paid off), cancelled or expires (IFRS 9: para. 3.3.1).
Where a part of a financial instrument (or group of similar financial instruments) meets the criteria
above, that part is derecognised (IFRS 9: para. 3.2.2(a)).
For example, if an entity holds a bond it has the right to two separate sets of cash inflows: those
relating to the principal and those relating to the interest. It could sell the right to receive the interest
to another party while retaining the right to receive the principal.
Essential reading
Chapter 8 section 3 of the Essential Reading contains further details on derecognition. This is
available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Activity 1: Derecognition
Required
Discuss whether the following financial instruments would be derecognised.
(a) AB sells an investment in shares, but retains a call option to repurchase those shares at any
time at a price equal to their current market value at the date of repurchase.
(b) EF enters into a stocklending agreement where an investment is lent to a third party for a fixed
period of time for a fee. At the end of the period of time the investment (or an identical one) is
returned to EF.
Solution
TT2020
167
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5 Classification and measurement (IFRS 9)
5.1 Definitions
The following definitions are relevant in understanding this section, and you should refer back to
them when studying this material.
Amortised cost: The amount at which the financial asset or financial liability is measured at initial
recognition minus the principal repayments, plus or minus the cumulative amortisation using the
Key terms
effective interest method of any difference between that initial amount and the maturity amount and,
for financial assets, adjusted for any loss allowance.
Effective interest rate: The rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash payments or receipts
through the expected life of the financial asset or financial liability to the gross carrying amount of a
financial asset or to the amortised cost of a financial liability.
Held for trading: A financial asset or financial liability that:
(a) Is acquired or incurred principally for the purpose of selling or repurchasing it in the near term;
(b) On initial recognition is part of a portfolio of identified financial instruments that are managed
together and for which there is evidence of a recent actual pattern of short-term profit-taking; or
(c) Is a derivative (except for a derivative that is a financial guarantee contract or a designated and
effective hedging instrument).
Financial guarantee contract: A contract that requires the issuer to make specified payments to
reimburse the holder for a loss it incurs because a specified debtor fails to make payment when due
in accordance with the original or modified terms of the debt instrument.
(IFRS 9: Appendix A)
168
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Subsequent
Initial measurement measurement
(IFRS 9: para. 5.1.1) (IFRS 9: paras. 4.1.2–4.1.5,
5.7.5)
2 Investments in equity Fair value + transaction Fair value through other
instruments not 'held for costs comprehensive income (no
trading' reclassification to P/L on
(optional irrevocable election on derecognition)
initial recognition) NB: dividend income
recognised in P/L
3 All other financial assets Fair value (transaction Fair value through profit or loss
(and any financial asset if this would costs expensed in P/L)
eliminate or significantly reduce an
'accounting mismatch' (Note 2))
Notes
1 The business model approach relates to groups of debt instrument assets and the
accounting treatment depends on the entity's intention for that group of assets.
(a) If the intention is to hold the group of debt instruments until they are redeemed, ie
receive ('collect') the interest and capital ('principal') cash flows, then changes in fair
value are not relevant, and the difference between initial and maturity value is
recognised using the amortised cost method.
(b) If the intention is principally to hold the group of debt instruments until they are
redeemed, but they may be sold if certain criteria are met (eg to meet regulatory
solvency requirements), then their fair value is now relevant as they may be sold and so
they are measured at fair value. Changes in fair value are recognised in other
comprehensive income, but interest is still recognised in profit or loss on the same basis
as if the intention was not to sell if certain criteria are met.
2 An 'accounting mismatch' is a measurement or recognition inconsistency that would otherwise
arise from measuring assets or liabilities or recognising gains or losses on them on different
bases. Any financial asset can be designated at fair value through profit or loss if this would
eliminate the mismatch.
Illustration 6
Fair value of debt on initial recognition
A $5,000 three-year interest-free loan is made to a director. If market interest charged on a similar
1
loan would be, say, 4%, the fair value of the loan at inception is $5,000 × 3
= $4,445 and the
1.04
loan is recorded at that value.
Illustration 7
Amortised cost revision
A company purchases loan notes (nominal value $100,000) for $96,394 on 1 January 20X3,
incurring transaction costs of $350. The loan notes carry interest paid annually on 31 December of
4% of nominal value ($4,000 pa). The loan notes will be redeemed at par on 31 December 20X5.
The effective interest rate is 5.2%.
TT2020
169
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Required
Show the amortised cost of the loan notes from 1 January 20X3 to 31 December 20X5 (before
redemption).
Solution
$ $ $
1 January b/d (96,394 + 350) 96,744 97,775 98,859
Effective interest at 5.2% of b/d (interest in P/L) 5,031 5,084 5,141
'Coupon' interest received (4,000) (4,000) (4,000)
31 December c/d 97,775 98,859 100,000
170
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Initial
measurement Subsequent measurement
(IFRS 9: para. (IFRS 9: para. 4.2.1)
5.1.1)
2 Financial liabilities at fair value Fair value Fair value through profit or
through profit or loss (Note 1) (transaction costs loss*
– 'Held for trading' (short-term profit expensed in P/L)
making)
– Derivatives that are liabilities
– Designated on initial recognition at
'fair value through profit or loss' to
eliminate/significantly reduce an
'accounting mismatch' (Note 2)
– A group of financial liabilities (or
financial assets and financial
liabilities) managed and performance
evaluated on a fair value basis in
accordance with a documented risk
management or investment strategy
TT2020
171
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Initial
measurement Subsequent measurement
(IFRS 9: para. (IFRS 9: para. 4.2.1)
5.1.1)
*Changes in fair value due to changes in the liability's credit risk are recognised separately in other
comprehensive income (unless doing so would create or enlarge an 'accounting mismatch') (IFRS 9:
para. 5.7.7).
Notes
1 Most financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost.
However, some financial liabilities are measured at fair value through profit or loss if
fair value information is relevant to the user of the financial statements. This includes where a
company is 'trading' in financial liabilities, ie taking on liabilities hoping to settle them for less
in the short term to make a profit, and derivatives standing at a loss which are financial
liabilities rather than financial assets.
2 As with financial assets, financial liabilities can be designated at fair value through profit or
loss if doing so would eliminate an 'accounting mismatch', ie a measurement or
recognition inconsistency that would otherwise arise from measuring assets or liabilities or
recognising gains or losses on them on different bases.
3 Financial guarantee contracts are a form of financial insurance. The entity guarantees it
will make a payment to another party if a specified debtor does not pay that other party. On
initial recognition the fair value of the 'premiums' received (less any transaction costs) are
recognised as a liability. This is then amortised as income to profit or loss over the period of
the guarantee, representing the revenue earned as the performance obligation (ie providing
the guarantee) is satisfied, thereby reducing the liability to zero over the period of cover if no
compensation payments are actually made. However, if, at the year end, the expected
impairment loss that would be payable on the guarantee exceeds the remaining liability, the
liability is increased to this amount.
4 Commitments to provide a loan at below-market interest rate arise where an
entity has committed itself to make a loan to another party at an interest rate which is lower
than the rate the entity itself would pay to borrow the money. These are accounted for in the
same way as financial guarantee contracts. The impairment loss in this case would be the
present value of the expected interest receipts from the other party less the expected (higher)
interest payments the entity would pay.
172
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
TT2020
173
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6 Embedded derivatives (IFRS 9)
Some contracts (that may or may not be financial instruments themselves) may have derivatives
embedded in them. Ordinarily, derivatives not used for hedging are treated as 'held for trading' and
measured at fair value through profit or loss.
With limited exceptions, IFRS 9 requires embedded derivatives that would meet the definition of a
separate derivative instrument to be separated from the host contract (and therefore be measured
at fair value through profit or loss like other derivatives) (IFRS 9: paras. 4.3.3–4.3.5).
Illustration 8
An entity may issue a bond which is redeemable in five years' time with part of the redemption price
being based on the increase in the FTSE 100 index.
However, IFRS 9 does not require embedded derivatives to be separated from the host contract if:
Exception Reason
(a) The economic characteristics and risks of Eg an oil contract between two companies
the embedded derivative are closely reporting in €, but priced in $.
related to those of the host contract; or The 'derivative' element ($ risk) is a normal
feature of the contract (as oil is priced in $) so not
really derivative
(b) The hybrid (combined) instrument is Both parts would be at fair value through profit
measured at fair value through profit or loss anyway, so no need to split
or loss; or
(c) The host contract is a financial asset The measurement rules for financial assets require
within the scope of IFRS 9; or the whole instrument to be measured at fair value
through profit or loss anyway, so no need to split
(d) The embedded derivative significantly If the derivative element changes the cash flows
modifies the cash flows of the contract. so much, then the whole instrument should be
measured at fair value through profit or loss due
to the risk involved (which is the measurement
category that would apply without these rules,
being derivative)
174
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
7.2 Scope
IFRS 9's impairment rules apply primarily to certain financial assets (IFRS 9: paras. 5.5.1–5.5.2):
Financial assets measured at amortised cost (business model: objective – to collect contractual
cash flows of principal and interest)
Investments in debt instruments measured at fair value through other comprehensive income
(OCI) (business model: objective – to collect contractual cash flows of principal and interest
and to sell financial assets)
The impairment rules do not apply to financial assets measured at fair value through profit or loss as
subsequent measurement at fair value will already take into account any impairment.
Loss allowance: The allowance for expected credit losses on financial assets.
Key terms Expected credit losses: The weighted average of credit losses with the respective risks of a
default occurring as the weights.
Credit loss: The difference between all contractual cash flows that are due to an entity…and all the
cash flows that the entity expects to receive, discounted.
(IFRS 9: Appendix A)
TT2020
175
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7.3.2 At subsequent reporting dates (IFRS 9: paras. 5.5.3–5.5.8)
At each subsequent reporting date, the loss allowance required depends on whether there has been
a significant increase in credit risk of that financial instrument since initial recognition.
Stakeholder perspective
IFRS 9's impairment model requires management to exercise their professional judgement. For
Stakeholder
perspective example, assessing whether there has been a significant increase in the credit risk of a financial
asset since initial recognition requires management to consider forward-looking and past due
information in making a considered opinion. This assessment is important as it determines whether
12-month expected credit losses or lifetime expected credit losses are recognised as a loss
allowance.
To aid investors and stakeholders in their assessment of the entity (eg uncertainty over future cash
flows, financial performance and position) and of management's stewardship of the entity's
resources, IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures requires in-depth disclosures of how an entity has
applied the impairment model, what the results of applying the model are and the reasons for any
changes in expected losses.
176
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
7.4 Presentation
Credit losses are treated as follows.
Investments in debt instruments Portion of the fall in fair value relating to credit
measured at fair value through other losses recognised in profit or loss
comprehensive income
Remainder recognised in other comprehensive
income
No allowance account necessary because already
carried at fair value (which is automatically reduced for
any fall in value, including credit losses)
Illustration 9
A company has a portfolio of loan assets. Its business model is to collect the contractual cash flows of
interest and principal only. All loan assets have an effective interest rate of 7.5%. The portfolio was
initially recognised at $840,000 on 1 January 20X1 with a separate allowance of $5,000 for
12-month expected credit losses (present value of lifetime expected credit losses of $100,000 × 5%
chance of default within 12 months). A discount factor of 7.5% has been applied in calculating the
loss allowance. No repayments are due in the first year.
At 31 December 20X1, the credit risk of the loan assets has increased significantly. The expectation
of lifetime expected credit losses remains the same.
Required
Explain the accounting treatment of the portfolio of loan assets, with suitable calculations.
Solution
The loan assets are initially recognised on 1 January 20X1 as follows:
$
Loan assets 840,000
Allowance for credit losses (5,000)
Carrying amount (net of allowance for credit losses) 835,000
As the business model for the loan assets is to collect the contractual cash flows of interest and
principal only, they should be measured at amortised cost:
$
At 1 January 20X1 840,000
Effective interest income (7.5% × $840,000) 63,000
Cash received (0)
At 31 December 20X1 903,000
TT2020
177
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The discount on the allowance must be unwound by one year resulting in a finance cost of $375
(7.5% × $5,000). At 31 December 20X1, as there has been a significant increase in credit risk, the
allowance for credit losses is adjusted to the present value of lifetime expected credit losses
(measured at the end of the first year) of $107,500 ($100,000 × 1.075):
$
At 1 January 20X1 5,000
Unwind discount 375
Increase in allowance 102,125
At 31 December 20X1 107,500
A total finance cost relating to the allowance of $102,500 ($375 + $102,125) should be
recognised in profit or loss for the year ended 31 December 20X1.
At 31 December 20X1, the amount to recognise in the statement of financial position is therefore:
$
Loan assets 903,000
Allowance for credit losses (107,500)
Carrying amount (net of allowance for credit losses) 795,500
In the year ended 31 December 20X2, effective interest income and finance cost will be calculated
on the gross figures of $903,000 and $107,500 respectively, or (if there is objective evidence of
actual impairment) on the net figure of $795,500.
7.5 Measurement
The measurement of expected credit losses should reflect (IFRS 9: para. 5.5.17):
(a) An unbiased and probability-weighted amount that is determined by evaluating a
range of possible outcomes;
(b) The time value of money; and
(c) Reasonable and supportable information that is available without undue cost and
effort at the reporting date about past events, current conditions and forecasts of future
economic conditions.
7.5.1 Impairment loss reversal
If an entity has measured the loss allowance at an amount equal to lifetime expected credit losses
in the previous reporting period, but determines that the conditions are no longer met, it
should revert to measuring the loss allowance at an amount equal to 12-month expected credit
losses (IFRS 9: para. 5.5.7).
The resulting impairment gain is recognised in profit or loss (IFRS 9: para. 5.5.8).
178
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
TT2020
179
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8 Hedge accounting (IFRS 9)
Companies enter into hedging transactions in order to reduce business risk. Where an item in the
statement of financial position or future cash flow is subject to potential fluctuations in value that
could be detrimental to the business, a hedging transaction may be entered into. The aim is that
where the item hedged makes a financial loss, the hedging instrument would make a gain and vice
versa, reducing overall risk.
Illustration 10
Pumpkin acquired inventories of coffee beans at 30 November 20X6 for their fair value of
$1.3 million. It is worried that the fair value will fall so has entered into a futures contract to
sell the coffee for its current fair value in three months' time.
At the year ended 31 December 20X6, the fair value of the coffee is $1.2 million.
At the reporting date:
Inventories Futures
With no hedging With no hedging
• Assuming net realisable value is • N/A
equal to fair value, a loss of
With hedging
$0.1m would be recognised in
profit or loss • The gain on the futures contract
Offsets is $0.1m as the contract allows
With hedging
the holder to sell at $0.1m more
• The loss on the inventories of than market value ($1.2m)
$0.1m would be recognised
• The gain would be reported in
whether or not their fair value
profit or loss
has been hedged
• The loss would be reported in
profit or loss
Adopting the hedge accounting provisions of IFRS 9 is mandatory where the hedging relationship
meets all of the following criteria (IFRS 9: para. 6.4.1):
(a) The hedging relationship consists only of eligible hedging instruments and eligible
hedged items;
(b) It was designated at its inception as a hedge with full documentation of how this
hedge fits into the company's strategy;
(c) The hedging relationship meets all of the following hedge effectiveness requirements:
(i) There is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging
instrument; ie the hedging instrument and the hedged item have values that generally
move in the opposite direction because of the same risk, which is the hedged risk;
(ii) The effect of credit risk does not dominate the value changes that result from
that economic relationship; ie the gain or loss from credit risk does not frustrate the
effect of changes in the underlyings on the value of the hedging instrument or the
hedged item, even if those changes were significant; and
(iii) The hedge ratio of the hedging relationship (quantity of hedging instrument vs
quantity of hedged item) is the same as that resulting from the quantity of the hedged
item that the entity actually hedges and the quantity of the hedging instrument that
the entity actually uses to hedge that quantity of hedged item.
180
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Practically however, hedge accounting is effectively optional in that an entity can choose whether
to set up the hedge documentation at inception or not.
An entity discontinues hedge accounting when the hedging relationship ceases to meet the
qualifying criteria, which also arises when the hedging instrument expires or is sold, transferred
or exercised (IFRS 9: para. 6.5.6).
TT2020
181
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 11
Fair value hedge
On 1 July 20X6 Joules acquired 10,000 ounces of a material which it held in its inventories. This
cost $220 per ounce, so a total of $2.2 million. Joules was concerned that the price of these
inventories would fall, so on 1 July 20X6 it sold 10,000 ounces in the futures market for $215
per ounce for delivery on 30 June 20X7; ie the contract gives Joules the right (and obligation) to sell
10,000 ounces at $215 on 30 June 20X7 whatever the market price on that date.
On 1 July 20X6 the IFRS 9 conditions for hedge accounting were all met, and these continued to be
met throughout the hedging period.
At 31 December 20X6, the end of Joules's reporting period, the fair value of the inventories was
$200 per ounce while the futures price for 30 June 20X7 delivery was $198 per ounce. On 30 June
20X7 the trader sold the inventories and closed out the futures position at the then spot price of $190
per ounce.
Required
Explain the accounting treatment in respect of the above transactions.
Solution
This is a fair value hedge as Joules is hedging the fair value of its inventories. The IFRS 9 hedge
accounting criteria have been met, so hedge accounting was permitted.
At 31 December 20X6
The decrease in the fair value of the inventories (a loss) was $200,000 (10,000 × ($200 – $220)).
The increase in the futures contract asset (a gain) was $170,000 (10,000 × ($215 – $198)). These
are offset in profit or loss:
$ $
DEBIT Profit or loss 200,000
CREDIT Inventories 200,000
(To record the decrease in the fair value of the inventories)
DEBIT Futures contract asset 170,000
CREDIT Profit or loss 170,000
(To record the gain on the futures contract)
At 30 June 20X7
The decrease in the fair value of the inventories (a further loss) was another $100,000 (10,000 ×
($190 – $200)). The increase in the futures contract asset (a further gain) was another $80,000
(10,000 × ($198 – $190)).
Again, these are offset in profit or loss. The gain on the futures contract compensates the loss on the
inventories in profit or loss, mitigating the profit or loss effect of the changes in fair value.
$ $
DEBIT Profit or loss 100,000
CREDIT Inventories 100,000
(To record the decrease in the fair value of the inventories)
DEBIT Futures contract asset 80,000
CREDIT Profit or loss 80,000
(To record the gain on the futures contract)
182
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
The inventories are sold on 30 June 20X7, so they are transferred to cost of sales at their carrying
amount of $1.9 million ($2.2m – $200,000 – $100,000). Revenue of the same amount is
recognised (as the inventories have been remeasured to their fair value of $190 per ounce, which is
the selling price).
$ $
Profit or loss (cost of sales) 1,900,000
Inventories (2,200,000 – 200,000 – 100,000) 1,900,000
(To record the inventories now sold)
DEBIT Cash 1,900,000
CREDIT Revenue (10,000 × 190) 1,900,000
(To record the revenue from the sale of inventories)
The inventories are being sold at $1.9 million which is $300,000 less than their original cost of
$2.2 million on 1 July 20X6.
However, this fall in value is mitigated by selling the futures contract asset for its fair value of
$250,000, as a third party would now be willing to pay $250,000 for the right to sell 10,000
ounces of material at the agreed futures contract price of $215 rather than the market price of $190
per ounce. A futures contract is an exchange-traded contract so this is settled net in cash on the
market:
$ $
DEBIT Cash 250,000
CREDIT Futures contract asset (170,000 + 80,000) 250,000
(To record the settlement of the net balance due on closing the futures contract)
Consequently, Joules made an overall loss of only $50,000 ($300,000 loss on inventories, net of the
$250,000 gain on the futures contract). The purpose of hedging is to eliminate risk, but because
futures prices move differently to spot prices it cannot always be a perfect match, so a smaller loss of
$50,000 did still arise.
TT2020
183
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
184
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
9 Disclosures (IFRS 7)
9.1 Objective
The objective of IFRS 7 is to provide disclosures that enable users of financial statements to evaluate:
(a) The significance of financial instruments for the entity's financial position and performance; and
(b) The nature and extent of risks arising from financial instruments to which the entity is exposed,
and how the entity manages those risks (IFRS 7: para. 1).
Stakeholder perspective
The disclosure requirements in IFRS 7 are extensive but important because many financial instruments
Stakeholder
perspective
are inherently risky. The disclosures provide investors and other stakeholders with additional
information that may affect their assessment of the entity's financial position, financial performance
and its ability to generate future cash flows. Disclosures are required to enable users to see the
judgements and accounting choices management has made in applying IFRS 9 and IAS 32 and how
those have affected the financial statements.
TT2020
185
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Ethics note
Financial instruments involve a lot of complexity. This means that they are a higher risk area in terms
of incorrect accounting either due to a lack of competence or due to a lack of integrity.
Potential ethical issues to consider include:
Misclassification of financial assets and financial liabilities to achieve a desired accounting
effect
Manipulation of profits using the estimations in the allowance for expected credit losses
Accounting for certain financial instruments as hedges (and reducing losses, by offsetting
'hedging' gains against them) when they do not meet the criteria to be classified as hedging
instruments
186
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Chapter summary
Financial instruments
TT2020
187
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Classification and measurement (IFRS 9)
188
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Embedded Impairment
derivatives (IFRS 9) (IFRS 9)
• Derivative • Applies to investments in debt and other receivables (unless held at FV through
characteristics: P/L)
– Settled at a future • No test required for FA at FV through P/L (as impairment automatically dealt with)
date • Follows an 'expected loss' model:
– Value changes in – At initial recognition of a financial asset, a loss allowance equal to 12-month
response to an expected credit losses must be recognised.
underlying variable – At subsequent reporting dates:
– No/little initial net No significant increase in Significant increase in Objective evidence of
investment vs credit risk since initial credit risk since initial impairment at the
contracts for similar recognition (Stage 1) recognition (Stage 2) reporting date (Stage 3)
market response ↓ ↓ ↓
• Embedded derivative: Recognise 12-month Recognise lifetime Recognise lifetime
an item meeting expected credit losses expected credit losses expected credit losses
definition of a ↓ ↓ ↓
derivative within a FL Effective interest Effective interest Effective interest
'host' contract calculated on gross calculated on gross calculated on net
• Separate from 'host' carrying amount carrying amount carrying amount
contract unless: of financial asset of financial asset of financial asset
– Economic
• Credit losses (and loss reversals) recognised in P/L
characteristics and
• For investments in debt held at FV through OCI, change in FV not due to credit
risks closely related;
losses still recognised in OCI
– Combined
• For investments in debt not held at FV through OCI a separate allowance account
instrument held
is used:
at FVTP/L;
Gross carrying amount X
– Host is an IFRS 9
FA; or Allowance for impairment losses (X)
– Embedded derivative Net carrying amount X
significantly • Permitted simplified approaches:
modifies cash flows – Trade receivables and contract assets (with no financing element):
→ lifetime expected credit losses on initial recognition
Hedging (IFRS 9)
TT2020
189
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
190
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
Question practice
Now try the questions below from the Further question practice bank:
Q14 PQR
Q15 Sirus
Q16 Debt vs Equity
Further reading
The Study support resources section of the ACCA website contains several extremely useful articles
related to SBR. You should prioritise reading the following in relation to this chapter:
Giving investors what they need (Financial capital)
The definition and disclosure of capital
When does debt seem to be equity?
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
191
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
192
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Leases
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the lessee accounting requirements for leases including the C4(a)
identification of a lease and the measurement of the right-of-use asset and liability.
Discuss and apply the circumstances where there may be re-measurement of the C4(c)
lease liability.
Discuss and apply the reasons behind the separation of the components of a C4(d)
lease contract into lease and non-lease elements.
Discuss the recognition exemptions under the current leasing standard. C4(e)
Discuss and apply the principles behind accounting for sale and leaseback C4(f)
transactions.
Exam context
In Financial Reporting, you studied leases from the point of view of the lessee. The SBR syllabus
introduces the accounting for leases in the lessor's financial statements. It is an area which could form
a major part of a question and is likely to be tested often, particularly as IFRS 16 is a recent
standard.
TT2020
193
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Lessee accounting
194
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
1 Lessee accounting
1.1 Introduction
IFRS 16 Leases requires lessees and lessors to provide relevant information in a manner that faithfully
represents those transactions.
Link to the Conceptual Framework
The accounting treatment in the lessee's books is driven by the Conceptual Framework's definitions of
Link to the
Conceptual assets and liabilities rather than the legal form of the lease. The legal form of a lease is that the title
Framework to the underlying asset remains with the lessor during the period of the lease.
Stakeholder perspective
Companies generally use leasing arrangements as a means of obtaining assets. Consequently,
Stakeholder
perspective IFRS 16 requires the majority of leased assets and the associated obligations to be recognised in the
financial statements. This is a significant change from the previous standard, IAS 17 Leases, which
was criticised for allowing 'off balance sheet' financing.
While IFRS 16 has benefits for the users of financial statements in terms of transparency and
comparability, it has had a significant impact on the most commonly used financial ratios, such as:
• Gearing, because debt has increased
• Asset turnover, because assets have increased
• Profit margin ratios, because rent expenses are removed and replaced with depreciation and
finance costs.
This in turn affects the way in which users interpret and analyse the financial statements. For
example, banks often impose loan covenants when making loans to companies. These covenants
may need renegotiating if applying IFRS 16 causes a company's liabilities to increase significantly.
Essential reading
Chapter 9 section 1 of the Essential Reading contains more discussion on IAS 17 and why it was
replaced. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
1.2 Definitions
Lease: A contract, or part of a contract, that conveys the right to use an asset (the underlying
Key term
asset) for a period of time in exchange for consideration. (IFRS 16: Appendix A)
A lease arises where the customer obtains the right to use the asset. Where it is the supplier that
controls the asset used, a service rather than a lease arises.
1.2.1 Identifying a lease
An entity must identify whether a contract contains a lease, which is the case if the contract conveys
the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for
consideration (IFRS 16: para. 9).
TT2020
195
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The right to control an asset arises where, throughout the period of use, the customer has
(IFRS 16: para. B9):
(a) The right to obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from use of the identified
asset; and
(b) The right to direct the use of the identified asset.
The identified asset is typically explicitly specified in a contract. However, an asset can also be
identified by being implicitly specified at the time that the asset is made available for use by the
customer (IFRS 16: para. B13).
Even if an asset is specified, a customer does not have the right to use an identified asset if the
supplier has the substantive right to substitute the asset throughout the period of use
(IFRS 16: para. B14).
Where a contract contains multiple components, the consideration is allocated to each lease
and non-lease component based on relative stand-alone prices (the price the lessor or similar supplier
would charge for the component, or a similar component, separately) (IFRS 16: paras. 13–14).
Illustration 1
Under a four year agreement a car seat wholesaler (WH) buys its seats from a manufacturer (MF).
Under the terms of the agreement, WH licenses its know-how to MF royalty-free to allow it to
construct a machine capable of manufacturing the car seats to WH's specifications. Ownership of
the know-how remains with WH and the machine has an economic life of four years.
WH pays an amount per car seat produced to MF; however, the agreement states that a minimum
payment will be guaranteed each year to allow MF to recover the cost of its investment in the
machinery.
The agreement states that the machinery cannot be used to make seats for other customers of MF and
that WH can purchase the machinery at any time (at a price equivalent to the minimum guaranteed
payments not yet paid).
Required
How should WH account for this arrangement?
Solution
The agreement is a contract containing a lease component (for the use of the machinery, the
'identified asset' in the contract) and a non-lease component (the purchase of inventories).
WH will obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from the use of the machinery over the
period of the agreement as it will be able to sell on all the car seat output for its own cash flow
benefit, and has the right to direct its use, as it cannot be used to make seats for other customers.
The payments that WH makes will need to be split into amounts covering the purchase of car seat
inventories, and amounts which represent lease payments for use of the machine. The allocation will
be based on relative stand-alone prices for hiring the machine and buying the inventories (or for a
similar machine and inventories).
Essential reading
Chapter 9 sections 2.1–2.2 of the Essential Reading contain further examples of identifying lease
components of a contract and separating multiple components of a contract. This is available in
Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
196
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
Lease term: 'The non-cancellable period for which a lessee has the right to use an
Key term
underlying asset, together with both:
(a) Periods covered by an option to extend the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain to
exercise that option; and
(b) Periods covered by an option to terminate the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain
not to exercise that option.' (IFRS 16: Appendix A)
The lease term is relevant when determining the period over which a leased asset should be
depreciated (see below).
Illustration 2
A lease contract is for five years with lease payments of $10,000 per annum. The lease contract
contains a clause which allows the lessee to extend the lease for a further period of three years for a
lease payment of $5 per annum (as it is unlikely the lessor would be able to lease the asset to
another party). The economic life of the asset is estimated to be approximately eight years.
The lessee assesses it is highly likely the lease extension would be taken. The lease term is therefore
eight years.
TT2020
197
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.3.3 Right-of-use asset
The right-of-use asset is initially measured at its cost (IFRS 16: para. 23), which includes (IFRS 16:
para. 24):
The amount of the initial measurement of the lease liability (the present value of lease
payments not paid at the commencement date)
Payments made at/before the lease commencement date (less any lease incentives received)
Initial direct costs (eg legal costs) incurred by the lessee
An estimate of dismantling and restoration costs (where an obligation exists).
The right-of-use asset is normally measured subsequently at cost less accumulated depreciation
and impairment losses in accordance with the cost model of IAS 16 Property, Plant and
Equipment (IFRS 16: para. 29).
The right-of-use asset is depreciated from the commencement date to the earlier of the end of
its useful life or end of the lease term (end of its useful life if ownership is expected to be
transferred) (IFRS 16: paras. 31–32).
Alternatively the right-of-use asset is accounted for in accordance with:
(a) The revaluation model of IAS 16 (optional where the right-of-use asset relates to a class
of property, plant and equipment measured under the revaluation model, and where elected,
must apply to all right-of-use assets relating to that class) (IFRS 16: para. 35)
(b) The fair value model of IAS 40 Investment Property (compulsory if the right-of-use
asset meets the definition of investment property and the lessee uses the fair value model for its
investment property) (IFRS 16: para. 34)
Right-of-use assets are presented either as a separate line item in the statement of financial position
or by disclosing which line items include right-of-use assets (IFRS 16: para. 47).
Illustration 3
Lessee accounting revision
A company enters into a four-year lease commencing on 1 January 20X1 (and intends to use the
asset for four years). The terms are four payments of $50,000, commencing on 1 January 20X1, and
annually thereafter. The interest rate implicit in the lease is 7.5% and the present value of lease
payments not paid at 1 January 20X1 (ie three payments of $50,000) discounted at that rate is
$130,026.
Legal costs to set up the lease incurred by the company were $402.
Required
Show the lease liability from 1 January 20X1 to 31 December 20X4 and explain the treatment of the
right-of-use asset.
Solution
20X1 20X2 20X3 20X4
$ $ $ $
1 January b/d 130,026 139,778 96,512 50,000
Lease payments (0) (50,000) (50,000) (50,000)
130,026 89,778 46,512 0
Interest at 7.5% (interest in P/L) 9,752 6,734 3,488 0
31 December c/d 139,778 96,512 50,000 0
198
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
The right-of-use asset is recognised (at the lease commencement date, 1 January 20X1) at:
$
Present value of lease payments not paid at the commencement date 130,026
Payments made at the lease commencement date 50,000
Initial direct costs 402
180,428
This is depreciated over four years (as lease term and useful life are both four years) at $45,107
($180,428/4 years) per annum.
Illustration 4
An entity leases a second-hand car which has a market value of $2,000. When new it would have
cost $15,000.
The lease would not qualify as a lease of a low-value asset because the car would not have been low
value when new.
1.3.5 Remeasurement
The lease liability is remeasured (if necessary) for any reassessment of amounts payable (IFRS 16:
para. 39).
The revised lease payments are discounted using the original discount interest rate where the
change relates to an expected payment on a residual value guarantee or payments linked
to an index or rate (and a revised discount rate where there is a change in lease term,
purchase option or payments linked to a floating interest rate) (IFRS 16: paras. 40–43).
The change in the lease liability is recognised as an adjustment to the right-of-use asset (or
in profit or loss if the right-of-use asset is reduced to zero) (IFRS 16: para. 39).
Essential reading
Chapter 9 section 2.3 of the Essential Reading contains an example of remeasurement of the lease
liability. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
TT2020
199
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 1: Lessee accounting
Lassie plc leased an item of equipment on the following terms:
Commencement date 1 January 20X1
Lease term 5 years
Annual lease payments (commencing $200,000 (rising annually by CPI as at
1 January 20X1) 31 December)
Interest rate implicit in the lease 6.2%
The present value of lease payments not paid at 1 January 20X1 was $690,000. The price to
purchase the asset outright would have been $1,200,000.
Inflation measured by the Consumer Price Index (CPI) for the year ending 31 December 20X1 was
2%. As a result the lease payments commencing 1 January 20X2 rose to $204,000. The present
value of lease payments for the remaining four years of the lease becomes approximately $747,300
using the original discount rate of 6.2%.
Required
Discuss how Lassie plc should account for the lease and remeasurement in the year ended
31 December 20X1.
Solution
200
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
1.4.2 Measurement
*The tax base is $0 as we are assuming that the lease payments are tax deductible when paid
2 Lessor accounting
2.1 Classification of leases for lessor accounting
The approach to lessor accounting classifies leases into two types (IFRS 16: para. 61):
Finance leases (where a lease receivable is recognised in the statement of financial
position); and
Operating leases (which are accounted for as rental income).
Finance lease: A lease that transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to
ownership of an underlying asset.
Key terms
Operating lease: A lease that does not transfer substantially all the risks and rewards
incidental to ownership of an underlying asset.
(IFRS 16: Appendix A)
202
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
IFRS 16 identifies five examples of situations which would normally lead to a lease being
classified as a finance lease (IFRS 16: para. 63):
(a) The lease transfers ownership of the underlying asset to the lessee by the end of the lease
term.
(b) The lessee has the option to purchase the underlying asset at a price expected to be
sufficiently lower than fair value at the exercise date, so that it is reasonably certain, at
the inception date, that the option will be exercised.
(c) The lease term is for a major part of the economic life of the underlying asset even if title
is not transferred.
(d) The present value of the lease payments at the inception date amounts to at least
substantially all of the fair value of the underlying asset.
(e) The underlying asset is of such specialised nature that only the lessee can use it without
major modifications.
Additionally the following situations which could lead to a lease being classified as a finance lease
(IFRS 16: para. 64):
(a) Any losses on cancellation are borne by the lessee.
(b) Gains/losses on changes in residual value accrue to the lessee.
(c) The lessee can continue to lease for a secondary term at a rent substantially lower
than market rent.
The net investment in the lease (IFRS 16: Appendix A) is the sum of:
An unguaranteed residual value arises where a lessor expects to be able to sell an asset at the end
of the lease term for more than any minimum amount guaranteed by the lessee in the lease contract.
Amounts guaranteed by the lessee are included in the 'present value of lease payments receivable by
the lessor' as they will always be received, so only the unguaranteed amount needs to be added on,
which accrues to the lessor because it owns the underlying asset.
Finance income is recognised over the lease term based on a pattern reflecting a constant
periodic rate of return on the lessor's net investment in the lease (IFRS 16: para. 75).
The derecognition and impairment requirements of IFRS 9 Financial Instruments are applied to
the net investment in the lease (IFRS 16: para. 77).
TT2020
203
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 5
A lessor enters into a three year leasing arrangement commencing on 1 January 20X3. Under the terms
of the lease, the lessee commits to pay $80,000 per annum commencing on 31 December 20X3.
A residual guarantee clause requires the lessee to pay $40,000 (or $40,000 less the asset's residual
value, if lower) at the end of the lease term if the lessor is unable to sell the asset for more than
$40,000.
The lessor expects to sell the asset based on current expectations for $50,000 at the end of the lease.
The interest rate implicit in the lease is 9.2%. The present value of lease payments receivable by the
lessor discounted at this rate is $232,502.
Required
Show the net investment in the lease from 1 January 20X3 to 31 December 20X5 and explain what
happens to the residual value guarantee on 31 December 20X5.
Solution
The net investment in the lease (lease receivable) on 1 January 20X3 is:
$
Present value of lease payments receivable by the lessor 232,502
3
Present value of unguaranteed residual value (50,000 – 40,000 = 10,000 × 1/1.092 ) 7,679
240,181
The net investment in the lease (lease receivable) is as follows:
20X3 20X4 20X5
$ $ $
1 January b/d 240,181 182,278 119,048
Interest at 9.2% (interest income in P/L) 22,097 16,770 10,952
Lease instalments (80,000) (80,000) (80,000)
31 December c/d 182,278 119,048 50,000
On 31 December 20X5, the remaining $50,000 will be realised by selling the asset for $50,000 or
above, or selling it for less than $50,000 and claiming up to $40,000 from the lessee under the
residual value guarantee.
An allowance for impairment losses is recognised in accordance with the IFRS 9 principles, either
applying the three stage approach or by recognising an allowance for lifetime expected credit losses
from initial recognition (as an accounting policy choice for lease receivables) – see Chapter 8.
204
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
Solution
Revenue – fair value of underlying asset (or present value of lease payments if lower) X
Cost of sales – cost (or carrying amount) of the underlying asset less present value of
the unguaranteed residual value (X)
Gross profit X
Illustration 6
A manufacturer lessor leases out equipment under a ten year finance lease. The equipment cost
$32 million to manufacture. The normal selling price of the leased asset is $42 million and the
present value of lease payments is $38 million. The present value of the unguaranteed residual value
at the end of the lease is $2.2 million.
The manufacturer recognises revenue of $38 million, cost of sales of $29.8 million ($32 million –
$2.2 million), and therefore a gross profit of $8.2 million.
The lease receivable is $40.2 million ($38 million + $2.2 million). The lease receivable is increased
by interest and reduced by lease instalments received (in the same way as for a standard finance
lease).
TT2020
205
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.3 Operating leases
2.3.1 Recognition and measurement
Lease payments from operating leases are recognised as income on either a straight-line basis
or another systematic basis (if more representative of the pattern in which benefit from use of
the underlying asset is diminished) (IFRS 16: para. 81).
Any initial direct costs incurred in obtaining the lease are added to the carrying amount of the
underlying asset. IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment or IAS 38 Intangible Assets then applies to
the depreciation or amortisation of the underlying asset as appropriate (IFRS 16: paras. 83–84).
Illustration 7
A lessor leases a property to a lessee under an operating lease for five years at an annual rate of
$100,000. However, the contract states that the first six months are 'rent-free'.
Solution
The benefit received from the asset is earned over the five years. However, in the first year, the lessor
only receives $100,000 × 6/12 = $50,000. Lease rentals of $450,000 ($50,000 + ($100,000 ×
4 years)) are received over the five year lease term.
Therefore, the lessor recognises income of $90,000 per year ($450,000/5 years).
A receivable of $40,000 is recognised at the end of Year 1 ($90,000 – $50,000 cash received).
206
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
The lease liability is originally recorded at the present value of lease payments. This amount
is then split between:
The present value of lease payments at market rates; and
The additional financing (the difference) which is in substance a loan.
3.1.2 Buyer-lessor
The buyer-lessor accounts for the purchase as a normal purchase and for the lease in
accordance with IFRS 16 (IFRS 16: para. 100).
3.2.2 Buyer-lessor
The buyer-lessor does not recognise the transferred asset and recognises a financial asset
equal to the transfer proceeds (and accounts for it in accordance with IFRS 9) (IFRS 16: para. 103).
Illustration 8
Fradin, an international hotel chain, is currently finalising its financial statements for the year ended
30 June 20X8 and is unsure how to account for the following transaction.
On 1 July 20X7, it sold one of its hotels to a third party institution and is leasing it back under a
ten year lease. The sale price is $57 million and the fair value of the asset is $60 million.
The lease payment is $2.8 million per annum in arrears commencing on 30 June 20X8 (below
market rate for this kind of lease). The present value of lease payments is $20 million and the implicit
interest rate in the lease is 6.6%. The purchaser can cancel the lease agreement and take full control
of the hotel with six months' notice.
The hotel had a remaining economic life of 30 years at 1 July 20X7 and a carrying amount (under
the cost model) of $48 million.
Required
Discuss how the above transaction should be dealt with in the financial statements of Fradin for the
year ended 30 June 20X8. Work to the nearest $0.1 million.
TT2020
207
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
In substance, this transaction is a sale. A performance obligation is satisfied (IFRS 15) as control of
the hotel is transferred as the significant risks and rewards of ownership have passed to the
purchaser, who can cancel the lease agreement and take full control of the hotel with six months'
notice. Additionally, the lease is only for ten years of the hotel's remaining economic life of 30 years.
However, Fradin does retain an interest in the hotel, as it does expect to continue to operate it for the
next ten years. Fradin was the legal owner and is now the lessee.
As a sale has occurred, the carrying amount of the hotel asset of $48 million must be derecognised.
Per IFRS 16, a right-of-use asset should then be recognised at the proportion of the previous carrying
amount that relates to the right of use retained. This amounts to $16 million ($48m carrying amount
× $20m present value of lease payments/$60m fair value).
As the fair value of $60 million is in excess of the proceeds of $57 million, IFRS 16 requires the
excess of $3 million ($60m – $57m) to be treated as a prepayment of the lease rentals. Therefore,
the $3 million prepayment must be added to the right-of-use asset (like a payment made at/before
lease commencement date), bringing the right-of-use asset to $19 million ($16m + $3m).
A lease liability must also be recorded at the present value of lease payments of $20 million.
A gain on sale is recognised in relation to the rights transferred to the buyer-lessor.
The total gain would be $12 million ($60m fair value – $48m carrying amount). As fair value ($60m)
The portion recognised as a gain relating to the rights transferred is $8 million exceeds sale proceeds
($57m), excess is a
($12m gain × ($60m – $20m)/$60m portion of fair value transferred). prepayment of lease
rentals
On 1 July 20X7, the double entry to record the sale is:
DR Cash $57m
DR Right-of-use asset ($48m × $20m/$60m = $16m + $3m prepayment) $19m
CR Hotel asset Proportion of carrying amount $48m
re rights retained
CR Lease liability $20m
CR Gain on sale (P/L) (balancing figure or ($60m – $48m) × ($60m – $20m)/$60m) $8m
Interest on the lease liability is then accrued for the year:
Proportion of
DR Finance costs (W) $1.3m profit re rights
CR Lease liability $1.3m sold
The lease payment on 30 June 20X8 reduces the lease liability by $2.8m:
DR Lease liability $2.8m
CR Cash $2.8m
The carrying amount of the lease liability at 30 June 20X8 is therefore $18.5 million (see Working
below).
The proportion of the carrying amount of the hotel asset relating to the right of use retained of
$19 million (including the $3 million lease prepayment) remains as a right-of-use asset in the
statement of financial position and is depreciated over the lease term:
DR P/L ($19m/10 years) $1.9m
CR Right-of-use asset $1.9m
This results in a net credit to profit or loss for the year ended 30 June 20X8 of $4.8 million ($8m –
$1.3m – $1.9m).
208
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
Essential reading
Chapter 9 section 2.4 of the Essential Reading contains a further example of accounting for a sale
and leaseback transaction. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Ethics note
Leases have traditionally been an area where ethical application of the Standard is essential to give
a true and fair view. Indeed, the accounting for leases in the financial statements of lessees was
revised in IFRS 16 to avoid the issue of 'off balance sheet financing' that previously arose by not
recognising all leases as a liability in the financial statements of lessees.
In terms of this topic area, some potential ethical issues to watch out for include:
Contracts which in substance contain a lease, where the lease element may not have been
accounted for correctly
Material amounts of leases accounted for as short-term with no liability shown in the financial
statements (eg by writing contracts which expire every year)
Use of sale and leaseback arrangements to improve an entity's cash position and alter
accounting ratios, as finance costs are generally shown below operating profit (profit before
interest and tax) whereas depreciation is shown above that line
In lessor financial statements, manipulation of the accounting for leases as operating leases or
finance leases to achieve a particular accounting effect. For example, classification of a lease
as an operating leases since operating lease income is shown as rental income (and included
in operating profit) while finance lease income is shown as finance income, which could be
below a company's operating profit line if being a lessor is not their main business.
TT2020
209
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Lessee accounting
210
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
TT2020
211
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Lessee accounting
Where a contract contains a lease, a right-of-use asset and a liability for the
present value of lease payments are recognised in the lessee's books.
An optional exemption is available for short-term leases (lease term of 12 months or
less) and leases of low value assets, which can be accounted for as an expense over the
lease term.
Deferred tax arises on leases where lease payments are tax deductible when paid:
Carrying amount:
Right-of-use asset X
Lease liability (X)
X
Tax base (0)
Temporary difference X
Deferred tax asset x% X
2. Lessor accounting
Assets leased out under finance leases are derecognised from the lessor's books and
replaced with a receivable, the 'net investment in the lease'.
Assets leased under an operating lease remain in the lessor's books and rental income is
recognised on a straight line basis (or another systematic basis if more representative of the
pattern in which benefit from the underlying asset is diminished).
3. Sale and leaseback transactions
Accounting for sale and leaseback transactions depends on whether in substance a sale has
occurred (ie a performance obligation is satisfied) in accordance with IFRS 15 Revenue from
Contracts with Customers.
Where the transfer is in substance a sale, the seller-lessee derecognises the asset
sold, and recognises a right-of-use asset and lease liability relating to the right of use
retained and a gain/loss in relation to the rights transferred. The buyer-lessor accounts for
the transaction as a normal purchase and a lease.
Where the transfer is in substance not a sale, the seller-lessee accounts for the
proceeds as a financial liability (in accordance with IFRS 9). The buyer-lessor
recognises a financial asset.
212
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
Further reading
There are articles in the CPD section of the ACCA website which are relevant to the topics covered in this
chapter and would be useful to read:
All change for accounting for leases (2016)
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
213
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
214
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Share-based payment
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the recognition and measurement of share-based payment C8(a)
transactions.
Exam context
Share-based payment is a very important topic for SBR and could be tested as a full 25-mark
question in Section B of the exam or as part of a question in either Section A or Section B. Questions
could include the more challenging parts of IFRS 2, such as performance conditions, settlements and
curtailments of share-based payment arrangements.
TT2020
215
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Measurement
216
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Essential reading
See Chapter 10 section 1 of the Essential Reading for the background to IFRS 2. This is available in
Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Illustration 1
Company A issues 100 share options to each of its employees as part of their remuneration
package. Each share option gives the employee the right to purchase one share in Company A in
two years' time for $2.50, subject to the employee remaining in employment with Company A until
then.
Suppose that Company A's current share price is $4.50. The share option is clearly valuable to the
employee, because as it stands, the employee could purchase a share for $2.50, which is much less
than the current market price of $4.50. The share option is said to be 'in the money'.
However, suppose that Company A's share price falls to $2.00. The share option is now effectively
worthless because the employee would be better to purchase Company A's shares on the stock
market for less than the option price. The share option is said to be 'out of the money'.
1.2 Definitions
There are a number of definitions in IFRS 2 which you need to be aware of. It isn't necessary to read
through all of these immediately, but you should refer back to them as you work through this chapter.
Share-based payment transaction: A transaction in which the entity receives goods or services
as consideration for equity instruments of the entity (including shares or share options), or acquires
Key terms
goods or services by incurring liabilities to the supplier of those goods or services for amounts that
are based on the price of the entity's shares or other equity instruments of the entity.
TT2020
217
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Share-based payment arrangement: An agreement between the entity and another party
(including an employee) to enter into a share-based payment transaction.
Equity instrument granted: The right (conditional or unconditional) to an equity instrument of the
entity conferred by the entity on another party, under a share-based payment arrangement.
Share option: A contract that gives the holder the right, but not the obligation, to subscribe to the
entity's shares at a fixed or determinable price for a specified period of time.
Fair value: The amount for which an asset could be exchanged, a liability settled, or an equity
instrument granted could be exchanged between knowledgeable, willing parties in an arm's length
transaction.
Grant date: The date at which the entity and another party (including an employee) agree
to a share-based payment arrangement. At grant date the entity confers on the other party (the
counterparty) the right to cash, other assets, or equity instruments of the entity, provided the
specified vesting conditions, if any, are met.
Vest: To become an entitlement. Under a share-based payment arrangement, a counterparty's right
to receive cash, other assets, or equity instruments of the entity vests upon satisfaction of any
specified vesting conditions.
Vesting conditions: The conditions that must be satisfied for the counterparty to become entitled to
receive cash, other assets or equity instruments of the entity, under a share-based payment arrangement.
Vesting period: The period during which all the specified vesting conditions of a share-based
payment arrangement are to be satisfied.
(IFRS 2: Appendix A)
Equity-settled share- The entity receives goods or services as consideration for equity
based payment instruments of the entity (including shares or share options).
Cash-settled share- The entity acquires goods or services by incurring liabilities to the
based payment supplier of those goods or services for amounts that are based on the
price (or value) of the entity's shares or other equity instruments.
Transactions with a The entity receives or acquires goods or services and the terms of the
choice of settlement arrangement provide either the entity or the supplier with a choice of
whether the entity settles the transaction in cash or by issuing equity
instruments.
Essential reading
See Chapter 10 section 2 of the Essential Reading for further detail on the scope of IFRS 2 and share-
based payments in groups. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
218
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
2 Recognition
An entity should recognise goods or services received or acquired in a share-based payment
transaction when it obtains the goods or as the services are received.
Goods or services received or acquired in a share-based payment transaction should be recognised
as expenses (unless they qualify for recognition as assets).
The corresponding entry in the accounting records depends on whether the transaction is equity-
settled or cash-settled (IFRS 2: paras. 7 and 8).
*IFRS 2 does not specify where in the equity section the credit entry should be presented. Some
entities present a separate component of equity (eg 'Share-based payment reserve'); other entities
may include the credit in retained earnings.
3 Measurement
The entity measures the expense using the method that provides the most reliable information:
The indirect method is usually used for employee services as it is not normally possible to measure
directly the services received.
The fair value of equity instruments should be based on market prices, taking into account the
terms and conditions upon which the equity instruments were granted (IFRS 2: para. 16).
Any changes in estimates of the expected number of employees being entitled to receive share-based
payment are treated as a change in accounting estimate and recognised in the period of the
change.
For subsequent years, the expense is calculated as the movement in the equity or liability balance:
Equity/liability
Balance b/d X
Cash paid (cash-settled only) (X)
Expense (balancing figure)* X
Balance c/d X
* The share-based payment expense is the balancing figure, and is charged to profit or loss
Illustration 2
Accounting for equity-settled share-based payment transactions
On 1 January 20X1 an entity granted 100 share options to each of its 400 employees. Each grant is
conditional upon the employee working for the entity until 31 December 20X3. The fair value of each
share option is $20.
On the basis of a weighted average probability, the entity estimates on 1 January that 18% of
employees will leave during the three-year period and therefore forfeit their rights to share options.
During 20X1, 20 employees leave and the estimate of total employee departures over the three-year
period is revised to 20% (80 employees).
During 20X2, a further 25 employees leave and the entity now estimates that 25% (100) of its
employees will leave during the three-year period.
During 20X3, a further 10 employees leave.
Required
Show the accounting entries which will be required over the three-year period in respect of the share-
based payment transaction.
Solution
IFRS 2 requires the entity to recognise the remuneration expense, based on the fair value of the share
options granted, as the services are received during the three-year vesting period.
In 20X1 and 20X2 the entity estimates the number of options expected to vest (by estimating the
number of employees likely to leave) and bases the amount that it recognises for the year on this
estimate.
In 20X3 the entity recognises an amount based on the number of options that actually vest. A total of
55 employees actually left during the three-year period and therefore 34,500 options ((400 – 55) ×
100) vested.
220
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
1. Calculate
Year to 31 December 20X1 $
2. Then work out
equity Equity b/d the expense 0
carried as the
down Profit or loss expense balancing 213,333
figure 213,333
1
Equity c/d ((400 – 80) × 100 × $20 × )
3
222
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Illustration 3
Cash-settled share-based payment transaction
On 1 January 20X1 an entity grants 100 cash share appreciation rights (SARs) to each of its 500
employees, on condition that the employees continue to work for the entity until 31 December 20X3.
During 20X1, 35 employees leave. The entity estimates that a further 60 will leave during 20X2 and
20X3.
During 20X2, 40 employees leave and the entity estimates that a further 25 will leave during 20X3.
During 20X3, 22 employees leave.
There is an 'exercise period' between 31 December 20X3 and 31 December 20X5 during which the
employees can choose when to exercise their SARs. At 31 December 20X3, 150 employees exercise
their SARs. Another 140 employees exercise their SARs at 31 December 20X4 and the remaining
113 employees exercise their SARs at the end of 20X5.
The fair values of the SARs for each year in which a liability exists are shown below, together with
the intrinsic values at the dates of exercise. The intrinsic value is
Intrinsic the difference
Fair value value between the fair value
and the 'exercise
$ $ price' of the SARs.
20X1 14.40 When the SARs are
20X2 15.50 exercised, the
increase in share
20X3 18.20 15.00 price above the
20X4 21.40 20.00 exercise price is paid
20X5 25.00 to the employees.
Required
Calculate the amount to be recognised in the profit or loss for each of the five years ended
31 December 20X5 and the liability to be recognised in the statement of financial position at
31 December for each of the five years.
Solution
For the three years to the vesting date of 31 December 20X3 the expense is based on the entity's
estimate of the number of SARs that will actually vest (as for an equity-settled transaction). However,
the fair value of the liability is remeasured at each year-end. The fair value of the SARs at the
grant date is irrelevant. The intrinsic value of the SARs at the date of exercise is the amount of cash
actually paid to the employees.
$
Year ended 31 December 20X1
Fair value of the
Liability b/d SARs at 31.12.X1 0
Profit or loss expense 194,400
1 194,400
Liability c/d ((500 – 60 – 35) × 100 × $14.40 × )
3
TT2020
223
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$
Year ended 31 December 20X2 Fair value of the
SARs at 31.12.X2
Liability b/d 194,400
Profit or loss expense 218,933
2 413,333
Liability c/d ((500 – 35 – 40 – 25) × 100 × $15.50 × )
3
SARs vest on
31.12.X3 Intrinsic value of
150 employees
the SARs at $
exercise their SARs
Year ended 31 December 20X3 31.12.X3 = cash
Liability b/d paid out 413,333
Less cash paid on exercise of SARs by employees (150 × 100 × $15.00) (225,000)
Liability c/d ((500 – 35 – 40 – 22 – 150) × 100 × $18.20) 460,460
$
Year ended 31 December 20X4
Liability b/d 460,460
Profit or loss expense 272,127
Less cash paid on exercise of SARs by employees (140 × 100 × $20.00) (280,000)
Liability c/d ((500 – 35 – 40 – 22 – 150 – 140) × 100 × $21.40) 241,820
$
Remaining 241,820
employees who have
$
not exercised their
Year ended 31 December 20X5 SARs
224
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Solution
Essential reading
See Chapter 10 section 4 of the Essential Reading for an illustration showing the difference between
equity-settled and cash-settled share-based payment transactions. This is available in Appendix 2 of
the digital edition of the Workbook.
TT2020
225
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Is there a present
obligation to settle in cash?
Yes No
A present obligation exists if the entity has a stated policy of settling such transactions in cash or past
practice of settling in cash, because this creates an expectation, and so a constructive obligation, to
settle future such transactions in cash.
As for cash-settled transaction Measured as the residual fair value at grant date
Fair value of shares alternative at grant date X
Fair value cash alternative at grant date (X)
Equity component X
226
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
TT2020
227
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
4 Vesting conditions
Vesting conditions are the conditions that must be satisfied for the counterparty to become
unconditionally entitled to receive payment under a share-based payment agreement (IFRS 2:
Appendix A).
Vesting conditions include service conditions and performance conditions. Other features,
such as a requirement for employees to make regular contributions into a savings scheme, are not
vesting conditions.
228
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
average probability, that a further 30 employees will leave during Year 2, and therefore expects that
440 employees will vest in 100 shares at the end of Year 2.
By the end of Year 2, the entity's earnings have increased by only 10% and therefore the shares do
not vest at the end of Year 2. 28 employees have left during the year. The entity expects that a
further 25 employees will leave during Year 3, and that the entity's earnings will increase by at least
6%, thereby achieving the average of 10% per year.
By the end of Year 3, 23 employees have left and the entity's earnings had increased by 8%,
resulting in an average increase of 10.67% per year. Therefore 419 employees received 100 shares
at the end of Year 3.
Required
Show the expense and equity figures which will appear in the financial statements in each of the
three years.
Solution
TT2020
229
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5 Modifications, cancellations and settlements
The entity might:
(a) Modify share options, eg by repricing or by changing from cash-settled to equity-settled; or
(b) Cancel or settle the options.
Repricing of share options might occur, for example, where the share price has fallen. The entity may
then reduce the exercise price of the share options, which increases the fair value of those options
(IFRS 2: para. 26).
5.1 Modifications
5.1.1 General rule
At the date of the modification, the entity must recognise, as a minimum, the services already
received measured at the grant date fair value of the equity instruments granted (IFRS 2:
para. 27); ie the normal IFRS 2 approach is followed up to the date of the modification.
Any modifications that increase the total fair value of the share-based payment must be recognised
over the remaining vesting period (ie as a change in accounting estimate). This increase is
recognised in addition to the amount based on the grant date fair value of the original equity
instruments (which is recognised over the remainder of the original vesting period) (IFRS 2:
para. B43).
For equity-settled share-based payment, the increase in total fair value is measured as:
Fair value of modified equity instruments at the date of modification X
Less fair value of original equity instruments at the date of modification (X)
X
This ensures that only the differential between the original and modified instrument is measured,
rather than any increase in the fair value of the original instruments (which would be inconsistent with
the principle of measuring equity-settled share-based payment at grant date fair values).
Illustration 4
Grant of share options that are subsequently repriced
Background
At the beginning of Year 1, an entity grants 100 share options to each of its 500 employees. Each
grant is conditional upon the employee remaining in service over the next three years. The entity
estimates that the fair value of each option is $15. On the basis of a weighted average probability,
the entity estimates that 100 employees will leave during the three-year period and therefore forfeit
their rights to the share options.
Suppose that 40 employees leave during Year 1. Also suppose that by the end of Year 1, the entity's
share price has dropped, and the entity reprices its share options, and that the repriced share
options vest at the end of Year 3. The entity estimates that a further 70 employees will leave during
Years 2 and 3, and hence the total expected employee departures over the three-year vesting period
is 110 employees.
During Year 2 a further 35 employees leave, and the entity estimates that a further 30 employees will
leave during Year 3, to bring the total expected employee departures over the three-year vesting
period to 105 employees.
During Year 3, a total of 28 employees leave, and hence a total of 103 employees ceased
employment during the vesting period. For the remaining 397 employees, the share options vested
at the end of Year 3.
230
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
The entity estimates that, at the date of repricing, the fair value of each of the original share options
granted (ie before taking into account the repricing) is $5 and that the fair value of each repriced
share option is $8.
Application
The incremental value at the date of repricing is $3 per share option ($8–$5). This amount is
recognised over the remaining 2 years of the vesting period, along with remuneration expense
based on the original option value of $15.
The amounts recognised in Years 1–3 are as follows:
Year 1
This is the usual
calculation for an equity- $
settled transaction
Equity b/d 0
P/L charge 195,000
Equity c/d [(500 – 110) × 100 × $15 × 1/3] 195,000
DEBIT Expenses $195,000
CREDIT Equity $195,000
At the end of Year 1, the shares options are repriced. Because this modification happens at the end
of Year 1, the effect of it is not shown in the financial statements until Year 2.
Year 2 Add on the effect of the
Continue to spread the
original IFRS 2 charge repricing, spread over the
remaining vesting period $
over the vesting period
Equity b/d 195,000
P/L charge 259,250
Equity c/d [(500 – 105) × 100 × (($15 × 2/3) + ($3 × ½))] 454,250
Year 3
$
Equity b/d 454,250
P/L charge 260,350
2 714,600
Equity c/d [(500 – 103) × 100 × (($15 × 3/3) + ($3 × ))]
2
DEBIT Expenses $260,350 This is the total IFRS 2
equity reserve
CREDIT Equity $260,350
TT2020
231
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5.1.2 Accounting for modifications of share-based payment transactions from
cash-settled to equity-settled
If a share-based payment arrangement is modified so that it is now equity-settled rather than cash-
settled, the accounting treatment is as follows (IFRS 2: paras. 33A–33D):
(a) The original liability recognised in respect of the cash-settled share-based payment should
be derecognised and the equity-settled share-based payment should be
recognised at the modification date fair value to the extent services have
been rendered up to the modification date.
(b) The difference, if any, between the carrying amount of the liability as at the modification
date and the amount recognised in equity at the same date would be recognised in profit
or loss immediately.
5.2.2 Settlement
If a payment (ie a settlement) is made to the employee on cancellation, it is treated as a deduction
from (repurchase of) equity or extinguishment of a liability (depending on whether the
share-based payment was equity- or cash-settled) (IFRS 2: para. 28(b)).
For equity-settled share-based payment settlements, any excess of the payment over the fair
value of equity instruments granted measured at the repurchase date is recognised as an
expense (IFRS 2: para. 28(b)).
A liability is first remeasured to fair value at the date of cancellation/settlement and any
payment made is treated as an extinguishment of the liability (IFRS 2: para. 28(b)).
5.2.3 Replacement
If equity instruments are granted to the employee as a replacement for the cancelled instruments (and
specifically identified as a replacement) this is treated as a modification of the original grant (IFRS 2:
para. 28(c)).
*Fair value immediately before cancellation less any payments to employee on cancellation
232
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
The share price of Piper fell substantially during 20X1. On 1 January 20X2 the fair value of the share
options had fallen to $1 each and 975 of the employees who were awarded options remained in
the company's employ. During the year ended 31 December 20X2 35 of those employees left and
the company estimated that a further 40 would leave each year before 31 December 20X4.
Required
Discuss, with suitable calculations, the accounting treatment of the share options in Piper's financial
statements for the year ended 31 December 20X2 if on 1 January 20X2:
(a) The original options were cancelled and $4 million is paid to employees as compensation.
(b) Piper's management cancelled the share options and replaced them with new share options,
vesting on 31 December 20X4, the fair value of each replacement option on 1 January 20X2
being $7. No compensation would be paid.
Solution
TT2020
233
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6 Deferred tax implications
6.1 Issue
An entity may receive a tax deduction that differs from related cumulative remuneration expense
which may arise in a later accounting period.
For example, an entity recognises an expense for share options granted under IFRS 2, but does not
receive a tax deduction until the options are exercised and receives the tax deduction based on the
share price on the exercise date.
6.2 Measurement
The deferred tax asset temporary difference is measured as:
If the amount of the tax deduction (or estimated future tax deduction) exceeds the amount of the
related cumulative remuneration expense, this indicates that the tax deduction relates also to an
equity item.
The excess is therefore recognised directly in equity (note it is not reported in other comprehensive
income) (IAS 12: paras. 68A–68C).
Illustration 5
Deferred tax implications of share-based payment
On 1 June 20X5, Farrow grants 16,000 share options to one of its employees. At the grant date, the
fair value of each option is $4. The share options vest two years later on 1 June 20X7.
Tax allowances arise when the options are exercised and the tax allowance is based on the option's
intrinsic value at the exercise date. The intrinsic value of the share options is $2.25 at 31 May 20X6
and $4.50 at 31 May 20X7 on which date the options are exercised.
Assume a tax rate of 30%.
Required
Show the deferred tax accounting treatment of the above transaction at 31 May 20X6, 31 May
20X7 (before exercise) and on exercise.
234
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Solution
31.5.X7
Before
This is always nil 31.5.X6 exercise
$ $
Carrying amount of share-based payment expense 0 0
Less tax base of share-based payment expense
(16,000 × $2.25 × ½)/(16,000 × $4.50) (18,000) (72,000)
To determine where to record the deferred tax, we must first compare the cumulative accounting
expense with the cumulative tax deduction for each year. Where the tax deduction is greater than
the accounting expense recognised, the excess is taken directly to equity.
Year 1 Year 2
$ $
Accounting expense recognised (16,000 × $4 × ½)/(16,000 × $4) 32,000 64,000
Tax deduction (18,000) (72,000)
Excess temporary difference 0 (8,000)
Excess deferred tax asset to equity at 30% 0 2,400
In Year 1, the accounting expense is greater than the tax deduction, so the double entry to record the
deferred tax asset is:
DEBIT Deferred tax asset $5,400
CREDIT Deferred tax (P/L) $5,400
In Year 2, the tax deduction is $8,000 greater than the accounting expense, therefore the excess
deferred tax asset of $2,400 is credited to equity:
DEBIT Deferred tax asset $16,200 Credit profit or loss
CREDIT Deferred tax (P/L) with the increase in
(21,600 – 5,400 – 2,400) $13,800 the deferred tax asset
less the amount
CREDIT Deferred tax (equity) $2,400 credited to equity
On exercise, the deferred tax asset is replaced by a current tax asset. The double entry is:
DEBIT Deferred tax (P/L) $19,200
Reversal of
DEBIT Deferred tax (equity) $2,400 deferred tax asset
CREDIT Deferred tax asset $21,600
DEBIT Current tax asset $21,600
CREDIT Current tax (P/L) $19,200
CREDIT Current tax (equity) $2,400
TT2020
235
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 6: Deferred tax implications of share-based payment
On 1 January 20X2, an entity granted 5,000 share options to an employee vesting two years later
on 31 December 20X3. The fair value of each option measured at the grant date was $3.
Tax law in the jurisdiction in which the entity operates allows a tax deduction of the intrinsic value
of the options on exercise. The intrinsic value of the share options was $1.20 at 31 December 20X2
and $3.40 at 31 December 20X3 on which date the options were exercised.
Assume a tax rate of 30%.
Required
Show the deferred tax accounting treatment of the above transaction at 31 December 20X2,
31 December 20X3 (before exercise), and on exercise.
Solution
Performance objective 7 of the PER requires you to demonstrate that you can contribute to the
drafting or reviewing of primary financial statements according to accounting standards and
PER alert
legislation. This chapter will help you with the drafting and reviewing of disclosure required for
share-based payments in the financial statements.
236
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Ethics note
Ethical issues will always be tested in Question 2 of every exam. Therefore you need to be alert to
any threats to the fundamental principles of the ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct when
approaching each topic.
In relation to share-based payments granted to directors, one key threat that could arise is that of
self-interest if the vesting conditions are based on performance measures. There is a danger that
strategies and accounting policies are manipulated to obtain maximum return on exercise of
share-based payments. For example, if vesting conditions are based on achieving a certain profit
figure, a director may be tempted to improve profits by suggesting that, for example:
The useful lives of assets are extended (reducing depreciation or amortisation)
A policy of revaluing property is changed to the cost model
Development costs are capitalised when they should be expensed
The revenue recognition policy is changed to recognise revenue earlier
Some other form of 'creative accounting' is undertaken
A change in accounting policy to provide more reliable and relevant information is of course
permitted by IAS 8. But to change a policy purely to boost profits to maximise share-based payments
is unethical.
TT2020
237
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Measurement
238
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
TT2020
239
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
240
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Question practice
Now try the questions below from the Further question practice bank:
Q17 Vesting conditions
Q18 Lowercroft
Further reading
There are articles on the ACCA website which are relevant to the topics covered in this chapter and which
you should read:
Exam support resources section of the ACCA website
IFRS 2, Share-based Payment
CPD section of the ACCA website
Get to grips with IFRS 2 (2017)
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
241
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
242
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 2
Resolving financial reporting issues
aging information
Man
aging information
Man
An
sw
Resolving financial
er
pl
t
en
reporting issues
manag ime
an
em
t
nin
Approaching Resolving financial Exam Success Skills
Good
r p re t ati o n
Specific SBR Skills
e nts
Applying good
req f rrprneteation
consolidation
re m
Creating effective techniques
i ts
discussion
m eun
of t inotect i
uireeq
Eff d p
an
c re
Interpreting
e c re
r re o r
e C
ti v
financial statements
se w ri
nt tin
ati g
Co
on
Efficient numerical
analysis
Introduction
Section A of the Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam will consist of two scenario based
questions that will total 50 marks. The first question will be based on the financial statements of
group entities, or extracts thereof (syllabus area D), and is also likely to require consideration of
some financial reporting issues (syllabus area C). The second question will require
candidates to consider the reporting implications and the ethical implications of specific
events in a given scenario.
Section B will contain two further questions which may be scenario or case-study or essay based
and will contain both discursive and numerical elements. Section B could deal with any
aspect of the syllabus.
As financial reporting issues are highly likely to be tested in both sections of your SBR exam, it is
essential that you have mastered the skill for resolving financial reporting issues in order to
maximise your chance of passing the SBR exam.
TT2020
243
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2: Resolving financial reporting issues
STEP 1:
Look at the mark allocation of the question and
work out how many minutes you have to
answer the question (based on 1.95 minutes a
mark).
STEP 2:
Read the requirement and analyse it. Highlight each
sub-requirement separately, identify the verb(s) and
ask yourelf what each sub-requirement means.
STEP 3:
Read the scenario, asking yourself for each
paragraph which IAS or IFRS may be relevant and
apply that acccounting standard to each paragraph
of the question.
STEP 4:
Prepare an answer plan ensuring that you cover
each of the issues raised in the scenario. Choose
your preferred format (eg mind map, bullet pointed
list, annotating the question paper).
STEP 5:
Write up your answer with a separate underlined
heading for each of the items in the scenario. Write
in full sentences and clearly explain each point.
244
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
However, how you write up your answer in Step 5 depends on whether in the
scenario:
(a) The items have not yet been accounted for; or
(b) The items have already been accounted for.
The diagram below summaries how you should write up your answer in each of the
above circumstances:
TT2020
245
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam success skills
For this question, we will focus on the following exam success skills and in particular:
Good time management. Remember that as the exam is 3 hours and
15 minutes long, you have 1.95 minutes a mark. The following question is
worth 15 marks so you should allow approximately 29 minutes. Approximately
a quarter to a third of your time (7–10 minutes) should be allocated to analysis
of the requirement, active reading of the scenario and an answer plan. The
remaining time should be used to write up your answer.
Managing information. This type of case study style question typically
contains several paragraphs of information and each paragraph is likely to
revolve around a different IAS or IFRS. This is a lot of information to absorb and
the best approach is effective planning. As you read each paragraph, you
should think about which IAS or IFRS may be relevant (there could be more than
one relevant for each paragraph) and if you cannot think of a relevant IAS or
IFRS, you can fall back on the principles of the Conceptual Framework for
Financial Reporting (the Conceptual Framework).
Correct interpretation of requirements. Firstly, you should identify the
verb in the requirement. You should then read the rest of the requirement and
analyse it to determine exactly what your answer needs to address.
Answer planning. After Skills Checkpoint 1, you should have practised some
questions which will have allowed you to identify your preferred format for an
answer plan. It may be simply annotating the question paper or you might
prefer to write out your own bullet-pointed list or even draw up a mind map.
Effective writing and presentation. Each paragraph of the question will
usually relate to its own standalone transaction with its own related IAS or IFRS.
It is useful to set up separate headings in your answer for each paragraph in the
question. As for ethical issues questions, underline your headings and sub-
headings with a ruler and write in full sentences, ensuring your style is
professional. For Question 2 (where both financial reporting and ethical issues
are tested), there will be two professional skills marks available and if reporting
issues are tested in the Section B analysis question, there will also be two
professional skills marks available in this question. You must do your best to
earn these marks. It could end up being the difference between a pass and a
fail. The use of headings, sub-headings and full sentences as well as clear
explanations and ensuring that all sub-requirements are met and all issues in the
scenario are addressed will help you obtain these two marks.
246
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
Skill Activity
STEP 1 Look at the mark allocation of the following question and work out
how many minutes you have to answer the question. Just the
requirement and mark allocation have been reproduced here. It is a
15 mark question and at 1.95 minutes a mark, it should take
29 minutes. This time should be split approximately as follows:
Reading the question – 4 minutes
Planning your answer – 4 minutes
Writing up your answer – 21 minutes
Within each of these phases, your time should be split equally
between the three issues in the scenario as you can see from the
question that they are worth the same number of marks each (five
marks).
Required
Advise Cate on the matters set out above (in (a), (b) and (c)) with reference to relevant
International Financial Reporting Standards. (15 marks)
STEP 2 Read the requirement for the following question and analyse it.
Highlight each sub-requirement, identify the verb(s) and ask yourself
what each sub-requirement means.
There is just a
single
requirement
Verb – what
here
does this mean?
Required
Advise Cate on the matters set out above (in (a), (b) and (c)) with reference to relevant
TT2020
247
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
In the context of this question, the type of guidance required relates to the appropriate
accounting treatment to follow for each issue in the question according to the relevant
accounting standard. The 'recipient' you need to advise here is the company, Cate,
and presumably more specifically, the board of directors.
STEP 3 Now read the scenario. For each paragraph, ask yourself which IAS
or IFRS may be relevant (remember you do not need to know the IAS
or IFRS number). Then think about which specific rules or principles
from that IAS or IFRS are relevant to the particular transaction or
balance in the paragraph. Then you need to decide whether the
proposed accounting treatment complies with the relevant IAS or IFRS.
If you cannot think of a relevant IAS or IFRS, then refer to the
Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting (Conceptual
Framework).
To identify the issues, you might want to consider whether one or more
of the following are relevant in the scenario:
248
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
Likely to recur? 31 May 20X5. In the financial year to 31 May 20X6 Cate made Relevant accounting
standard = IAS 12
a small profit before tax. This included significant non-operating Income Taxes.
Is the deferred tax asset
gains. In 20X5, Cate recognised a material deferred tax asset in recoverable? Indicators
of recoverability
respect of carried forward losses, which will expire during (IAS 12: para. 36)
Assess deferred tax asset recoverability from IAS 12 (para. 36) indicators:
Sufficient taxable temporary differences which will result in taxable
amounts against which unused losses can be utilised before they expire
Probable taxable profits before unused tax losses expire
Losses result from identifiable causes which are unlikely to recur
Tax planning opportunities are available that will create taxable profit in
the period in which unused tax losses can be utilised
TT2020
249
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Relevant accounting
standard = IAS 28
Investments in Associates
and Joint Ventures
IFRS 13 definition
agreement. Cate also stated that the quoted share price was not an
of fair value
appropriate measure when considering the fair value of Cate's
significant influence on Bates. Therefore, Cate measured the fair value of
Acceptable fair
its interest in Bates through application of two measurement
value measures
This should arouse under IFRS 13?
techniques; one based on earnings multiples and the other
your suspicions – is
Cate deliberately based on an option-pricing model. Neither of these methods
avoiding recording
an impairment loss? supported the existence of an impairment loss as of 31 May
20X6. (5 marks)
Relevant accounting
standard = IAS 19
(c) In its 20X6 financial statements, Cate disclosed the existence of a Employee Benefits
Who has the risks voluntary fund established in order to provide a post-retirement
and rewards
associated with the benefit plan (Plan) to employees. Cate considers its contributions to
pension plan? Is this accounting
Employees = defined the Plan to be voluntary, and has not recorded any related liability treatment correct?
contribution;
employers = defined in its consolidated financial statements. Cate has a history of paying
benefit
benefits to its former employees, even increasing them to Creates a valid
expectation in
keep pace with inflation since the commencement of the Plan. employees that they
will receive pension
Cate guaranteeing The main characteristics of the Plan are as follows: payments =
constructive obligation
pensions = defined
benefit (i) The Plan is totally funded by Cate.
250
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
Cate argues that it should not have to recognise the Plan because,
according to the underlying contract, it can terminate its
contributions to the Plan, if and when it wishes. The termination Cate has obligation to
pay promised pension
clauses of the contract establish that Cate must immediately either directly or via
purchasing an annuity
purchase lifetime annuities from an insurance company for all the = defined benefit
Required
Advise Cate on the matters set out above (in (a), (b) and (c)) with
reference to relevant International Financial Reporting Standards.
(15 marks)
TT2020
251
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
STEP 4 Prepare an answer plan using a separate heading for each of the three issues in the
scenario ((a), (b) and (c)). Ask yourself:
(1) What is the proposed accounting treatment in the scenario?
(2) What is the correct accounting treatment (per relevant rules/principles from IAS or
IFRS) and why (apply the rules/principles per the IAS/IFRS to the scenario)?
(3) What adjustment (if any) is required?
As this is a 15-mark question, you should aim to generate 12–13 points to achieve a
comfortable pass.
252
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
STEP 5 Write up your answer with a separate underlined heading for each
of the three items in the scenario. Write in full sentences and
clearly explain each point in professional language. Structure your
answer for each of the three items as follows:
Rule/principle per IAS or IFRS (state briefly)
Apply rule/principle to the scenario (correct accounting
treatment and why)
Conclude
Underlined heading
Suggested solution (one for each of the 3
items in the scenario)
(a) Deferred tax
In principle, IAS 12 Income Taxes allows recognition of deferred tax
assets, if material, for deductible temporary differences, unused tax
losses and unused tax credits. However, IAS 12 states that deferred
tax assets should only be recognised to the extent that they
Rule/principle (per
are regarded as recoverable. They should be regarded as accounting standard)
recoverable to the extent that on the basis of all the evidence available it
is probable that there will be suitable taxable profits against
which the losses can be recovered. There is evidence that this is
not the case for Cate:
(i) While Cate has made a small profit before tax in the year to
31 May 20X6, this includes significant non-operating gains.
In other words the profit is not due to ordinary business activities.
(iii) The fact that there are unused tax losses is strong evidence,
according to IAS 12, that future taxable profits may not be
Apply
available against which to offset the losses.
TT2020
253
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
In conclusion, Cate should not recognise deferred tax assets on Conclude
Underlined heading
(one for each of the
3 items in the
scenario)
(b) Investment in Bates
in respect of Bates.
Cate argues that there is no binding sale agreement and that the quoted
share price is not an appropriate measure of the fair value or its
significant influence over Bates. IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement defines
fair value as 'the price that would be received to sell an asset…in an
Apply
orderly transaction between market participants'. Just because there is no
binding sale agreement does not mean that Cate cannot measure fair
value. IFRS 13 has a three-level hierarchy in measuring fair value:
254
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
IAS 36 states that the value in use of an asset is measured as the present
value of estimated future cash flows (inflows minus outflows) generated by
the asset, including its estimated net disposal value (if any). IAS 28
Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures gives some more specific
guidance on investments where there is significant influence. In
Rule/principle
determining the value in use of these investments an entity should estimate: (per accounting
standard)
(1) Its share of the present value of the estimated future cash flows
expected to be generated by the associate (including disposal
proceeds); and
(2) The present value of future cash flows expected to arise from
dividends to be received from the investment.
TT2020
255
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Cate has not produced any cash flow estimates, but it could, Apply
Conclusion
Cate is able to produce figures for fair value less cost to sell and for value
in use, and it should do so. If the carrying amount exceeds the higher of Conclude
these two, then the asset is impaired and must be written down to its
recoverable amount.
Underlined heading
(one for each of the 3
(c) 'Voluntary' post-retirement benefit plan items in the scenario)
(i) While the plan is voluntary, IAS 19 Employee Benefits says that an
Rule/principle
entity must account for constructive as well as legal (per accounting
standard)
obligations. These may arise from informal practices, where an
entity has no realistic alternative but to pay employee benefits,
because employees have a valid expectation that they will be
Apply
paid.
256
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
Cate must account for the scheme as a defined benefit plan and
Conclude
recognise, as a minimum, its net present obligation for the benefits to be
paid.
TT2020
257
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam success skills diagnostic
Every time you complete a question, use the diagnostic below to assess how effectively you
demonstrated the exam success skills in answering the question. The table has been
completed below for the Cate activity to go you an idea of how to complete the diagnostic.
Good time Did you spend approximately a quarter to a third of your time
management reading and planning?
Did you allow yourself time to address all three of the issues in
the scenario?
Your writing time should be split between these three issues but
it does not necessarily have to be spread evenly – there is more
to say about some issues (eg impairment) than others.
Managing Did you identify which IASs or IFRSs were relevant for each
information paragraph of the scenario?
Did you ask yourself whether the proposed accounting treatment
complies with that IAS or IFRS or the Conceptual Framework?
Answer planning Did you draw up an answer plan using your preferred
approach (eg mind map, bullet-pointed list or annotated
question paper)?
Did your plan address all three of the issues in the scenario?
Did you take the following approach in your plan?
(a) What is the proposed accounting treatment in the scenario?
(b) What is the correct accounting treatment (per the relevant
rules/principles) and why (apply the rules/principles per the
IAS/IFRS to the scenario)?
(c) What adjustment (if any) is required?
Effective writing and Did you use full sentences and professional language with clear
presentation explanations?
Did you structure your answer with underlined headings (one for
each of (a), (b) and (c)?
When stating the relevant rule or principle, was your answer
concise (remember most of the marks are for application of that
rule or principle)?
Did you structure your answer as follows?
(a) State relevant rule or principle briefly
(b) Apply the rule or principle to the scenario
(c) Conclude whether the proposed accounting treatment is
correct
258
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 2
Summary
To answer a financial reporting issues question well in the SBR exam, you need to be
familiar with the key rules and principles of accounting standards so that you can
identify the relevant ones to apply in a question. The following website has very useful
summaries for IAS and IFRS:
www.iasplus.com/en-gb/standards
But do not panic if you cannot identify a relevant accounting standard, because a
sensible discussion in the context of the Conceptual Framework will be given credit.
The key is to explain why you are proposing a certain accounting treatment.
Remember the best way to write up your answer is:
State the relevant rule or principle per IAS or IFRS (state briefly)
Apply the rule or principle to the scenario (correct accounting treatment and why)
Conclude
TT2020
259
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
260
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Basic groups
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the principles behind determining whether a business D1(a)
combination has occurred.
Discuss and apply the method of accounting for a business combination including D1(b)
identifying an acquirer and the principles in determining the cost of a business
combination.
Apply the recognition and measurement criteria for identifiable acquired assets D1(c)
and liabilities including contingent amounts and intangible assets.
Discuss and apply the accounting for goodwill and non-controlling interest. D1(d)
Discuss and apply the equity method of accounting for associates. D2(b)
TT2020
261
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam context
Group accounting is extremely important for the SBR exam. Section A Question 1 of the exam will be
based on the financial statements of group entities, or extracts from them. Group accounting could
also feature in a Section B question. A lot of this chapter is revision as it has been covered in your
earlier studies in Financial Reporting. However, ensure you study it carefully, as not only does it form
the basis for the more complex chapters that follow, some basic group accounting techniques will
usually be required in groups questions in the exam.
262
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Chapter overview
Basic groups
Consolidated Subsidiaries
financial statements
Consideration transferred
TT2020
263
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1 Consolidated financial statements
1.1 Preparing consolidated financial statements
IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements requires a parent to present consolidated financial
statements in which the accounts of the parent and subsidiaries are combined and presented as a
single economic entity (IFRS 10: para. 4).
The individual financial statements of parents, subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures should be
prepared to the same reporting date.
Where this is impracticable, the most recent financial statements are used, and:
The difference must be no greater than three months;
Adjustments are made for the effects of significant transactions in the intervening period; and
The length of the reporting periods and any difference in the reporting dates must be the same
from period to period.
Uniform accounting policies should be used. Adjustments must be made where members of a group
use different accounting policies, so that their financial statements are suitable for consolidation.
(IFRS 10: para. B87, B92–93)
Link to the Conceptual Framework
The revised Conceptual Framework has introduced the concept of the reporting entity for the first
Link to the
Conceptual
time. A reporting entity is an entity that chooses, or is required, to prepare general purpose financial
Framework statements. For a reporting entity which consists of a parent and its subsidiaries, the reporting entity's
financial statements are the consolidated financial statements of the group.
264
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
2 Subsidiaries
Subsidiary: An entity that is controlled by another entity.
Key terms Control: The power to govern the financial and operating policies of an entity so as to obtain
benefits from its activities.
Power: Existing rights that give the current ability to direct the relevant activities of the investee.
(IFRS 10: Appendix A)
The key point in the definition of a subsidiary is control. An investor controls an investee if, and only
if, the investor has all of the following (IFRS 10: paras. 10–12):
Examples of power Examples of variable returns An investor can have the current
(IFRS 10: para. B15): (IFRS 10: paras. 15, B57): ability to direct the activities of
an investee even if it does not
• Voting rights • Dividends
actively direct the activities
• Rights to appoint, • Interest from debt of the investee
reassign or remove
• Changes in value of
key management Only the principal (not an agent)
investment
personnel may control an investee when
• Remuneration for exercising its decision-making
• Rights to appoint or
servicing investee's assets powers
remove another entity
or liabilities
that directs relevant
activities • Fees/exposure to loss from
providing credit/liquidity
• Management contract
support
Examples of relevant • Residual interest in assets
activities: and liabilities on liquidation
• Sell and purchase • Tax benefits
goods/services
• Access to future liquidity
• Manage financial assets
• Returns not available to
• Select, acquire, dispose other interest holders,
of assets eg cost savings
• Research and develop new
products/processes
• Determine funding
structure/obtain funding
TT2020
265
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 1: Control
Edwards, a public limited company, acquires 40% of the voting rights of Hope. The remaining
investors each hold 5% of the voting rights of Hope. A shareholder agreement grants Edwards the
right to appoint, remove and set the remuneration of management responsible for key business
decisions of Hope. To change this agreement, a two-thirds majority vote of the shareholders is
required.
Required
Discuss, using the IFRS 10 definition of control, whether Edwards controls Hope.
Solution
266
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
The reasons directors may not want to consolidate a subsidiary and why that would not be
appropriate under IFRS are given below.
Severe long-term restrictions limit the Consider parent's ability to control the subsidiary;
parent's ability to run the subsidiary if it is not controlled, it should not be
consolidated (because the definition of a subsidiary
is not met)
Stakeholder perspective
It is important that all entities which a parent controls are included in the consolidated financial
Stakeholder
perspective
statements so that current and potential investors can make informed decisions about providing
resources to the group.
Consider, for example, Royal Dutch Shell which is a very large and complex group containing over
1,000 subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures in around 150 countries. If consolidated financial
statements were not prepared, investors would have to review and understand each of the individual
financial statements and consider their impact on the other entities within the group, which is not
practical and would not result in a consistent basis for decision making.
TT2020
267
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Typical characteristics of an investment entity are that it has (IFRS 10: para. 28):
more than one investment;
more than one investor;
investors that are not related parties of the entity; and
ownership interests in the form of equity or similar interests.
DEBIT Cash X
CREDIT Receivables X
*The convention is to make this adjustment in the accounts of the receiving company.
Business combination: A transaction or other event in which an acquirer obtains control of one
or more businesses.
Key terms
Business: An integrated set of activities and assets that is capable of being conducted and
managed for the purpose of providing goods or services to customers, generating investment income
(such as dividends or interest) or generating other income from ordinary activities.
(IFRS 3: Appendix A)
268
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
The definition of a business is important. If an acquired group of assets and liabilities meets the
definition of a business, the transaction is a business combination and is accounted for under
IFRS 3. If not, then it is an asset acquisition and is accounted for as such. This is an application of
substance over form.
Business combination:
Meets the definition of
apply acquisition
a business in IFRS 3
accounting
Acquisition of asset(s)
and liabilities
Does not meet the
Account for as an asset
definition of a business
acquisition
in IFRS 3
Ability to
A substantive contribute to
An input
process the creation
of outputs
IFRS 3 also contains an optional 'concentration test' to help entities determine if an acquisition is a
business. To apply the test, the entity should determine if substantially all of the fair value of the gross
assets acquired is concentrated in a single identifiable asset or group of similar identifiable assets. If
it is, then the transaction is not the acquisition of a business.
TT2020
269
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.2 Acquisition method
All business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method in IFRS 3. This requires
(IFRS 3: paras. 4–5):
(a) Identifying the acquirer: ie the parent.
(b) Determining the acquisition date: the date control is obtained.
(c) Recognising and measuring the identifiable assets acquired, the liabilities assumed
and any non-controlling interest in the subsidiary.
(d) Recognising and measuring goodwill or a gain from a bargain purchase.
Choice
Impairment of goodwill
• Deduct all of cumulutative Impairment of goodwill
impairment losses from
goodwill (control) • Deduct all of cumulutative
impairment losses from
• Deduct all of cumulutative goodwill (control)
impairment losses to the
retained earnings working • Post the group share (80%)
(ownership) (as they all relate to of cumulative impairment losses
group goodwill) to the retained earnings
working and the NCI share
of impairment losses (20%) to
the NCI working (ownership)
(as some of the losses relate to
group goodwill and some to
NCI godwill)
270
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Purpose To show the assets and liabilities which the parent (P) controls and the
ownership of those assets and liabilities
Assets and Always 100% of P plus 100% of the subsidiary (S) providing P controls S
liabilities
Goodwill Consideration transferred plus non-controlling interests (NCI) less fair value
(FV) of net assets at acquisition
Reason: shows the value of the reputation etc of the company acquired at
acquisition date
Consideration transferred X
Non-controlling interests (at FV or at share of FV of net assets) X
Less: Net fair value of identifiable assets acquired and
liabilities assumed:
Share capital X
Share premium X
Retained earnings at acquisition X
Other reserves at acquisition X
Fair value adjustments at acquisition X
(X)
X
Less impairment losses on goodwill to date (X)
X
TT2020
271
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(2) Consolidated retained earnings
Associate/
Parent Subsidiary joint venture
At year end X X X
Adjustments X(X) X(X) X(X)
Fair value adjustments movement X/(X) X/(X)
Pre-acquisition retained earnings (X) (X)
Y Z
Group share of post-acquisition retained
earnings:
Subsidiary (Y × group share) X
Associate/Joint venture (Z × group X
share)
Less group share of impairment losses to (X)
date
X
272
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Brown Harris
$'000 $'000
Equity
Share capital 1,000 500
Retained earnings 3,430 1,800
4,430 2,300
Non-current liabilities 350 290
Current liabilities 1,580 1,100
6,360 3,690
Additional information:
(1) Brown acquired a 60% investment in Harris on 1 January 20X6 for $720,000 when the
retained earnings of Harris were $300,000.
(2) On 30 November 20X9, Harris sold goods to Brown for $200,000, one-quarter of which
remain in Brown's inventories at 31 December. Harris earns 25% mark-up on all items sold.
(3) An impairment review was conducted at 31 December 20X9 and it was decided that the
goodwill on acquisition of Harris was impaired by 10%.
Required
Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position for the Brown group as at 31 December 20X9
under the following assumptions:
(a) It is group policy to value non-controlling interest at fair value at the date of acquisition. The
fair value of the non-controlling interest at 1 January 20X6 was $480,000.
(b) It is group policy to value non-controlling interest at the proportionate share of the fair value of
the net assets at acquisition.
Solution
TT2020
273
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.5 Consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive
income
3.5.1 Overview
The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income shows a true and fair
view of the group's activities since acquisition of any subsidiaries.
(a) The top part of the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
shows the income, expenses, profit and other comprehensive income controlled by the group.
(b) The reconciliation at the bottom of the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income shows the ownership of those profits and total comprehensive income.
Revision of working for NCI's share of subsidiary's profit for the year (PFY) and
total comprehensive income (TCI)
× NCI share X X
274
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Additional information:
(a) Constance acquired an 80% investment in Spicer on 1 April 20X5. It is group policy to
measure non-controlling interests at fair value at acquisition. Goodwill of $100,000 arose on
acquisition. The fair value of the net assets was deemed to be the same as the carrying
amount of net assets at acquisition.
(b) An impairment review was conducted on 31 December 20X5 and it was decided that the
goodwill on the acquisition of Spicer was impaired by 10%.
(c) On 31 October 20X5, Spicer sold goods to Constance for $300,000. Two-thirds of these goods
remain in Constance's inventories at the year end. Spicer charges a mark-up of 25% on cost.
(d) Assume that the profits and other comprehensive income of Spicer accrue evenly over the year.
Required
Prepare the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the
Constance group for the year ended 31 December 20X5.
TT2020
275
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
4 Associates
Associate: An entity over which the investor has significant influence. (IAS 28: para. 3)
Key term
Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the
investee but is not control or joint control over those policies (IAS 28: para. 3). This could be shown by:
(a) Representation on the board of directors
(b) Participation in policy-making processes
(c) Material transactions between the entity and investee
(d) Interchange of managerial personnel
(e) Provision of essential technical information
If an investor holds 20% or more of the voting power of the investee, it can be presumed that the
investor has significant influence over the investee, unless it can be clearly shown that this is not the
case (IAS 28: para. 5).
Significant influence can be presumed not to exist if the investor holds less than 20% of the voting
power of the investee, unless it can be demonstrated otherwise.
276
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Sale by parent (P) to the associate (A), where A still holds the inventories, where A% is the
parent's holding in the associate and PUP is the unrealised profit
DEBIT Cost of sales/Retained earnings of P PUP × A%
CREDIT Investment in associate PUP × A%
Sale by associate (A) to parent (P), where P still holds the inventories, A% is the parent's holding
in the associate and PUP is the unrealised profit
DEBIT Share of associate's profit/Retained earnings of P PUP × A%
CREDIT Group inventories PUP × A%
TT2020
277
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 1
Associate
P purchased a 60% holding in S on 1 January 20X0 for $6.1 million when the retained earnings of
S were $3.6 million. The retained earnings of S at 31 December 20X4 were $10.6 million. Since
acquisition, there has been no impairment of the goodwill in S.
P also has a 30% holding in A which it acquired on 1 July 20X1 for $4.1m when the retained earnings
of A were $6.2 million. The retained earnings of A at 31 December 20X4 were $9.2 million.
An impairment test conducted at the year end revealed that the investment in associate was impaired
by $500,000.
During the year A sold goods to P for $3 million at a profit margin of 20%. One-third of these goods
remained in P's inventories at the year end. The retained earnings of P at 31 December 20X4 were
$41.6 million.
Required
(a) What accounting adjustment in relation to unrealised profit is required in the consolidated
financial statements of P for the year ended 31 December 20X4?
(b) Calculate the following amounts for inclusion in the consolidated statement of financial position
of the P group as at 31 December 20X4:
(i) Investment in associate
(ii) Consolidated retained earnings
Solution
(a) As the associate is the seller, the share of the profit of associate (rather than cost of sales) must
be reduced.
Accounting adjustment
DEBIT Share of profit of associate $60,000
CREDIT Inventories $60,000
Calculation:
Unrealised profit
20% 1
adjustment = $3,000,000 × margin × in inventory × 30% group share
100% 3
= $60,000
278
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Tutorial note.
Even though the associate was the seller for the intragroup trading, unrealised profit is
adjusted in the parent's column so as not to multiply it by the group share twice.
Working: Group structure
P
S A
Where a parent transfers a 'business' to its associate (or joint venture), the full gain or loss is
recognised (as it is similar to losing control of a subsidiary – covered in Chapter 13).
5 Fair values
5.1 Goodwill
To understand the importance of fair values in the acquisition of a subsidiary consider again the
calculation of goodwill.
Goodwill $
Consideration transferred X
Non-controlling interests at acquisition (at FV or at % FV of net assets) X
Fair value of acquirer's previously held equity interest
(for business combinations achieved in stages – covered in Chapter 12) X
X
Less net acquisition – date fair value of identifiable assets acquired
and liabilities assumed (X)
X
Both the consideration transferred and the net assets at acquisition must be measured at fair value
to arrive at true goodwill.
TT2020
279
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Normally goodwill is a positive balance which is recorded as an intangible non-current
asset. Occasionally it is negative and arises as a result of a 'bargain purchase'. In this instance,
IFRS 3 requires reassessment of the calculations to ensure that they are accurate and then any
remaining negative goodwill should be recognised as a gain in profit or loss and therefore also
recorded in group retained earnings (IFRS 3: paras. 34, 36).
Item Treatment
280
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Deferred tax assets/liabilities Measurement based on IAS 12 values (not IFRS 13)
Employee benefit assets/ Measurement based on IAS 19 values (not IFRS 13)
liabilities
Reacquired rights (eg a licence Fair value is based on the remaining term, ignoring the likelihood of
granted to the subsidiary renewal
before it became a subsidiary)
Assets held for sale Measurement at fair value less costs to sell per IFRS 5
282
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
The draft financial statements for the year ended 31 December 20X9 are:
STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT 31 DECEMBER 20X9
Bailey Hill Campbell
Non-current assets $m $m $m
Property, plant and equipment 2,300 1,900 700
Investment in Hill 72720 – –
Investment in Campbell 225 – –
3,245 1,900 700
$m $m $m
Current assets 3,115 1,790 1,050
6,360 3,690 1,750
Equity
Share capital 1,000 500 240
Retained earnings 3,430 1,800 330
4,430 2,300 570
Non-current liabilities 350 290 220
Current liabilities 1,580 1,100 960
66,360 3,690 1,750
TT2020
283
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(c) Bailey elected to measure the non-controlling interests in Hill at fair value at the date of
acquisition. The fair value of the non-controlling interests in Hill at 1 January 20X6 was
$450 million.
(d) Cumulative impairment losses on recognised goodwill in Hill at 31 December 20X9 amounted
to $20 million, of which $15 million arose during the year. It is the group's policy to recognise
impairment losses on positive goodwill in administrative expenses. No impairment losses have
been necessary on the investment in Campbell.
Required
Using the proformas below to help you, prepare the consolidated statement of financial position for
the Bailey Group as at 31 December 20X9 and the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income for the year then ended.
Solution
Bailey Group
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT 31 DECEMBER 20X9
$m
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment (2,300 + 1,900)
Goodwill (W2)
Investment in associate (W3)
Bailey Group
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X9
$m
Revenue (5,000 + 4,200)
Cost of sales (4,100 + 3,500)
Gross profit
Distribution costs and administrative expenses (320 + 175)
Share of profit of associate
Profit before tax
Income tax expense (240 + 170)
Profit for the year
Other comprehensive income
Items not reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation (net of deferred tax) (50 + 20)
Share of gain on property revaluation of associate
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
Total comprehensive income for the year
284
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
$m
Profit attributable to:
Owners of the parent
Non-controlling interests (W6)
Workings
1 Group structure
Bailey
1.1.X6 (4 years ago) 1.5.X9 (current year)
300 72
= 60% = 30%
500 240
Hill Campbell
2 Goodwill
$m $m
Consideration transferred 720
Non-controlling interests (at fair value)
Fair value of net assets at acquisition:
Share capital
Retained earnings
Fair value adjustment
3 Investment in associate
$m
Cost of associate 225
Share of post-acquisition retained earnings
Less impairment losses to date
4 Retained earnings
Bailey Hill Campbell
$m $m $m
At year end 3,430 1,800 330
TT2020
285
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Bailey Hill Campbell
$m $m $m
Group share of post-acquisition retained earnings:
Hill
Campbell
Less impairment losses:
Hill
Campbell
Total
Profit for comprehensive
year income
$m $m
Hill's PFY/TCI per question 355 375
× NCI share
8 Intragroup trading
PO7 – Prepare External Financial Reports requires you to take part in reviewing and preparing
financial statements in accordance with legislation and regulatory requirements. It does not specify
PER alert
whether the financial reports are single entity or consolidated, but it is reasonable to assume that the
preparation of consolidated accounts, as covered within this chapter, falls within this objective.
286
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Ethics note
Ethical issues will always be examined in Question 2 of the exam. Therefore you need to be alert to
potential ethical issues which could be tested relating to each topic.
For example, in terms of group accounting, if there is pressure on the directors to keep gearing
below a certain level, directors may be tempted to keep loan liabilities out of the group accounts by
putting those liabilities into a new subsidiary and then creating reasons as to why that subsidiary
should not be consolidated.
TT2020
287
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Basic groups
Consolidated Subsidiaries
financial statements
288
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
TT2020
289
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
290
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
11: Basic groups
Question practice
Now try the questions below from the Further question practice bank (available in the digital edition of the
Workbook):
Q19 Highland
Q20 Investor
Further reading
The Study support resources section of the ACCA website includes an article on IFRS 3 which is useful
revision of knowledge from Financial Reporting as well as more complex scenarios which are covered in
the next two chapters:
Business Combinations – IFRS 3 (Revised)
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
291
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
292
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Changes in group
structures: step
acquisitions
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the implications of changes in ownership interest and loss of D1(h)
control.
Note. Loss of control covered in Chapter 13.
Prepare group financial statements where activities have been discontinued, or D1(i)
have been acquired or disposed of in the period.
Note. Only acquisitions are covered in this chapter. Disposals are covered in
Chapter 13 and discontinued operations in Chapter 14.
Exam context
Changes in group structures incorporates two topics:
(a) Step acquisitions – covered in this chapter
(b) Disposals – covered in Chapter 13
Changes in group structures are likely to feature regularly in the SBR exam and could be tested in
any question. It is most likely to be tested in Section A Question 1, which will be based on the
financial statements of group entities. For example, this question could require you to prepare an
extract incorporating an increase in a shareholding in an existing investment and explain the
principles underlying the accounting treatment.
TT2020
293
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
NCI (SOFP)
Adjustment to equity
294
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
1 Step acquisitions
A parent company may build up its shareholding with several successive share purchases
rather than purchasing the shares all on the same day.
Where a controlling interest in a subsidiary is built up over a period of time, IFRS 3 Business
Combinations (para. 41) refers to this as 'business combination achieved in stages'. This
may be also be known as a 'step acquisition' or 'piecemeal acquisition'.
It is also possible for a parent to increase its controlling shareholding in a subsidiary; this will be
covered in section 3.
Acquisition
Significant
Control is achieved influence is Control is retained
achieved
The entity's status (investment, subsidiary, associate) during the year will determine the
accounting treatment in the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income (SPLOCI) (pro-rate accordingly).
The entity's status at the year end will determine the accounting treatment in the
consolidated statement of financial position (SOFP) (never pro-rate).
Tutorial note
Throughout this chapter, we have assumed that:
a shareholding of more than 50% = control
a shareholding of 20% - 49% = significant influence
However, as seen in Chapter 11, share ownership is not the only factor in determining whether
control or significant influence exists.
TT2020
295
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2 Step acquisitions where control is achieved
2.1 Accounting concept
The concept of substance over form drives the accounting treatment. In substance:
(1) An investment (or associate) has been 'sold' – the investment previously held is remeasured
to fair value at the date of control and a gain or loss reported*; and
(2) A subsidiary has been 'purchased' – goodwill is calculated including the fair value of the
investment previously held (eg where 35% was held originally then an additional 40% was
purchased giving the parent control):
Goodwill $
Consideration transferred (for 40% purchased) X
Fair value of previously held investment (35%) X
Non-controlling interests (at fair value or at NCI share of fair value of net assets) (25%) X
Less fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition (X)
X
*The gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss unless the investment previously held was an
investment in equity instruments and the election was made to hold the investment at fair
value through other comprehensive income.
(IFRS 3: paras. 41–42)
296
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
On 1 July 20X9, Alpha acquired an additional 65% of the 2 million $1 equity shares in Beta for
$2,210,000 and gained control on that date. The retained earnings of Beta at that date were
$1,100,000. Beta has no other reserves. Alpha elected to measure non-controlling interest at fair
value at the date of acquisition. The non-controlling interest had a fair value of $680,000 at 1 July
20X9.
There has been no impairment in the goodwill of Beta to date.
Required
(a) Explain, with appropriate workings, how goodwill related to the acquisition of Beta should be
calculated for inclusion in Alpha's group accounts for the year ended 31 December 20X9.
(b) Explain, with appropriate workings, the treatment of any gain or loss on remeasurement of the
previously held 15% investment in Beta in Alpha's group accounts for the year ended
31 December 20X9.
Solution
(a) Goodwill
From 1 January 20X6 to 30 June 20X9, Beta is a simple equity investment in the group
accounts of Alpha. On acquisition of the additional 65% investment on 1 July 20X9, Alpha
obtained control of Beta, making it a subsidiary. This is a step acquisition where control has
been achieved in stages.
In substance, on 1 July 20X9, on obtaining control, Alpha 'sold' a 15% equity investment and
'purchased' an 80% subsidiary. Therefore, goodwill is calculated using the same principles
that would be applied if Alpha had purchased the full 80% shareholding at fair value on
1 July 20X9 as that is the date control is achieved.
IFRS 3 requires that goodwill is calculated as the excess of:
The sum of:
The fair value of the consideration transferred for the additional 65% holding, which is
the cash paid at 1 July 20X9; plus
The 20% non-controlling interest, measured at its fair value at 1 July 20X9 of
$680,000; plus
The fair value at 1 July 20X9 of the original 15% investment 'sold' of $500,000.
Less the fair value of Beta's net assets at 1 July 20X9.
Goodwill is calculated as:
$’000 $’000
Consideration transferred (for 65% on 1 July 20X9) 2,210
Relates to the
Non-controlling interests (at fair value) 20% not owned 680
Fair value at by the group on
date control Fair value of previously held investment (15%) 1 July 20X9 500
is achieved
(1 July 20X9)
Fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition:
Share capital 2,000
Retained earnings (1 July 20X9) 1,100
At the date (3,100)
control is
achieved 290
TT2020
297
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b) Gain or loss on remeasurement
On 1 July 20X9, when control of Beta is achieved, the previously held 15% investment is
remeasured to fair value for inclusion in the goodwill calculation. On initial recognition of the
investment, Alpha made the irrevocable election under IFRS 9 to carry the investment at fair
value through other comprehensive income, therefore any gain or loss on remeasurement is
recognised in consolidated OCI. The gain or loss on remeasurement is calculated as follows.
$’000
Fair value at date control achieved (1.7.X9) 500
Carrying amount of investment (fair value at previous year end: 31.12.X8) (480)
Gain on remeasurement 20
The difference between the fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities of Miel and their
carrying amount relates to Miel's brands. The brands were estimated to have an average remaining
useful life of five years from 30 September 20X2.
Income and expenses are assumed to accrue evenly over the year. Neither company paid dividends
during the year.
Peace elected to measure non-controlling interests at fair value at the date of acquisition. No
impairment losses on recognised goodwill have been necessary to date.
298
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Required
Calculate the following amounts, explaining the principles underlying each of your calculations:
(a) For inclusion in the Peace Group's consolidated statement of profit or loss for the year to
31 December 20X2:
(i) Consolidated revenue
(ii) Share of profit of associate
(iii) Gain on remeasurement of the previously held investment in Miel
(b) For inclusion in the Peace Group's consolidated statement of financial position at
31 December 20X2:
(i) Goodwill relating to the acquisition of Miel
(ii) Group retained earnings
(ii) Non-controlling interests
Solution
(a)(i) Consolidated revenue
Explanation:
Calculation:
Calculation:
TT2020
299
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Calculation:
$'000
Fair value at date control obtained
Carrying amount of associate
(b)(i) Goodwill
Explanation
Calculation:
$'000
Consideration transferred
Fair value of previously held investment
Non-controlling interests
Fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition
Calculation:
Peace Miel Miel
25% 60%
$'000 $'000 $'000
At year end/date control obtained
Fair value movement
Gain on remeasurement of associate
At acquisition
300
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Explanation:
Calculation:
$'000
NCI at the date control was obtained
NCI share of retained earnings post control:
Miel – 40%
Working
Group structure and timeline
Essential reading
See Chapter 12 section 1 of the Essential Reading for a further explanation and an illustration of
investment to associate step acquisitions. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the
Workbook.
TT2020
301
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
4 Step acquisitions where control is retained
4.1 Subsidiary to subsidiary (eg 60% shareholding to 70%
shareholding)
A step acquisition where control is retained when there is an increase in the parent's
shareholding in an existing subsidiary through the purchase of additional shares. It is sometimes
known as 'an increase in a controlling interest'.
The accounting treatment is driven by the concept of substance over form.
In substance, there has been no acquisition because the entity is still a subsidiary.
Instead this is a transaction between group shareholders (ie the parent is buying 10% from
the non-controlling interests).
Therefore, it is recorded in equity as follows:
(a) Decrease non-controlling interests (NCI) in the consolidated SOFP
(b) Recognise the difference between the consideration paid and the decrease in NCI as an
adjustment to equity (post to the parent's column in the consolidated retained earnings
working) (IFRS 10: paras. 23, B96)
% purchased
*Calculated as: NCI at date of step acquisition ×
NCI % before step acquisition
302
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
TT2020
303
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
(a) Goodwill
Explanation
Calculation
$m
Consideration transferred (for 60%)
Non-controlling interests (at fair value)
Fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition
Calculation
Denning Heggie
$m $m
At year end
Adjustment to equity
At acquisition
304
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Calculation
$m
NCI at acquisition
NCI share of post-acquisition reserves up to step acquisition
$m
Fair value of consideration paid
Decrease in NCI
Solution
Explanation:
TT2020
305
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Calculations:
Correcting entry:
306
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Ethics note
Step acquisitions are very complex. Watch out for threats to the fundamental principles of ACCA's
Code of Ethics and Conduct in group scenarios. For example, time pressure around year end
reporting or inexperience of the reporting accountant could lead to errors in the calculation of:
Goodwill on step acquisitions where control is achieved (eg failing to remeasure the existing
investment to fair value at the date of control)
The adjustment to equity or the change to non-controlling interests (NCI) where there is an
increase in a controlling interest (eg reporting the adjustment in profit or loss instead of equity,
recording additional goodwill instead of an adjustment to equity, ignoring the NCI's share of
goodwill when calculating the decrease in NCI under the full goodwill method, failing to
pro-rate the NCI in the consolidated SPLOCI for a mid-year acquisition).
Alternatively, there could be a fundamental misunderstanding of the principles involved (eg reporting
the legal form rather than the substance).
It is also possible that a specific accounting policy is chosen (eg full goodwill method versus partial
goodwill method) to create a particular financial effect (eg to increase profit to maximise a profit-
related bonus or share-based payment).
TT2020
307
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Step acquisitions
Acquisition
Knowledge diagnostic
308
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Adjustment to equity
FV of consideration paid (X)
Decrease in NCI * X
Adjustment to equity (X)/X
TT2020
309
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
310
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q21 ROB Group
Q22 Gaze
Further reading
The examining team have written an article entitled 'Business combinations – IFRS 3 revised',
available on the study support resources section of the ACCA website. Read through Examples 3 and
4 which are on step acquisitions.
www.accaglobal.com
Deloitte has a useful website with summaries of IAS and IFRS. Read the section entitled 'Business
combinations achieved in stages (step acquisitions)' in the summary of IFRS 3 and the section entitled
'Changes in ownership interests' in the summary of IFRS 10:
www.iasplus.com/en/standards
TT2020
311
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
312
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Changes in group
structures: disposals
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the implications of changes in ownership interest and loss of D1(h)
control.
Prepare group financial statements where activities have been discontinued, or D1(i)
have been acquired or disposed of in the period.
Note. Only disposals are covered in this chapter. Acquisitions are covered in
Chapter 12 and discontinued operations in Chapter 14.
Discuss and apply accounting for group companies in the separate financial D3(a)
statements of the parent company.
Apply the accounting principles where the parent reorganises the structure of the D3(b)
group by establishing a new entity or changing the parent.
Exam context
Changes in group structures incorporates two topics:
(a) Step acquisitions – covered in Chapter 12
(b) Disposals – covered in this chapter
In the SBR exam disposals are likely to be tested in a similar way to step acquisitions – primarily as
part of Section A Question 1 on groups. However, they could also feature as part of a Section B
question.
TT2020
313
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Disposals
314
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
1 Disposals
Disposals, in the context of changes in group structure, occur when the parent company sells
some or all of its shareholding in a group company:
Full shareholding is sold = full disposal.
Only some shareholding is sold = partial disposal.
For a full or partial disposal of a shareholding in a subsidiary, there are four outcomes:
Disposal
Tutorial note
Throughout this chapter, we have assumed that:
a shareholding of more than 50% = control
a shareholding of 20% – 49% = significant influence
However, as seen in Chapter 11, share ownership is not the only factor in determining whether
control or significant influence exists.
$ $
Fair value of consideration received X
Fair value of any investment retained X
Less: Share of consolidated carrying amount at date control lost:
Net assets at date control lost X
Goodwill at date control lost X
Less non-controlling interests at date control lost (X)
(X)
Group profit/(loss) (recognise in SPL) X/(X)
(IFRS 10: para. 25, B97–B98)
Where significant, the profit or loss should be disclosed separately (IAS 1: para. 85).
316
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Additional information
(a) Mart has owned 60% of the equity interest in Oat for several years.
(b) On 1 May 20X2, Mart acquired 80% of the equity interests of Pipe. The purchase
consideration comprised cash of $250 million and the fair value of the identifiable net assets
acquired was $300 million at that date.
(c) Mart wishes to use the 'partial goodwill' method for all acquisitions. There has been no
impairment of goodwill in either Oat or Pipe since acquisition.
(d) Mart disposed of a 70% equity interest in Pipe on 31 October 20X3 for $290 million. At that
date Pipe's identifiable net assets were $370 million. The remaining equity interest of Pipe
held by Mart was fair valued at $40 million.
(e) Mart wishes to measure non-controlling interest at its proportionate share of net assets at the
date of acquisition.
Required
(a) Calculate the group profit on disposal of the shares in Pipe.
(b) Prepare the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the
year ended 30 April 20X4 for the Mart Group.
TT2020
317
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
(a) Group profit on disposal of the shares in Pipe
Oat Pipe
$m
Consideration transferred 250
Non-controlling interests (20% × 300) 60
Fair value of identifiable net assets (300)
10
$m
NCI at acquisition (20% × 300) 60
NCI share of post-acquisition reserves to disposal (20% × [370 – 300]) 14
74
In this question reserves were not provided. However, net
assets at acquisition and disposal were given. As net assets
= equity, the movement in net assets will be the movement
in reserves (as there has been no share issue by Pipe).
318
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
(b) Consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the year ended
30 April 20X4
SPLOCI
Consolidate for 6/12
NCI 20% for 6/12
TT2020
319
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Pro-rate as Pipe only a
Step 6 subsidiary for 6 months
Calculate non-controlling interests (NCI) in the year (1.5.X3 –
31.10.X3)
In profit for the year:
Oat Pipe
$m $m
Per question (40 × 6/12) 35 20
NCI share × 40% × 20%
= 14 =4
18
Pro-rate as Pipe only a
subsidiary for 6 months in
the year (1.5.X3 –
31.10.X3)
In total comprehensive income:
Oat Pipe
$m $m
Per question (50 × 6/12) 40 25
NCI share × 40% × 20%
= 16 =5
21
$m
Revenue (800 + 140 + [6/12 × 230]) 1,055
Cost of sales and expenses (680 + 90 + [6/12 × 170]) (855)
Profit on disposal of share in subsidiary (from Step 4) 24
Profit before tax 224
Income tax expense (30 + 15 + [6/12 × 20]) (55)
Profit for the year 169
Other comprehensive income for the year (net of tax)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation (20 + 5 + [6/12 × 10]) 30
Total comprehensive income for the year 199
320
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Profit or loss and revaluations accrued evenly over the year. Amber holds Byrne in its own books at
fair value based on the share price multiplied by the number of shares held. Reserves include a fair
value gain on the investment in Byrne of $800,000 from 1 January 20X2 to 30 September 20X6,
which is tax exempt. There were no fair value changes between then and 31 December.
To date no impairment losses at a group level have been necessary. No dividends were paid by
either company in 20X6.
Amber sold 200,000 of its shares in Byrne for $1,250,000 on 30 September 20X6. The sale has
not yet been paid for or accounted for. At that date Byrne has reserves of $1,240,000.
Amber chose to measure the non-controlling interests at fair value at the date of acquisition. The fair
value of the non-controlling interests in Byrne on 1 January 20X2 was $300,000.
Byrne's total comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 20X6 amounted to $160,000.
Required
(a) Explain the accounting treatment for the investment in Byrne in the consolidated financial
statements of the Amber Group for the year ended 31 December 20X6.
(b) Calculate the group profit on disposal of the shares in Byrne for inclusion in the consolidated
statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the Amber Group for the year
ended 31 December 20X6.
Ignore income tax on the disposal.
(c) Show the investment in associate for inclusion in the consolidated statement of financial
position of the Amber Group as at 31 December 20X6.
TT2020
321
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
(a) Explanation of accounting treatment
Workings
1 Group structure and timeline
2 Goodwill
$'000 $'000
Consideration transferred
Non-controlling interests
Less: Fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition:
Share capital
Reserves
322
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
$'000
NCI at acquisition
NCI share of post-acquisition reserves
Required
Explain to the directors of Vail, with suitable calculations, how the group profit on disposal of the
shareholding in Nest should have been accounted for.
Solution
Explanation:
Calculation:
Group profit or loss on disposal
TT2020
323
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Workings
1 Group structure
2 Goodwill
324
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Treatment in group
Treatment if the parent financial statements
had disposed of related on loss of control of
assets and liabilities Example subsidiary
Items that are reclassified from Investment in debt instruments Reclassify previous
OCI to profit or loss (P/L) held to collect cash flows and remeasurement gains or losses
sell where the cash flows are on the investment in debt
solely the principal and interest instruments from OCI to P/L
(as part of the group profit on
disposal)
TT2020
325
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Instead this is a transaction between the equity holders of the group (eg the parent is selling 15% to
the non-controlling interests). Therefore, it is recorded in equity as follows:
(a) Increase non-controlling interests (NCI) in the consolidated SOFP
(b) Recognise the difference between the consideration received and the increase in NCI as an
adjustment to equity (post to the parent's column in the consolidated retained earnings
working)
(IFRS 10: para. 23, B96)
– Calculate the adjustment to equity (post to the parent's column in the consolidated
retained earnings working)
Adjustment to equity:
$
Fair value of consideration received X
Increase in NCI (A × 15%/30%)* (X)
Adjustment to parent's equity X/(X)
% sold
* Calculated as: NCI at date of disposal ×
NCI % before disposal
326
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Calculation
$m
NCI at acquisition
NCI share of post-acquisition retained earnings to disposal
TT2020
327
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b) Adjustment to equity
Explanation
Calculation
$m
Fair value of consideration received
Increase in NCI
4 Deemed disposals
A 'deemed' disposal occurs when a subsidiary issues new shares and the parent does not take
up all of its rights such that its holding is reduced.
In substance this is a disposal and is therefore accounted for as such. The percentages owned by the
parent before and after the subsidiary issues shares must be calculated, and, where control is lost, a
group profit on disposal must be calculated.
328
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Illustration 2
Deemed disposal
At 1 January 20X2 Rey, a public limited company, had a direct holding of shares giving 75% of the
voting rights in a subsidiary Mago.
The consolidated carrying amount of Mago's net assets on 1 September 20X2 was $14 million.
Goodwill of $2 million was recognised upon the initial acquisition of Mago, and has not
subsequently been impaired. Rey elected to measure the non-controlling interests in Mago at fair
value at acquisition. At 1 September 20X2, non-controlling interests (based on the original
shareholding in Mago) amounted to $3.9 million.
On 1 September 20X2, Mago then issued new shares for $5 million, which were all purchased by a
new investor unrelated to Rey. The fair value of Mago at that date (before the share issue) was
$18 million.
After the share issue, Rey retained an interest of 40% of the voting rights of Mago and retained two
of the six seats on the board of directors (previously Rey held five of the six seats).
Required
Explain the accounting treatment for Mago in the consolidated financial statements of the Rey group
for the year ended 31 December 20X2.
Solution
Rey loses control of Mago on 1 September 20X2. Mago is consolidated as a subsidiary for the first
eight months of the year until that date.
A profit or loss is calculated on the loss of control:
$m $m
Fair value of consideration received 0
Fair value of 30% investment retained ((18 + 5) 40%) 9.2
Less: share of consolidated carrying amount when control lost:
Net assets 14.0
Goodwill 2.0
Less non-controlling interests (3.9)
(12.1)
Loss on disposal (2.9)
For the final four months of 20X2, Mago will be equity accounted as an associate.
5 Associates
The principles underlying the accounting treatment for the disposal of all of some of a shareholding
in an associate are the same as those for a subsidiary.
TT2020
329
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Statement of financial position
Remeasure the investment remaining to fair value at the date of disposal
Investment in equity instruments (IFRS 9) thereafter
Ethics note
Disposals is a technically challenging topic and therefore there is significant scope for error and
manipulation. For example, there may be pressure from the CEO on the reporting accountant to
achieve a certain effect (eg meet a loan covenant ratio, maximise share price) which might tempt the
accountant to overstate the group profit on disposal (on loss of control) or where a controlling interest
is reduced, report the adjustment in profit or loss rather than equity.
Alternatively, time pressure around year end reporting or inexperience of the reporting accountant
could lead to errors such as:
Not remeasuring any remaining investment to fair value on loss of control
Incorrect treatment of the shareholding in the group accounts – this is a particular risk for
disposals (eg not equity accounting for the period the entity was an associate, not
consolidating for the period the entity was a subsidiary)
Miscalculation of the calculation of the group profit or loss on disposal or the adjustment to
equity
Not recording the increase in non-controlling interests for disposals where control is retained
330
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Chapter summary
Disposals
Disposal
TT2020
331
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Subsidiaries: disposals where Deemed Associates
control is retained disposals
% sold
* NCI at date of disposal ×
NCI % before disposal
332
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
13: Changes in group structures: disposals
Knowledge diagnostic
TT2020
333
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q23 Holmes and Deakin
Further reading
The Study support resources section of the ACCA website includes an article on IFRS 3 which is useful
revision of knowledge from Financial Reporting as well as discussing more complex issues covered in
SBR:
Business Combinations – IFRS 3 (Revised)
www.accaglobal.com
Deloitte has a useful website with summaries of IAS and IFRS. Read the section entitled 'Changes in
ownership interests' in the summary of IFRS 10:
www.iasplus.com/en/standards
334
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Non-current assets held
for sale and
discontinued operations
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the accounting requirements for the classification and C2(b)
measurement of non-current assets held for sale.
Prepare group financial statements where activities have been discontinued, or D1(i)
have been acquired or disposed of in the period.
Note. Only discontinued operations are covered in this chapter. Acquisitions are
covered in Chapter 12 and disposals in Chapter 13.
Discuss and apply the treatment of a subsidiary which has been acquired D1(j)
exclusively with a view to subsequent disposal.
Exam context
You studied non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations in your previous studies so
both areas are revision; however, the topic can be examined in more detail in SBR. These topics
could form the basis of part of a written question, with relevant calculations. Both areas could also be
examined in the context of consolidated financial statements at this level.
TT2020
335
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Accounting treatment
Presentation
336
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
1.2 Scope
IFRS 5 applies to all of an entity's recognised non-current assets and disposal groups (as defined
below) with the following exceptions (IFRS 5: para. 5):
Deferred tax assets
Assets arising from employee benefits
Financial assets within the scope of IFRS 9
Investment properties accounted for under the fair value model
Biological assets measured at fair value
Contractual rights under insurance contracts
Disposal group: A group of assets to be disposed of, by sale or otherwise, together as a group in
a single transaction, and liabilities directly associated with those assets that will be transferred in the
Key term
transaction. (IFRS 5: Appendix A)
The disposal group may be a group of CGUs (cash-generating units), a single CGU, or part of a
CGU.
TT2020
337
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.5 Measurement and presentation of non-current assets (or disposal
groups) classified as held for sale
1.5.1 Approach
Immediately before initial classification as held for sale, the asset (or disposal group) is
Step 1 measured in accordance with the applicable IFRS (eg property, plant and
equipment held under the IAS 16 revaluation model is revalued).
On classification of the non-current asset (or disposal group) as held for sale, it is written
down to fair value less costs to sell (if less than carrying amount).
Step 2 Any impairment loss arising under IFRS 5 is charged to profit or loss (and the credit
allocated to assets of a disposal group using the IAS 36 rules, ie first to goodwill then to
other assets pro rata based on carrying amount).
Any subsequent changes in fair value less costs to sell are recognised as a
further impairment loss (or reversal of an imapairment loss).
Step 4
However, gains recognised cannot exceed cumulative impairment losses to date (whether
under IAS 36 or IFRS 5).
Presented:
• As single amounts (of assets and liabilities);
Step 5 • On the face of the statement of financial position;
• Separately from other assets and liabilities; and
• Normally as current assets and liabilities (not offset).
338
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
Inconsistencies in accounting standards can lead to problems for the users of financial statements in
understanding the information included within financial statements.
Illustration 1
An item of property, plant and equipment measured under the revaluation model has a revalued
carrying amount of $76 million at 1 January 20X1 and a remaining useful life of 20 years (and a
zero residual value). On 1 July 20X1 the asset met the criteria to be classified as held for sale. Its fair
value was $80 million and costs to sell were $1 million on that date. The asset had not been
disposed of at 31 December 20X1 due to legal issues. The fair value less costs of disposal at that
date was $77 million.
Analysis
The asset is depreciated to 1 July 20X1 reducing its carrying amount by $1.9 million ($76m/20 years
× 6/12) to $74.1 million. The asset is revalued (under IAS 16) to $80 million on that date and a
gain of $5.9 million ($80m – $74.1m) is recognised as a revaluation surplus in other comprehensive
income.
On classification as held for sale, the asset is remeasured to fair value less costs to sell of $79 million
($80m – $1m) as this is lower than its carrying amount ($80m). The loss of $1 million is recognised
in profit or loss. The asset is no longer depreciated. As the asset is still held at 31 December 20X1, it
is held at the lower of its carrying amount ($79m) and its revised fair value less costs of disposal of
$77 million. The additional impairment loss of $2 million should be recognised in profit or loss. The
held for sale asset is presented as a separate line item 'Non-current assets held for sale' at $77 million
within current assets.
1.5.3 Disclosure
As well as separate presentation of non-current assets held for sale, and liabilities
directly associated with assets held for sale in the statement of financial position, any
cumulative income or expense recognised in other comprehensive income relating to
a non-current asset held for sale is presented separately in the reserves section of the statement of
financial position (IFRS 5: para. 38).
The following is disclosed in the notes to the financial statements in respect of non-current
assets/disposal groups held for sale or sold (IFRS 5: para. 41):
(a) A description of the non-current asset (or disposal group);
(b) A description of the facts and circumstances of the sale, or leading to the expected disposal,
and the expected manner and timing of the disposal;
(c) The gain or loss recognised on assets classified as held for sale, and (if not presented
separately on the face of the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income) the
caption which includes it;
(d) If applicable, the operating segment in which the non-current asset is presented in accordance
with IFRS 8 Operating Segments.
TT2020
339
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.5.4 Proforma presentation: Non-current assets held for sale (adapted from
IFRS 5: IG Example 12 and IAS 1: IG)
XYZ GROUP
STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT 31 DECEMBER 20X3
20X3 20X2
$'000 $'000
Assets
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment X X
Goodwill X X
Other intangible assets X X
Financial assets X X
X X
Current assets
Inventories X X
Trade and other receivables X X
Cash and cash equivalents X X
X X
Non-current assets held for sale X X
X X
Total assets X X
340
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
Illustration 2
On 20 October 20X3 the directors of a parent company made a public announcement of plans to
close a steel works owned by a subsidiary. The closure means that the group will no longer carry out
this type of operation, which until recently has represented about 10% of its total turnover. The works
will be gradually shut down over a period of several months, with complete closure expected in July
20X4. At 31 December output had been significantly reduced and some redundancies had already
taken place. The cash flows, revenues and expenses relating to the steel works can be clearly
distinguished from those of the subsidiary's other operations.
Required
How should the closure be treated in the consolidated financial statements for the year ended
31 December 20X3?
Solution
Because the steel works is being closed rather than sold, it cannot be classified as 'held for sale'. In
addition, the steel works is not a discontinued operation. Although at 31 December 20X3 the group
was firmly committed to the closure, this has not yet taken place and therefore the steel works must
be included in continuing operations. Information about the planned closure could be disclosed in the
notes to the financial statements.
3 Discontinued operations
Discontinued operation: A component of an entity that either has been disposed of or is
classified as held for sale and:
Key terms
(a) Represents a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations;
(b) Is part of a single co-ordinated plan to dispose of a separate major line of business or
geographical area of operations; or
(c) Is a subsidiary acquired exclusively with a view to resale.
Component of an entity: A part that has operations and cash flows that can be clearly
distinguished, operationally and for financial reporting purposes, from the rest of the entity.
(IFRS 5: Appendix A)
TT2020
341
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The following presentation and disclosure requirements apply:
Discontinued operations (IFRS 5: para. 33)
(a) On the face of the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
(i) A single amount comprising the total of:
(1) The post-tax profit or loss of discontinued operations; and
(2) The post-tax gain or loss recognised on the remeasurement to fair value less
costs to sell or on the disposal of assets/disposal groups comprising the
discontinued operation.
(b) On the face of the financial statements or in the notes:
(i) The revenue, expenses, and pre-tax profit or loss of discontinued operations,
and the related income tax expense;
(ii) The gain or loss recognised on the measurement to fair value less costs to sell or on
the disposal of assets/disposal groups comprising the discontinued operation, and the
related income tax expense; and
(iii) The net cash flows attributable to the operating, investing, and financing activities of
discontinued operations.
Illustration 3
A 70% subsidiary of a group with a 31 December year end meets the definition of a discontinued
operation, through being classified as held for sale, on 1 September 20X1.
The subsidiary's profit for the year ended 31 December 20X1 is $36 million. The carrying amount of
the consolidated net assets on 1 September 20X1 is $220 million and goodwill $21 million. The
non-controlling interests were measured at the proportionate share of the fair value of the net assets
at acquisition; ie the goodwill is partial goodwill. The fair value less costs to sell of the subsidiary on
1 September 20X1 was $245 million.
Analysis
In the consolidated statement of profit or loss, the subsidiary's profit for the year of $36 million must be
shown as a discontinued operation, presented as a single line item combined with any loss on
remeasurement.
The loss on remeasurement as held for sale is calculated as:
As only partial goodwill is recognised, it
$m must be grossed up for the impairment
'Notional' goodwill (21 × 100%/70%) 30 test to compare correctly fair value less
Consolidated net assets 220 costs to sell (which is 100%) with 100%
of the subsidiary
Consolidated carrying amount of subsidiary 250
Less fair value less costs to sell (245)
Impairment loss (gross) 5
The impairment loss is written off to the goodwill balance. However, as only the group share of the
goodwill is recognised in the financial statements, only the group share of the impairment loss 70% ×
$5m = $3.5m is recognised.
The single amount recognised as a separate line item in the statement of profit or loss as profit on the
discontinued operation is:
$m
Profit or loss of discontinued operations 36.0
Loss on remeasurement to fair value less costs to sell (ignoring any tax effect) (3.5)
32.5
342
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
TT2020
343
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 1: Discontinued operation
Titan is the parent entity of a group of companies with two subsidiaries, Cronus and Rhea. Cronus is
100% owned and Rhea is 80% owned. Both subsidiaries have been owned for a number of years.
STATEMENTS OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME FOR THE YEAR
ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X5
Titan Cronus Rhea
$m $m $m
Revenue 450 265 182
Cost of sales (288) (152) (106)
Gross profit 162 113 76
Operating expenses (71) (45) (22)
Finance costs (5) (3) (2)
Profit before tax 86 65 52
Income tax expense (17) (13) (10)
Profit for the year 69 52 42
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gain on property revaluation, net of tax 16 9 6
Total comprehensive income for the year 85 61 48
The consolidated carrying amount of the net assets (excluding goodwill) of Rhea on 1 January 20X5
was $320 million. The goodwill of Rhea was $38 million on that date. The non-controlling interests
were measured at the proportionate share of the fair value of the net assets at acquisition.
Titan decided to sell its investment in Rhea and on 1 October 20X5 the investment in Rhea met the
criteria to be classified as held for sale. The fair value less costs to sell of Rhea on that date was
$395 million.
The investment in Rhea was still held at the year end and continued to meet the IFRS 5 'held for sale'
criteria but no further adjustment to the consolidated carrying amount of Rhea was required.
Required
Prepare the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the Titan
Group for the year ended 31 December 20X5.
The profit and total comprehensive income figures attributable to owners of the parent and
attributable to non-controlling interests need not be subdivided into continuing and discontinued
operations. Ignore the tax effects of any impairment loss.
Work to the nearest $0.1m.
344
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
Solution
TITAN GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X5
$m
Continuing operations
Revenue
Cost of sales
Gross profit
Operating expenses
Finance costs
Profit before tax
Income tax expense
Profit for the year from continuing operations
Discontinued operations
Profit for the year from discontinued operations
Profit for the year
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gain on property revaluation, net of tax
Total comprehensive income for the year
Workings
1 Group structure
TT2020
345
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Stakeholder perspective
As noted above, part of the criteria for a discontinued operation is that an operation 'represents a
Stakeholder
perspective
separate major line of business or geographical area of operations'. The IASB has
acknowledged that this part of the definition is subject to interpretation (IFRS Foundation, 2016, p1).
Whether an operation represents a major line of business depends on how an entity determines its
operating segments under IFRS 8 Operating Segments (see Chapter 18 for more detail). Therefore
there may be inconsistency between different entities as to what is identified and accounted for as a
discontinued operation. This inconsistency can make it difficult for investors or potential investors to
interpret the financial statements of entities which have applied the definition in different ways.
Essential reading
Chapter 14 section 1 of the Essential Reading contains a comprehensive activity including a
subsidiary held for sale. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
346
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
Ethics note
Classification of assets as held for sale or treatment of an operation as discontinued means that the
user of the financial statements will view that data in a different way. For example, a user will expect
the value of non-current assets held for sale to be replaced with cash resources within a year, and
that any losses relating to a discontinued operation will cease to arise.
It is therefore important for management to behave ethically when applying these principles to ensure
the financial statements give a true and fair view.
It is also worth noting that assets classified as held for sale are not depreciated which could result in
an increase in profits as a result, so there is an incentive for management to classify assets in that
way.
PO7 – Prepare External Financial Reports requires you to take part in reviewing and preparing
financial statements in accordance with legislation and regulatory requirements, an element of which
PER alert
is being able to classify information accordingly. Understanding the requirements of IFRS 5 as
covered in this chapter will help you to meet this objective.
TT2020
347
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
• Only when at year end: • Not classified as held • A component of an entity (ie
– Available for immediate sale in for sale operations and cash flows can be
present condition, subject to usual • Show results and cash clearly distinguished operationally
and customary sales terms, and flows as discontinued and for financial reporting purposes)
– Sale is highly probable: operation if meets that either:
◦ Price actively marketed at is definition – Has been disposed of; or
reasonable vs FV – Is classified as held for sale and
◦ Unlikely that significant changes (a) Represents a separate major line
made to plan of business or geographical area
◦ Management committed to plan of operations;
to sell (b) Is part of a single co-ordinated
◦ Active programme to locate buyer plan to dispose of a separate
◦ Sale expected to be completed major line of business or
within one year of classification geographical area of operations;
or
(c) Is a subsidiary acquired
Accounting treatment exclusively with a view to resale
(1) Depreciate and (if previously held • Presentation/disclosure
at FV) revalue – On face of SPLOCI
(2) Reclassify as 'held for sale' and Single amount comprising:
write down to fair value less costs to ◦ Post-tax profit/loss of
sell* (if < carrying amount) discontinued operations
(3) Any loss recognised in P/L ◦ Post-tax gain or loss on
(4) Do not depreciate remeasurement to FV – CTS or on
(5) Subsequent changes disposal
– Impairment loss/loss reversal – On face or in notes
(reversals capped at losses to Revenue X
date) through P/L Expenses (X)
* 'Costs to distribute' if the asset is held Profit before tax X
for distribution to owners Income tax expense (X)
X
Gain/loss on remeasurement/
Presentation disposal X
• Single amount Tax thereon (X)
• On face of SOFP X
• Separate
X
• Normally current assets/liabilities
Net cash flows
(not offset)
Operating X/(X)
Investing X/(X)
Financing X/(X)
348
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
Knowledge diagnostic
TT2020
349
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Further reading
The CPD section of the ACCA website contains a useful article on IFRS 5 which you should read:
The challenge of implementing IFRS 5 (2017)
www.accaglobal.com
350
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Joint arrangements
and group disclosures
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the application of the joint control principle. D2(c)
Exam context
Joint arrangements could feature in the Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam either as an
adjustment in a consolidation question or as a separate part of a written question discussing their
accounting treatment. You need an overview of the key disclosures relating to consolidated financial
statements required by IFRS 12.
TT2020
351
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Definitions
Joint operations
Joint ventures
352
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
15: Joint arrangements and group disclosures
1 Joint arrangements
1.1 Definitions
Joint arrangement: An arrangement in which two or more parties have joint control.
Key terms Joint control: The contractually agreed sharing of control of an arrangement, which exists only
when decisions about the relevant activities require the unanimous consent of the parties sharing
control.
(IFRS 11: Appendix A)
A joint arrangement has the following characteristics (IFRS 11: para. 5):
(a) The parties are bound by a contractual arrangement
(b) The contractual arrangement gives two or more of those parties joint control of the
arrangement.
Essential reading
Chapter 15 section 1 of the Essential Reading contains more detail about what constitutes a
contractual arrangement and how this distinguishes between joint operations and joint ventures. This
is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Key terms Joint operation: A joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control of the
arrangement have rights to the assets, and obligations for the liabilities, relating to the
arrangement.
Joint venture: A joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control of the arrangement
have rights to the net assets of the arrangement.
(IFRS 11: Appendix A)
Under these definitions, the accounting treatment is determined based on the substance of the joint
arrangement. If no separate entity has been created, the investor should separately recognise in its
financial statements the direct rights it has to the assets and the obligation it has for liabilities under
that arrangement. If a separate vehicle (entity) is created, the venturer accounts for its share of that
entity using equity accounting.
JOINT OPERATION
Not structured through (line by line
a separate vehicle accounting)
Entity considers:
• Legal form
• Terms of the contractual
arrangement JOINT VENTURE
Structured through a
separate vehicle • (Where relevant) other facts (equity accounting)
and circumstances
TT2020
353
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1.2 Accounting for joint operations
In its separate financial statements a joint operator recognises (IFRS 11: para. 20):
Its own assets, liabilities and expenses
Its share of assets held and expenses and liabilities incurred jointly
Its revenue from the sale of its share of the output arising from the joint operation
Its share of revenue from the sale of output by the joint operation itself
No adjustments are necessary on consolidation as the figures are already incorporated correctly
into the separate financial statements of the joint operator.
354
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
15: Joint arrangements and group disclosures
At cost;
At fair value (as a financial asset under IFRS 9 Financial Instruments); or
Using the equity method as described in IAS 28 Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures.
Where a joint venturer has no subsidiaries, the equity method must be used.
(IFRS 11: para. 24)
1.3.2 Consolidated financial statements
Joint ventures are accounted for using the equity method in the consolidated financial statements
in exactly the same way as for associates (covered in Chapter 13) (IFRS 11: para. 24).
Illustration 1
XYZ Group has a 50% share in a joint venture, acquired a number of years ago. XYZ's accounting
policy is to measure investments in joint ventures using the equity method in both its separate and its
consolidated financial statements.
Details relating to the joint venture for the year ended 31 December 20X7 are:
$m
Cost of the 50% share 11
Reserves at 31 December 20X7 44
Reserves at the date of acquisition of the joint venture 18
Profit for the year ended 31 December 20X7 6
Other comprehensive income (gain on property 2
revaluations) for the year ended 31 December 20X7
Analysis
In the statement of financial position, the investment is shown using the equity method:
$m
Cost of 50% share 11
Share of post acquisition reserves ((44 – 18) × 50%) 13
24
In the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income the following are shown as
separate line items:
$m
Share of profit of joint venture (6 × 50%) 3
Share of other comprehensive income of joint venture (2 50%) 1
TT2020
355
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Presentation
XYZ GROUP
STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AT 31 DECEMBER (Extract)
20X7 20X6
Assets $m $m
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment X X
Goodwill X X
Other intangible assets X X
Investment in joint venture 24 X
Investment in equity instruments X X
X X
XYZ GROUP
STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X7 (Extract)
20X7 20X6
$m $m
Revenue X X
Cost of sales (X) (X)
Gross profit X X
Other income X X
Distribution costs (X) (X)
Administrative expenses (X) (X)
Other expenses (X) (X)
Finance costs (X) (X)
Share of profit of joint venture 3 X
Profit before tax X X
Income tax expense (X) (X)
Profit for the year X X
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation X X
Investments in equity instruments (X) (X)
Share of other comprehensive income of joint venture 1 X
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified X X
X X
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax (X) (X)
Total comprehensive income for the year X X
356
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
15: Joint arrangements and group disclosures
Structured entity: An entity that has been designed so that voting or similar rights are not
the dominant factor in deciding who controls the entity, such as when any voting rights
Key term
relate to administrative tasks only and the relevant activities are directed by means of contractual
arrangements. (IFRS 12: Appendix A)
Structured entities are often set up to undertake a narrow range of activities, such as a specific
research and development project or to provide a source of funding to another entity. They normally
do not have sufficient equity to finance their own activities and are therefore backed by financing
arrangements. Disclosures are required for structured entities due to their sensitive nature (see below).
Stakeholder perspective
An investor or potential investor needs to understand the entity it is investing in. Business structures
Stakeholder
perspective
can be highly complex and it can be difficult to understand where the lines of control and influence
are drawn and what the implications are for the reporting entity. Prior to IFRS 12, there was a
perceived gap in IFRS relating to a specific type of entity known as a 'special purpose entity', now
referred to as a 'structured entity'. These entities were often not consolidated and not disclosed as
part of a group despite the reporting entity having exposure to the risks and returns associated with
them. As such, investors did not fully understand the risks they were exposed to.
2.3 Disclosures
The main disclosures required by IFRS 12 for an entity that has investments in other entities are:
(a) The significant judgements and assumptions made in determining whether the entity
has control, joint control or significant influence over the other entities, and in determining the
type of joint arrangement (IFRS 12: para. 7)
(b) Information to understand the composition of the group and the interest that
non-controlling interests have in the group's activities and cash flows (IFRS 12: para. 10)
(c) The nature, extent and financial effects of interests in joint arrangements and
associates, including the nature and effects of the entity's contractual relationship with other
investors (IFRS 12: para. 20)
(d) The nature and extent of interests in unconsolidated structured entities (IFRS 12:
para. 24)
(e) The nature and extent of significant restrictions on the entity's ability to access or use
assets and settle liabilities of the group (IFRS 12: para. 10)
TT2020
357
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(f) The nature of, and changes in, the risks associated with the entity's interests in
consolidated structured entities, joint ventures, associates and unconsolidated structured
entities (eg commitments and contingent liabilities) (IFRS 12: paras. 10, 20, 24)
(g) The consequences of changes in the entity's ownership interest in a subsidiary that
do not result in loss of control (ie the effects on the equity attributable to owners of the
parent) (IFRS 12: paras. 10, 18)
(h) The consequences of losing control of a subsidiary during the reporting period (ie the
gain or loss, and the portion of it that relates to measuring any remaining investment at fair
value, and the line item(s) in profit or loss in which the gain or loss is recognised if not
presented separately (IFRS 12: paras. 10, 19)
Ethics note
You should be alert for evidence of directors classifying a joint arrangement as a joint venture when
it may be a joint operation. The reasons for doing this could be ethically dubious. For example, joint
ventures are equity accounted, which means the liabilities of the joint venture are not visible in the
joint operator's financial statements. However, in accounting for a joint operation, the assets and
liabilities are presented 'gross', separate from each other in the joint operator's statement of financial
position. IFRS 11 focuses on the substance of the arrangement, not just the legal form, to ensure that
this does not happen, but this does not prevent directors from acting unethically.
Structured entities are another way of achieving 'off balance sheet finance' if they are not
consolidated. For this reason, IFRS 12 requires substantial disclosures relating to the decision-making
process of the treatment of investments in other entities and disclosures where they are not
consolidated or equity accounted in the financial statements.
358
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
15: Joint arrangements and group disclosures
Chapter summary
TT2020
359
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Joint arrangements
There are two types of joint arrangement. Joint ventures (where the venturers have rights to
the net assets) are accounted for using the equity method in the consolidated financial
statements. Joint operations (where the operators have rights to the assets and
obligations for the liabilities) are accounted for based on the relevant share in the joint
operator's own financial statements.
2. IFRS 12 Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities
An entity must make disclosures relating to the nature and extent of, and risks associated
with, investments in subsidiaries, associates, joint arrangements and both consolidated and
unconsolidated structured entities.
360
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
15: Joint arrangements and group disclosures
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q16 Burley
Further reading
There are articles on the CPD section of the ACCA website which are relevant to the topics covered in this
chapter and which would be useful to read:
Vexed Concept (2014) (Equity accounting: how does it measure up?)
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
361
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
362
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Foreign transactions
and entities
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Outline and apply the translation of foreign currency amounts and transactions D4(a)
into the functional currency and the presentation currency.
Account for the consolidation of foreign operations and their disposal. D4(b)
Exam context
Foreign currency transactions could feature as part of a groups question in the SBR exam, perhaps
requiring you to prepare extracts from the translation reserve where the entity has a foreign
subsidiary. You therefore need to be comfortable with the treatment of foreign currency in both the
individual financial statements of an entity and consolidated financial statements which include a
foreign operation. You need to be able to explain the accounting treatment, and not just calculate the
numbers.
TT2020
363
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
364
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
1 Currency concepts
1.1 Objective
The translation of foreign currency transactions and financial statements should:
(a) Produce results which are generally compatible with the effects of rate changes on a
company's cash flows and its equity; and
(b) Ensure that the financial statements present a true and fair view of the results of
management actions.
IAS 21 The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates covers this area.
FUNCTIONAL PRESENTATION
CURRENCY CURRENCY
2 Functional currency
Functional currency: The currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity
operates.
Key terms
Monetary items: Units of currency held and assets and liabilities to be received or
paid in a fixed or determinable number of units of currency.
Spot exchange rate: The exchange rate for immediate delivery.
Closing rate: The spot exchange rate at the end of the reporting period.
(IAS 21: para. 8)
Functional currency is the currency in which the financial statement transactions are measured.
366
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
Illustration 1
An entity whose functional currency is the dollar ($) sold goods to a customer on credit for 100,000
antons on 1 November 20X1. The anton is a foreign currency. Exchanges rates were:
1 November 20X1 $1 = 5.8 antons
31 December 20X1 $1 = 6.3 antons
The entity's year end is 31 December 20X1.
Required
Show the accounting treatment at the date of the transaction and at the year end (to the nearest $).
Solution Spot exchange rate at
1 November 20X1
At 1 November 20X1:
DEBIT Trade receivables (100,000/5.8) $17,241
At closing (year end)
CREDIT Revenue $17,241 exchange rate
At 31 December 20X1:
As it is a monetary item, the trade receivable must be retranslated to $15,873 (100,000/6.3).
An exchange loss is reported in profit or loss as follows:
DEBIT Profit or loss $1,368
CREDIT Trade receivables (17,241 – 15,873) $1,368
TT2020
367
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Link to the Conceptual Framework
There is an argument that exchange differences arising on long-term monetary assets and
Link to the
Conceptual
liabilities (such as loans repayable in the future) should not be recognised in profit or loss. This is
Framework because gains and losses reported in one period may then be reversed in a future period, leading to
unnecessary fluctuations in reported profit or loss. As the exchange differences will not be realised
until the monetary item is received or settled at some point in the future, some argue that recognising
exchange differences in OCI would be more appropriate.
The revised Conceptual Framework makes it clear that the statement of profit or loss is the primary
source of information relating to an entity's performance but that standards can require the use of
OCI on an exceptional basis. This perhaps implies that profit or loss is the 'default' position for
reporting gains and losses and therefore IAS 21 is consistent with this.
3 Presentation currency
Presentation currency: The currency in which the financial statements are presented.
(IAS 21: para. 8)
Key term
An entity may present its financial statements in any currency (or currencies) (IAS 21: para. 38).
368
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
4 Foreign operations
Foreign operation: An entity that is a subsidiary, associate, joint arrangement or branch of a
reporting entity, the activities of which are based or conducted in a country or currency other than
Key term
those of the reporting entity. (IAS 21: para. 8)
TT2020
369
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
In practical terms the following approach is used when translating the financial statements of a
foreign operation for exam purposes (IAS 21: para. 39):
(a) STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION
All assets and liabilities – Closing rate (CR)
Share capital and pre-acquisition reserves – Historical rate (HR) at date of control
(for exam purposes)
Post-acquisition reserves:
Profit for each year – Actual (or average) rate (AR) for each year
Dividends – Actual rate at date of payment
Exchange differences on net assets – Balancing figure ( )
Functional Presentation
currency Rate currency
Assets X CR X
X X
Share capital X HR X
Share premium X HR X
Pre-acquisition retained earnings X HR X
X X
Post-acquisition retained earnings:
Profit for year 1 X AR X
Dividend for year 1 X Actual X
Profit for year 2 X AR X
Dividend for year 2 X Actual X
etc
Exchange difference on net assets - X
X X
Liabilities X CR X
X X
370
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
*There is no explicit rule on which rate to use for impairment losses, therefore use of an average rate
or the closing rate is acceptable.
TT2020
371
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 2
Hood, a public limited company whose functional currency is the dollar ($), has recently purchased a
foreign subsidiary, Robin. The functional currency of Robin is the crown.
Hood purchased 80% of the ordinary share capital of Robin on 1 September 20X5 for 86 million
crowns. The carrying amount of the net assets of Robin at that date was 90 million crowns. The fair
value of the net assets at that date was 100 million crowns. At the year end of 31 December 20X5,
the goodwill was tested for impairment and this review indicated that it had been impaired by 1.8
million crowns.
At 31 December 20X5, goodwill of $4.6 million should be recognised in the consolidated statement
of financial position. Management has recorded it at $4.4 million, being the goodwill on acquisition
without any further adjustment for impairment or exchange differences.
372
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
Adjustments required
The impairment loss should be recognised in the consolidated statement of profit or loss (translated at
either the average rate or the closing rate). In this case the average rate has been used giving an
impairment loss of $0.8 million, but there is no fixed rule, so the closing rate could alternatively have
been used:
DEBIT Profit or loss $0.8m
CREDIT Goodwill $0.8m
The exchange gain on the retranslation of goodwill of $1.0 million should be credited to other
comprehensive income and accumulated in the translation reserve (group share, 80% × $1.0m =
$0.8m) and in NCI (NCI share, 20% × $1m = $0.2m):
DEBIT Goodwill $1.0m
CREDIT Translation reserve $0.8m
NCI $0.2m
Note. If non-controlling interests had instead been measured at the proportionate share of net assets
at acquisition ('partial goodwill' method), any exchange difference arising on the retranslation of
goodwill would be reported in the translation reserve with no impact on NCI. This is because under
the partial goodwill method, the goodwill calculated relates only to the group, therefore any
exchange difference arising also relates only to the group. Under the full goodwill method, the
goodwill calculated relates to both the group and the NCI and so any exchange difference arising
must be allocated to both the group and the NCI.
TT2020
373
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Bennie Jennie
$'000 J'000
Share capital 1,700 1,200
Pre-acquisition retained earnings 5,280
Post-acquisition retained earnings 5,185 2,400
6,885 8,880
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY FOR THE YEAR (Extract for retained earnings)
Bennie Jennie
$'000 J'000
Balance at 1 January 20X2 4,623 6,760
Dividends paid (610) (1,120)
Total profit/comprehensive income for the year 1,172 2,040
Balance at 31 December 20X2 5,185 7,680
Jennie pays its dividends on 31 December. Jennie's profit for 20X1 was 2,860,000 Jens and a
dividend of 1,380,000 Jens was paid on 31 December 20X1.
Jennie's statements of financial position at acquisition and at 31 December 20X1 were as follows.
JENNIE
STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT:
1.1.X1 31.12.X1
J'000 J'000
Property, plant and equipment 5,710 6,800
Current assets 3,360 5,040
9,070 11,840
374
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
TT2020
375
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$'000
Profit attributable to:
Owners of the parent
Non-controlling interests (W7)
Workings
1 Group structure
376
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
4 Goodwill
J'000 J'000 Rate $'000
Consideration transferred (993)
Non-controlling interests
Less: FV of net assets at acquisition
Share capital
Retained earnings
Goodwill at acquisition
Impairment losses 20X1
Exchange gain/(loss) 20X1 –
Goodwill at 31 December 20X1
Impairment losses 20X2
Exchange gain/(loss) 20X2 –
Goodwill at year end
TT2020
377
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
7 Non-controlling interests (SPLOCI)
PFY TCI
$'000 $'000
Profit for the year (W3)
Impairment losses (W4)
Other comprehensive income: exchange differences (W9) –
× % × %
On goodwill (W4)
An entity may have a monetary item that is receivable from or payable to a foreign operation for which
settlement is neither planned nor likely to occur in the foreseeable future. This may include a long-term
receivable or loan. They do not include trade receivables or trade payables. (IAS 21: para. 15)
In substance such items are part of the entity's net investment in a foreign operation.
The amount could be due between the parent and the foreign operation, or a subsidiary and the
foreign operation.
378
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
Illustration 3
On 1 January 20X8, Gabby, a company whose functional currency is the dollar ($), bought a 100%
interest in a Japanese company for ¥75,000,000. The company is run as an autonomous subsidiary.
On the day of purchase a long-term loan was advanced to the subsidiary – value ¥5,000,000
(repayable in yen).
On 1 January 20X8 the exchange rate was $1: 150 ¥; on 31 December 20X8, $1: 130 ¥.
Required
(a) Explain the accounting treatment of the investment and loan in Gabby's separate financial
statements at 31 December 20X8.
(b) Explain the effect in Gabby's consolidated financial statements at 31 December 20X8.
(c) Show the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income effect in Gabby's
consolidated financial statements if the subsidiary was sold on 30 June 20X9 for $720,000
when the exchange rate was 120 ¥ to the dollar and the value of the Japanese subsidiary's
net assets and goodwill in the consolidated books was $660,000.
Assume that the investment is held in Gabby's separate financial statements using the cost option in
IAS 27 and that cumulative exchange gains on translation of the financial statements of the foreign
operation of $128,900 were recognised in the consolidated financial statements up to 31 December 20X8.
Solution
(a) Separate financial statements of Gabby
The accounting treatment is as follows:
At recognition: Both at the historical exchange
¥75,000,000 rate (150) at the date of initial
Investment = $500,000. recognition
150
¥5,000,000
Loan asset = $33,333. At closing exchange
150 rate (130) because the
loan is a monetary item
At the year end:
The investment in the subsidiary remains at cost (Gabby's accounting policy).
¥5,000,000
The loan asset is retranslated to = $38,462 at the closing rate.
130
Therefore, a gain of $5,129 ($38,462 – $33,333) on the loan receivable is recognised in
profit or loss.
TT2020
379
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b) Consolidated financial statements
The subsidiary will be consolidated and shown at the translated value of its net assets and goodwill
(both at the closing exchange rate). Exchange differences on the translation are recognised in other
comprehensive income. No exchange gain or loss on the loan payable occurs in the individual
financial statements of the Japanese company as the loan is denominated in yen.
IAS 21 requires the exchange difference on the retranslation of the loan in Gabby's books to be
taken in full (moved) to other comprehensive income on consolidation (ie it is reported in the same
section of the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income as the exchange
difference on translation of the subsidiary).
Therefore the $5,129 gain on the loan is reported in other comprehensive income rather than
profit or loss.
(c) Consolidated financial statements
STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (Extracts)
Gain on sale of subsidiary
$
Sale proceeds 720,000
Activity 3: Ethics
Rankin owns 60% of Jenkin. The directors of Rankin are thinking of acquiring further foreign
investments in the near future, but the entity currently lacks sufficient cash to exploit such
opportunities. They would prefer to raise finance from an equity issue as Rankin already has
significant loans within non-current liabilities and they do not wish to increase Rankin’s gearing any
further. They are therefore keen to maximise the balance on the group retained earnings in order to
attract the maximum level of investment possible. One proposal is that they may sell 5% of the equity
interest in Jenkin during 20X6. This will improve the cash position but will enable Rankin to maintain
control over Jenkin. In addition, the directors believe that the shares can be sold profitably to boost
the retained earnings of Rankin and of the group. The directors intend to transfer the relevant
proportion of the exchange differences on translation of the subsidiary to group retained earnings,
knowing that this is contrary to accounting standards.
Required
Discuss why the proposed treatment of the exchange differences by the directors is not in compliance
with International Financial Reporting Standards, explaining any ethical issues which may arise.
380
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
Solution
Ethics note
Foreign currency translation adds additional complexity to the financial statements. It also makes the
financial statements less transparent, because the translation itself is not visible to the user of the
financial statements. The choice of exchange rate and need for consistent application of the
translation principles are areas where manipulation of the financial statements could arise.
Similarly, the choice of presentation currency (which is a free choice under IAS 21) could affect the
image the financial statements give depending on which currency is chosen and the volatility of
exchange rates with that currency.
Performance objective 7 of the PER requires you to demonstrate that you can contribute to the
drafting or reviewing of primary financial statements according to accounting standards and
PER alert
legislation. Accounting for foreign currency transactions and foreign operations under IAS 21 will
help you meet this objective.
TT2020
381
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
• 'The currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity • 'The currency in which the
operates' financial statements are
• Transactions are measured in this currency presented'
• Translated at spot rate at date of transaction (or average for period) • Can be any currency
• At year end: • Translation from functional
– Restate monetary items → CR currency:
– Non-monetary items →not restated – Presentation currency
– Items held at FV → use rate when FV determined method (see below)
• Exchange differences → P/L • Exchange differences → other
• Considerations in determining functional currency: comprehensive
– Currency that mainly influences sales prices
– Currency of the country whose regulations mainly determine sales
prices
– Currency that mainly influences labour, material and other costs
Also:
– Currency in which financing generated
– Currency in which operating receipts usually retained
Also for a foreign operation:
– Degree of autonomy
– Volume of transactions with parent
– Whether cash flows directly impact the parent
382
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
16: Foreign transactions and entities
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Currency concepts
IAS 21 introduces functional currency and presentation currency concepts.
2. Functional currency
The functional currency is the currency of the primary economic environment that the
entity faces. This is based on an entity's circumstances. It is not a free choice.
The measurement of the financial statements is made in this currency.
Transactions in foreign currency are translated at the spot exchange rate at the date of
the transaction.
At the period end, monetary assets and liabilities are retranslated at the closing
rate, and the exchange difference is recognised in profit or loss.
Non-monetary assets and liabilities are not retranslated (unless they are measured
at fair value, in which case they are translated at the exchange rate at the date of the fair
value measurement).
3. Presentation currency
The presentation currency is the currency in which the financial statements are
presented. An entity can choose any currency as its presentation currency.
There are specific translation rules to translate from the functional currency to a different
presentation currency.
Assets and liabilities are translated at the closing rate. Income and expenses are
translated at the exchange rate at the date of the transaction (or an average rate
for the period if exchange rates do not fluctuate significantly).
Any resulting exchange differences are recognised in other comprehensive income.
4. Foreign operations
Foreign operations are translated using the presentation currency rules where their
functional currency is different to that of the parent.
5. Monetary items forming part of a net investment in a foreign operation
Exchange differences arising on monetary items forming part of a net investment in
a foreign operation are recognised in profit or loss in the individual entity's financial
statements under the normal functional currency rules. However, they are reclassified as
other comprehensive income in the consolidated financial statements (so that they are
recognised in the same location as the re-translation of the foreign operation itself).
TT2020
383
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q24 Harvard
Further reading
The SBR examining team has written the following article which you should read:
IAS 21 – Does it need amending? (2017)
Available in the study support resources section of the ACCA website.
www.accaglobal.com
384
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Group statements of
cash flows
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Exam content
Group statements of cash flows could be examined in either Section A or B of the SBR exam. The first
question in Section A of the exam will be based on the financial statements of groups and could
therefore be entirely focused on the group statement of cash flows. Questions may require the
preparation of extracts from the group statement of cash flows and will require discussion and
explanation of any calculations performed. Threats to ethical principles in preparing the group
statement of cash flows could also be examined. Analysis and interpretation of a group statement of
cash flows could also be examined in Section B.
TT2020
385
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Additional considerations
386
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
1.2 Format
Essential reading
You should be familiar with the usefulness of cash flow information and with the format and
preparation of single entity statements of cash flows from your earlier studies in Financial Reporting.
Chapter 17 section 1 of the Essential Reading revises the detail if you are unsure. This is available in
Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
The format of a consolidated statement of cash flows is consistent with that for a single entity. Both
the direct and indirect methods of preparing the group statements of cash flows are acceptable
(IAS 7: para. 18).
Illustration 1
Indirect method: illustrative consolidated statement of cash flows
Note. New entries for a consolidated statement of cash flows are shaded in grey.
31.12.X1
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before taxation 3,350
Adjustment for:
Depreciation 520
Profit on sale of property, plant and equipment (10)
Share of profit of associate/joint venture (60)
Foreign exchange loss 40
Investment income (500)
Interest expense 400
3,740
Decrease in inventories 1,050
Increase in trade and other receivables (500)
Decrease in trade payables (1,740)
Cash generated from operations 2,550
Interest paid (270)
Income taxes paid (900)
Net cash from operating activities 1,380
TT2020
387
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
31.12.X1
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from investing activities
Acquisition of subsidiary X net of cash acquired (550)
Purchase of property, plant and equipment (350)
Proceeds from sale of equipment 20
Interest received 200
Dividends received (from associates/JVs and other investments) 200
Net cash used in investing activities (480)
Illustration 2
Direct method: illustrative consolidated statement of cash flows
Note. New entries for a consolidated statement of cash flows are shaded in grey.
31.12.X1
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Cash receipts from customers 30,150
Cash paid to suppliers and employees (27,600)
Cash generated from operations 2,550
Interest paid (270)
Income taxes paid (900)
Net cash from operating activities 1,380
388
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
31.12.X1
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from financing activities
Proceeds from issue of share capital 250
Proceeds from long-term borrowings 250
Payments of lease liabilities (90)
Dividends paid* (to owners of parent and NCI) (1,200)
Net cash used in financing activities (790)
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents 110
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period 120
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period 230
Use of the direct method is encouraged where the necessary information is not too costly to obtain,
but IAS 7 does not require it. In practice the direct method is rarely used because the indirect method
is much easier to prepare. However, it could be argued that companies ought to monitor their cash
flows carefully enough on an ongoing basis to be able to use the direct method at minimal extra cost.
See section 4 for more detail.
TT2020
389
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.1 Dividends paid to non-controlling interests
Actual cash payments made in the form of dividends paid to non-controlling interests are shown in
the consolidated statement of cash flows.
The dividend paid to the non-controlling interests (NCI) during the reporting period can be calculated
from the NCI figures in the consolidated financial statements:
Non-controlling interests
$'000
Opening balance (b/d) X
NCI share of total comprehensive income X
Acquisition of subsidiary (NCI at fair value or share of net assets) X
Disposal of subsidiary (X)
Non-cash (eg exchange loss on foreign operation) (X)
Dividends paid to NCI (balancing figure (β)) (X)
Closing balance (c/d) X
Dividends paid to NCI are included as a cash outflow in 'cash flow from financing activities'.
Illustration 3
Dividends paid to non-controlling interests
Woody Group has owned a number of subsidiaries for several years. It acquired a new subsidiary,
Hamm Co, during the year ended 31 December 20X7. The fair value of the non-controlling interests
in Hamm Co at the date of acquisition was $1,200,000. The statement of financial position of
Woody Group shows non-controlling interest of $5,150,000 at the start of the year and
$6,040,000 at the end of the year. The non-controlling interest's share of total comprehensive
income for the year is $1,680,000.
Required
Calculate the cash dividend paid to the non-controlling interests (NCI) in the year.
Solution
Non-controlling interests
$'000
Opening balance (b/d) 5,150
NCI share of total comprehensive income 1,680
Acquisition of subsidiary (NCI at fair value) 1,200
Cash (dividends paid to NCI) β (1,990)
Closing balance (c/d) 6,040
390
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Required
Calculate the dividend paid to non-controlling interests, using the proforma below to help you.
Solution
Non-controlling interests
$'000
Opening balance (b/d)
NCI share of total comprehensive income
TT2020
391
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.2 Dividends received from associates and joint ventures
Dividends received from associates or joint ventures can be calculated from the investment in
associate or investment joint venture figures in the consolidated financial statements.
Dividends received from associates or joint ventures are included as a cash inflow in 'cash flow from
investing activities’.
392
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
$'000
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation 15
Share of gain on property revaluation of associate 3
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified (5)
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 13
Total comprehensive income for the year 60
Required
(a) Calculate the dividends received from associates during the year to 31 December 20X2.
(b) Complete the extracts (given below) from the operating activities section and the investing
activities section of the group statement of cash flows.
(c) Briefly explain why an adjustment for the share of profits of associates is required when using
the indirect method.
Solution
(a) Dividends received from associates
Investment in associates
$'000
Carrying amount at 31 December 20X1
Group share of associates' profit for the year
Group share of associates' OCI (gains on property revaluation)
Acquisition of associate
Dividends received from associates (balancing figure)
Carrying amount at 31 December 20X2
(b) Extracts
EXTRACT FROM STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS (OPERATING ACTIVITIES)
$'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before tax
Adjustment for:
Share of profit of associates
EXTRACT FROM STATEMENT OF CASH FLOW (INVESTING ACTIVITIES)
$'000
Cash flows from investing activities
Dividends from associates
Acquisition of an associate
TT2020
393
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(c) Explanation
Acquisition
(1) The cash paid to buy the shares
(for an acquisition) or the cash
Group Cash received from selling the shares
P (1) (for a disposal)
These two cash flows should be netted off and shown as a single line in the consolidated
statement of cash flows under 'cash flows from investing activities' (IAS 7: paras. 39, 42).
394
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Illustration 4
Disposal of subsidiary
Darth Group disposed of its 100% owned subsidiary Jynn during the year ended 31 August 20X5.
Darth Group received $52 million cash proceeds from the acquirer. Jynn had a cash balance of
$14 million at the date of disposal.
Required
Show how the disposal of Jynn should be presented in the 'cash flows from investing activities'
section of the consolidated statement of cash flows of the Darth Group.
Solution
DARTH GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS (Extract)
$m
Cash flows from investing activities
Net cash received on disposal of subsidiary (W) 38
Working
$m
Cash proceeds from acquirer 52
Less cash disposed of in the subsidiary (14)
Net cash received on disposal of subsidiary 38
Subsidiary The subsidiary’s property, plant Reason: the new susbsidiary's assets and
acquired in the and equipment, inventories, liablities have been consolidated for the
period payables, receivables etc at the first time in the period. We need to take
date of acquisition should be account of that when we look at the
added in the relevant cash flow movement in group assets and liabilities
working. in the relevant cash flow working.
Subsidiary The subsidiary’s property, plant Reason: the assets and liabilities of the sold
disposed of in and equipment, inventories, subsidiary have been deconsolidated in
the period payables, receivables etc at the the period. We need to take account of that
date of disposal should be when we look at the movement in group
deducted in the relevant cash assets and liabilities in the relevant cash flow
flow working. working.
TT2020
395
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 5
Acquisition of a subsidiary – effect on cash flow workings
Below is an extract from the consolidated statement of financial position of Chip Group for the year
ended 31 December:
20X6 20X5
$'000 $'000
Property, plant and equipment 34,800 27,400
Chip Group acquired 100% of the equity shares of Potts on 1 August 20X6. At the date of
acquisition, Potts had property, plant and equipment with a carrying amount of $3,980,000.
During the year, Chip Group charged depreciation of $3,420,000 and acquired new equipment
under lease agreements totalling $4,450,000.
Required
Calculate the cash purchase of property, plant and equipment for the Chip Group for the year ended
31 December 20X6.
Solution
You should approach this in the same way as for a single entity, but remember to add the assets on
acquisition of Potts.
Property, plant and equipment
$'000
Opening balance (b/d) 27,400 Add amounts
Add acquired with subsidiary 3,980 acquired from Potts
Add acquired under lease agreements 4,450
Less depreciation (3,420)
32,410 Balancing figure is
the cash outflow
Acquired for cash β 2,390
Closing balance (c/d) 34,800
The cash outflow of $2,390 is shown in the consolidated statement of cash flows under the 'cash
from investing activities' section.
2.8 Disclosure
Essential reading
Chapter 17 section 3 of the Essential Reading considers the additional disclosure requirements in
respect of acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries and an entity's financing activities. This is
available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
396
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Essential reading
Chapter 17 section 2 of the Essential Reading contains an illustration showing the preparation of a
group statement of cash flows. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the
Workbook.
Current liabilities
Trade payables 10,100 9,400
Current tax 600 500
10,700 9,900
71,530 63,400
TT2020
397
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the year ended
31 December 20X8 was as follows.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X8
$'000
Revenue 60,800
Cost of sales (48,600)
Gross profit 12,200
Expenses (8,320)
Other operating income 120
Share of profit of associate 800
Profit before tax 4,800
Income tax expense (1,200)
Profit for the year 3,600
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation 1,000
Share of gain on property revaluation of associates 180
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified (250)
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 930
Total comprehensive income for the year 4,530
P elected to measure the non-controlling interests in S at the date of acquisition at their fair
value of $320,000.
(b) Depreciation charged to consolidated profit or loss amounted to $2,200,000.
398
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
(c) Part of the additions to property, plant and equipment during the year were imports made by P
from a foreign supplier on 30 September 20X8 for 1,080,000 corona. This was paid in full
on 30 November 20X8.
Exchange gains and losses are included in other operating income or expenses. Relevant
exchange rates were as follows:
Corona to $1
30 September 20X8 4.0
30 November 20X8 4.5
(d) There were no disposals of property, plant and equipment during the year.
Required
Prepare the consolidated statement of cash flows for P Group for the year ended 31 December 20X8
under the indirect method in accordance with IAS 7, using the proforma below to help you.
Notes to the statement of cash flows are not required.
Solution
P GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X8
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before taxation
Adjustments for:
Depreciation
Impairment loss
Share of profit of associate
Foreign exchange gain
in inventories
Increase or
decrease
in trade and other receivables
in trade payables
TT2020
399
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$'000 $'000
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year
Workings
1 Assets
Property, plant
& equipment Goodwill Associate
$'000 $'000 $'000
Opening balance (b/d)
Statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income (SPLOCI)
Depreciation
Impairment
Acquisition of subsidiary
Non-cash additions
Cash paid/(rec'd) β
Closing balance (c/d)
2 Equity
Share capital/ Retained
share premium earnings NCI
$'000 $'000 $'000
Opening balance (b/d)
SPLOCI
Acquisition of subsidiary
Cash (paid)/rec'd β
Closing balance (c/d)
3 Liabilities
Tax payable
$'000
Opening balance (b/d)
SPLOCI
Acquisition of subsidiary
Cash (paid)/rec'd β
Closing balance (c/d)
400
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
5 Foreign transaction
Essential reading
Chapter 17 section 2.1 of the Essential Reading includes an activity requiring the preparation of a
consolidated statement of cash flows including the disposal of a subsidiary during the year. This is
available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
TT2020
401
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.1 Areas to consider
Asking the following questions will help you to analyse and interpret a group's statement of cash
flows.
Companies that are seen as cash rich can often come under pressure from investors to either invest
the cash within the business or distribute it in the form of dividends paid. Employees are more likely
to demand increases in wages or expect bonuses if a company has large amounts of cash.
Not all stakeholders view increases in cash positively. A lender, such as a bank, may consider it
more likely that a company with a positive cash balance will repay its debts early or not require
future finance, which has a negative impact on the bank’s profits.
One of the group companies could be insolvent or have a declining working capital position,
but that cannot be seen from the consolidated statement of cash flows.
The degree to which the consolidated statement of cash flows gives a faithful representation of
the cash position of the individual group companies depends on the degree of deviation of the
individual statements of cash flow from the group statement.
402
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
TT2020
403
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
3.1.5 Ratio analysis
You might find it helpful to your analysis to calculate some or all of these ratios:
Activity 4: Analysis
The Horwich Group has been trading for a number of years and is currently going through a period
of expansion of its core business area.
The statement of cash flows for the year ended 31 December 20X0 for the Horwich Group is
presented below.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X0
Cash flows from operating activities $'000 $'000
Profit before taxation 2,200
Adjustments for:
Depreciation 380
Gain on sale of investments (50)
Loss on sale of property, plant and equipment 45
Investment income (180)
Interest costs 420
2,815
Increase in trade receivables (400)
Increase in inventories (390)
Increase in payables 550
Cash generated from operations 2,575
Interest paid (400)
Income taxes paid (760)
Net cash from operating activities 1,415
404
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Required
Analyse the above statement of cash flows for the Horwich Group, highlighting the key features of
each category of cash flows.
Solution
TT2020
405
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exercise 1: Cash flow analysis
Go online and look up the annual report of a company you are familiar with. Have a go at
analysing the statement of cash flows for that company, then review the narrative material in the front
of the annual report to see what the company has said about its cash flows.
4 Criticisms of IAS 7
4.1 Presentation
Cash flows from operating activities can be presented using the direct method or the indirect
method.
The direct method:
Is preferred by IAS 7
Is more likely to be readily understood by the users of financial statements
But is rarely used in practice because companies' systems often do not collect the type of
data required in an easily accessible form.
It can be difficult for users to compare the cash flows from operating activities of entities which use
different methods.
Illustration 6
During December 20X5, the Smith Group obtained a new bank loan which will be used to purchase
assets in the first quarter of 20X6. The interest paid on the loan will be included as an operating cash
outflow in the consolidated statement of cash flows for the year ended 31 December 20X5. The
directors of the Smith Group also want to include the loan proceeds as an operating cash inflow
because they suggest that presenting the loan proceeds and loan interest together will be more useful
for users of the accounts. The directors also wish to present the consolidated statement of cash flows
using the indirect method because they believe that the indirect method is more useful and
informative to users of financial statements than the direct method. The directors of Smith will each
receive a bonus if the Smith Group's operating cash flow for the year exceeds a certain amount.
Required
Comment on the directors' view that the indirect method of preparing statements of cash
flow is more useful and informative to the primary users of financial statements than the
direct method, providing specific reference to the treatment of the loan proceeds.
Solution
The direct method of preparing cash flow statements discloses major classes of gross cash
receipts and gross cash payments. It shows the items that affected cash flow and the size of
those cash flows. Cash received from, and cash paid to, specific sources such as customers and
suppliers are presented. This contrasts with the indirect method, where accrual-basis net income (loss)
is converted to cash flow information by means of add-backs and deductions.
The Conceptual Framework (paras. 1.2 1.4) identifies the primary users as present and potential
investors, lenders and other creditors. Primary users need information that will allow them to assess
an entity's prospects for future net cash inflows and how management are using the resources (cash
and non-cash) available to them. The statement of cash flows is essential in providing this
information.
406
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
From the point of view of primary users, an important advantage of the direct method is that primary
users can see and understand the actual cash flows, and how they relate to items of income or
expense. In this way, the user is able to better understand the cash receipts and payments for the
period. Additionally, the direct method discloses information not available elsewhere in the financial
statements, which could be of use in estimating future cash flows.
The indirect method involves adjusting the net profit or loss for the period for:
(a) Changes during the period in inventories, operating receivables and payables
(b) Non-cash items, eg depreciation, provisions, profits/losses on the sales of assets
(c) Other items, the cash flows from which should be classified under investing or financing
activities
The indirect method is less easily understood as it requires a level of accounting knowledge to
understand. It is therefore generally considered to be less useful to primary users than the direct
method.
From the point of view of the preparer of accounts, the indirect method is easier to
prepare, and nearly all companies use it in practice. The main argument companies have for using
the indirect method is that the direct method is too costly as it requires information to be
prepared that is not otherwise available. However, as the indirect method is less well understood by
primary users, it is perhaps more open to manipulation. This is particularly true with regard to
classification of specific cash flows.
The directors wish to inappropriately classify the loan proceeds as an operating cash inflow
(rather than a financing cash inflow as required by IAS 7) on the basis that this will be more useful to
users. This may be due to a misunderstanding of the requirements of IAS 7. Alternatively, it may be
an attempt by the directors to manipulate the statement of cash flows by improving the net cash from
operating activities which will improve their bonus prospects. Although this misclassification could
also take place using the direct method, it is arguably easier to 'hide' when using the indirect
method, because users find it more difficult to understand.
Therefore the indirect method would not, as is claimed by the directors, be more useful and
informative to users than the direct method. IAS 7 allows both methods, however, so the indirect
method would still be permissible.
TT2020
407
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
4.3 Purpose of cash flows
Classification of certain cash flows may be inconsistent with the purpose of the cash flows. For
example, research expenditure is classified as a cash outflow from operating activities but is often
considered to be a long-term investment. As such, some stakeholders believe the related cash flows
should be presented within investing activities, but this is not permitted under IAS 7.
Ethics note
Question 2 of the exam will always test ethical issues, so you need to be alert to any threats to the
fundamental principles of ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct when approaching statement of cash
flow questions. For example, there may be pressure on the reporting accountant to achieve a certain
level of cash flows from operating activities, which might tempt the accountant to manipulate how
certain cash flows are presented (this could be a self-interest or intimidation threat, depending on the
reasons for the pressure).
It is possible to manipulate cash flows by, for example, delaying paying suppliers until after the year
end, or perhaps by selling assets and then repurchasing them immediately after the year end in order
to show an improved cash position at the year end.
It is also possible to manipulate how cash flows are classified. Most entities opt to present 'cash flows
from operating activities' using the indirect method. This is usually because gathering the information
required to use the direct method is deemed too costly. However, the indirect method requires
complicated adjustments to get from profit before tax to cash from operations. These adjustments are
difficult to understand and confusing to users of the financial statements, and therefore provide
opportunities for manipulation by preparers.
There may be a temptation to misclassify cash flows between operating, investing and financing
activities in order to improve, say, cash from operations. The lack of understanding of the indirect
method may make it easier to hide the misclassification. If the classification of a cash flow is
motivated by say, self-interest on behalf of the reporting accountant, rather than by the most
appropriate application of IAS 7, the behaviour of the accountant would be unethical.
Time pressure at the year end may also lead to errors, especially when preparing the statement of
cash flows using the indirect method where some of the adjustments are not straightforward.
408
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Chapter summary
• Cash flows are cash Additional considerations • Dividends rec'd from associates/JVs:
and 'cash equivalents' • Cash paid/received to acquire/sell Inv in A/JV
(short term highly subsidiaries (net of cash acq'd/ b/d X
liquid investments disposed)
– Readily convertible SPLOCI (%PFY + %OCI) X
• Cash paid/received to acquire/sell
into cash Acquisition of A/JV X
associates/joint ventures
– Insignificant risk of Disposal of A/JV (X)
• Adjust workings for assets/liabilities
changes in value) of subsidiaries acquired/disposed Non-cash (eg FX loss
• Formats: • Dividends paid to NCI: foreign A/JV) (X)
– Indirect method NCI Cash (dividends rec’d) β (X)
– Direct method b/d – SOFP X c/d X
SPLOCI (NCI in TCI) X • Foreign currency transactions:
Acquisition of S (NCI at FV Eliminate FX differences that are not
or %FVNA) X cash flows:
Disposal of S (X)
Profit before taxation 3,350
Non-cash (eg FX loss foreign S) (X)
Adjustment for:
Cash (dividends paid to NCI) β (X)
Depreciation 450
c/d – SOFP X
Foreign exchange loss 40
Investment income (500)
Interest expense 400
3,740
• Adjust in workings (see examples
above)
TT2020
409
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Knowledge diagnostic
The format of a consolidated statement of cash flows is consistent with that for a single entity.
Both the direct and indirect methods of preparation are acceptable.
The preferred method under IAS 7 is the direct method (as it shows information not
available elsewhere in the financial statements). However, the indirect method is more
common in practice as it is easier to prepare.
The indirect method is more difficult for users to understand and is therefore open to
manipulation.
2. Consolidated statements of cash flows
Additional considerations include:
– Dividends paid to non-controlling shareholders
– Dividends received from associates
– Cash flows on acquisition/disposal of group entities
3. Analysis and interpretation of group statements of cash flows
The statement of cash flows itself can tell us useful information about the business' ability
to generate cash and the source/use of cash. Ratio analysis can also assist in
interpretation.
4. Criticisms of IAS 7
There are several criticisms of IAS 7, including those relating to presentation (direct vs
indirect method), inconsistency of classification (eg choice of classification for dividends
and interest) and inconsistency between the purpose of a cash flow and its classification in
the Statement of cash flows.
410
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Question practice
Now try the question below from the Further question practice bank:
Q26 Porter
Further reading
There are articles on the CPD section of the ACCA website which are relevant to the topics studied in this
chapter and which you should read:
Cashflow statements (2010)
Cash equivalents or not cash (2013)
Reconciliation? (2015)
www.accaglobal.com
TT2020
411
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
412
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 3
Applying good consolidation techniques
aging information
Man
aging information
Man
An
sw
er
pl
t
en
Manag ime
an
em
T
nin
Approaching Resolving financial Exam Success Skills
Good
g
Applying good
r p re t ati o n
consolidation Specific SBR Skills
techniques
e nts
Applying good
req f rrprneteation
consolidation
re m
Creating effective techniques
i ts
discussion
m eun
of t inotect i
uireeq
Eff d p
an
c re
Interpreting
e c re
r re o r
e C
ti v
financial statements
se w ri
nt tin al
ati g Efficient numeric
Co
on analysis
Efficient numerical
analysis
Introduction
Section A of the Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam will consist of two scenario based
questions that will total 50 marks. The first question will be based on the financial
statements of group entities, or extracts thereof. ACCA's approach to examining the
syllabus states that 'candidates should understand that in addition to the consideration of the
numerical aspects of group accounting (max. 25 marks), a discussion and explanation of
these numbers will also be required' (ACCA, 2018).
This Skills Checkpoint is designed to demonstrate application of good consolidation techniques
when answering the group accounting element of Question 1 of your SBR exam.
Note that Section B of the exam could deal with any aspect of the syllabus so it is also
possible that groups feature in Question 3 or 4. The technique that you learn in this Skills
Checkpoint will also prepare you for answering a Section B question featuring group accounting.
It is highly unlikely that you will be asked to prepare full consolidated financial statements in the SBR
exam and therefore, this Skills Checkpoint will cover the common extracts of the consolidated
financial statements that may be asked for. It will focus on providing sufficient explanation and
identifying and correcting errors and incorrect judgements made by the preparer of the draft
consolidated financial statements.
TT2020
413
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3: Applying good consolidation techniques
STEP 1:
Look at the mark allocation of the question and work out how many
minutes you have to answer each part of the question (based on 1.95
minutes a mark).
STEP 2:
Read the requirement for each part of the question and analyse it.
Highlight each sub-requirement separately, identify the verb(s) and ask
yourself what each sub-requirement means.
STEP 3:
Read the scenario. Identify exactly what information has been provided (eg
individual company financial statements, group financial statements,
extracts thereof and/or narrative information). Ask yourself what you need
to do with this information (eg which extract from the consolidated financial
statements you are focusing on). Identify which consolidation adjustments
may be required and which standards or parts of the Conceptual
Framework you need to explain.
STEP 4:
Draw up a group structure (incorporating % acquired, acquisition date
and reserves at acquisition). Make notes in the margins of the question as
to which extracts you are focusing on and what adjustments/corrections
are required. Also note any key points you wish to include in your
explanations. Do not perform any detailed calculations at this stage.
STEP 5:
Write up your answer using key words from the requirements as
headings. Ensure your explanations refer to underlying accounting
concepts and the relevant standards. When correcting errors, it may be
easier to perform the calculations first then explain why there was an error
and what the correct treatment is. Be careful not to overrun on time with
your calculations – they will typically be worth around 40% of the total
marks available.
414
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
416
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
Skill Activity
STEP 1 Look at the mark allocation of the following question and work out
how many minutes you have to answer each part of the question.
Based on 1.95 minutes a mark, you have approximately 29 minutes
to answer part (a) and approximately 10 minutes to answer part (b).
You should write the finishing time for each part on your question
paper, ensuring that you do not overrun.
Required
(a) Explain, with suitable workings, how the following figures should be calculated for
inclusion in the consolidated statement of financial position of the Grape Group as
at 30 November 20X9, showing the adjustments required to correct any errors:
(i) Goodwill on acquisition of Pear
(ii) Non-controlling interests in Pear (15 marks)
(b) Calculate the goodwill in Fraise and explain any adjustments required to correct for
errors. (5 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
STEP 2 Read the requirement for each part of the following question and
analyse it. Highlight each sub-requirement, identify the verb(s) and ask
yourself what each sub-requirement means.
Sub-requirement 1
Required
(a) Explain, with suitable workings, how the following figures should be calculated for
(ii) Non-controlling interests in Pear. Note the two consolidated (15 marks)
SOFP workings required
Sub-requirement 1
(b) Calculate the goodwill in Fraise and explain the adjustment required to correct any
errors. (5 marks)
Sub-requirement 2
(Total = 20 marks)
TT2020
417
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Note the three verbs used in the requirements. Two of them have been defined by the
ACCA in their list of common question verbs ('explain' and 'calculate'). A dictionary
definition can be used for the third ('show'). These definitions are shown below:
Explain To make an idea clear; to show Identify the error and explain
logically how a concept is why it is an error. State the
developed; to give the reason for correct accounting treatment
an event. and explain why it is correct.
Conclude with the adjustment
required to correct the error.
STEP 3 Read the scenario. Identify exactly what information has been
provided (eg individual company financial statements, group financial
statements, extracts thereof and/or narrative information). Ask yourself
what you need to do with this information.
Identify which adjustments are required and which accounting
standards or parts of the Conceptual Framework you need to refer to.
418
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
Consolidated
SOFP has
Question – Grape (20 marks) Three group
already been companies –
prepared –
The following group statement of financial position relates to the Grape you will need
you will need to prepare a
to correct
Group which comprises Grape, Pear and Fraise. group structure
errors
GROUP STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT 30 NOVEMBER 20X9
$m
Assets
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment 690
Goodwill 45
Positive goodwill
Intangible assets in subsidiaries 30
765
Current assets 420
1,185
Equity and liabilities
Share capital 250
Retained earnings 300
Other components of equity 60
Non-controlling interests Partly owned 195
subsidiaries 805
Non-current liabilities 220
Current liabilities 160
1,185
TT2020
419
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Pear held a franchise right, which at 1 June 20X9 had a fair IFRS 3 requires
separate
value of $10 million. This had not been recognised in the recognition of
identifiable
financial statements of Pear. The franchise agreement had a intangible assets
Amortise
franchise right remaining term of five years to run at that date and is not
for 6 months
post-acquisition renewable. Pear still holds this franchise at the year-end.
Measure NCI
Grape wishes to use the 'full goodwill' method for all acquisitions.
at acquisition
Post to 2nd line of at fair value
The fair value of the non-controlling interest in Pear was
goodwill working and
1st line of NCI working
$155 million on 1 June 20X9. The retained earnings and
other components of equity of Pear were
Use to work out NCI $115 million and $10 million at the date of acquisition
share of post-
acquisition reserves in and $170 million and $15 million at 30 November 20X9. Permitted under
NCI working
IFRS 3 but
The accountant accidentally used the 'partial goodwill' method to group wishes
to use full
Add franchise calculate the goodwill in Pear and used the fair value of net goodwill
right to fair value method – need
of net assets in to amend NCI
assets of $350 million excluding the franchise right. This
goodwill from % of net
calculation assets to fair
valuation of goodwill $30 million calculated as the consideration
value (in
goodwill and
transferred of $240 million plus non-controlling interests (NCI) of
NCI workings)
Revise to fair
value of $155 $140 million ($350 million × 40%) less net assets of $350
million in Add franchise
goodwill and million has been included in the group statement of financial position right to fair
NCI workings value of net
(full goodwill above. There has been no impairment of goodwill since acquisition. assets in
method) goodwill
calculation
The accountant has calculated NCI in Pear at 30 November 20X9 as
Revise to fair
Also need to $164 million being NCI of $140 million at acquisition plus NCI
value
deduct
amortisation on share of post-acquisition retaining earnings (($170 million –
franchise rights
(fair value $115 million) × 40%) and post-acquisition other components
adjustment) Correct – no
adjustment
of equity (($15 million – $10 million) × 40%). needed
420
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
1 December 20X8 6
This rate is not
30 November 20X9 5 Retranslate
required for this
question goodwill using
Average for the year to 30 November 20X9 5.5 this closing rate
Required
(a) Explain, with suitable workings, how the following figures should be
calculated for inclusion in the consolidated statement of financial
position of the Grape Group as at 30 November 20X9, showing the
adjustments required to correct any errors:
(i) Goodwill on acquisition of Pear
(ii) Non-controlling interests in Pear.
(15 marks)
(b) Calculate the goodwill in Fraise and explain the adjustment required
to correct any errors. (5 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
TT2020
421
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
STEP 4 Draw up a group structure (incorporating the percentage acquired,
acquisition date and reserves at acquisition). Make notes in the
margins of the question as to which consolidation working,
adjustment or corrections are required and any key points you
wish to make in your explanations. Do not perform any detailed
calculations at this stage.
Group structure
Grape ($)
The remainder of your planning should be in the form of annotations in the margin of the
question paper. This has been demonstrated for you in Step 3.
STEP 5 Write up your answer using key words from the requirements as
headings. When correcting errors, it is easier to perform the
calculations first then explain why you made that adjustment. Be
careful not to overrun on time with your calculations – you can see
from the marking guide below that they are only worth 40% of the
marks. Therefore, you need to leave 60% of your writing time for
the explanations. You will not be able to pass the question with
calculations alone. For the explanation, you might find it helpful to
write up your answer using the following structure:
(1) Identify the incorrect accounting treatment in the question.
(2) Explain why that accounting treatment is incorrect.
(3) Explain what the correct accounting treatment should be.
(4) Explain the adjustment required to correct the errors in the
question.
422
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
Marking guide
Marks
20
TT2020
423
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
A second error has been made because the fair value of identifiable
(1) Explain the
incorrect net assets used in the goodwill calculation excludes the franchise
accounting
treatment. (2) Explain why
right. IFRS 3 requires the parent to recognise goodwill the accounting
treatment is
separately from the identifiable intangible assets acquired in a incorrect.
business combination even if they have not been recognised in the
subsidiary's individual financial statements. An intangible asset is
identifiable if it meets either the separability criterion (capable of
being separated or divided from the subsidiary and sold, transferred,
(3) Explain what
licensed, rented or exchanged) or the contractual-legal criterion (arises the correct
accounting
from contractual or legal rights). The franchise right arises for treatment
should be
contractual arrangements; therefore it should be recognised as a (initial
measurement).
(4) Explain the separate intangible asset in the consolidated statement of
adjustment
required financial position of the Grape Group. This increases the fair
(initial
measurement). value of identifiable net assets at acquisition and decreases
goodwill as shown by the corrected goodwill calculation below.
Note that the fair value adjustment required for the land has already
been included in the fair value of identifiable net assets of
$350 million given in the question.
Goodwill in Pear
$m $m
Consideration transferred 240 Calculation:
424
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
TT2020
425
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Tutorial note
You might have found it helpful to prepare a fair value adjustments table to
assist your understanding but this was not required.
Fair value adjustments
At acq'n Year-end
(1.6.X9) Movement (30.11.X9)
$m $m $m
Land [350 – (220 + 115 + 10)] 5 – 5
Franchise at 1.6.X8 10 (1) 9
15 (3) 14
Goodwill in Fraise
426
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
TT2020
427
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam success skills diagnostic
Every time you complete a question, use the diagnostic below to assess how effectively you
demonstrated the exam success skills in answering the question. The table has been completed
below for the Grape question to give you an idea of the type of points that you should be
considering when assessing your answer. Complete the section entitled 'most important action
points to apply to your next question'.
428
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 3
Summary
Groups are very important in your SBR exam as they are guaranteed to be tested in
Question 1. Therefore, applying good consolidation techniques will have an important
part to play in you passing the exam.
The question in this Skills Checkpoint demonstrated the approach to correcting errors and
explaining the adjustments required in preparing extracts from consolidated financial
statements. With this type of question, the key to success is not spending all your time on
the calculations. Sufficient time must be allocated to the narrative explanation or you will
not pass the question. Make sure that when you practise further questions on groups that
you attempt the written element of requirements rather than just focusing on the
calculations.
TT2020
429
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
430
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Interpreting financial
statements for different
stakeholders
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Outline the principles behind the application of accounting policies and C11(c)
measurement in interim reports.
Discuss and apply relevant indicators of financial and non-financial performance E1(a)
including earnings per share and additional performance measures.
Discuss the increased demand for transparency in corporate reports, and the E1(b)
emergence of non-financial reporting standards.
Appraise the impact of environmental, social and ethical factors on performance E1(c)
measurement.
Discuss the current framework for integrated reporting (IR) including the objectives, E1(d)
concepts, guiding principles and content of an Integrated Report.
Discuss the nature of segment information to be disclosed and how segmental E1(f)
information enhances the quality and sustainability of performance.
Discuss the impact of current issues in corporate reporting. This learning outcome F1(c)
may be tested by requiring the application of one or several existing standards to
an accounting issue. It is also likely to require and explanation of the resulting
accounting implications (for example, accounting for cryptocurrency in the Digital
Age or accounting for the effects of a natural disaster and the resulting
environmental liabilities). The following examples are relevant to the current
syllabus:
4. Management commentary
5. Sustainability Reporting
Discuss developments in devising a structure for corporate reporting that addresses F1(d)
the needs of stakeholders.
TT2020
431
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam context
The SBR syllabus requires students to analyse the financial statements of different types of entity, from
traditional manufacturing companies to digital companies, from a number of different stakeholder
perspectives and using a range of methods of interpretation. Section B of the exam will always
include a full question or a part of a question that requires the analysis and interpretation of financial
and/or non-financial information from the preparer's or another stakeholder's perspective. This takes
you beyond simply preparing financial statements to understanding how the financial statements
provide information to end users.
432
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Chapter overview
Financial
Alternative
Non-financial
Reportable segments
Disclosure requirements
TT2020
433
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1 Stakeholders
Stakeholder: Anyone with an interest in a business; they can either affect or be affected by the
business.
Key term
Interpretation and analysis of financial statements and other elements of corporate reports is
performed by stakeholders when they are making decisions about an entity. There are a range of
different stakeholder groups, often with competing interests and not all stakeholders are interested in
the financial performance of a business.
Activity 1: Stakeholders
Required
Complete the table below by including an additional reason why each of the given stakeholders may
be interested in the financial statements prepared by an entity, and identify two further stakeholders
with reasons.
434
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
2 Performance measures
'Performance' can mean different things to different stakeholders. It can also differ between types of
company. Traditional financial performance measures remain important, but there is an increasing
focus on alternative performance measures, such as Economic Value Added (EVA)® and
non-financial measures such as employee well-being and the environmental impact that an entity
has.
Preparers of financial statements need to carefully balance the demand for a wide range of
information against the cost of preparing it and the risk of publishing information that is potentially
commercially sensitive.
It is important to put yourself in the shoes of the stakeholder in an exam question in order to perform
the appropriate type of analysis. The interpretation of financial statements must also be relevant to the
type of entity being analysed.
Essential reading
You should be familiar with how to calculate the common ratios and perform ratio analysis.
Chapter 18 section 1 of the Essential Reading provides revision of the calculations and analysis
technique and section 2 explains common problems with ratio analysis. This is available in Appendix
2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Essential reading
You should be familiar with the definitions used in IAS 33 and with how to calculate basic EPS and
diluted EPS from your previous studies. Chapter 18 section 3 of the Essential Reading provides further
detail on the definitions, calculations, presentation and significance of EPS. This is available
in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
TT2020
435
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The objective of IAS 33 is to improve the comparison of the performance of different entities in the
same period and of the same entity in different accounting periods. It is a measure of the amount of
profits (after tax, non-controlling interests and preference dividends) earned by a company for each
ordinary share (IAS 33: para. 1).
There are two EPS figures which must be disclosed – basic EPS and diluted EPS:
Calculated by dividing the net profit or Calculated by adjusting the net profit or loss
loss for the period attributable to ordinary and weighted average number of ordinary
equity holders of the parent by the shares that are used in the basic EPS
weighted average number of calculation to reflect the impact of potential
ordinary shares outstanding during the ordinary shares.
period (IAS 33: para. 10).
EPS is an important factor in assessing the stewardship and management role performed by
company directors and managers. Remuneration packages might be linked to EPS growth, thereby
increasing the pressure on management to improve EPS. The danger of this, however, is that
management effort may go into distorting results to produce a favourable EPS.
Illustration 1
EPS Earnings manipulation
Vero manufactures furniture and is heavily capitalised. The depreciation expense is significant to the
financial statements, marking up around 40% of the operating expenses of the company for the last
three years. For unrelated reasons, the EPS of the company has been declining across the same
period, which is detrimental to Vero's directors as their annual bonus is based, in part, on achieving
EPS targets.
The Finance Director of Vero is considering extending the remaining useful lives of its property, plant
and equipment by an average of five years, which will reduce the depreciation expense by around
$4m per annum, and in turn help to increase EPS.
Required
Comment on any ethical issues associated with the proposed change in useful life of Vero's assets.
436
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Solution
Step 1 State the relevant rule or principle per the accounting standard(s)
IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment requires an entity to review the useful life
of its assets at least every financial year end, and, if expectations differ from
previous estimates, the change should be accounted for as a change in
accounting estimate (IAS 16: para. 51).
IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors only
permits revisions of accounting estimates if changes occur in the circumstances
on which the estimate was based or as a result of new information or more
experience (IAS 8: para. 34).
Step 3 Explain the ethical issues (threats to the ethical principles of the
ACCA Code of Ethics and Conduct)
However, it appears that the aim of the Director is to use the change in useful life
as a means to manipulate earnings. We are told that EPS has been declining
and as it is a factor in determining the directors' annual bonus, there appears to
be an incentive for the Finance Director to manipulate earnings in order to
increase EPS.
Therefore, there is a threat to the fundamental principles of integrity and
objectivity if the Finance Director deliberately changes an accounting estimate to
increase earnings and EPS. Furthermore, an unjustified change would result in
non-compliance with IAS 16 and therefore, contravene the fundamental principle
of professional competence.
From an ethical perspective, the Director should not actively take steps to
manipulate earnings and attempt to mislead stakeholders.
TT2020
437
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
Illustration 2
Facebook reports revenue excluding foreign exchange effects, advertising revenue excluding foreign
exchange effects and free cash flow as non-GAAP performance measures that it considers useful to
investors in understanding the performance of its business.
The European Securities and Markets Authority (ESMA) has issued guidelines to promote the
usefulness and transparency of APMs. In those guidelines, ESMA defines an APM as follows.
438
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Advantages Maximisation of EVA® will create real wealth for the shareholders.
EVA® may be less distorted by the accounting policies selected as the
measure is based on figures that are closer to cash flows than accounting profits.
EVA® recognises costs such as advertising and development as investments
for the future and thus they do not immediately reduce the EVA® in the year
of expenditure.
EVA® focuses on efficient use of capital.
TT2020
439
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.2.2 Advantages and disadvantages of APMs
Advantages Disadvantages
Exercise 1: APMs
Go online and have a look at ESMA's Guidelines on Alternative Performance Measures. They are
available at www.esma.europa.eu in the Rules, Databases & Library tab.
Then do some research on the types of APMs disclosed by companies you are familiar with.
440
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Activity 3: APM
'EBITDAR' is defined as earnings before interest, tax, depreciation, amortisation and rent. The
directors of Sharky issued an earnings release just prior to the year end, in which they disclosed that
EBITDAR had improved by $68 million as a result of the restructuring of the company during the year.
The directors discussed EBITDAR in detail, citing the successful restructuring as the reason for the
'exceptional performance' but did not disclose any comparable IFRS information nor a reconciliation
to IFRS line items. In previous years, Sharky disclosed EBITDA rather than EBITDAR.
Required
Discuss whether the earnings release is consistent with ESMA guidelines.
Solution
TT2020
441
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Entities have different 'success measures'– some of the more common ones include:
Illustration 3
The financial statements of Twitter report Daily Active Users, Monthly Active Users and Advertising
Engagements as key metrics as its business model relies on active and engaged users.
Customer What do existing and new Gives rise to targets that matter to
customers value about us? customers (eg cost, quality, delivery,
inspection, handling, response to needs)
442
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Innovation and learning Can we continue to improve Considers the business's capacity to
and create future value? maintain its competitive position through
the acquisition of new skills and the
development of new products
Customer
Internal
TT2020
443
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Perspective Measure Why?
Required
Discuss, providing explanations, whether the performance measures described below are consistent with
your expectations for Company A and Company B.
444
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Solution
3 Sustainability reporting
3.1 What is 'sustainability'?
Sustainability: Limiting the use of depleting resources to a level that can be replenished.
Key term Sustainable development: 'Development that meets the needs of present generations, without
compromising the rights of future generations to fulfil their needs' (UN, 2019: p. XV).
TT2020
445
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Illustration 4
IKEA, the Swedish home furnishing store, has a sustainability strategy called People & Planet
Positive. In 2018, IKEA updated its strategy to align with the UN Sustainable Development Goals.
The three main aims of IKEA's sustainability strategy are:
• Inspiring and enabling healthy and sustainable living
• Transforming IKEA into a circular and climate positive business
• Being fair and equal
IKEA publishes an annual sustainability report which details how it has followed its sustainability
strategy and the challenges it has faced. Read more online in the reports and downloads section of
the IKEA website: www.ikea.com
General public
Regulators and
and future
policy makers
population
Core values of a
sustainable business
Customers and
Employees
suppliers
The growing awareness of the part that business has to play in sustainable development has led to
stakeholder expectations that quoted organisations will make these disclosures.
Sustainability reporting is key part of a company's dialogue with its stakeholders. In fact,
the stakeholder desire for and expectation of such information is so strong, companies that fail to make
sustainability disclosure will likely now be at a significant disadvantage.
This demand for transparency has resulted in the emergence of non-financial reporting standards for
such issues. The most well-known standards on sustainability reporting are produced by the Global
Reporting Initiative.
446
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Essential reading
Further detail on the GRI Standards can be found in Chapter 18 section 4 of the Essential Reading.
This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
Essential reading
The concept of human capital accounting is explained in Chapter 18 section 5 of the Essential
Reading. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
TT2020
447
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
External benefits include:
Mitigating – or reversing – negative environmental, social and governance impacts
Enabling external stakeholders to understand the organisation's true value, and tangible and
intangible assets
Demonstrating how the organisation influences, and is influenced by, expectations about
sustainable development
(GRI, no date)
4 Integrated reporting
Integrated reporting combines financial reporting and
sustainability reporting with the aim of helping readers
Traditional
to understand three discrete elements of the value
financial
of a business (KPMG, 2012):
reporting
• Business as usual - the current shape and
performance of the business
Integrated
reporting • The likely effect of management's plans,
external issues and opportunities
• The long-term value of a business
Sustainability
reporting
The aim of integrated reporting (known as '<IR>') is to demonstrate the linkage between
strategy, governance and financial performance and the social, environmental and
economic context within which the business operates. <IR> is based on the concept of
integrated thinking.
Integrated thinking: 'Is the active consideration by the organization of the relationships
between its various operating and functional units and the capitals that the organization
Key term
uses or affects.' (International Integrated Reporting Council (IIRC), 2019)
4.1 Definitions
Integrated reporting <IR>: A process founded on integrated thinking that results in a periodic
integrated report by an organisation about value creation over time and related communications
Key terms
regarding aspects of value creation.
Integrated report: A concise communication about how an organisation's strategy,
governance, performance and prospects, in the context of its external environment, lead to the
creation of value over the short, medium and long term.
(International <IR> Framework, Glossary)
448
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
TT2020
449
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
4.5 Guiding principles
There are seven guiding principles that the <IR> Framework requires an organisation's reporting to
demonstrate in order to be seen as meaningful (IIRC, 2013: p.16-23).
Provide insight into
strategy and plans for
the future, in the context
of capitals and value creation
Strategic focus
and future Show a holistic picture
orientation of combination,
Present information interrelatedness and
consistently over time Consistency dependencies of factors
in a way that allows Connectivity of
and that affect ability to
comparison with information
comparability create value
other organisations
Guiding
principles
Give a balanced Provide insight into
Reliability and Stakeholder
view, including both nature, quality of
completeness relationships
positive and negative relationships with key
material matters, stakeholders and how
without material error organisation responds
to their needs/interests
Conciseness Materiality
450
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Organisational overview 'What does the organisation do and what are the circumstances
and external environment under which it operates?'
'What are the specific risks and opportunities that affect the
Risks and opportunities organisation's ability to create value over the short, medium and
long term, and how is the organisation dealing with them?'
Strategy and 'Where does the organisation want to go and how does it intend
resource allocation to get there?'
'To what extent has the organisation achieved its strategic objective
Performance
and what are its outcomes in terms of effects on the capital?'
Basis of preparation 'How does the organisation determine what matters to include in the
and presentation integrated report and how are such matters quantified or evaluated?'
Illustration 5
Materiality and integrated reporting
Materiality is an issue in preparing financial statements and is cited as one of the reasons why
financial statements often contain too much irrelevant information ('clutter') and not enough relevant
information upon which stakeholders can take decisions. The IAS 1 Presentation of Financial
Statements definition of material is not wholly consistent with the integrated reporting definition of
materiality.
Required
Discuss whether the concept of materiality in IAS 1 is appropriate for use in an integrated report.
Solution
In traditional financial reporting, 'information is material if omitting, misstating or obscuring it could
reasonably be expected to influence decisions that primary users of financial statements make on the basis
of those financial statements' (IAS 1: para. 7).
Integrated reporting considers transactions and events to be material if they impact an entity's ability to
create value for its owners in the short, medium and long term.
TT2020
451
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The IAS 1 definition of materiality is too narrow to be applied to an integrated report as its sole
focus is the financial statements. The Integrated Reporting framework takes a wider view that items
considered material under IAS 1 would only also be material to an integrated report if they influence those
who may provide capital (in its many different forms) with regards to the organisation's ability to create
value. Additional matters may, however, be deemed material in integrated reporting if the matter could
influence the assessments of the report's users.
The Integrated Reporting framework would also consider an item material if it helped to demonstrate that
senior management was discharging its responsibilities, regardless of the financial value of that item.
Required
Discuss any concerns that stakeholders may have in considering whether integrated reporting is
suitable for helping to evaluate a company.
Solution
452
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Essential reading
The benefits and limitations of integrated reporting is covered in Chapter 18 section 6 of the Essential
Reading. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
5 Management commentary
The purpose of the management commentary is to provide a context for interpreting a
company's financial position, performance and cash flows.
Supplements and
complements financial
statements
Management
commentary
Provides management's view
of performance, position
and progress
Management commentary: A narrative report that relates to financial statements that have
been prepared in accordance with IFRSs. Management commentary provides users with
Key term
historical explanations of the amounts presented in the financial statements, specifically the
entity's financial position, financial performance and cash flows. It also provides commentary on an
entity's prospects and other information not presented in the financial statements. Management
commentary also serves as a basis for understanding management's objectives and its
strategies for achieving those objectives. (IFRS Practice Statement 1: Appendix)
5.2.1 Presentation
The form and content of management commentary will vary between entities, reflecting the
nature of their business, the strategies adopted by management and the regulatory environment in
which they operate (IFRS Practice Statement 1: para. 22).
TT2020
453
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5.3 Elements of management commentary
The particular focus of management commentary will depend on the facts and circumstances
of the entity.
However, Practice Statement 1 requires a management commentary to include information that is
essential to an understanding of (para. 24):
(a) The nature of the business
(b) Management's objectives and its strategies for meeting those objectives
(c) The entity's most significant resources, risks and relationships
(d) The results of operations and prospects
(e) The critical performance measures and indicators that management uses to evaluate the
entity's performance against stated objectives
Essential reading
These elements are explained further in Chapter 18 section 7 of the Essential Reading. The
advantages and disadvantages of a compulsory management commentary are covered in the same
section. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
6 Segment reporting
Financial statements are highly aggregated which can make them of limited use for stakeholders
who want to understand more about how an entity has arrived at its financial performance and
position for a period.
Large entities in particular often have a wide range of products or services and operate in a
diverse range of locations, all of which contribute to the results of the entity as a whole.
In order to allow shareholders to fully understand the development of the company's business, certain
entities are required to provide segment information which discloses revenues, profits and
assets (amongst other items) by major business area.
IFRS 8 Operating Segments is only compulsory for entities whose debt or equity instruments are
traded in a public market (or entities filing or in the process of filing financial statements for the
purpose of issuing instruments) (IFRS 8: para. 2).
It is key that you understand:
6.1 Definition
454
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
There were no significant intra-group balances in the segment assets and liabilities. Due to the
disappointing performance of Europe in the year, the management of Jesmond would prefer not to
include Europe as a reportable segment. They believe reporting North America and the other regions
will provide the stakeholders with sufficient information.
Required
Advise the management of Jesmond on the principles for determining reportable segments under
IFRS 8 and comment on whether Europe can be omitted as a reportable segment.
Solution
IFRS 8 requires a business to determine its operating segments on the basis of its internal management
reporting. As Jesmond reports to management on the basis of geographical reasons, this is how
Jesmond determines its segments.
IFRS 8 requires an entity to report separate information about each operating segment that:
(a) Has been identified as meeting the definition of an operating segment; and
(b) Has a segment total that is 10% or more of total:
(i) Revenue (internal and external);
(ii) All segments not reporting a loss (or all segments in loss if greater); or
(iii) Assets.
TT2020
455
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The quantitative 10% criteria have been applied to Europe in the following table:
Profit or loss The absolute amount of its reported Total of all segments in No
profit or loss is 10% or more of profit = $60m +
the greater of, in absolute $105m = $165m
amount, all operating segments Total of all segments in
not reporting a loss, and all loss = $(10)m
operating segments reporting
10% of greater =
a loss
$16.5m
456
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
There were no significant intragroup balances in the segment assets and liabilities. All companies
were originally set up by the Endeavour Group. Endeavour decided to sell off its Body care
operations and the sale was completed on 31 December 20X5. On the same date the group
acquired another group in the Hair care area. The fair values of the assets and liabilities of the new
Hair care group were $32 million and $13 million respectively. The purpose of the purchase was to
expand the group's presence by entering the Chinese market, with a subsidiary providing lower cost
products for the mass retail markets. Until then, Hair care products had been 'high end' products sold
mainly wholesale to hairdressing chains. The directors plan to report the new purchase as part of the
Hair care segment.
Required
Discuss which of the operating segments of Endeavour constitute a 'reportable' operating segment
under IFRS 8 Operating Segments for the year ended 31 December 20X5.
Solution
TT2020
457
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6.3 Disclosures
Key items to be disclosed are:
(a) Factors used to identify the entity's reportable segments
(b) Types of products and services from which each reportable segment derives its revenues
(c) Reportable segment revenues, profit or loss, assets, liabilities and other material items
Reporting of a measure of profit or loss by segment is compulsory. Other items are disclosed
if included in the figures reviewed by or regularly provided to the chief operating decision
maker.
(d) External revenue by each product and service (if reported basis is not products and services)
(e) Geographical information
(f) Information about reliance on major customers (ie those who represent > 10% external revenue)
Essential reading
IFRS 8 is essentially concerned with disclosure and therefore the disclosures required by IFRS 8 are
extensive. Chapter 18 section 8 of the Essential Reading includes an illustrative example of an IFRS 8
disclosure. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
458
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
TT2020
459
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Reconciliations of reportable segment revenues, profit or loss, assets and liabilities
Total for Elimination
reportable of inter- Unallocated
segments Other segment amounts Group
$m $m $m $m $m
Revenue 352 10 (2.0) – 360.0
Profit or loss 22 1 (0.5) (5) 17.5
Assets 140 5 (2.0) 8 151.0
Liabilities 110 3 (2.0) 20 131.0
Required
Discuss the usefulness of the disclosure requirements of IFRS 8 for investors, illustrating your answer
where applicable with JH's segment report. (13 marks)
Professional marks will be awarded for clarity and quality of presentation. (2 marks)
(Total = 15 marks)
Solution
460
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
The minimum components of an interim financial report prepared in accordance with IAS 34 are:
A condensed statement of financial position;
A condensed statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income;
A condensed statement of cash flows;
A condensed statement of changes in equity; and
Selected explanatory notes.
Condensed financial statements must include at least each of the headings and subtotals included in
the entity's most recent annual financial statements and limited explanatory notes required by the
standard.
Interim reports are voluntary as far as IAS 34 is concerned; however IAS 34 applies where an
interim report is described as complying with IFRS Standards, and publicly traded entities are
encouraged to provide at least half yearly interim reports. Regulators in a particular regime may
require interim reports to be published by certain companies, eg companies listed on a regulated
stock exchange.
Essential reading
For further detail on the requirements of IAS 34 see Chapter 18 of the Essential Reading (available in
Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook).
Ethics note
This chapter has included discussion of the manipulation of earnings, which is one of a number of
potential ethical issues you may be required to comment on in the SBR exam. Other examples could
include a company that makes significant sales to related parties and the directors not wanting to
disclose details of the transactions, directors trying to window dress revenue by offering large
incentives to make sales to un-creditworthy customers (although IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with
Customers makes this difficult), or manipulating estimates to achieve required results.
Performance Objective 8 (PO8) requires you to demonstrate that you can analyse and interpret
financial reports, including (a) assessing the financial performance and position of an entity based on
PER alert
its financial statements and (b) evaluating the effect of accounting policies on the financial position
and performance of an entity. The knowledge gained from this chapter will give you the skills to
satisfy this performance objective.
TT2020
461
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
462
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Stakeholders
A stakeholder is anyone with an interest in a business, and can either affect or be affected by the
business.
2. Performance measurement
Financial. Mainly ratio analysis. Make sure that you understand what each of the ratios
represents. Always remember that 'profit' and 'net assets' are fairly arbitrary figures, affected
by different accounting policies and manipulation.
EPS is a measure of the amount of profits earned by a company for each ordinary share.
Earnings are profits after tax and preferred dividends. Accounting policies may be adopted for
the purpose of manipulation. New accounting standards (or changes in standards)
can have a significant impact on the financial statements and therefore EPS.
Alternative performance measures such as EBITDA and EVA® help management disclose
information that is relevant for that entity, but there is a lack of consistency in reporting and
APMs are subject to manipulation. ESMA guidelines have been issued to alleviate some of the
problems with APMs.
Non-financial measures such as employee wellbeing, customer satisfaction, productivity levels,
social and environmental are increasingly important.
3. Sustainability reporting
A sustainability report is a report published by a company about the economic, environmental
and social impacts caused by its everyday activities.
Sustainability reporting is key part of a company's dialogue with its stakeholders. There is an
expectation from investors that companies will make disclosure on sustainability issues, for
example including the risks and opportunities it faces from climate change.
4. Integrated reporting
Integrated reporting is concerned with conveying a wider message on organisational
performance. It is fundamentally concerned with reporting on the value created by the
organisation's resources. Resources are referred to as 'capitals'. Value is created or lost when
capitals interact with one another. It is intended that integrated reporting should lead to a holistic
view when assessing organisational performance.
5. Management commentary
The purpose of the management commentary is to provide a context for interpreting a company's
financial position, performance and cash flows. Management commentary supplements and
complements financial statements and provides management's view of performance, position and
progress.
6. Segment reporting
Operating segments are parts of a business that engage in revenue earnings activities,
management review and for which financial information is available.
Reportable segments are operating segments or aggregation of operating segments that
meet specified criteria.
IFRS 8 disclosures are of:
Operating segment profit or loss
Segment assets
Segment liabilities
Certain income and expense items
TT2020
463
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Disclosures are also required about the revenues derived from products or services and about the
countries in which revenues are earned or assets held, even if that information is not used by
management in making decisions.
7. IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting
Interim reports are voluntary but must comply with IAS 34 if described as complying with IFRS
Standards.
Minimum components: condensed primary statements and selected explanatory notes
464
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Question practice
Now try the questions below from the Further question practice bank (available in the digital edition of the
Workbook):
Q27 Grow by acquisition
Q28 Ghorse
Q29 German competitor
Q30 Peter Holdings
Q31 Jay
Further reading
There are articles on the ACCA website, written by the SBR examining team, which are relevant to the
topics studied in this chapter and which you should read.
Technical articles
On the study support resources section of the website:
Additional performance measures
Giving investors what they need
The definition and disclosure of capital
The Integrated report framework
Bin the clutter
Using the business model of a company to help analyse its performance
The Sustainable Development Goals
On the CPD section of the website:
Changing face of additional performance measures in the UK (2014)
Exam approach articles
On the study support resources section of the website:
Recommended approach to Section B of the SBR exam
How to earn professional marks
www.accaglobal.com
On the ACCA YouTube channel:
John Kattar on Alternative performance measures (APMs)
www.youtube.com/watch?v=5b6EXX2JBFc
For further information on the IASB's project on APMs, see:
IASB Accounting for non-GAAP earnings measures
www.ifrs.org/news-and-events/2017/03/accounting-for-non-gaap-earnings-measures/
For further information on <IR> and GRI, see:
integratedreporting.org
www.globalreporting.org
www.pwc.com/my/en/services/sustainability/gri-index.html
For further information on the UN's Sustainable Development Goals, see:
www.un.org/sustainabledevelopment/sustainable-development-goals/
TT2020
465
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
466
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 4
Interpreting financial statements
aging information
Man
aging information
Man
An
sw
er
pl
t
en
Manag ime
an
em
T
nin
Approaching Resolving financial Exam Success Skills
Good
r p re t ati o n
Specific SBR Skills
e nts
Applying good
req f rrprneteation
consolidation
re m
Creating effective
Interpretingtechniques
i ts
discussion
m eun
financial statements
of t inotect i
uireeq
Eff d p
an
c re
Performing
e c re
r re o r
e C
ti v
financial analysis
se w ri
nt tin er ica
l
ati g Efficient num
Co
on analysis
Efficient numerical
analysis
Introduction
Section B of the Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam will contain two questions, which may
be scenario, case-study or essay based and will contain both discursive and computational
elements. Section B could deal with any aspect of the syllabus but will always include either a
full question, or part of a question that requires appraisal of financial or
non-financial information from either the preparer's and/or another
stakeholder's perspective. Two professional marks will be awarded to the question in
Section B that requires analysis.
Given that the interpretation of financial statements will feature in Section B of every exam, it is
essential that you master the appropriate technique for analysing and interpreting information
and drawing relevant conclusions in order to maximise your chance of passing the SBR exam.
As a reminder, the detailed syllabus learning outcomes for interpreting financial statements are:
E Interpret financial statements for different stakeholders
(a) Discuss and apply relevant indicators of financial and non-financial performance including
earnings per share and additional performance measures.
(b) Discuss the increased demand for transparency in corporate reports, and the emergence of
non-financial reporting standards.
(c) Appraise the impact of environmental, social and ethical factors on performance
measurement.
(d) Discuss the current framework for integrated reporting (IR) including the objectives,
concepts, guiding principles and content of an Integrated Report.
(e) Determine the nature and extent of reportable segments.
(f) Discuss the nature of segment information to be disclosed and how segmental information
enhances quality and sustainability of performance.
TT2020
467
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4: Interpreting financial statements
468
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
STEP 1:
Work out the time per requirement (1.95 minutes a
mark).
STEP 2:
Read and analyse the requirement.
STEP 3:
Read and analyse the scenario.
STEP 4:
Prepare an answer plan.
STEP 5:
Write up your answer.
TT2020
469
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam success skills
In this question, we will focus on the following exam success skills and in particular:
Good time management. The exam will be time-pressured and you will
need to manage it carefully to ensure that you can make a good attempt at
every part of every question. You will have 3 hours and 15 minutes in the exam,
which works out at 1.95 minutes a mark. The following question is worth 20
marks so you should allow 39 minutes. For the other syllabus areas, our advice
has been to allow a third to a quarter of your time for reading and planning.
However, analysis questions require deep thinking at the planning stage so it is
recommended that you dedicate a third of your time to reading and planning
(here, 13 minutes) and the remainder for writing up your answer (here, 26
minutes).
Managing information. There is a lot of information to absorb in this
question and the best approach is active reading. Firstly you should identify any
specific ratio mentioned in the requirement – in this question, it is earnings per
share. You need to think of the formula and, as you read each paragraph of the
question, you should assess whether the accounting treatment in the scenario
complies with the relevant IAS or IFRS. Where the accounting treatment is
incorrect, you need to work out the impact on the numerator and/or
denominator of the ratio in question. Also look out for threats to the fundamental
principles from the ACCA Code of Ethics and Conduct. It can be helpful to jot
down your ideas in the margins of the question paper.
Correct interpretation of the requirements. There are three parts to the
following question and the first part has two sub-requirements. Make sure you
identify the verbs and analyse the requirement carefully so you understand how
to approach your answer.
Answer planning. Everyone will have a preferred style for an answer plan.
For example, it may be a mind map, bullet-pointed lists or simply annotating the
question paper. Choose the approach that you feel most comfortable with or, if
you are not sure, try out different approaches for different questions until you
have found your preferred style. You will typically be awarded 1 mark per
relevant, well explained point so you should aim to generate sufficient points to
score a comfortable pass.
Efficient numerical analysis. The most effective way to approach this part
of the question is to draw up a proforma to correct the original earnings per
share (EPS) calculation – you will need a working for earnings and a separate
working for the number of shares. You should start off with the figures per the
question then correct each of the errors to arrive at the revised figures. Clearly
label each number in your working.
Effective writing and presentation. Use headings and sub-headings in
your answer, underlined with a ruler, and write in full sentences, ensuring your
style is professional. Two professional marks will be awarded to the analysis
question in Section B of the SBR exam. The use of headings, sub-headings and
full sentences as well as clear explanations and ensuring that all
sub-requirements are answered and that all issues in the scenario are addressed
will help you obtain these two marks.
470
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
Skill Activity
STEP 1 Look at the mark allocation of the following question and work out
how many minutes you have to answer the question. It is a 20 mark
question and, at 1.95 minutes a mark, it should take 39 minutes, of
which a third should be spent reading and planning (13 minutes) and
the remainder writing up your answer (26 minutes). You then divide
your writing time between the three parts of the question in
accordance with the mark allocation – so around half of your time on
(a) (13 minutes), around 8 minutes on (b) and 5 minutes on (c).
Required
(a) Advise Mr Low as to whether earnings per share has been accurately
calculated by the directors and show a revised calculation of earnings
per share if necessary. (10 marks)
(b) Discuss whether the directors may have acted unethically in the way they
have calculated earnings per share. (5 marks)
(c) Discuss Mr Low's suggestion that non-recurring items should be removed
from profit before EPS is calculated. (3 marks)
Professional marks will be awarded for clarity and quality of presentation.
(2 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
STEP 2 Read the requirements for the following question and analyse them.
Watch out for hidden sub-requirements! Underline and number each
sub-requirement or highlight them in different colours. Identify the
verb(s) and ask yourself what each sub-requirement means.
(b) Discuss whether the directors may have acted unethically in the way they
Verb – refer to
have calculated earnings per share. (5 marks)
definition
(c) Discuss Mr Low's suggestion that non-recurring items should be removed
from profit before EPS is calculated. Single requirement (written)
Professional marks will be awarded for clarity and quality of presentation. (2 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
TT2020
471
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Part (a) of this question tests analysis and interpretation skills. Part (b) tests ethical issues
(covered in more detail in Skills Checkpoint 1). Part (c) tests your knowledge of APMs as
an alternative to traditional financial performance measures.
Note the three verbs used in the requirements. 'Advise' and 'discuss' have been
defined by ACCA in their list of common question verbs. As 'show' is not defined by
ACCA, a dictionary definition can be used instead. These definitions are shown
below:
Advise To offer guidance or some Think about who the advice is for
relevant expertise to a (Mr Low) and what you are advising
recipient, allowing them to him about (earnings per share).
make a more informed Then break down the earnings per
decision share (EPS) ratio into its numerator
(profit attributable to the ordinary
equity holders of the parent entity)
and denominator (the weighted
average number of ordinary shares
outstanding during the period).
You will then need to assess the
accounting treatments in the
question, how they have affected the
numerator and/or denominator of
the EPS and what if any correction
is required.
472
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
STEP 3 Now read the scenario. For the advice on calculation of EPS,
keep in mind the IAS 33 Earnings per Share formula and for each of
the three paragraphs in the question, ask yourself which IAS or IFRS
may be relevant (remember you do not need to know the IAS or IFRS
number), whether the accounting treatment complies with that IAS or
IFRS and the impact any correction would have on the numerator and
denominator of EPS.
For the ethical implications, consider the ACCA Code. Identify
any of the fundamental principles that may be relevant (integrity,
objectivity, professional competence and due care, confidentiality,
professional behaviour) and any threats (self-interest, self-review,
advocacy, familiarity, intimidation) to these principles. For more detail
on the approach to ethical requirements, please refer back to Skills
Checkpoint 1.
You need to identify that profit before non-recurring items is an
alternative performance measure (APM). You should consider whether
presenting this additional information would be beneficial to users of
the financial statements and consider the ESMA guidelines if Low
Paints does decide to disclose this additional information.
Denominator of
the ordinary shares of Low Paints and the remainder is owned by
Self-interest threat
EPS (but at start to principles of
of year – watch
employees. As an incentive to the new management, Mr Low agreed to a
integrity,
out for any objectivity and
share issues in
new executive compensation plan which commenced after his retirement.
professional
the year) competence –
The plan provides cash bonuses to the board of directors when the
incentive to
overstate profit to
company's earnings per share exceeds the 'normal' earnings
maximise bonus
(Ethics)
per share which has been agreed at $0.50 per share. The cash
bonuses are calculated as being 20% of the profit generated in excess of
that required to give an earnings per share figure of $0.50.
TT2020
473
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Mr Low is now a
non-executive
Mr Low, who had taken no active part in management decisions, director (and
majority
decided to take advantage of his role as non-executive director and shareholder)
demanded an explanation of how the earnings per share figure of $0.80 Relevant IAS = IAS
20 Accounting for
had been calculated. His investigations revealed the following Government
Grants and
information. Disclosure of
Government
Assistance
(i) On 1 October 20X0, the company received a grant from the
Two possible
First day of
Government of $5 million towards the cost of purchasing a treatments for grants
accounting related to asset under
period
non-current asset of $15 million. The grant had been credited IAS 20:
(1) Record as deferred
to the statement of profit or loss in total and the non-current income and release
Incorrect
to P/L over useful
treatment per asset had been recognised at $15 million in the statement of life of asset
IAS 20 – need
(2) Net off cost of
to correct (will financial position and depreciated at a rate of 10% per asset
decrease
earnings and annum on the straight line basis. The directors believed that neither
EPS).
of the approaches for grants related to assets under IAS 20 Apply to asset
Genuine error
or deliberate to and grant
Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of Government
maximise
bonus? (Ethics)
Assistance were appropriate because deferred income does
not meet the definition of a liability under the IASB's
Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting and
Justifiable
reasons not to netting the grant off the related asset would hide the
apply IAS 20?
(Ethics) asset's true cost.
(ii) Shortly after Mr Low had retired from the company, Low Paints
made an initial public offering of its shares. The sponsor of
Relevant IAS = Incorrect – per
IAS 32 the issue charged a cash fee of $300,000. The directors had IAS 32 should
Financial deduct from
Instruments: charged the cash paid as an expense in the statement of equity. Need to
Presentation reverse from
profit or loss. The public offering was made on 1 January earnings in EPS
calculation.
3 months into 20X1 and involved vesting four million ordinary shares of $1 at a Adjustment will
the year so increase EPS so
only multiply market price of $1.20. Mr Low and other current shareholders does not look
the new shares deliberate –
by 9/12 in decided to sell three million of their shares as part of the offer, genuine error?
EPS calculation (Ethics)
leaving one million new shares to be issued.
Check if included in
denominator in EPS
calculation
(multiplied by 9/12
to give weighted
average)
474
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
(iii) The directors had calculated earnings per share for the year ended
30 September 20X1 as follows:
Adjust for grant and
Recalculate and issue costs
Profit for the year $4.8 million
check if still hits the
$0.50 bonus
Ordinary shares of $1 6,000,000 Number of shares at
threshold
start of year so add in
Earnings per share $0.80 new share issue
Mr Low was concerned over the way that earnings per share had
been calculated by the directors and he also felt that the above
In part (b), will
need to advise accounting practices were at best unethical and at worst
Mr Low on what
to do next fraudulent. He therefore asked your technical and ethical advice on
the practices of the directors. He has also suggested that as profit for
the year includes non-recurring items such as gains and losses on the
disposal of non-current assets, an adjusted 'profit before You should identify this
Alternative EPS as an APM and advise
may be calculated non-recurring items' should be calculated and disclosed as a line accordingly
and disclosed in
the notes, but EPS item in the statement of profit or loss. Mr Low wants to use this
per IAS 33 is still
required. adjusted profit figure to calculate EPS as he believes it will
provide more useful information to the users of the financial
statements.
Required
(a) Advise Mr Low as to whether earnings per share has been
accurately calculated by the directors and show a revised
calculation of earnings per share if necessary. (10 marks)
(b) Discuss whether the directors may have acted unethically in the
way they have calculated earnings per share. (5 marks)
(c) Discuss Mr Low's suggestion that profit before non-recurring items
should be disclosed and used to calculate EPS. (3 marks)
Professional marks will be awarded for clarity and quality of
presentation. (2 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
TT2020
475
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
STEP 4 Prepare an answer plan for each part of the question. For part (a),
identify whether the accounting treatment in the question is correct
per the relevant IAS or IFRS and where it is incorrect, think about
how the adjustment will impact the numerator and/or denominator of
the EPS ratio.
For part (b), be very careful to give a balanced answer. Try and think
of genuine reasons why the directors might have come up with the
accounting treatment in the question but also look out for threats to
the fundamental ethical principles. Consider each of the accounting
treatments mentioned in the question. Make sure you conclude with
advice on what Mr Low should do next.
For part (c), consider whether disclosing profit before non-recurring
items in the statement of profit or loss is permitted by IFRS, whether it
provides information that is useful to users and whether presenting
an alternative EPS calculation is in keeping with IAS 33. You should
refer to the ESMA guidelines when discussing APMs.
EPS =
Issue costs
Government grant Share issue
Likely to be lack of knowledge
Well-intentioned or Very basic error which has
as complex area and directors'
deliberate? Contravenes increased EPS – deliberate?
error has decreased EPS
IAS 20 – breach of
Contravenes IAS 33
professional competence Contravenes IAS 32
476
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
Discuss disclosure of
adjusted profit and
alternative EPS
Profit before
Alternative EPS
non-recurring items
IAS 33 permits additional
Alternative performance
alternative EPS to be
measure as not defined in
disclosed in notes
IFRS, may be useful if fairly
presented. Are items truly
non-recurring?
TT2020
477
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
STEP 5 Write up your answer using separate underlined headings for each
of parts (a), (b) and (c). Then use sub-headings for items (i), (ii) and
(iii) where appropriate. Ensure that you use full sentences and
explain your points clearly.
For part (a), the following approach is recommended:
What is the correct accounting treatment per the IAS or IFRS?
Is the directors' accounting treatment allowed? If not, why not?
What adjustment is required in the revised EPS working?
For part (b):
Examine the motive behind each of the accounting treatments
Identify relevant ethical principles and threats to them
Conclude with advice on what Mr Low should do next
For part (c):
Identify profit before non-recurring items as an APM and
discuss ESMA guidelines
Discuss whether its disclosure provides information that is
useful to users
Discuss whether alternative EPS is permitted and conclude
with advice as to how such information may be disclosed
You do not IAS 33 does not address the issue of manipulation of the
need to know Introductory
the accounting numerator in the calculation, the profit attributable to ordinary paragraph
standard recommended
number, you shareholders. The directors may manipulate it by selecting in discussion
just need to be questions –
able to apply accounting policies designed generally to boost the earnings figure, introduces
the relevant formula for
rules or and hence the earnings per share. EPS ratio
principles of and how it
the IAS or could be
IFRS. The denominator in the calculation is the number of shares by which manipulated
through
the earnings figure is divided. It is defined as the weighted average unethical
behaviour
number of ordinary shares outstanding during the period and is more
difficult to manipulate, although the directors may try, as explained
below.
478
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
Identify the (1) Set up the grant as deferred income and release it
correct
accounting to profit or loss over the useful life of the asset to offset
treatment per
the IAS or the depreciation charge; or
IFRS.
(2) Deduct the grant in arriving at the carrying amount of
the asset and depreciate the net figure.
Identify the The number of new shares issued is 1 million. This What
correct adjustment is
accounting needs to be time apportioned (the shares were in issue required in
treatment per the revised
the IAS or for 10 months) and added to the denominator of the EPS working?
IFRS.
EPS calculation.
TT2020
479
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Is the The treatment of the issue costs is also incorrect.
directors'
accounting IAS 32 states that transaction costs, defined as
treatment
allowed? If incremental external costs directly attributable to an
not, why not?
equity transaction, should be accounted for as a
$'000
9 750,000
1,000,000 ×
12
Revised number of shares 6,750,000
600, 000
Revised EPS = = $0.09
6, 750, 000
Underlined heading
summarising in tactful
professional language
(b) Ethical matters what the answer will cover
480
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
Each of the
accounting treatments
covered separately
because each has its
own distinct ethical
Government grant issues
Share issue
Examines
motive behind The treatment of the issue costs of the shares may simply
directors'
accounting reflect lack of knowledge on the part of directors, rather than
treatment
unethical accounting and the error actually reduces profit and EPS,
suggesting it was not a deliberate action to increase profit to meet
their bonus target. When corrected, the earnings figure is
actually increased.
TT2020
481
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Unless the treatment of the share issue costs is made and the new
Identifies the
shares added to the EPS denominator, IAS 32 and IAS 33 relevant
ethical
principle and
would be contravened and the directors would not be
the threat to
it in this
demonstrating professional competence.
scenario
Conclusion
IFRS do not prohibit the use of APMs, but for such measures to be
useful to users, they should be fairly presented. IAS 1 permits
additional line items to be included in the statement of profit or loss if
such information is relevant to the understanding of entity's financial
performance. If additional line items are included, they should be
comprised of amounts recognised and measured in line with IFRS,
they are clearly labelled and presented, they should not be
presented with more prominence than the totals and sub-totals
required by IAS 1 and they should be presented consistently from
period to period. ESMA guidelines also provide guidance for
presenting APMs. The ESMA guidelines suggest fair presentation can
be achieved by describing the measure appropriately, which
482
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
EPS
TT2020
483
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Exam success skills diagnostic
Every time you complete a question, use the diagnostic below to assess how effectively you
demonstrated the exam success skills in answering the question. The table has been completed
below for the Low Paints activity to give you an idea of how to complete the diagnostic.
Good time Did you spend a third of your time reading and planning?
management Do you spend half of your writing time on part (a), around 8
minutes on part (b) and 5 minutes on part (c)?
Did you spread your time to cover each of the accounting
treatments in the scenario (government grant, issue costs
and share issue)?
Managing information Did you identify the relevant IAS or IFRS for each issue in
the scenario?
Did you highlight or underline useful information and make
notes in the margins where appropriate?
Did you think about the impact of correcting each
accounting treatment on both the numerator and
denominator of EPS?
Did you remember to look out for threats to the ethical
principles?
Did you identify Mr Low's suggestion as an APM?
Answer planning Did your plan cover all parts of the question?
Did you generate enough points to score a pass?
Efficient numerical Did you draw up a proforma for the revised EPS
analysis calculation?
Did you have separate workings for earnings and the
number of shares?
Did you start with the figures per the question then post the
relevant adjustments?
Were all your numbers clearly labelled?
Effective writing and Did you use underlined headings and sub-headings?
presentation Did you write in full sentences and use professional
language?
Did you answer all the requirements?
Did you structure your answer as follows?
For part (a):
What is the correct accounting treatment per the IAS or
IFRS?
484
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 4
Summary
For a question requiring you to explain the impact on a specified ratio, the key to
success is to think of the formula of the ratio. Then you need to think about the double
entry and the impact it has on the numerator and/or denominator and therefore the
overall ratio.
However, this is a very broad syllabus area which could generate many different types
of questions so the approach in this Skills Checkpoint will have to be adapted to suit
the specific requirements and scenario in the exam. The basic five steps for answering
any SBR question will always be a good starting point:
(1) Time (1.95 minutes per mark)
(2) Read and analyse the requirement(s)
(3) Read and analyse the scenario
(4) Prepare an answer plan
(5) Write up your answer
TT2020
485
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
486
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Reporting requirements
of small and
medium-sized entities
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss the key differences in accounting treatment between full IFRS and the IFRS C10(a)
for SMEs.
Discuss and apply the simplifications introduced by the IFRS for SMEs. C10(b)
Exam context
You should be aware that smaller entities have different accounting needs from larger entities and
that the IFRS for Small and Medium-Sized Entities (IFRS for SMEs) helps to meet these needs. It is
important that you understand the key differences between full IFRS and the IFRS for SMEs. This topic
is in syllabus area C and could therefore be examined in either Section A or Section B of the SBR
exam. It is likely to form part of a larger question.
TT2020
487
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
Revenue recognition
Group financial statements
488
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
These characteristics mean there are some issues with trying to apply full IFRS to small and
medium-sized entities such as:
Relevance Some IFRSs are not relevant to small and medium-sized company accounts; for
example, a company with equity that is not quoted on a stock exchange has no
need to comply with IAS 33 Earnings per Share.
Cost to One of the underlying principles of financial reporting is that the cost and effort
prepare required to prepare financial statements should not exceed the benefits to
users. This applies to all reporting entities, not just smaller ones. However, smaller
entities are more likely to make use of this as a reason not to comply with full IFRS.
Materiality IFRSs apply to material items. In the case of smaller entities, the amount that is
material may be very small in monetary terms. However, the effect of not reporting
that item may be material by nature in that it would mislead users of the financial
statements. Consider, for example, IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures. Smaller
entities may well rely on trade with relatives of the directors/shareholders which are
relatively small in value, but essential to the operations of the entity and should
therefore be disclosed.
TT2020
489
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
group and the biggest external stakeholder group is lenders and others who provide credit to the
entity. The IASB states that the IFRS for SMEs is focused on the information needs of lenders and
creditors and any other stakeholders interested in information relating to cash flow, solvency and
liquidity. Having a single standard that applies to small and medium-sized entities helps to promote
transparency and comparability between entities, allowing the providers of finance to make more
informed judgements about the performance and position of the entity.
Essential reading
Chapter 19 section 1 of the Essential Reading provides further information on the background to the
development of the IFRS for SMEs. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the
Workbook.
1.2 Scope
The standard is intended for small and medium-sized entities, defined as those that:
There is no size test, as this would be difficult to apply to companies operating under different legal
frameworks.
• Earnings per Full IFRS requires IAS 33 Earnings per Share to be applied for listed
share (EPS) companies. IAS 33 requires calculation and presentation of EPS and diluted
EPS for all reported periods. The concept of EPS is not relevant to SMEs as they
are not listed.
490
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
• Interim IAS 34 Interim Financial Reporting applies when an entity prepares interim
reporting reports. SMEs are highly unlikely to prepare such reports. Interim reporting is
omitted from the IFRS for SMEs.
• Segmental IFRS 8 Operating Segments requires listed entities to report information on the
reporting different types of operations they are involved in, different geographical areas
etc. SMEs are not listed and therefore IFRS 8 does not apply. The IFRS for
SMEs does not require any other segmental reporting as SMEs are unlikely to
have such diverse operations and the cost of reporting such information would
be prohibitive for such entities.
• Assets held for IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations contains
sale specific accounting requirements for assets classified as held for sale. The cost
of reporting in this way is expected to exceed the benefits for SMEs and it is
therefore omitted from the IFRS for SMEs (instead, holding assets for sale is an
impairment indicator).
Investment Fair value through profit or loss Permitted to make a choice between
property must be used (if fair value can be fair value model, or cost model
measured without undue cost or (accounting policy choice)
effort); otherwise the cost model is
applied (para. 16.7)
Intangible assets The revaluation model is not Revaluations permitted where active
permitted. Intangible assets must be market
held at cost less accumulated
amortisation (para. 18.18)
TT2020
491
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Area IFRS for SMEs Full IFRSs
Pension actuarial Actuarial gains and losses can be Remeasurements in OCI only
gains and losses recognised immediately in profit or
loss or other comprehensive
income (OCI) (para. 28.24)
Simplified calculation of defined Projected unit credit method must be
benefit obligations (ignoring future used
service/salary rises) permitted if not
able to use projected unit credit
method without undue cost/effort
(para. 28.18)
492
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
Illustration 1
Borrowing costs – full IFRS v IFRS for SMEs
Harold Co completed the construction of a new warehouse facility during the year ended
31 December 20X6. Harold incurred borrowing costs totalling $1,680,000 in the year. Of this,
$980,000 was incurred before the warehouse was complete on 1 August 20X6 and $700,000 was
incurred between completion and the year end date. The warehouse facility was available for use
and brought into use on 1 October 20X6 and has an estimated useful life of 20 years.
Required
Briefly discuss the difference in accounting treatment in respect of the borrowing costs incurred under
full IFRS and the IFRS for SMEs and consider the impact on the reported profit of Harold Co for the
year ended 31 December 20X6.
Solution
Under full IFRS
Borrowing costs incurred up to 1 August 20X6 should be capitalised as part of the cost of the asset.
Those incurred after the asset is completed should be expensed to profit or loss. The asset should be
depreciated from the date it is first brought into use. The amount charged to profit or loss in respect
of the borrowing costs would be:
$
Expensed borrowing costs 700,000 Remember
Depreciation on capitalised costs depreciation starts
when asset is
(980,000/20 yrs 3/12) 12,250 available for use
Total expense 712,250
TT2020
493
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
494
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
Intangible assets All intangibles (including goodwill) Only amortised if finite useful life
are amortised
Useful life cannot exceed ten No specific limit on useful lives
years if cannot be established
reliably
(paras. 18.19, 18.20)
An impairment test is required An annual impairment test is
only if there is an indication of required for goodwill, for intangible
impairment assets with an indefinite useful life, and
for an intangible asset not yet available
for use
Illustration 2
Goodwill – full IFRS v IFRS for SMEs
Poppy Co acquired 70% of the ordinary shares of Branch Co on 1 August 20X3. Poppy Co paid
$3.45 million to acquire the investment in Branch Co. The fair value of Branch Co’s identifiable net
assets was assessed as $4.5 million at the date of acquisition. The fair value of the non-controlling
interest (NCI) in Branch Co was assessed to be $1.7 million.
Required
(a) Calculate the amount that would be recognised as goodwill using
(i) Full IFRS, assuming NCI is valued at fair value
(ii) The IFRS for SMEs
(b) Briefly discuss the reason for the difference between the two methods.
TT2020
495
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Solution
(b) Under full IFRS, the non-controlling interest can be valued either at its share of net assets or its
fair value whereas the IFRS for SMEs does not permit fair value to be used. In the given
example the fair value of the NCI is higher than its share of net assets, which gives rise to a
higher amount of goodwill being recognised.
496
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
Essential reading
Chapter 19 section 2 of the Essential Reading includes discussion on the likely consequences of
adopting the IFRS for SMEs. This is available in Appendix 2 of the digital edition of the Workbook.
TT2020
497
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
Revenue recognition
• Goods: when risks and rewards Group financial statements
transferred • Investment in associate or joint
• Services: stage of completion basis venture at cost or FVTP/L or equity
• Intangibles and goodwill always method
amortised (useful life cannot exceed • NCI in goodwill at % net assets not FV
10 years if cannot be established
reliably)
498
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
Knowledge diagnostic
TT2020
499
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Question practice
Now try the following question from the Further question practice bank:
Q31 Small and medium-sized entities
Further reading
There are articles on the ACCA website, written by the SBR examining team, which are relevant to the
topics studied in this Chapter and which you should read:
Study support resources section of the ACCA website
IFRS for SMEs
CPD section of the ACCA website
500
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The impact of changes
and potential changes
in accounting
regulation
Learning objectives
On completion of this chapter, you should be able to:
Syllabus
reference no.
Discuss and apply the accounting implications of the first-time adoption of new F1(a)
accounting standards.
Identify issues and deficiencies which have led to proposed changes to an F1(b)
accounting standard.
Discuss the impact of current issues in corporate reporting. This learning outcome F1(c)
may be tested by requiring the application of one or several existing standards to
an accounting issue. It is also likely to require an explanation of the resulting
accounting implications (for example, accounting for cryptocurrency in the Digital
Age or accounting for the effects of a natural disaster and the resulting
environmental liabilities). The following examples are relevant to the current
syllabus.
(1) Accounting policy changes
(2) Materiality in the context of financial reporting
(3) Defined benefit plan amendments, curtailment or settlement
(4) Management commentary
(5) Sustainability reporting
Exam context
The Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam doesn't just test financial reporting standards as they
are, but how and why they are changing.
The current issues element of the syllabus (syllabus area F) may be examined in Section A or B but
will not be a full question; it is more likely to form part of another question.
TT2020
501
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter overview
502
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
1 Current issues
The following current issues are specifically mentioned in the SBR syllabus and study guide.
(a) Accounting policy changes (ED 2018/1)
See Chapter 2.
(b) Materiality in the context of financial reporting
See section 2 below.
(c) Defined benefit plan amendments, curtailment or settlement
Narrow scope amendments to IAS 19 were issued in 2018. See Chapter 5.
(d) Management commentary
See Chapter 18.
(e) Sustainability reporting
See Chapter 18.
The following exposure drafts and discussion paper are also examinable:
(a) Exposure draft: ED 2019/6 Disclosure of Accounting Policies (Proposed
amendments to IAS 1 and IFRS Practice Statement 2)
See section 2 below.
(b) Exposure draft: ED 2019/5 Deferred Tax related to Assets and Liabilities
arising from a single transaction (Proposed amendments to IAS 12)
See Chapter 7.
(c) Discussion paper: DP 2018/1 Financial Instruments with Characteristics of
Equity
See Chapter 8.
1.1.1 Cryptocurrency
Background
Cryptocurrency is a form of intangible digital currency which does not exist in physical
form, Bitcoin and Ethereum are two of the best-known cryptocurrencies.
Cryptocurrencies have had a disruptive effect on traditional banking systems as they are not
controlled by a central bank in the same way as conventional currencies. This lack of control has led
to dramatic fluctuations in the value of cryptocurrencies as they are traded and exchanged
around the world.
TT2020
503
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Cryptocurrencies work in a similar way to conventional currencies in as much that they can be used
to pay for (and to receive payments for) goods and services purchased online, with a growing
number of vendors accepting this form of payment. Transactions made using cryptocurrencies make
use of blockchain technology, which helps to ensure that all transactions made between
participants are verified and recorded.
Accounting for cryptocurrencies
There are no accounting standards that specifically deal with cryptocurrencies. When there are no
accounting standards dealing with an issue, accountants should develop an accounting policy
relating to the matter that can be applied and disclosed.
In developing the policy, IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Accounting Estimates and Errors requires that the
directors consider the following hierarchy:
(a) IFRSs dealing with similar issues
(b) The Conceptual Framework
(c) The most recent pronouncements of other national GAAPs based on a similar conceptual
framework and accepted industry practice
Current practice
The current discussion on cryptocurrencies from professional bodies and accountancy firms focuses
on which IFRS can be applied to this area. They generally agree that cryptocurrencies:
Do not meet the definition of cash (per IAS 32 Financial Instruments: Presentation, they are not
a widely accepted 'medium of exchange' as they are not legal tender, although an increasing
number of companies do choose to accept them as tender), nor the definition of a cash
equivalent under IAS 7 Statement of Cash Flows as they are not subject to 'an insignificant
risk of changes in value' due to the significant price volatility they are subject to.
Do not meet the definition of financial assets as they are not cash (as above), do not result in
an equity interest in an entity and do not give a contractual right to receive cash or other
financial instruments.
Do not have any physical substance and therefore cannot be any form of tangible assets
(although for commodity broker-traders they may meet the definition of inventories but this is
beyond the scope of SBR)
Most closely meet the criteria in IAS 38 Intangible Assets in that they are identifiable (as they
are capable of being separated from the holder and transferred individually), they are non-
monetary (as they do not result in fixed or determinable units of currency) and do not have
physical substance. They should therefore be:
(a) Initially measured – at cost
(b) Subsequently measured – either
at cost less accumulated amortisation (although they are likely to have an
indefinite useful life and will not be amortised) and impairment losses; or
at revalued amount (provided an active market exists, which is likely to be the
case for the most common cryptocurrencies which are traded, but may not be the
case for all cryptocurrency).
Given the extent of judgement and estimates involved in accounting for cryptocurrency, extensive
disclosures are likely to be required.
504
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
Go online and take a look at the responses of professional bodies (eg the Australian accounting
standards setter: CPA Australia) and big accountancy firms (such as EY) for their take on accounting
for the issues which arise after a natural disaster.
EY has published a document called 'Accounting for the financial impact of natural disasters' which
is a good place to start. It is available online from the publications section of the EY website:
www.ey.com
506
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
The
disclosure
problem
The Disclosure Initiative began in 2013 and has resulted in a number of completed and ongoing
projects.
Disclosure Initiative
IFRS Practice
Statement 2:
Amendments Amendments Definition Principles of disclosure
Making
to IAS 1 to IAS 7 of material
Materiality
Judgements
ED 2019/6 Other
Disclosure of projects
Accounting (not on SBR
Policies syllabus)
The Disclosure Initiative projects that are relevant to the SBR syllabus are covered in this section.
TT2020
507
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2.1.1 Definition of material
The IASB has amended the definition of 'material' to make it clear that obscuring information has
the same effect as omitting or misstating it. Obscuring information means making the information so
difficult to find or so difficult to understand, that it may as well have been omitted.
This addresses the issue that too much information can be just as problematic as the omission or
misstatement of information.
508
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
(b) Financial statements provide financial information to primary users that is useful to them
when making decisions about providing resources to the entity.
Primary users are investors, lenders and other creditors, both existing and potential.
General purpose financial statements cannot meet all of the information needs of
primary users. Instead the entity should aim to meet the information needs common to all
investors, all lenders and all other creditors.
The entity is not required to meet the information needs of other stakeholders, or the
individual requirements of particular primary users.
Four-step process to making materiality judgements (paras. 29–65)
One way of making materiality judgements when preparing the financial statements is to apply the
following four-step process:
Apply judgment to determine best way to Eg: emphasise material matters, explain
communicate clearly and concisely simply, minimise duplication
On the basis of complete set of financial On the basis of complete set of financial
statements: has all material information statements: has materiality been
been identified? considered from a wide perspective and
in aggregate?
Illustration 1
Information about a related party transaction assessed as material
(Based on Practice Statement 2 Example I)
Red has identified measures of profitability as of great interest to the primary users of its financial
statements. During the year, Red agreed a five year contract in which Green (a related party), will
perform maintenance services for Red for an annual fee of $1.5 million.
Red first assessed whether the information about the transaction was material from a quantitative
perspective. A threshold of $2.5 million (3% of net profit) was used. From a purely quantitative
perspective, Red assessed that the effect of the contract was not material.
Red then considered the transaction from a qualitative perspective. Having considered that the
transaction was with a related party, Red concluded that the impact of the transaction was large
enough to reasonably be expected to influence primary users' decisions (eg the presence of a
qualitative factor lowered the quantitative threshold).
Red assessed information about the transaction with Green as material and disclosed that
information in its financial statements.
The presence of qualitative factors does not mean that information is always material. An entity may
decide that, despite the presence of qualitative factors, information is not material because its effect
on the financial statements is so small that it could not reasonably be expected to
influence primary users' decisions (para. 54).
Illustration 2
Information about a related party transaction assessed as immaterial
(Based on Practice Statement 2 Example J)
During the year Red sold an almost fully depreciated machine to Blue (a related party) at an amount
consistent with the machine's market value.
Red assessed whether the information about the transaction was material. From a purely quantitative
perspective, Red initially concluded that the impact of the related party transaction was not material.
510
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
However, a qualitative factor exists: the fact that the machine was sold to a related party makes the
information more likely to influence the decisions of primary users. Therefore Red further assessed the
transaction from a quantitative perspective, but concluded that its impact was too small to reasonably
be expected to influence primary users' decisions, even though the transaction was with a related
party.
Red assessed information about the transaction with Blue to be immaterial and did not disclose it in
its financial statements.
Stakeholder perspective
The IASB hopes that Practice Statement 2 will change the behaviour of preparers and auditors of
Stakeholder
perspective financial statements. Preparers should put the information needs of the primary users of their financial
statements at the centre of their financial statement preparation process. Primary users need
information that is relevant to their decision-making and is not obscured by information that cannot
reasonably be expected to influence their decisions. The article 'Bin the Clutter' available in the
student resources section of the ACCA website provides further discussion on the issue of clarity in
financial reporting.
IFRS 1 First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards was issued to ensure that an
entity's first IFRS financial statements contain high quality information that:
(a) Is transparent for users and comparable over all periods presented;
(b) Provides a suitable starting point for accounting under IFRSs; and
(c) Can be generated at a cost that does not exceed the benefits to users.
Illustration 1
Comparative year First year of adoption
Transition
date
Preparation of an opening IFRS statement of financial position typically involves adjusting the
amounts reported at the same date under previous GAAP.
All adjustments are recognised directly in retained earnings (or, if appropriate, another
category of equity) not in profit or loss.
3.1.3 Estimates
Estimates in the opening IFRS statement of financial position must be consistent with estimates made
at the same date under previous GAAP even if further information is now available (in order
to comply with IAS 10) (IFRS 1: para. IG 3).
512
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
3.1.5 Main exemptions from applying IFRSs in the opening IFRS statement of
financial position
(a) Deemed cost
Fair value may be used as deemed cost at date of transition to IFRSs for:
(i) Property, plant and equipment
(ii) Investment properties (where using the cost model)
(iii) Intangible assets (which meet the IAS 38 recognition and revaluation criteria)
A previous GAAP revaluation (at or before the date of transition to IFRS) may also be used as
deemed cost at the date of the revaluation.
Further, an entity may use an 'event-driven' valuation (eg a valuation for an initial public offering)
before or after the date of transition to IFRS (providing it is before the first IFRS year end) as
deemed cost at the date of measurement (with a corresponding adjustment to equity).
(b) Business combinations
For business combinations prior to the date of transition to IFRS:
(i) The same classification (acquisition or uniting of interests) is retained as under previous GAAP.
(ii) For items requiring a cost measure for IFRS, the carrying amount at the date of the
business combination is treated as deemed cost and IFRS rules are applied from
thereon.
TT2020
513
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(iii) Items requiring a fair value measure for IFRS are revalued at the date of transition to IFRS.
(iv) The carrying amount of goodwill at the date of transition to IFRS is the amount as reported
under previous GAAP.
However, if any business combination prior to the date of transition to IFRS is restated to comply
with IFRS 3, all later acquisitions must be restated as well.
(c) Borrowing costs
(i) Borrowing costs need only be capitalised for assets where the commencement date for
capitalisation is on or after the date of transition to IFRS.
(d) Cumulative translation differences on foreign operations
(i) Translation differences (which must be included in a separate translation reserve under IFRS)
may be deemed zero at the date of transition to IFRS. IAS 21 is applied from then on.
(e) Adoption of IFRS by subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures
If a subsidiary, associate or joint venture adopts IFRS later than its parent, it measures its assets and
liabilities:
(i) Either: At the amount that would be included in the parent's financial statements, based on
the parent's date of transition;
(ii) Or: At the amount based on the subsidiary (associate or joint venture's) date of transition.
(IFRS 1: Appendix B)
3.1.6 Disclosure
(a) A reconciliation of previous GAAP equity to IFRS equity is required at the date of
transition to IFRSs and for the most recent financial statements presented under previous GAAP.
(b) A reconciliation of total comprehensive income under previous GAAP to total
comprehensive income using IFRS is required for the most recent financial statements presented
under previous GAAP.
(IFRS 1: para. 24)
Tutorial note
Skills Checkpoint 5 looks at the skill of creating effective discussion, which is particularly relevant to
the topics covered in this chapter.
514
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
Ethics note
Current issues are a key part of the SBR exam and will be tested at every sitting. The ethical dilemma
tested will clearly depend on the current issue itself. However, it can safely be assumed that it will
frequently concern someone in authority, such as a managing director wishing to present the
financial statements in a more favourable light.
The IASB often makes changes to IFRS Standards precisely to avoid the ethical dilemmas that result
from manipulation of ambiguities. The predecessor of IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with
Customers was less precise and so the key figure of revenue was subject to manipulation.
TT2020
515
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter summary
• Accounting policy changes (ED • The Disclosure Initiative – series of projects which seek to resolve the
2018/1) – see Chapter 2 disclosure problem
• Materiality in the context of • Revised definition of materiality: 'Information is material if omitting,
financial reporting – see below misstating or obscuring it could reasonably be expected to influence
• Defined benefit plan decisions that the primary users of general purpose financial reports
amendments, curtailments or make on the basis of those reports, which provide financial information
settlement – see Chapter 5 about a specific reporting entity’ (IAS 1: para. 7)
• Management commentary – • IFRS Practice Statement 2 Making Materiality Judgements
see Chapter 18 – Non-mandatory guidance
• Sustainability reporting – – Aims to encourage to greater application of judgement by preparers
see Chapter 18 of financial statements
• ED 2019/6 Disclosure of – Will help to tackle the problem of excessive disclosure which was
Accounting Policies (Proposed obscuring material information
amendments to IAS 1 and IFRS Key points:
Practice Statement 2) – – Recognition and measurement criteria only need to be applied if
see below resulting information is material
• ED 2019/5 Deferred Tax related – Disclosure need not be made if the information provided by the
to Assets and Liabilities arising disclosure is not material
from a single transaction – 4-step process to making materiality judgements: identify, assess,
(Proposed amendments to organise, review
IAS 12) – see Chapter 7 – Materiality factors include quantitative and qualitative (internal and
• DP 2018/1 Financial external) factors
Instruments with – The presence of a qualitative factor (eg related party) lowers the
Characteristics of Equity - quantitative threshold
see Chapter 8 • ED 2019/6 Disclosure of Accounting Policies (Proposed amendments to
• Specific issues (eg, IAS 1 and IFRS Practice Statement 2)
cryptocurrency and natural – Proposal to amend IAS 1 to require disclosure of material accounting
disasters) - apply existing policies (amended from ‘significant accounting policies’)
IFRS Standards to determine – Proposed amendments include guidance and examples to help
accounting required entities determine which accounting policies are material
516
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20: The impact of changes and potential changes in accounting regulation
Knowledge diagnostic
1. Current issues
The IASB has a number of projects underway. These could form the basis of a discussion
question or part of a question in the exam.
2. The Disclosure Initiative
Materiality is a factor in the disclosure problem. Definition of materiality amended to make it
clear that obscuring information has the same effect on the users of financial statements as
omitting or misstating it. Practice Statement 2 issued to encourage greater application
of judgement in the preparation of financial statements, to avoid excessive disclosure and
avoid using IFRS Standards as a disclosure checklist.
ED 2019/6 proposes amendments to IAS 1 so that material (rather than significant)
accounting policies should be disclosed, and provides guidance to help determine which
policies are material.
3. First-time adoption of a body of new accounting standards
IFRS 1 gives guidance to entities applying IFRS for the first time. The change to IFRS must
be carefully managed.
TT2020
517
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further study guidance
Further reading
The ACCA website contains the following articles related to the topics in this chapter which you should
read:
518
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
SKILLS CHECKPOINT 5
Creating effective discussion
aging information
Man
An
sw
er
pl
t
en
Manag ime
an
em
T
nin
Approaching Resolving financial Exam Success Skills
Good
r p re t ati o n
Creating effective Specific SBR Skills
e nts
discussion Applying good
req f rrprneteation
consolidation
re m
Creating effective techniques
i ts
discussion
m eun
of t inotect i
uireeq
Eff d p
an
c re
Performing
e c re
r re o r
e C
ti v
financial analysis
se w ri
nt tin
ati g
Co
on
Efficient numerical
analysis
Introduction
More marks in your Strategic Business Reporting (SBR) exam will relate to written answers than
numerical answers. It is very tempting to only practise numerical questions as they are easy to
mark because the answer is right or wrong whereas written questions are more subjective and
a range of different answers will be given credit. Even when attempting written questions, it is
tempting to write a brief answer plan and then look at the answer rather than writing a full
answer to plan. Unless you practise written questions in full to time, you will never
acquire the necessary skills to tackle discussion questions.
You will not pass the SBR exam on calculations alone. Therefore, it is essential to be
armed with the skills required to answer written requirements. This is what Skills Checkpoint 5
will focus on, with a particular emphasis on Section B of the exam which could feature an
essay-based question from any aspect of the syllabus.
TT2020
519
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5: Creating effective discussion
STEP 1:
Work out the time per requirement (1.95 minutes a mark).
STEP 2:
Read and analyse the requirement(s).
STEP 3:
Read and analyse the scenario.
STEP 4:
Prepare an answer plan.
STEP 5:
Write up your answer.
520
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
TT2020
521
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skill Activity
STEP 1 Look at the mark allocation of the following question and work out
how many minutes you have to answer the question. It is a 20 mark
question, so at 1.95 minutes a mark, it should take 39 minutes.
Approximately a third of your time should be spent reading
(requirement then scenario) and planning (13 minutes) and two-thirds
of your time writing up the answer (26 minutes). Then the planning
and writing time should be split in proportion to the mark allocation of
the two parts of the question (65% on part (a) and 35% on part (b)).
Required
(a) Discuss how the changes in accounting practices on transition to IFRSs and
choice in the application of individual IFRSs could lead to inconsistency between
the financial statements of companies. (13 marks)
(b) Discuss how management's judgement and the financial reporting infrastructure
of a country can have a significant impact on financial statements prepared
under IFRS. (7 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
STEP 2 Read the requirement for the following question and analyse it.
Highlight or number up each sub-requirement, identify the verb(s) and
ask yourself what each sub-requirement means.
Verb – refer
to ACCA Sub-requirement 1
definition
Required
(a) Discuss how the changes in accounting practices on transition to IFRSs and
choice in the application of individual IFRSs could lead to inconsistency between
the financial statements of companies. (13 marks)
(b) Discuss how management's judgement and the financial reporting infrastructure
of a country can have a significant impact on financial statements prepared
under IFRS. (7 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
Verb – refer
to ACCA
definition
522
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
Your verb is 'discuss'. This is defined by the ACCA as 'Consider and debate/argue
about the pros and cons of an issue. Examine in detail by using arguments in favour or
against'.
Here is a table to help you understand each sub-requirement:
(a) (1) Discuss how This is a very practical requirement. You need to
changes in view this requirement from the point of view of a
accounting company adopting IFRS for the first time and
practices on come up with the challenges it would face – but
transition to IFRSs be careful not to just list generic problems of first
could lead to time adoption as your points must be specifically
inconsistency tailored to issues causing inconsistency between
between financial financial statements of different companies.
statements of Remember that IFRS 1 First-time Adoption of
companies. International Financial Reporting Standards
provides guidance to companies adopting IFRS
for the first time.
(2) Discuss how The key here is to mentally run through the SBR
choice in the syllabus trying to identify IASs or IFRSs with
application of choices in accounting treatments. You do not
individual IFRSs need to know the IAS or IFRS number, just the
could lead to accounting treatment within them. No specific
inconsistency marks will be available for the IAS or IFRS
between financial number in the ACCA marking guide; however, if
statements of you happen to remember it, add it into your
companies. answer for increased credibility.
Including examples of areas of choice from
examinable IFRSs is key to passing this sub-
requirement but make sure you explain why
choice leads to inconsistency.
(b) (1) Discuss how The approach here is similar to areas of choice in
management's sub-requirement 2 of part (a). You should
judgement can consider the examinable documents for SBR to
have a significant identify subjective areas of an IAS or IFRS that
impact on financial require management judgement. Including these
statements prepared examples will help you generate enough points
under IFRS. to pass. You should also assess the level of
impact these areas have on financial statements
prepared under IFRS. As well as specific
examples of IAS or IFRS, you should address
the general characteristics of IFRS leading to the
need for judgement.
TT2020
523
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(2) Discuss how the Think about how an infrastructure could vary from
financial reporting country to country. Consider the regulatory
infrastructure of a framework, the staff involved in preparing
company can have a financial statements, the existence of an active
significant impact on market and standards of corporate governance
financial statements and audit.
prepared under IFRS.
Now read the scenario. You will notice that the scenario for an
STEP 3 essay-style question is typically shorter than it is for a case-study style
question. However, read it carefully, as it is likely to provide some
inspiration for you to generate points in your answer.
Challenge of
adopting more
Question – Implementing IFRS (20 marks) complex
accounting
The transition to International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) standards than
local GAAP
involves major change for companies as IFRSs introduce significant (a) Sub-
requirement (1)
changes in accounting practices that were often not required
by national generally accepted accounting practice. It is
important that the interpretation and application of IFRSs is consistent
from country to country. IFRSs are partly based on rules, and partly on
principles and management's judgement. Judgement is more likely
Ability of to be better used when it is based on experience of IFRSs
preparers of
accounts within within a sound financial reporting infrastructure. It is hoped that national
financial reporting
infrastructure will differences in accounting will be eliminated and financial statements will
have significant
impact be consistent and comparable worldwide.
(b) Sub-
requirement (2)
Required
(a) Discuss how the changes in accounting practices on transition to
IFRSs and choice in the application of individual IFRSs could lead
to inconsistency between the financial statements of companies. (13 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
524
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
STEP 4 Prepare an answer plan using key words from the requirements as
headings. Try and come up with separate points for each sub-
requirement. You will be awarded 1 mark per point so in order to
achieve a comfortable pass, you should aim to generate at least
10 points for part (a) (spread across the two sub-requirements) and
at least 5 points for part (b) (again spread across the two sub-
requirements).
TT2020
525
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Plan for part (b)
How management judgement and financial reporting infrastructure can
have significant impact on financial statements prepared under IFRS
526
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
STEP 5 Write up your answer using key words from the requirements as
headings and sub-requirements as sub-headings. Create a separate
sub-heading for each key paragraph in the scenario.
In a discussion style question, the structure should be as follows:
(a) A brief introduction
(b) The main body of your answer – this should be balanced,
bringing out both positive and negative aspects, with all points
fully explained, using examples to illustrate your points
(c) A conclusion with your opinion that is supported by the
arguments in the main body of your answer
The approach for part (a) sub-requirement 1 should be:
Identify a problem
Explain the problem in the context of consistency between
financial statements
Illustrate your point with an example
The approach for part (a) sub-requirement 2 should be:
Give examples of areas of choice within IFRSs
You do not need to name the IAS or IFRS but you do need to
explain the choice in accounting treatment
Cover general characteristics of IFRS (as well as specific
examples above)
The approach for part (b) sub-requirement 1 should be:
Give examples of areas of judgement within IFRSs
You do not need to name the IAS or IFRS but you do need to
explain the area of judgement
Cover general characteristics of IFRS (as well as specific
examples above)
Finally, for part (b) sub-requirement 2:
Think about the financial reporting infrastructure of your
country to generate ideas
Your points should be practical
TT2020
527
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Use of key words
in requirement as
Suggested solution heading
The challenge
Presentation
528
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
IFRSs have provision for early adoption, and this can affect
Identify problem
comparability, although impact of a new standard must be
disclosed under IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting
Estimates and Errors. Further, IFRS 1 First-time Adoption of
International Financial Reporting Standards permits a number of
Explain
exemptions during the periods of transition to IFRS. This gives problem in
context of
scope for manipulation if exemptions are 'cherry-picked' to consistency of
financial
produce a favourable picture. statements
TT2020
529
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment gives a choice of
either the cost model or the revaluation model for a class of
property, plant or equipment as well as a choice of
depreciation method (for example, straight-line, diminishing
balance or units of production method).
530
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
TT2020
531
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers involves
You do not need
to know the IAS or
judgement in identifying the separate performance
IFRS number but
just the rules or
obligations in a contract, allocating the transaction price to
principles within
the accounting
those performance obligations and determining when the
standards. Note
that even though
performance obligations have been satisfied.
bullet-points have
been used, the
answer is still in IAS 16 and IAS 38 both require judgement in determining
full sentences
the useful life of non-current assets.
532
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
statements prepared under IFRS than under local GAAP. The main
reasons for this are as follows:
(b) Many issues are perhaps addressed for the first time,
for example share-based payment.
TT2020
533
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(d) High standards of corporate governance and
audit. This is all the more important in the transition period,
especially where there is resistance to change.
534
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Skills Checkpoint 5
Every time you complete a question, use the diagnostic below to assess how effectively you
demonstrated the exam success skills in answering the question. The table has been
completed below for the Implementing IFRS activity to give you an idea of how to complete
the diagnostic.
Good time Did you spend approximately a third of your time reading
management and planning?
Did you spend approximately 65% of your time on part (a)
and 35% on part (b), per the split of marks in the question?
Did you answer both parts of the question and all four
sub-requirements?
Answer planning Did you draw up a separate answer plan rather than just
annotating the question paper?
Did your answer plan address all sub-requirements?
Did you generate enough points to pass based on 1 mark
per point (you needed 50% × 20 marks = 10 points to pass
but should have aimed for at least 13 points [a 65%
answer] to allow a margin of safety)?
Correct interpretation Did you understand what was meant by the verb 'discuss'?
of requirements Did you spot all four sub-requirements?
Did you understand what each sub-requirement was asking
for?
Effective writing and Was your answer in discussion format (an introduction, the
presentation main body of answer with a balanced approach covering
positive and negative aspects, a conclusion with your
opinion)?
Did you use the requirements and sub-requirements as
headings and sub-headings?
Did you add your own examples to illustrate your points?
Did your answer contain enough points to pass (based on
one point per mark)?
TT2020
535
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Summary
In the SBR exam, discussion will feature across the paper with the majority of the
marks being available for written rather than numerical analysis. This Skills Checkpoint
should help with your approach to all narrative requirements, and in particular, an
essay-style question, should it feature in Section B. Make sure you practice discussion
questions in full, to time. The most important aspects to take away are:
Spend a third of your time planning and generate an answer plan containing
sufficient points for a strong point (on the basis of one mark per point).
Structure your answer with an introduction, the main body of your answer with a
balanced argument, finishing with a conclusion with your opinion supported by
the arguments in the main body of your answer.
Use examples to illustrate your points.
Do not overlook the scenario in the question – it is likely to provide you with some
ideas for your answer.
536
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
TT2020
537
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
However, it appears as though the CEO is more concerned with self-interest and maximising
the gains on his share options by manipulating the share price.
This pressure from the CEO is a threat to the integrity and objectivity of the Finance Director.
The Finance Director is in a difficult position ethically as he reports directly to the CEO and the
CEO has direct influence over his job security and remuneration.
The Finance Director could speak directly to the CEO and seek clarification of the intent of his
comments, explaining that he is unable to change Kelshall's accounting policies just to
maximise Kelshall's share price in the short term and that he is bound by the ACCA Code of
Ethics and Conduct to act with professional competence. However, if he felt under too much
pressure from the CEO to speak to him directly, he could raise his concerns with the non-
executive directors and/or the audit committee.
The problem here is that the threats to both the CEO's and the Finance Director's objectivity
and integrity are similar so there is a danger that the Finance Director reacts to the CEO's
comments by changing accounting policies to maximise profits and share price rather than
acting in the company's and stakeholders' best long-term interests. This would definitely
constitute unethical behaviour.
538
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Merchant banks tend to regard companies which would qualify for associate status as trade
investments since the relationship is designed to provide finance.
IAS 28 presumes that a party owning or able to exercise control over 20% of
voting rights is a related party. So an investor with a 25% holding and a director on
the board would be expected to have significant influence over operating and financial
policies in such a way as to inhibit the pursuit of separate interests. If it can be shown that this
is not the case, there is no related party relationship.
If it is decided that there is a related party situation then all material transactions should
be disclosed including management fees, interest, dividends and the terms of the
loan.
(b) IAS 24 does not require intragroup transactions and balances eliminated on
consolidation to be disclosed. IAS 24 does not deal with the situation where an
undertaking becomes, or ceases to be, a subsidiary during the year.
Best practice indicates that related party transactions should be disclosed for the period when
X was not part of the group. Transactions between RP and X should be disclosed between
1 July 20X9 and 31 October 20X9 but transactions prior to 1 July will have been eliminated
on consolidation.
There is no related party relationship between RP and Z since it is a normal business
transaction unless either party's interests have been influenced or controlled in some way by
the other party.
(c) Post-employment benefit schemes of the reporting entity are included in the IAS 24
definition of related parties.
The contributions paid, the non-current asset transfer ($10m) and the charge of administrative
costs ($3m) must be disclosed.
The pension investment manager would not normally be considered a related
party. However, the manager is key management personnel by virtue of his
non-executive directorship. Therefore, the manager is considered to be related party
of RP.
The manager receives a $25,000 fee. Although this amount is not likely to be material from a
quantitative perspective, it is likely to be material from a qualitative perspective as the
remuneration of key management personnel is likely to influence primary users’ decisions.
Therefore, the transaction should be disclosed under IAS 24.
Chapter 3 Revenue
TT2020
539
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Munro's ability and intention to pay is in doubt:
(i) Munro's liability under the loan is limited because the loan is non-recourse. If
Munro defaults, Jute is not entitled to full compensation for the amount owed, but only
has the right to repossess the building.
(ii) Munro intends to repay the loan (which has a significant balance outstanding) primarily
from income derived from its fitness centre. This is a business facing significant
risks because of high competition in the industry and because of Munro's limited
experience.
(iii) Munro appears to have no other income or assets that could be used to repay the
loan. Munro's health food business is in decline and its assets are already pledged as
collateral for other financing arrangements, so it is unlikely they could be sold to
generate income to repay the loan from Jute.
It is therefore not probable that Jute will collect the consideration to which it is
entitled in exchange for the transfer of the building. The contract does not meet the criteria
within IFRS 15 and the revenue recognition model cannot be applied.
In situations where the revenue recognition model cannot be applied, IFRS 15 permits amounts
received from customers to be recognised as revenue when:
(a) Substantially all of the consideration has been received and is not refundable; or
(b) The seller has terminated the contract
Neither of these are applicable to Jute, therefore, Jute cannot recognise revenue for
any of the consideration received.
Jute must account for the non-refundable $150,000 deposit as a liability at 1 June 20X3.
Tutorial note
IFRS 15 para. 14 requires the entity to continue to assess whether the criteria for applying the
revenue recognition model (para. 9) are met. Until the criteria are met, or until the criteria in
para. 15 are met (substantially all of the consideration has been received and is not
refundable or the seller has terminated the contract), para. 16 requires the entity to continue to
account for the initial deposit, as well as any future payments of principal and interest, as a
liability.
When Bodiam recognises revenue from the sale of goods, the transaction price should be
reduced by 10% ($3 million/$30 million) of the invoice price.
540
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Tutorial note
Assume that Bodiam transferred goods with an invoice price of $4 million to the customer
during December 20X7, Bodiam should recognise $3.6 million of revenue being the $4
million invoiced less 10% ($0.4 million). The accounting entry would be as follows:
DEBIT Trade receivable $4m
CREDIT Revenue $3.6m
CREDIT Contract asset $0.4m
TT2020
541
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
On 31 December 20X7, an asset should be recorded for the right to recover the product and
the item should be removed from inventory at the amount of $8,000 (the cost of the inventory):
DEBIT Asset for right to recover product to be returned $8,000
CREDIT Inventory $8,000
A receivable and revenue of $10,000 will be recognised when the right of return lapses
on 31 March 20X8 provided the product is not returned. The 'asset for right to recover
product to be returned' will also be transferred to cost of sales:
DEBIT Receivable $10,000
CREDIT Revenue $10,000
DEBIT Cost of sales $8,000
CREDIT Asset for right to recover product to be returned $8,000
The contract also includes a significant financing component since there is a difference
between the amount of the promised consideration of $12,100 and the cash selling price of
$10,000 at the date the goods are transferred to the customer.
During the three-month right of return period (1 January 20X8 – 31 March 20X8) no interest
is recognised because no contract asset or liability is recognised.
Interest revenue on the receivable should then be recognised at the effective interest rate
(based on the remaining contractual term of 21 months) in accordance with IFRS 9 Financial
Instruments.
542
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Workings
1 Test of individual CGUs
Division A Division B
$m $m
Carrying amount 1,020 760
Recoverable amount (1,000) (720)
Impairment loss 20 40
Allocated to:
Goodwill 20 30
Other assets in the scope of IAS 36 – 10
20 40
Allocated to:
Unallocated goodwill 10
Other unallocated assets 5
15
TT2020
543
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 4: Defined benefit plans
Notes to the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
1 Defined benefit expense recognised in profit or loss
$m
Current service cost 76
Past service cost 40
Net interest cost (from SOFP obligation and asset notes: 58 – 52) 6
122
2 Other comprehensive income (items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss):
Remeasurements of defined benefit plans
$m
Actuarial gain/(loss) on defined benefit obligation (16)
Return on plan assets (excluding amounts in net interest) 34
18
544
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Activity 1: Restructuring
Plan 1:
A provision for restructuring should be recognised in respect of the closure of the factories in
accordance with IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets. The plan has been
communicated to the relevant employees (those who will be made redundant) and factories have
already been identified. A provision should only be recognised for directly attributable
costs that will not benefit ongoing activities of the entity. Thus, a provision should be recognised for
the redundancy costs and the lease termination costs, but none for the retraining costs:
$m
Redundancy costs 9
Retraining –
Lease termination costs 5
Liability 14
Any change in the expected present value of the provision would be made as an adjustment to
the provision and to the asset value (affecting future depreciation charges).
546
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
In the consolidated financial statements a deferred tax asset of $4,000 should be recognised:
DEBIT Deferred tax asset (in consolidated statement of financial position) $4,000
CREDIT Deferred tax (in consolidated statement of profit or loss) $4,000
Finance income of $454 should be recorded in profit or loss for the year ended 31 December
20X1 and the amortised cost of $9,524 in the statement of financial position as at
31 December 20X1.
(b) Loan notes
These loan notes are an investment in debt instruments where the business model is to collect
the contractual cash flows (which are solely principal and interest) and to sell financial assets.
This is because Wharton will make decisions on an ongoing basis about whether collecting
contractual cash flows or selling financial assets will maximise the return on the portfolio until
the need arises for the invested cash.
Therefore, they should be measured initially at fair value plus transaction costs: $45,450
([$50,000 90%] + $450).
Subsequently, the loan notes should be held at fair value through other comprehensive income
under IFRS 9. However, the interest revenue must still be shown in profit or loss.
$
Fair value on 1 January 20X1 ((50,000 90%) + 450)) 45,450
Effective interest income (45,450 5.6%) 2,545
Coupon received (50,000 3%) (1,500)
46,495
Revaluation gain (to other comprehensive income) [bal. figure] 4,505
Fair value at 31 December 20X1 51,000
Consequently, $2,545 of finance income will be recognised in profit or loss for the year,
$4,505 revaluation gain recognised in other comprehensive income and there will be a
$51,000 loan note asset in the statement of financial position.
548
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
TT2020
549
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Interest revenue of $380,000 ($10,000,000 3.8%) should also be recognised in profit or loss for
the year ended 31 December 20X5. This is calculated on the gross carrying amount of
$10,000,000. The interest rate of 3.8% is the LIBOR of 1.8% plus 2% per the loan agreement.
The gross carrying amount of the loans at 31 December 20X5 is:
$
1 January 20X5 10,000,000
Interest revenue (3.8% $10,000,000) 380,000
Cash received (400,000)
31 December 20X5 gross carrying amount 9,980,000
However, by 31 December 20X5, due to the economic recession and the existence of objective
evidence of impairment in the form of late payment by customers, Stage 3 has now been reached.
Therefore, the revised lifetime expected credit losses of $800,000 should now be recognised in full.
The allowance must be increased from $77,250 ($75,000 + interest of $2,250) to $800,000 which
will result in an extra charge of $722,750 to profit or loss:
$
1 January 20X5 (12-month expected credit losses) (15% $500,000) 75,000
Unwind discount (3% $75,000) 2,250
Increase in allowance 722,750
31 December 20X5 (lifetime expected credit losses) 800,000
The following amounts will be presented in the statement of financial position at 31 December 20X5:
$
Loan assets 9,980,000
Allowance for credit losses (800,000)
Net carrying amount 9,180,000
In the year ended 31 December 20X6, as Stage 3 has been reached, interest revenue will be
calculated on the carrying amount net of the allowance for credit losses of $9,180,000
($9,980,000 – $800,000). Conversely, if the loans were still at Stage 1 or Stage 2, interest income
and interest cost would have been calculated on the gross carrying amounts of $9,980,000 and
$800,000 respectively.
550
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
ppendix 1 – ctivity answers
The gain is recognised in other comprehensive income ('items that may be reclassified subsequently
to profit or loss') as the cash flow has not yet occurred:
m m
D T Forward contract (Financial asset in S F ) 3.36
C DT ther comprehensive income 3.36
1 March 20 2
t 31 March 2 2, the purchase of 3 million gallons of fuel at the market price of 2.19 per
gallon results in a charge to cost of sales of (3 m 2.19) 65.7 million.
t this point the forward contract is settled net in cash at its fair value on that date, calculated in the
same way as before:
m
Market price of forward contract for delivery on 31 March (28m 2.19 spot rate) 61.32
ne ir's forward price (28m 2. 4) (57.12)
Cumulative gain = cash settlement 4.2
This results in a further gain of .84 million ( 4.2m – 3.36m) in 2 2 which is credited to profit
or loss as it is a realised profit:
m m
D T Cash 4.2
C D T Forward contract at carrying amount 3.36
C D T rofit or loss (4.2 – 3.36) .84
The overall gain of 4.2 million on the forward contract has compensated for (hedged) the increase
in price of fuel.
The gain of 3.36 million previously recognised in other comprehensive income is transferred to
profit or loss as the cash flow has now affected profit or loss:
m m
D T ther comprehensive income 3.36
C DT rofit or loss 3.36
The overall effect on profit or loss is:
m
Profit or loss (extract)
Cost of sales (65.7 )
rofit on forward contract: .84
n current period 3.36
eclassified from other comprehensive income (61.5 )
Without hedging the company would have suffered the cost at market rates on 31 March 2 2 of
65.7 million.
Chapter eases
552
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
20X5 $
Equity b/d 0
Profit or loss expense 212,500
20X6 $
Equity b/d 212,500
Profit or loss expense 227,500
TT2020
553
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20X7 $
Equity b/d 440,000
Profit or loss expense 224,500
Equity c/d (443 100 $15) 664,500
$
Year ended 31 December 20X4
Liability b/d 0
Profit or loss expense 156,000
Liability c/d ((500 – 110) 100 $8.00 ½) 156,000
$
Year ended 31 December 20X5
Liability b/d 156,000
Profit or loss expense 180,000
Less cash paid on exercise of SARs by employees (100 100 $8.10) (81,000)
Liability c/d (300 100 $8.50) 255,000
$
Year ended 31 December 20X6
Liability b/d 255,000
Profit or loss expense 15,000
Less cash paid on exercise of SARs by employees (300 100 $9.00) (270,000)
Liability c/d – –
554
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
would be disclosed if considered material. This is unlikely here, but may be considered material due
to the fact that it is a transaction with a member of key management personnel.
At the settlement date the liability element of the share-based payment will be re-measured to its fair
value at that date and the method of settlement chosen by the director will then determine the
accounting treatment (payment of the liability or transfer to share capital/share premium).
Working: Fair value of equity component $
Fair value of the shares alternative at grant date
(24,000 shares $4.50) 108,000
Fair value of the cash alternative at grant date
(20,000 phantom shares $5.20) (104,000)
Fair value of the equity component of the compound instrument 4,000
It can be seen that where the right to the shares alternative is more valuable than the right to a cash
alternative, at the grant date the equity component then has a value of the residual amount, not the
full amount of the shares alternative, as the director must surrender the cash alternative in order to
accept the shares alternative; he cannot accept both.
Year 2
At the end of Year 2, the earnings only increased by 10%, which gives an average earnings rate of 12%
((14% + 10%)/2 years). Therefore the shares do not vest. Kingsley expects the growth rate to be at least
6% in Year 3 giving an average of at least 10% over three years, and therefore expects the vesting
condition to be met at the end of Year 3. The vesting period is now assumed to be three years.
Year 2 of 3 year
(revised) vesting
period $
Equity b/d 660,000
Profit or loss expense 174,000
Equity c/d [(500 – 30 – 28 – 25) 100 $30 2/3] 834,000
TT2020
555
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Year 3
In Year 3, the average increase in earnings is 10.67% per year, so the performance condition is met
and the shares vest.
$
Equity b/d 834,000
Profit or loss expense 423,000
Equity c/d [(500 – 30 – 28 – 23) 100 $30] 1,257,000
The equity balance of $1,257,000 can be transferred to share capital and share premium on issue
of the shares.
Summary of expense and equity balance
Equity
Expense (per SOFP)
$ $
Year 1 660,000 660,000
Year 2 174,000 834,000
Year 3 423,000 1,257,000
556
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Activity 1: Control
Power over the investee to direct relevant activities
The absolute size of Edwards' shareholding in Hope (40%) and the relative size of the other
shareholdings alone are not conclusive in determining whether Edwards has rights sufficient to give it
power.
However, the shareholder agreement which grants Edwards the right to appoint, remove and set the
remuneration of management responsible for the key business decisions of Hope gives Edwards
power to direct the relevant activities of Hope.
This is supported by the fact that a two-thirds majority is required to change the shareholder
agreement and, as Edwards owns more than one-third of the voting rights, the other shareholders will
be unable to change the agreement whilst Edwards owns 40%.
Exposure or rights to variable returns of the investee
As Edwards owns a 40% shareholding in Hope, it will be entitled to receive a dividend. The amount
of this dividend will vary according to Hope's performance and Hope's dividend policy. Therefore,
Edwards has exposure to the variable returns of Hope.
Ability to use power over the investee
The fact that Edwards might not exercise the right to appoint, remove and set the remuneration of
Hope's management should not be considered when determining whether Edwards has power over
Hope. It is just the ability to use the power which is required and this ability comes from the
shareholder agreement.
Conclusion
The IFRS 10 definition of control has been met. Edwards controls Hope and therefore Edwards
should consolidate Hope as a subsidiary in its group financial statements.
558
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Workings
1 Group structure
Brown
1.1.X6 60%
2 Goodwill
Part (a) Part (b)
$'000 $'000 $'000 $'000
Consideration transferred 720 720
Non-controlling interests 480 (800 40%) 320
Fair value of net assets at acquisition:
Share capital 500 500
Retained earnings 300 300
(800) (800)
400 240
Less impairment losses to date (10%) (40) (24)
360 216
3 Retained earnings
Brown Harris
$'000 $'000
At the year end 3,430 1,800
Provision for unrealised profit (W5) (10)
At acquisition (300)
1,490
Share of Harris's post-acquisition retained earnings:
(1,490 60%) 894
Less impairment loss on goodwill:
Part (a) (40 (W2) 60%)/Part (b) (24 (W2)) (24)
4,300
4 Non-controlling interests (NCI)
Part (a) Part (b)
$'000 $'000
NCI at acquisition (fair value)([500 + 300] 40%) 480 320
NCI share of post-acquisition retained earnings 596 596
(1,490 (W3) 40%)
NCI share of impairment losses (40 (W2) 40%) (16) –
1,060 916
5 Provision for unrealised profit (PUP)
Harris sells to Brown
PUP = $200,000 ¼ in inventory 25/125 mark-up = $10,000
DEBIT Harris's retained earnings $10,000
CREDIT Inventories $10,000
TT2020
559
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 3: Consolidated statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income
CONSTANCE GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME FOR
THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X5
$'000
Revenue (5,000 + [4,200 9/12] – 300 (W4)) 7,850
Cost of sales (4,100 + [3,500 9/12] – 300 (W4) + 40 (W4)) (6,465)
Gross profit 1,385
Distribution and administration expenses (320 + [180 9/12] + 10 (W2)) (465)
Profit before tax 920
Income tax expense (190 + [160 9/12]) (310)
PROFIT FOR THE YEAR 610
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation (net of tax) (60 + [40 9/12]) 90
Total comprehensive income for the year 700
1.4.X5* 80%
Spicer
560
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
3 Impairment of goodwill
Impairment of goodwill for the year = $100,000 goodwill 10% impairment = $10,000
Add $10,000 to 'administration expenses' and deduct from PFY/TCI in NCI working (as full
goodwill method adopted here)
4 Intra-group trading
Spicer sells to Constance
Intra-group revenue and cost of sales:
Cancel $300,000 out of revenue and cost of sales
PUP = $300,000 2/3 in inventories 25/125 mark-up = $40,000
Increase cost of sales by $40,000 and reduce PFY/TCI in NCI working (as subsidiary is the
seller)
The $5 million due diligence fees are transaction costs which are expensed in the books of Pau under
IFRS 3 so as not to distort the fair values used in the goodwill calculation.
The deferred consideration is initially measured at present value. Interest is then applied over the
period to payment (31 December 20X2). This results in an interest charge of $5.4 million ($108.8m
5%) in the year to 31 December 20X1 which is charged to profit or loss.
The contingent consideration is measured at its fair value, and as it is a liability, it must be
remeasured at each year end and at the date of payment. By 31 December 20X1, the fair value of
the consideration has risen to $65 million. The increase of $11 million is charged to profit or loss.
This is because, even though the change is within the measurement period (one year from acquisition
date), it is a result of a change in expected profits, which is a post-acquisition event, rather than
additional information regarding fair value at the date of acquisition.
TT2020
561
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$m
Equity attributable to owners of the parent
Share capital 1,000
Reserves (W4) 4,216
5,216
Non-controlling interests (W5) 962
6,178
Non-current liabilities (350 + 290) 640
Current liabilities (1,580 + 1,100) 2,680
Total equity and liabilities 9,498
BAILEY GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X9
$m
Revenue (5,000 + 4,200 – (W8) 200) 9,000
Cost of sales (4,100 + 3,500 + (W7) 10 – (W8) 200 + (W8) 20) (7,430)
Gross profit 1,570
Distribution costs and administrative expenses (320 + 175 + (W2) 15) (510)
Share of profit of associate (110 × 30% × 8/12) 22
Profit before tax 1,082
Income tax expense (240 + 170) (410)
PROFIT FOR THE YEAR 672
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation (net of deferred tax) (50 + 20) 70
Share of gain on property revaluation of associate (10 × 30% × 8/12) 2
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 72
Total comprehensive income for the year 744
Hill Campbell
Pre-acq'n reserves $440m $270m
562
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
2 Goodwill (Hill)
$m $m
Consideration transferred 720
Non-controlling interests (at fair value) 450
4 Reserves
Bailey Hill Campbell
$m $m $m
At year end 3,430 1,800 330
Fair value movement (W7) (40)
Provision for unrealised profit (W8) (20)
Pre-acquisition (440) (270)
1,300 60
Group share post acquisition reserves:
Hill (1,300 × 60%) 780
Campbell (60 × 30%) 18
Impairment losses:
Hill ((W2) 20 × 60%) (12)
Campbell (W3) (0)
4,216
5 Non-controlling interests (SOFP)
$m
NCI at acquisition (W2) 450
NCI share of post acquisition reserves ((W4) 1,300 × 40%) 520
NCI share of impairment losses ((W2) 20 × 40%) (8)
962
TT2020
563
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6 Non-controlling interests (SPLOCI)
PFY TCI
$m $m
Hill's PFY/TCI per question 355 375
Fair value adjustment movement (W7) (10) (10)
Provision for unrealised profit (W8) (20) (20)
Impairment loss on goodwill for year (W2) (15) (15)
310 330
× NCI share × 40% × 40%
= 124 = 132
7 Fair value adjustment (Hill)
At acquisition Movement Year end
1.1.X6 X6, X7, X8, X9 31.12.X9
$m $m $m
Property, plant and equipment 100 *(40) 60
(W2) (1,040 – 500 – 440)
564
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
TT2020
565
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b)(ii) Consolidated retained earnings
Explanation:
Peace should include in consolidated retained earnings:
Its own retained earnings at 31 December 20X2, plus the gain on remeasurement of the
previously held investment in Miel which is recognised in consolidated profit or loss.
Its 25% share of Miel's retained earnings from acquisition on 1 January 20X1 until control
is achieved on 30 September 20X2. This reflects the period that Miel was an associate by
including the group share of post-acquisition retained earnings generated under Peace’s
significant influence.
Its 60% share of Miel's retained earnings since obtaining control on 30 September 20X2,
after adjustment for amortisation of the fair value uplift relating to Miel's brands
recognised on acquisition. This reflects the period that Miel was a subsidiary by including
the group share of post-acquisition retained earnings generated under Peace’s control.
Calculation:
Miel Miel
Peace 25% 60%
$'000 $'000 $'000
At year end/date control obtained 39,920 7,800 7,900
Fair value movement
((9,200 – (800 + 7,800)/5 years 3/12) (30)
Gain on remeasurement of associate (a(iii)) 380
At acquisition (5,800) (7,800)
2,000 70
Group share of post-acquisition retained earnings:
Miel – 25% (2,000 25%) 500
– 60% (70 60%) 42
Consolidated retained earnings 40,842
566
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Working
Group structure and timeline
Peace
SPLOCI
Associate – Equity account 9/12 Consolidate
3/12
TT2020
567
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Its 60% share of Heggie's retained earnings from the date of acquisition (1 January
20X2). As the additional purchase of 20% did not occur until the final day of the reporting
period, no additional retained earnings in respect of the additional shareholding are
recorded in consolidated retained earnings for this year.
Calculation
Denning Heggie
$m $m
At year end 530 240
Adjustment to equity (W2) (18)
At acquisition (180)
60
Group share of post-acquisition retained earnings:
(60 60%) 36
548
Workings
1 Group structure
Denning
Heggie
$m
Fair value of consideration paid (130)
Decrease in NCI (224 (part (c)) 20%/40%) 112
(18)
568
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
5%
= $32 million
20%
= $8 million
Adjustment to equity
$m
Fair value of consideration paid (10)
Decrease in NCI ($32m × 5%/20%) 8
Adjustment to equity (2)
Correcting entry
The correcting entry to record the further decrease in NCI, reverse the original entry in profit or loss
and record the correct adjustment to equity is as follows:
DEBIT Group retained earnings $2 million
DEBIT Non-controlling interests $1 million
CREDIT Profit or loss $3 million
TT2020
569
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Working: Group structure
Robe
1.6.X6 80%
31.5.X9 5%
85%
Dock
570
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Workings
1 Group structure and timeline
Amber
SPLOCI
Subsidiary – 9/12 Associate – 3/12
2 Goodwill
$'000 $'000
Consideration transferred (2,000 – 800) 1,200
Non-controlling interests (at fair value) 300
Less: fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition
share capital 400
reserves 760
(1,160)
340
3 Non-controlling interests (SOFP) at date of loss of control
$'000
NCI at acquisition 300
NCI share of post-acquisition reserves ([1,240* – 760] 20%) 96
396
TT2020
571
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
* Reserves at the date of loss of control (30 September 20X6) were given in the question but
they could also have been calculated as follows:
$'000
Reserves at year end (per Byrne's SOFP) 1,280
Less share of total comprehensive income from 1.10.X6–31.12.X6
(160 3/12) (40)
Reserves at date of loss of control 1,240
Workings
1 Group structure
Vail
Nest
572
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
2 Goodwill
$m
Consideration transferred 80
Non-controlling interests (100 40%) 40
Less fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition (100)
20
Impairment (4)
16
3 Non-controlling interests (SOFP) at date of loss of control
$m
NCI at acquisition (100 40%) 40
NCI share of post-acquisition reserves ((130 – 100)* 40%) 12
52
*Post-acquisition reserves can be calculated as the difference between net assets at disposal and net
assets at acquisition. This is because net assets equal equity and, provided there has been no share
issue since acquisition, the movement in equity and net assets is solely due to the movement in
reserves.
(b) Explanation
This is a transaction between shareholders of Dial: Trial has sold of a 5% shareholding in Dial
to the NCI of Dial. In substance then, no disposal has taken place and no profit on disposal
should be recognised. Instead an adjustment to equity should be recorded, attributed to the
owners of Trail, being the difference between the consideration received for the shareholding
and the increase in the NCI.
TT2020
573
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Calculation
Adjustment to equity
$m
Fair value of consideration received 60
Increase in NCI (56)
4
Workings
1 Group structure
Trail
1.12.X0 80%
30.11.X1 Sell (5%)
75%
Dial
Discontinued operations
Profit for the year from discontinued operations (42 – (W2) 6.8) 35.2
Profit for the year 156.2
574
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
$m
Total comprehensive income attributable to:
Owners of the parent ( ) 177.6
Non-controlling interests (48 × 20%) 9.6
187.2
Workings
1 Group structure
Titan
100% 80%
Cronus Rhea
2 Impairment losses (Rhea)
$m
'Notional'* goodwill (38 100%/80%) 47.5
Carrying amount of net assets (320 + (48 9/12)) 356.0
403.5
Fair value less costs to sell (395.0)
Impairment loss: gross 8.5
*Where the partial goodwill method is used part of the calculation of the recoverable amount
of the CGU relates to the unrecognised non-controlling interest share of the goodwill.
For the purpose of calculating the impairment loss, the carrying amount of the CGU is
therefore notionally adjusted to include the non-controlling interests in the goodwill by
grossing it up.
The resulting impairment loss calculated is only recognised to the extent of the parent's
share.
This adjustment is not required where non-controlling interests are measured at fair value at
acquisition.
576
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
$'000
Profit attributable to:
Owners of the parent ( ) 1,076
Non-controlling interests (W7) 4
1,080
Total comprehensive income attributable to:
Owners of the parent ( ) 1,398.5
Non-controlling interests (W7) 84.6
1,483.1
Workings
1 Group structure
Bennie
1.1.X1 80%
TT2020
577
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2 Translation of Jennie – Statement of financial position
J'000 Rate $'000
Property, plant and equipment 7,280 8 910
Current assets 5,600 8 700
12,880 1,610
*As there is no explicit rule, either average rate (as here) or closing rate could be used.
578
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
TT2020
579
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Activity 3: Ethics
If Jenkin were to sell the shares profitably a gain would arise in its individual financial statements
which would boost retained earnings. However, if only 5% of the equity shares in Rankin were sold,
it would still hold 55% of the equity and presumably control would not be lost. The IASB views this as
an equity transaction (ie transactions with owners in their capacity as owners) (IFRS 10: para. 23).
This means that the relevant proportion of the exchange differences should be re-attributed to the
non-controlling interest rather than to the retained earnings (IAS 21: para. 48C) (and not reclassified
to profit or loss because control has not been lost). The directors appear to be motivated by their
desire to maximise the balance on the group retained earnings. It would appear that the directors'
actions are unethical by overstating the group's interest in Rankin at the expense of the
non-controlling interest.
The purpose of financial statements is to present a fair representation of the company's financial
position, financial performance and cash flows (IAS 1: para. 15) and if the financial statements are
deliberately falsified, then this could be deemed unethical. Accountants have a social and ethical
responsibility to issue financial statements which do not mislead the public.
Any manipulation of the accounts will harm the credibility of the profession since the public assume
that professional accountants will act in an ethical capacity. The directors should be reminded that
professional ethics are an integral part of the profession and that they must adhere to ethical
guidelines such as ACCA's Code of Ethics and Conduct. Deliberate falsification of the financial
statements would contravene the guiding principles of integrity, objectivity and professional
behaviour. The directors' intended action appears to be in direct conflict with the code by
deliberating overstating the parent company's ownership interest in the group in order to maximise
potential investment in Jenkin.
Stakeholders are becoming increasingly reactive to the ethical stance of an entity. Deliberate
falsification would potentially harm the reputation of Jenkin and could lead to severe, long-term
disadvantages in the market place. The directors' intended action will therefore not be in the best
interests of the stakeholders in the business. There can be no justification for the deliberate
falsification of an entity's financial statements.
580
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
(b) Extract
EXTRACT FROM STATEMENT OF CASH FLOW (OPERATING ACTIVITIES)
$'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before tax 67
Adjustment for:
Share of profit of associates (7)
EXTRACT FROM STATEMENT OF CASH FLOW (INVESTING ACTIVITIES)
$'000
Cash flows from investing activities
Dividend from associate 16
Acquisition of an associate (12)
(c) Explanation
Cash flows from operating activities are principally derived from the key trading activities of
the entity. This includes cash receipts from the sale of goods, cash payments to suppliers and
cash payments on behalf of employees. The indirect method adjusts profit or loss for the effects
of transactions of a non-cash nature, any deferrals or accruals from past or future operating
cash receipts or payments and any items of income or expense associated with investing or
financing cash flows. Therefore the share of profit of associates must be removed from profit
before tax as it is an item of income associated with investing activities.
The actual dividend received from the associates will be shown as a cash inflow in the
investing activities section of the statement of cash flows as this is the actual cash received.
There will also be a cash outflow under investing activities to show the purchase of Acton
during the year.
Workings
1 Assets
PPE Goodwill Associate
$'000 $'000 $'000
b/d 41,700 1,400 3,100
SPLOCI 1,000 980 (800 + 180)
Depreciation (2,200)
Impairment (180) β
Acquisition of subsidiary 1,900 720*
Non-cash additions (W5) 30
Cash paid/(rec'd) β 2,440 (260)
c/d 44,870 1,940 3,820
582
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
3 Liabilities
Tax payable
$'000
b/d (2,100 + 500) 2,600
SPLOCI (1,200 + 250) 1,450
5 Foreign transaction
Transactions recorded on: $'000 $'000
(1) 30 Sep DEBIT Property, plant & equipment (1,080/4) 270
CREDIT Payables 270
(2) 30 Nov DEBIT Payables (1,080/4) 270
CREDIT Cash (1,080/4.5) 240
CREDIT P/L 30
The exchange gain created a cash saving on settlement that reduced the actual cash paid to
acquire property, plant and equipment and it is therefore shown separately in Working 1 as a
non-cash increase in property, plant and equipment.
Activity 4: Analysis
Cash from operating activities
The operating activities section of Horwich's statement of cash flows shows that the business is not
only profitable, but is generating healthy inflows of cash from its main operations.
A significant proportion of the cash generated from operations is utilised in paying tax and paying
interest on borrowings. The amount needed to pay interest in future may increase as the company
appears to be increasing its borrowings to fund its expansion.
The adjustments to profit show that receivables, inventories and payables are all increasing. This
trend may reflect the expansion of the business but working capital management must be reviewed
carefully to ensure that cash is collected promptly from receivables so that the company is able to
meet its obligations to pay its suppliers and maintain good trading relationships.
Cash from investing activities
The two main investing outflows in the year were the net cash payment of $800,000 to acquire a
new subsidiary and the payment of $340,000 to acquire new property, plant and equipment. These
are a clear reflection of the strategy of expansion and may lead to increased profits and cash flows
from operations in future years. This section also reflects cash received from the sale of equipment of
$70,000 and the operating cash flows section shows that this equipment was sold at a loss. This
suggests that the company may have acquired the new equipment to replace assets that were old
and inefficient.
TT2020
583
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Another significant inflow in this section is an amount of $150,000 from the sale of investments. It is
likely that this was done to help finance the acquisition and expansion. This type of cash flow is
unlikely to recur in future and also means that the other inflows in this section, the interest and
dividends received, are likely to cease or be reduced in future.
Cash from financing activities
The company has raised new finance totalling $600,000, which has probably been applied to the
acquisition and expansion. The new finance may have had a detrimental effect on the company's
gearing. The increased borrowings will mean that future interest expenses will increase which could
threaten profitability in the future if the expansion does not create immediate increases in operating
profits.
This section also includes the largest single cash flow, a dividend payment of $1,000,000. This
appears to be a very high payout (70% of the cash generated from operating activities) and raises
the question as to why the company has taken on additional borrowings rather than retaining more
profits to invest in the expansion. On the other hand, it may indicate that management are very
confident that the expanded business will generate returns that will easily cover the additional interest
costs and allow this level of dividend payment to continue in future.
Conclusion
The expansion appears to have been very successful both in terms of profitability and cash flow.
Management must just be careful not to pay excessive dividends in the future at the cost of
reinvesting in the business.
Activity 1: Stakeholders
Group Reason Further reason
Management Management are often set Management may use financial
performance targets and use the statements to aid them in important
financial statements to compare strategic decisions.
company performance to the targets
set, with a view to achieving bonuses.
Employees Employees are concerned with job Employees want to feel proud of the
stability and may use corporate company that they work for and
reports to better understand the future positive financial statements can
prospects of their employer. indicate a job well done.
Present and Existing investors will assess whether Investors will want to understand
potential their investment is sound and more about the types of products the
investors generates acceptable returns. company is involved in (the segment
Potential investors will use the report will help with this) and the
financial statements to help them way in which the company does
decide whether or not to buy shares business, which will help them make
in that company. ethical investment decisions.
Lenders and Lenders and suppliers are concerned Lenders and suppliers will be
suppliers with the credit worthiness of an entity interested in the future direction of a
and the likelihood that they will be business to help them plan whether
repaid amounts owing. it is likely that they will continue to
be a business partner of the entity
going forward.
584
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Note. There are many reasons you could have chosen – these are just examples.
Activity 3: APM
The earnings release does not appear to be consistent with the ESMA guidelines relating to APMs.
When an entity presents an APM, it should present the most directly comparable IFRS measure with
equal or greater prominence. Whether an APM is more prominent than a comparable IFRS measure
would depend on the facts and circumstances. In this case, Sharky has omitted comparable IFRS
information from the earnings release which discusses EBITDAR. Additionally, the entity has emphasised
the APM measure by describing it as 'exceptional performance' without an equally prominent
description of the comparable IFRS measure.
TT2020
585
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further, Sharky has provided a discussion of the APM measure without a similar discussion and analysis
of the IFRS measure. The entity has presented EBITDAR as a performance measure; such measures should
be reconciled to profit for the year as presented in the SPLOCI.
Sharky has changed the definition of the APM from EBITDA to EBITDAR and is therefore not reporting
a consistent measure over time. An entity may change the APM in exceptional circumstances and it is
not clear whether the restructuring would justify the change. Sharky should disclose the change and
the reason for the change should be explained and any comparatives restated.
Innovation & learning Number of new destinations Attracts more customers to airline
The company has reported an As there has been a decrease As the capital structure of the
increase in profits for the year, in ROCE despite the increase company has not changed and
but ROCE has decreased. The in profits, there must have been as it is not expected that there
company has not issued or an increase in capital would be significant
repaid any debt or equity in employed. This is likely to be revaluation gains as its data
the period. the result of the revaluation of centre is located in an area of
PPE in the year and is therefore stable land and property
in line with what may be prices, the decrease in ROCE
expected from Company A. is not in line with what we
would expect for Company B.
The company has reported in This is in line with what we Data centres are big energy
its annual report that it has would expect Company A to users and have higher levels of
changed its business processes report. Manufacturing emissions than stakeholders
to reduce its level of emissions industries are coming under might expect. It is difficult for
in the year, staying on track for increasing pressure to change such companies to change
its ten year emissions target. their procedures to reduce their processes to reduce
emissions and be more emissions (though they could
environmentally friendly. Also, consider compensating
the existence of a ten year plan measures to help them become
is more in keeping with a more neutral). Due to the rate
well-established company. of change in digital companies
and the fact the company was
only established two years
ago, it seems unlikely it would
have a ten year plan.
Therefore, this information is
not in line with what we would
expect Company B to report.
586
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
The company has reported that This is not what we would This is the kind of reporting
89% of customers agree it expect Company A to report. that would be expected from
responds to their needs, 87% Although traditional Company B. The purpose of
felt they were well connected manufacturing companies Company B is to respond to its
to their supplier and 82% of operate with the intention to customer needs and offer it
customers have engaged with satisfy their customers, they are bespoke solutions. It is likely to
its social media feeds. unlikely to be directly seek engagement through
communicating and connecting digital platforms. The statement
with their customers and are regarding customer experience
unlikely to be providing and interaction is consistent
bespoke solutions to their with expectations for a digital
needs. company.
588
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
a fully informed investment decision. For example, they would not know that personal care products
are making a profit margin of under half that of food (3% versus 7.8%).
Assess management strategy and different prospects of each segment
Disaggregation into operating segments allows investors to use the segment report to:
Assess management's strategy and effectiveness – for example, whether the most profitable
product accounts for the largest proportion of sales, (in JH, food has the highest margin at
7.8% and accounts for more than half of sales, demonstrating sound management judgement);
Assess the different rates of profitability, opportunities for growth, future prospects and degrees
of risk of each different business activity. For example, whether the segment has recently
invested in assets for future growth (in JH, all three segments have invested in assets in the year
and, overall, home care has the highest asset to revenue ratio, either implying a more capital-
intensive manufacturing process or the greatest potential for future growth and perhaps newer,
more efficient assets).
Limitations
Comparability with other entities
Segments are determined under IFRS 8 on the basis of internal reporting to the chief operating
decision maker. JH's three segments are food, personal care and home care. However, JH's
competitors are unlikely to structure their business or report to the board in exactly the same way as
JH. This could make the investment decision very difficult due to the lack of comparability of
reportable segments between entities.
Unallocated amounts
Where it is not possible to allocate an expense, asset or liability to a specific segment, the amounts
are reported as unallocated in the reconciliation of reportable segments to the entity's full financial
statements.
Here JH has $5 million of unallocated expenses. If these were allocated to specific segments, they
could turn personal care or home care's reported profit into a loss or reduce food's profit by a third.
Therefore, comparison of the different segments without taking into account these unallocated items
would be misleading.
Equally 15% of JH's group liabilities are unallocated. If these had been allocated to a specific
segment, they would more than double personal care's liabilities and significantly increase the other
two segments' liabilities. There is a danger that users believe that the total reported segment liabilities
show the complete liabilities of the JH group.
Therefore, where these unallocated amounts are significant, the figures by segment could be
misleading and could result in an ill-informed investment decision.
Reconciliations
IFRS 8 Operating Segments only requires reconciliation of segment revenues, profit or loss, assets
and liabilities (and for any material items separately disclosed) to the total entity's figures.
Therefore, it is not possible to see all the reasons for the differences in the statement of profit or loss
and other comprehensive income and statement of financial position between the reported segment
figures and the total entity figures.
In JH's case, it is not possible to see any unallocated expenses, interest or depreciation. Therefore
investors are not presented with the full picture.
Allocation between segments
Management judgement is required in allocating income, expenses, assets and liabilities to the
different segments. In some instances, such as interest revenue and interest expense where treasury
and financing decisions are likely to be made centrally rather than by division, it could be very
TT2020
589
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
difficult to allocate these items. Equally, central expenses, assets and liabilities (such as those relating
to head office) could be hard to allocate. This leaves scope for errors, manipulation and bias.
In JH's case, both interest revenue and interest expense are individually greater than total segment
profit so incorrect allocation could mislead an investor into making an ill-informed decision.
Intersegment items
The cancellation of intersegment revenue, assets and liabilities is clearly shown in the reconciliation
of the segment revenue, profit or loss, assets and liabilities to the total entity's. However, it is not
possible to see the cancellation of intersegment expenses or interest.
This could confuse investors as they cannot see the full impact of intersegment cancellations on the
group accounts. For example, in JH's segment report, the cancellation of $2 million intersegment
revenue is clearly shown but the corresponding cancellation of intersegment expense is not disclosed.
Understandability
The disclosure requirements of IFRS 8 Operating Segments are quite onerous as illustrated by the
level of detail in JH's segment report. There is a danger of 'information overload', overwhelming the
investor with the end result of the segment report being ignored altogether.
Disclosure requirements
The nature and quantify of information required to be disclosed by IFRS 8 depends on the content of
internal management reports reviewed by the chief operating decision maker. This will vary from
company to company, making it hard for an investor to compare the performance of different entities.
In the case of JH, a significant amount of information is reported internally and therefore disclosed.
However, IFRS 8 only requires as a minimum for an entity to report a measure of profit or loss for each
reportable segment. If this were the only disclosure, it would be very hard to make an investment
decision.
Reportable segments
IFRS 8 only requires segments to be reported on separately if they meet certain criteria (at least 10%
of revenue; or at least 10% of the higher of the combined reported profit or loss; or at least 10% of
assets). As long as at least 75% of external revenue is reported on, the remaining segments may be
aggregated.
Here, JH has combined the segments that have not met the 10% threshold into 'All others' which is
not helpful to investors as they will not know which products or services are included in this category.
590
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 1 – Activity answers
Tutorial note
You need to remember the following when accounting for goodwill under the IFRS for SMEs:
(a) NCI must be valued based on its share of net assets.
(b) If management are unable to estimate reliably the useful life of goodwill, then it should be
amortised over a maximum life of ten years.
TT2020
591
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Goodwill will be calculated as:
$m
Consideration transferred 7.7
Non-controlling interests (at %FVNA: 9.5 40%) 3.8
Fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition (9.5)
2.0
Amortisation (2.0/10 years 6/12) (0.1)
1.9
592
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
The financial
reporting framework
Essential reading
TT2020
593
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Non-current liabilities
Long-term borrowings 120,000 160,000
Deferred tax 28,800 26,040
Long-term provisions 28,850 52,240
Total non-current liabilities 177,650 238,280
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables 115,100 187,620
Short-term borrowings 150,000 200,000
Current portion of long-term borrowings 10,000 20,000
Current tax payable 35,000 42,000
Short-term provisions 5,000 4,800
Total current liabilities 315,100 454,420
Total liabilities 492,750 692,700
Total equity and liabilities 1,466,500 1,524,200
594
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
Changes in
accounting
policy – 400 – – – – 400 100 500
Restated
balance 600,000 118,500 (4,000) 1,600 2,000 – 718,100 29,900 748,000
Changes
in equity
for 20X6
Total
comprehensive
income for the
year – 53,200 6,400 16,000 (2,400) 1,600 74,800 18,700 93,500
Balance at
31 December
20X6 600,000 161,700 2,400 17,600 (400) 1,600 782,900 48,600 831,500
Changes in
equity for
20X7
Issue of share
capital 50,000 – – – – – 50,000 – 50,000
Total
comprehensive
income for the
year – 96,600 3,200 (14,400) (400) 800 85,800 21,450 107,250
Transfer to
retained
earnings – 200 – – – (200) – – –
Balance at
31 December
20X7 650,000 243,500 5,600 3,200 (800) 2,200 903,700 70,050 973,750
TT2020
595
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
20X7 20X6
$'000 $'000
Administrative expenses (20,000) (21,000)
Other expenses (2,100) (1,200)
Finance costs (8,000) (7,500)
Share of profit of associates 35,100 30,100
Profit before tax 161,667 128,000
Income tax expense (40,417) (32,000)
Profit for the year from continuing operations 121,250 96,000
Loss for the year from discontinued operations – (30,500)
Profit for the year 121,250 65,500
596
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
1: The financial reporting framework
TT2020
597
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
A long-term loan that becomes payable on demand because the entity breached a
condition of its loan agreement should be classified as current at the year end even if the lender
has agreed after the year end, and before the financial statements are authorised for issue,
not to demand payment as a consequence of the breach (IAS 1: para. 74).
However, if the lender has agreed by the year end to provide a period of grace ending at
least 12 months after the year end within which the entity can rectify the breach and during
that time the lender cannot demand immediate repayment, the liability is classified as non-current
(IAS 1: para. 75).
598
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Non-current assets
Essential reading
TT2020 599
Illustration 1
Componentisation of complex assets
An aircraft is considered to have the following components.
Cost Useful life
$'000
Fuselage 20,000 20 years
Undercarriage 5,000 500 landings
Engines 8,000 1,600 flying hours
Depreciation at the end of the first year, in which 150 flights totalling 400 hours were made,
would then be:
$'000
Fuselage 1,000
Undercarriage (5,000 150/500) 1,500
Engines (8,000 400/1,600) 2,000
4,500
1.2 Reconditioning/overhauls
Where an asset requires regular reconditioning/overhauls in order to continue to operate, the cost of
the overhaul is treated as an additional component and depreciated over the period to the next
overhaul (IAS 16: para. 14).
For example, assume that in the case of the aircraft in Illustration 1 above, an overhaul was required
at the end of Year 3 and every third year thereafter at a cost of $1.2 million per overhaul. The $1.2 million
would be capitalised as a separate component and depreciated over the useful life of three years
($400,000 per annum).
600
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
4: Non-current assets
TT2020
601
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
602
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Employee benefits
Essential reading
TT2020 603
Multi-employer plans: Defined contribution plans (other than State plans) or defined benefit
plans (other than State plans) that:
Key term
(a) Pool the assets contributed by various entities that are not under common control; and
(b) Use those assets to provide benefits to employees of more than one entity, on the basis that
contribution and benefit levels are determined without regard to the identity of the entity that
employs the employees concerned. (IAS 19: para. 8)
IAS 19 (IAS 19: paras. 32–39) requires an entity to classify such a plan as a defined contribution
plan or a defined benefit plan, depending on its terms (including any constructive obligation beyond
those terms).
604
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
For a multi-employer plan that is a defined benefit plan, the entity should account for its
proportionate share of the defined benefit obligation, plan assets and cost associated with the plan
in the same way as for any other defined benefit plan and make full disclosure.
When there is insufficient information to use defined benefit accounting, then the multi-employer
plan should be accounted for as a defined contribution plan and additional disclosures made (that
the plan is in fact a defined benefit plan and information about any known surplus or deficit).
Illustration 1
Defined benefit plan calculations
Clement operates a defined benefit pension scheme for its employees. At 1 January 20X1 the present
value of the defined benefit obligation was $5 million and the fair value of the plan assets was
$5.7 million. Equivalent values at 31 December 20X1 were $5.94 million and $7.1 million.
For the year ended 31 December 20X1:
Current service cost was $1.5 million
The interest rate applicable to the net defined benefit asset was 3%
Contributions of $2 million were made to the plan
$800,000 was paid out to former employees of Clement
The present value of future economic benefits in relation to the plan is $1.1 million. Assume the
contributions and benefits were paid on 31 December 20X1.
Required
Calculate the amount of remeasurement to be recognised in other comprehensive income in the year
ended 31 December 20X1.
Solution
Net defined
Obligation Assets benefit asset
$'000 $'000 $'000
At 1 January 20X1 5,000 5,700 700
Current service cost 1,500
Contributions 2,000
Benefits paid (800) (800)
Interest (3% 5m)/(3% 5.7m) 150 171
5,850 7,071
Remeasurements ( ) 90 29
At 31 December 20X1 5,940 7,100 1,160
Remeasurement due to asset ceiling (60)
Asset ceiling 1,100
TT2020
605
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Therefore, the total remeasurement amount recognised in other comprehensive income is:
$'000
Remeasurement loss on obligation 90
Remeasurement gain on assets (29)
Remeasurement loss due to asset ceiling 60
Net remeasurement loss 121
Illustration 2
Contributions and benefits paid other than at the end of the period
Jett Co has a defined benefit pension plan.
Required
Using the information below, prepare extracts from the statement of financial position and the
statement of comprehensive income of Jett Co, together with a reconciliation of plan movements for
the year ended 31 January 20X8. Ignore taxation.
(a) The plan assets were $4.1 million on 1 February 20X7 and plan liabilities at this date were
$4.8 million.
(b) The company paid a contribution of $680,000 in a lump sum on 1 February 20X7.
(c) Benefits paid to former employees, which amounted to $440,000, were paid in two equal
amounts on 31 July 20X7 and 31 January 20X8.
(d) The yield on high quality corporate bonds was 6% and the actual return on plan assets was
$282,000.
(e) Current service cost can be calculated as 4.2% of wages and salaries in the current year.
The wages and salaries expense is $5,900,000.
(f) The actuary valued the plan liabilities at 31 January 20X8 as $4.95.
606
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5: Employee benefits
Solution
STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION (Extract)
$'000
Non-current liabilities
Defined benefit pension obligations (4,950 – 4,622) 328
$'000
Reconciliation of pension plan movement
Plan deficit at 1 Feb 20X7 (4,100 – 4,800) (700)
Company contributions 680
Profit or loss total (249)
Other comprehensive income total (61 – 2) (59)
Plan deficit at 31 Jan 20X8 (4,950 – 4,622) (328)
$'000
TT2020
607
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
$'000
Changes in the fair value of plan assets
Fair value of plan assets at 1 Feb 20X7 4,100
Contributions 680
Benefits paid (440)
Interest income on plan assets ((4,100 + 680) × 6% × 6/12) + 280
(4,100 + 680 – 220) × 6% × 6/12)
Remeasurement gain through OCI (282 – 280) 2
Fair value of plan assets at 31 Jan 20X8 (bal. fig.) 4,622
608
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Financial instruments
Essential reading
TT2020
609
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
1 Definitions
We should clarify some points arising from the financial instruments definitions:
(a) A 'contract' need not be in writing, but it must comprise an agreement that has 'clear
economic consequences' and which the parties to it cannot avoid, usually because the
agreement is enforceable in law.
(b) Financial instruments include both of the following:
(i) Primary instruments: eg receivables, payables and equity securities; and
(ii) Derivative instruments: eg financial options, futures and forwards, interest rate
swaps and currency swaps.
IAS 32 makes it clear that the following items are not financial instruments (IAS 32: paras. AG9–12):
(a) Physical assets, eg inventories, property, plant and equipment, leased assets and
intangible assets (patents, trademarks etc);
(b) Prepaid expenses, deferred revenue and most warranty obligations, because
they result in the receipt/delivery of goods and services, rather than cash or financial assets
or liabilities;
(c) Liabilities or assets that are not contractual in nature, eg income tax payable; and
(d) Contractual rights/obligations that do not involve recognition of a financial asset,
eg operating leases for lessors as no receivable is recognised.
610
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
its own equity instruments in exchange for a fixed amount of cash is an equity
instrument. The reasoning behind this is that by fixing upfront the number of shares to be received
or delivered on settlement of the instrument in question, the holder is exposed to the upside and
downside risk of movements in the entity's share price.
In contrast, if the amount of cash or own equity shares to be delivered or received is
variable, then the contract is a financial liability or asset. The reasoning behind this is that
using a variable number of own equity instruments to settle a contract can be similar to using own
shares as 'currency' to settle what in substance is a financial liability. Such a contract does not
evidence a residual interest in the entity's net assets. Equity classification is therefore inappropriate.
IAS 32 gives two examples of contracts where the number of own equity instruments to be
received or delivered varies so that their fair value equals the amount of the contractual right or
obligation (IAS 32: para. AG 27).
(a) A contract to deliver a variable number of own equity instruments equal in value to a fixed
monetary amount on the settlement date is classified as a financial liability.
(b) A contract to deliver as many of the entity's own equity instruments as are equal in value to the
value of 100 ounces of a commodity results in liability classification of the instrument.
There are other factors which might result in an instrument being classified as debt:
(a) Dividends are non-discretionary.
(b) Redemption is at the option of the instrument holder.
(c) The instrument has a limited life.
(d) Redemption is triggered by a future uncertain event which is beyond the control of both the
issuer and the holder of the instrument.
Other factors which might result in an instrument being classified as equity include the
following:
(a) Dividends are discretionary.
(b) The shares are non-redeemable.
(c) There is no liquidation date.
TT2020
611
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
The standard also provides examples of situations where the risks and rewards of
ownership have not been transferred (IFRS 9: para. B3.2.5):
(a) A sale and repurchase transaction where the repurchase price is a fixed price or the sale price
plus a lender's return;
(b) A sale of a financial asset together with a total return swap that transfers the market risk
exposure back to the entity; and
(c) A sale of short-term receivables in which the entity guarantees to compensate the transferee for
credit losses that are likely to occur.
It is possible for only part of a financial asset or liability to be derecognised. This is allowed if the
part comprises:
(a) Only specifically identified cash flows; or
(b) Only a fully proportionate (pro rata) share of the total or specifically identified cash flows.
For example, if an entity holds a bond it has the right to two separate sets of cash inflows: those
relating to the principal and those relating to the interest. It could sell the right to receive the interest
to another party while retaining the right to receive the principal.
On derecognition, the amount to be included in profit or loss for the period is calculated as follows
(IFRS 9: para. 3.2.13):
$
Carrying amount (measured at the date of derecognition) allocated to the part derecognised X
Less: Consideration received for the part derecognised
(including any new asset obtained less any new liability assumed) (X)
Difference to profit or loss X
The following flowchart, taken from the appendix to the standard (IFRS 9: Appendix B, para.
B3.2.1), will help you decide whether, and to what extent, a financial asset is derecognised.
612
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
8: Financial instruments
No
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
TT2020
613
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
614
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Leases
Essential reading
TT2020
615
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
616
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
2 Lessee accounting
2.1 Identifying a lease: examples
The following flowchart may assist you in determining whether a lease may be identified in the
examples that follow:
No
Is there an identified asset?
Consider paragraphs B13−B20.
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Illustration 1
Coketown Council has entered into a five-year contract with Carefleet Co, under which Carefleet Co
supplies the council with ten vehicles for the purposes of community transport. Carefleet Co owns the
relevant vehicles, all ten of which are specified in the contract. Coketown Council determines the
routes taken for community transport and the charges and eligibility for discounts. The council can
choose to use the vehicles for purposes other than community transport. When the vehicles are not
being used, they are kept at the council's offices and cannot be retrieved by Carefleet unless
Coketown Council defaults on payment. If a vehicle needs to be serviced or repaired, Carefleet is
obliged to provide a temporary replacement vehicle of the same type.
TT2020
617
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Analysis
Conclusion: this is a lease. There is an identifiable asset, the ten vehicles specified in the
contract. The council has a right to use the vehicles for the period of the contract. Carefleet Co does
not have the right to substitute any of the vehicles unless they are being serviced or repaired.
Therefore Coketown Council would need to recognise an asset and liability in its statement of financial
position.
Illustration 2
Broketown Council has recently made substantial cuts to its community transport service. It will now
provide such services only in cases of great need, assessed on a case by case basis. It has entered
into a two-year contract with Fleetcar Co for the use of one of its minibuses for this purpose. The
minibus must seat ten people, but Fleetcar Co can use any of its ten-seater minibuses when required.
Analysis
Conclusion: this is not a lease. There is no identifiable asset. Fleetcar can exchange one
minibus for another. Therefore Broketown Council should account for the rental payments as an
expense in profit or loss.
Illustration 3
This example is taken from IFRS 16 Illustrative Example 3.
Kabal enters into a ten-year contract with a utilities company (Telenew) for the right to use three
specified, physically distinct dark fibres within a larger cable connecting North Town to South Town.
Kabal makes the decisions about the use of the fibres by connecting each end of the fibres to its
electronic equipment (ie Kabal 'lights' the fibres and decides what data, and how much data,
those fibres will transport). If the fibres are damaged, Telenew is responsible for the repairs and
maintenance. Telenew owns extra fibres, but can substitute those for Kabal's fibres only for reasons
of repairs, maintenance or malfunction (and is obliged to substitute the fibres in these cases).
Analysis
Conclusion: this is a lease. The contract contains a lease of dark fibres. Kabal has the right to
use the three dark fibres for ten years.
There are three identified fibres. The fibres are explicitly specified in the contract and are physically
distinct from other fibres within the cable. Telenew cannot substitute the fibres other than for reasons
of repairs, maintenance or malfunction (IFRS 16: para. B18).
Kabal has the right to control the use of the fibres throughout the ten-year period of use because:
(a) Kabal has the right to obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from use of the fibres
over the ten-year period of use and Kabal has exclusive use of the fibres throughout the period
of use.
(b) Kabal has the right to direct the use of the fibres because IFRS 16: para. B24 applies:
(i) The customer has the right to direct how and for what purpose the asset is used during
the whole of its period of use; or
(ii) The relevant decisions about use are pre-determined and the customer can operate the
asset without the supplier having the right to change those operating instructions.
Kabal makes the relevant decisions about how and for what purpose the fibres are used by deciding
(i) when and whether to light the fibres and (ii) when and how much output the fibres will produce
(ie what data, and how much data, those fibres will transport). Kabal has the right to change these
decisions during the ten-year period of use.
618
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
Although Telenew's decisions about repairing and maintaining the fibres are essential to their
efficient use, those decisions do not give Telenew the right to direct how and for what purpose the
fibres are used. Consequently, Telenew does not control the use of the fibres during the period of use.
Illustration 4
Livery Co leases a delivery van from Bettalease Co for three years at $12,000 per year. This
payment includes servicing costs.
Livery could lease the same make and model of van for $11,000 per year and would need to pay
$2,000 a year for servicing.
Solution
Livery Co would allocate $10,154 ($12,000 × $11,000 ÷ $(11,000 + 2,000)) to the lease
component and account for that as a lease under IFRS 16.
Livery Co would allocate $1,846 ($12,000 × $2,000 ÷ $(11,000 + 2,000)) to the servicing
component and recognise it in profit or loss as an expense.
Illustration 5
Remeasurement: revision of lease term
(Adapted from IFRS 16 Illustrative Example 13)
Lester enters into a ten-year lease of a floor of a building, with an option to extend for five years.
Lease payments are $50,000 per year during the initial term and $55,000 per year during the
optional period, all payable at the beginning of each year. The interest rate implicit in the lease was
not readily determinable. Lester's incremental borrowing rate was 5% per annum.
Lester is now in the sixth year of the ten-year lease, with its option to renew for another five years.
The optional period has not been included in the initial assessment of the lease term. Lester acquires
Wester, which has been leasing a floor in another building. The lease entered into by Wester
contains a termination option that is exercisable by Wester. Following the acquisition of Wester,
Lester needs two floors in a building suitable for the increased workforce of the combined companies.
To minimise costs, Lester (a) enters into a separate eight-year lease of another floor in the building it
currently occupies that will be available for use at the end of Year 7 and (b) terminates early the
lease entered into by Wester with effect from the beginning of Year 8. Wester will then move into the
new floor leased by Lester.
Lester's incremental borrowing rate at the end of Year 6 is 6% per annum.
TT2020
619
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Solution
Moving Wester's staff to the same building occupied by Lester creates an economic incentive for
Lester to extend its original lease at the end of the non-cancellable period of ten years. The
acquisition of Wester and the relocation of Wester's staff is a significant event that is within the
control of Lester and affects whether Lester is reasonably certain to exercise the extension option
not previously included in its determination of the lease term. This is because the original floor has
greater utility (and thus provides greater benefits) to Lester than alternative assets that could be
leased for a similar amount to the lease payments for the optional period – Lester would incur
additional costs if it were to lease a similar floor in a different building because the workforce
would be located in different buildings. Consequently, at the end of Year 6, Lester concludes that
it is now reasonably certain to exercise the option to extend its original lease as a result of its
acquisition and planned relocation of Wester.
Lester remeasures the lease liability at the present value of four payments of $50,000 followed by
five payments of $55,000, all discounted at the revised discount rate of 6% per annum.
Illustration 6
Sale and leaseback: Selling price greater than fair value (additional financing)
(Adapted from IFRS 16 Illustrative Example 24)
Selleasy Co sells a building to Buylesser for $800,000 cash. The carrying amount of the building
prior to the sale was $600,000. Selleasy arranges to lease the building back for five years at
$120,000 per annum, payable in arrears. The remaining economic life of the building is 15 years.
The transaction satisfies the performance obligations in IFRS 15, so will be accounted for as a sale
and leaseback.
At the date of the sale the fair value of the building was $750,000, so the excess $50,000 paid by
the buyer is recognised as additional financing provided by Buylesser.
The interest rate implicit in the lease is 4.5% and the present value of the annual payments is:
$
120,000/1.045 114,833
120,000/1.0452 109,888
120,000/1.0453 105,155
120,000/1.0454 100,627
120,000/1.0455 96,294
526,797
Of this, $476,797 relates to the lease and $50,000 relates to the additional financing.
At the commencement date, the seller-lessee measures the right-of-use asset arising from the
leaseback of the building at the proportion of the previous carrying amount of the building that
relates to the right of use retained. This is calculated as carrying amount × discounted lease
payments/fair value.
In this example: $600,000 × $476,797/$750,000 = $381,437
Selleasy only recognises the amount of gain that relates to the rights transferred. The gain on sale of
the building is $150,000 (750,000 – 600,000), of which:
(a) $150,000 × $476,797/$750,000 = $95,360 – relates to the rights retained
(b) The balance: $150,000 – $95,360 = $54,640 – relates to the rights transferred to the buyer.
620
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
9: Leases
At the commencement date the lessee accounts for the transaction as follows:
$ $
DEBIT Cash 800,000
DEBIT Right-of-use asset 381,437
CREDIT Building 600,000
CREDIT Financial liability 526,797
CREDIT Gain on rights transferred 54,640
The right-of-use asset will be depreciated over five years; the gain will be recognised in profit or loss
and the financial liability will be increased each year by the interest charge and reduced by the
lease payments.
TT2020
621
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
622
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Share-based payment
Essential reading
TT2020 623
1 Background to IFRS 2
1.1 Arguments against recognition of share-based payment in the
financial statements
There are a number of arguments against recognition of share-based payments in the financial
statements. The IASB has considered and rejected the arguments below.
(a) No cost therefore no charge
There is no cost to the entity because the granting of shares or options does not require the
entity to sacrifice cash or other assets. Therefore, a charge should not be recognised.
This argument is unsound because it ignores the fact that a transaction has occurred. The
employees have provided valuable services to the entity in return for valuable shares or
options.
(b) Earnings per share is hit twice
It is argued that the charge to profit or loss for the employee services consumed reduces the
entity's earnings, while at the same time there is an increase in the number of shares issued.
However, the dual impact on earnings per share simply reflects the two economic events that
have occurred.
(i) The entity has issued shares or options, thus increasing the denominator of the earnings
per share calculation.
(ii) It has also consumed the resources it received for those shares or options, thus reducing
the numerator.
(c) Adverse economic consequences
It could be argued that entities might be discouraged from introducing or continuing employee
share plans if they were required to recognise them on the financial statements. However, if
this happened, it might be because the requirement for entities to account properly for
employee share plans had revealed the economic consequences of such plans.
A situation where entities are able to obtain and consume resources by issuing valuable shares
or options without having to account for such transactions could be perceived as a distortion.
2 Scope of IFRS 2
IFRS 2 applies to all share-based payment transactions (IFRS 2: para. 2).
624
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10: Share-based payment
Illustration 1
Share-based payment
J&B granted 200 options on its $1 ordinary shares to each of its 800 employees on 1 January
20X1. Each grant is conditional upon the employee being employed by J&B until 31 December 20X3.
J&B estimated at 1 January 20X1 that:
(i) The fair value of each option was $4 (before adjustment for the possibility of forfeiture).
(ii) Approximately 50 employees would leave during 20X1, 40 during 20X2 and 30 during 20X3
thereby forfeiting their rights to receive the options. The departures were expected to be evenly
spread within each year.
The exercise price of the options was $1.50 and the market value of a J&B share on 1 January 20X1
was $3.
In the event, only 40 employees left during 20X1 (and the estimate of total departures was revised
down to 95 at 31 December 20X1), 20 during 20X2 (and the estimate of total departures was
revised to 70 at 31 December 20X2) and none during 20X3, spread evenly during each year.
Required
The directors of J&B have asked you to illustrate how the scheme is accounted for under IFRS 2
Share-based Payment.
(a) Show the double entries for the charge to profit or loss for employee services over the three
years and for the share issue, assuming all employees entitled to benefit from the scheme
exercised their rights and the shares were issued on 31 December 20X3.
(b) Explain how your solution would differ had J&B offered its employees cash based on the share
value rather than share options.
TT2020
625
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Solution
(a) Accounting entries
31.12.X1 $ $
DEBIT Profit or loss (staff costs) 188,000
CREDIT Equity reserve ((800 – 95) 200 $4 1/3) 188,000
31.12.X2
DEBIT Profit or loss (staff costs) (W1) 201,333
CREDIT Equity reserve 201,333
31.12.X3
DEBIT Profit or loss (staff costs) (W2) 202,667
CREDIT Equity reserve 202,667
Issue of shares
DEBIT Cash (740 200 $1.50) 222,000
DEBIT Equity reserve 592,000
CREDIT Share capital (740 200 $1) 148,000
CREDIT Share premium (balancing figure) 666,000
Workings
1 Equity reserve at 31.12.X2
£$
Equity b/d 188,000
P/L charge 201,333
Equity c/d ((800 – 70) 200 $4 2/3) 389,333
The movement in the accrual would be charged to profit or loss representing further entitlements
received during the year and adjustments to expectations accrued in previous years.
The accrual would continue to be adjusted (resulting in a profit or loss charge) for changes in
the fair value of the right over the period between when the rights become fully vested and are
subsequently exercised. It would then be reduced for cash payments as the rights are exercised.
626
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Changes in group
structures: step
acquisitions
Essential reading
TT2020
627
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
628
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
12: Changes in group structures: step acquisitions
Solution
(a) Following the IFRS 3 principles, the investment in associate is calculated as follows:
Do not record the initial 10% investment at its 1 June 20X7
The new 15% investment is
cost of $8m. Instead, record it at its fair value of $9m at the
recorded at its cost on the date
date significant influence is achieved (1 June 20X8), as in
significant influence is achieved
substance, a 25% associate was 'purchased' on 1 June
(1 June 20X8). In substance, it is
20X7. No gain on remeasurement of the 10% investment is
as if Bravado 'purchased' a 25%
recognised in this Illustration because the investment had
associate on 1 June 20X8.
already been remeasured to fair value at 31 May 20X8 in
the parent's (Bravado's) individual accounts.
$m
Cost = fair value at date significant influence is achieved ($9m + $11m) 20.0
(b) Following the IAS 28 principles for equity accounting, the investment in associate is
calculated as follows:
$m
Cost = fair value at date significant influence is achieved ($8m + $11m) 19.0
Share of post-acquisition reserves ($10m 25%) 2.5
Investment in associate 21.5
TT2020
629
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
630
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Non-current assets held
for sale and
discontinued operations
Essential reading
TT2020
631
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
1 Discontinued operations
632
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
This is indeed what happened. Lifetime credit losses on the loan notes at 1 January 20X4 were
estimated to be $4 million. Other than recording the cash received on 31 December 20X4, no
further adjustments have been made. The letter was not considered an adjusting event after the
reporting period affecting the 20X3 financial statements.
(d) No adjustments have yet been made for Balboa's defined benefit pension plan; details as
follows:
$m
Present value of obligation at 31 December 20X3 150
Fair value of plan assets at 31 December 20X3 175
Market yield on high quality corporate bonds 4%
Current service cost 12
On 31 December 20X4, given the surplus on the plan, the plan rules were changed to
improve benefits. This resulted in an additional liability of $3 million from that date.
The net pension cost is treated as a cost of sale.
Remeasurement of the defined benefit plan obligation and assets at the year end generated a
net gain of $5 million.
(e) Calculations conducted at the year end showed the recoverable amount (based on continuing
use) of Borbon to be $1,610 million at 31 December 20X4. Impairment losses on goodwill
are charged to cost of sales.
Balboa elected to measure the non-controlling interests of both subsidiaries at the date of
acquisition at the proportionate share of the fair value of the acquiree's identifiable assets
acquired and liabilities assumed.
(f) Assume that profits accrue evenly throughout the year and ignore any taxation effects.
Required
Prepare a consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the Balboa
Group for the year ended 31 December 20X4 in accordance with International Financial Reporting
Standards.
Notes to the financial statements are not required.
The profit and total comprehensive income figures attributable to owners of the parent and
attributable to non-controlling interests need not be subdivided into continuing and discontinued
operations.
Ignore the time value of money in part (c).
Solution
TT2020
633
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
BALBOA GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME FOR
THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X4
$m
Continuing operations
Revenue
Cost of sales
Gross profit
Other income
Distribution costs
Administrative expenses
Finance income
Finance costs
Profit before tax
Income tax expense
Profit for the year from continuing operations
Discontinued operations
Profit for the year from discontinued operations
PROFIT FOR THE YEAR
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax
Total comprehensive income for the year
Workings
1 Group structure and timeline
Timeline
634
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
% % % %
TT2020
635
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
7 Goodwill
Borbon Carbonell
$m $m
Consideration transferred
Non-controlling interests
Fair value of net assets at acq'n
8 Impairment losses
Borbon Carbonell
$m $m
'Notional' goodwill
Carrying amount of net assets (W9)/(W10)
Recoverable amount
Fair value less costs to sell
Impairment loss: gross
636
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
Activity answer
Borbon Carbonell
Carbonell is a discontinued operation (IFRS 5).
TT2020
637
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Timeline
SPLOCI
Balboa (parent) – all year
Carbonell 3/12
(discontinued)
2 Non-controlling interests (SPLOCI)
Profit for the year Total comp. income
Borbon Carbonell Borbon Carbonell
$m $m $m $m
PFY/TCI per question 180 220
(270 8/12)/(330 8/12)
(40 3/12)/(80 3/12) 10 20
Less fair value depreciation (W6) (10) (10)
170 10 210 20
10% 30% 10% 30%
17 3 21 6
20 27
3 Dividend payment by Borbon
Amount received by Balboa = $50m 90% = $45m.
Not included in consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income.
4 Loan note asset held by Balboa
At 1.1.X4
Stage 3 has now been reached as there is objective evidence of impairment. Therefore, an
allowance for lifetime credit losses of $4 million needs to be made in the statement of financial
position with a corresponding expense in profit or loss (finance costs).
$m
Carrying amount of loan at 1.1.X4 (amortised cost) 113
Allowance for credit losses at 1.1.X4 (4)
Net carrying amount of loan at 1.1.X4 109
At 31.12.X4
As Stage 3 has been reached, IFRS 9 requires effective interest to be calculated on the
carrying amount net of the allowance for credit losses; ie $109 million.
The net carrying amount at 31.12.X4 will then be cleared to zero through the repayment of
the principal by the loan note holder.
$m
Gross carrying amount of loan 1.1.X4 113
Effective interest income (109 5.5%) 6
Gross carrying amount at 31.12.X4 119
Allowance for credit losses at 31.12.X4 (4)
Net carrying amount at 31.12.X4 115
638
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
14: Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations
640
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Joint arrangements
and group disclosures
Essential reading
TT2020
641
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
1 Joint arrangements
1.1 Contractual arrangements
The existence of a contractual agreement distinguishes a joint arrangement from an investment in an
associate. If there is no contractual arrangement, then a joint arrangement does not
exist.
The contractual arrangement sets out the terms upon which the parties participate in the activity that
is the subject of the arrangement (IFRS 11: para. B4).
The contractual arrangement generally deals with such matters as (IFRS 11: para. B4):
(a) The purpose, activity and duration of the joint arrangement;
(b) How the members of the board of directors, or equivalent governing body, of the joint
arrangement, are appointed;
(c) The decision-making process: the matters requiring decisions from the parties, the
voting rights of the parties and the required level of support for those matters;
(d) The capital or other contributions required of the parties; and
(e) How the parties share assets, liabilities, revenues, expenses or profit or loss
relating to the joint arrangement.
The terms of the contractual arrangement are key to deciding whether the arrangement is a joint
venture or joint operation. IFRS 11 includes a table of issues to consider, and explains the influence
of a range of points that could be included in the contract (IFRS 11: para. B27). The table is
summarised below.
The terms of The parties to the joint arrangement have The parties to the joint
the contractual rights to the assets, and obligations for the arrangement have rights to the
arrangement liabilities, relating to the arrangement. net assets of the arrangement
(ie it is the separate vehicle, not
the parties, that has rights to the
assets, and obligations for the
liabilities).
Rights to assets The parties to the joint arrangement share The assets brought into the
all interests (eg rights, title or ownership) in arrangement or subsequently
the assets relating to the arrangement in a acquired by the joint
specified proportion (eg in proportion to arrangement are the
the parties' ownership interest in the arrangement's assets. The
arrangement or in proportion to the activity parties have no interests (ie no
carried out through the arrangement that is rights, title or ownership) in the
directly attributed to them). assets of the arrangement.
642
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
15: Joint arrangements and group disclosures
Obligations for The parties share all liabilities, obligations, The joint arrangement is liable
liabilities costs and expenses in a specified for the debts and obligations of
proportion (eg in proportion to their the arrangement.
ownership interest in the arrangement
or in proportion to the activity carried out The parties are liable to the
through the arrangement that is directly arrangement only to the extent
attributed to them). of:
Their respective investments
in the arrangement;
Their respective obligations
to contribute any unpaid or
additional capital to the
arrangement; or
Both.
Guarantees The parties to joint arrangements are often required to provide guarantees to
third parties that, for example, receive a service from, or provide financing
to, the joint arrangement. The provision of guarantees to third parties, or the
commitment by the parties to provide them, does not, by itself, determine that
the joint arrangement is a joint operation.
TT2020
643
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
644
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Group statements of
cash flows
Essential reading
TT2020 645
Management
• Cash flow provides more relevant information on which decisions should be taken.
• Cash flow accounting can be both retrospective and include a forecast for the future.
This is of great information value to all users of accounting information.
• Forecasts can subsequently be monitored by the use of variance statements which
compare actual cash flows against the forecast.
Users of cash
flow information
Shareholders
• Creditors (long- and short-term) are more
• Survival of a company depends on its ability to interested in an entity's ability to repay them than
generate cash. Cash flow accounting directs attention in its profitability.
towards this critical issue.
• Could be misled by profit accounting; eg creditors
• Cash flow accounting can be better for stewardship might consider that a profitable company is a
as cash flows are objective and not subject to manipulation. going concern
• Cash flow reporting provides a better means of comparing For example, if a company builds up large amounts
the results of different companies than traditional profit of unsold inventories of goods, their cost would
reporting. not be chargeable against profits, but cash would
• It helps manage expectations about potential dividend have been used up in making them, thus weakening
payments. Shareholders might believe that a company the company's liquid resources.
could pay all its profits as a dividend. The statement of
cash flows helps them understand the impact of cash
payments.
646
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
TT2020 647
647
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Illustration 1
Preparation of a statement of cash flows for a single entity
Below are the statements of financial position for Raglan at 31 December 20X7 and 31 December
20X8, and the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the year ended
31 December 20X8.
648
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Non-current liabilities
4% loan notes 250 100
Deferred tax 76 54
Provision for warranties 30 26
356 180
Current liabilities
Trade payables 152 146
Current tax payable 26 24
Interest payable 5 –
183 170
Total equity and liabilities 1,540 1,200
TT2020 649
649
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Notes
(1) Depreciation of property, plant and equipment during 20X8 was $54,000 and capitalised
development expenditure amortised was $25,000.
(2) Proceeds from the sale of equipment were $58,000, giving rise to a profit of $7,000. No
other items of property, plant and equipment were disposed of during the year.
(3) Finance costs represent interest paid on the loan notes. New loan notes were issued on
1 January 20X8.
(4) The company revalued its property at the year end. Company policy is to treat revaluations as
realised profits when the asset is retired or disposed of.
(5) Expenses include wages paid of $44,000 and bad debts of $12,000.
Required
(a) Prepare a statement of cash flows for Raglan for the year ended 31 December 20X8, using
the indirect method in accordance with IAS 7.
(b) Prepare the 'cash flows from operating activities' section using the direct method.
650
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Solution
(a) RAGLAN STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS FOR YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X8
(INDIRECT METHOD)
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before tax 100
Adjustments for:
Depreciation 54
Amortisation 25
Interest expense 10
Profit on disposal of equipment (7)
182
Increase in inventories (W4) (33)
Increase in trade receivables (W4) (22)
Increase in trade payables (W4) 6
Increase in provisions (W4) 4
Cash generated from operations 137
Interest paid (W3) (5)
Income taxes paid (W3) (24)
Net cash from operating activities 108
TT2020 651
651
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
2 Equity
Share capital/ Retained
share premium earnings
$'000 $'000
(200 + 80) 280 570
Opening balance (b/d)
Profit for the year 70
Non-cash items – –
Cash (paid)/rec'd β 80 (41)
Closing balance (c/d) (220 + 140) 360 599
3 Liabilities
Loan Income tax Interest
notes payable payable
$'000 $'000 $'000
Opening balance (b/d) 100 (54 + 24) 78 –
SPLOCI* – P/L 30 10
– OCI 18
Non-cash items – – –
Cash (paid)/rec'd β 150 (24) (5)
Closing balance (c/d) 250 (76 + 26) 102 5
(b) RAGLAN
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES (DIRECT METHOD)
$'000 $'000
Cash flows from operating activities
Cash receipts from customers (W1) 1,066
Cash paid to suppliers and employees (W2) (929)
Cash generated from operations 137
Interest paid (from part (a)) (5)
Income taxes paid (from part (a)) (24)
Net cash from operating activities 108
652
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Workings
1 Cash received from customers
Trade
receivables
$'000
Opening balance (b/d) 186
Revenue 1,100
Non-cash (bad debt) (12)
Cash received β (1,066)
Closing balance (c/d) 208
2 Cash paid to suppliers and employees
Trade
payables
$'000
Opening balance (b/d) 146
Purchases and other 935
expenses (W3)
Cash (paid) β (929)
Closing balance (c/d) 152
Inventory adjustments:
Opening inventories (280)
Closing inventories 313
Non-cash expenses:
Depreciation (54)
Amortisation (25)
Bad debts (12)
Increase in provision (4)
935
TT2020 653
653
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Illustration 2
Preparation of a consolidated statement of cash flows
On 1 October 20X8 P acquired 90% of S by issuing 100 million shares at an agreed value of
$1.60 per share and $140m in cash. At that time the statement of financial position of S (equivalent
to the fair value of the assets and liabilities) was as follows:
$m
Property, plant and equipment 190
Inventories 70
Trade receivables 30
Cash and cash equivalents 10
Trade payables (40)
260
Group policy is to measure non-controlling interests at the date of acquisition at the proportionate
share of net assets.
The consolidated statements of financial position of P as at 31 December were as follows:
20X8 20X7
$m $m
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment 2,642 2,300
Goodwill 60 –
2,702 2,300
Current assets
Inventories 1,450 1,200
Trade receivables 1,370 1,100
Cash and cash equivalents 2 50
2,822 2,350
5,524 4,650
Equity attributable to owners of the parent
Share capital ($1 ordinary shares) 1,150 1,000
Share premium account 590 500
Retained earnings 1,778 1,530
Revaluation surplus 74 –
3,592 3,030
Non-controlling interests 32 –
3,624 3,030
Non-current liabilities
Deferred tax 80 40
Current liabilities
Trade payables 1,710 1,520
Current tax 110 60
1,820 1,580
5,524 4,650
654
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the year ended
31 December 20X8 was as follows:
$m
Revenue 10,000
Cost of sales (7,500)
Gross profit 2,500
Administrative expenses (2,083)
Profit before tax 417
Income tax expense (150)
Profit for the year 267
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation 115
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified (40)
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 75
Total comprehensive income for the year 342
TT2020 655
655
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Solution
P GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X8
$m $m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before tax 417
Adjustments for:
Depreciation 210
Impairment of goodwill (W2) 6
633
Increase in inventories (W3) (180)
Increase in trade receivables (W3) (240)
Increase in trade payables (W3) 150
Cash generated from operations 363
Income taxes paid (W7) (100)
Net cash from operating activities 263
Workings
1 Property, plant and equipment
$m
b/d 2,300
Revaluation 115
Depreciation (210)
Acquisition of subsidiary 190
2,395
Additions (balancing figure) 247
c/d 2,642
656
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
2 Goodwill
$m
b/d –
Acquisition of subsidiary* 66
66
Impairment loss (balancing figure) (6)
c/d 60
*Goodwill on acquisition of subsidiary:
$m
Consideration transferred (140 + (100 $1.60)) 300
NCI (260 10%) 26
Less net assets at acquisition (260)
66
TT2020 657
657
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
6 Non-controlling interests
$m
b/d –
NCI share of total comprehensive income 10
Acquisition of subsidiary (W2) 26
36
Dividends paid to NCI (balancing figure) (4)
c/d 32
658
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
TT2020 659
659
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
The statement of financial position of New World at the date of disposal showed:
$m
Property, plant and equipment 370
Inventories 46
Trade receivables 42
Cash and cash equivalents 20
478
Share capital 100
Reserves 340
440
Trade payables 38
478
The non-controlling interests in New World were measured at fair value at the date of
acquisition of $44 million.
Impairment tests conducted annually since the date of acquisition did not reveal any
impairment losses in respect of the consolidated investment in New World.
All other subsidiaries were set up by Columbus and did not have any goodwill.
2 Depreciation charge for the year was $800 million.
There were no disposals of non-current assets other than on the disposal of the subsidiary.
Required
Using the proformas given below, work to the nearest $m and answer the following questions:
(a) How will the disposal appear in the statement of cash flows?
(b) What are the additions to property, plant and equipment?
(c) What is the dividend paid to non-controlling interests?
(d) Prepare the reconciliation of profit before tax to cash generated from operations, as at the top
of the indirect method statement of cash flows.
Solution $m
(a) Cash flows from investing activities
Disposal of subsidiary net of cash disposed of
660
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
$m
(d) Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before tax
Adjustments for:
Workings
1 Purchase of property, plant and equipment
Property, plant
and equipment
$m
b/d
SPLOCI –
Depreciation
Non-cash additions –
Disposal of subsidiary
Cash paid β
c/d
b/d
SPLOCI
Non-cash –
Disposal of subsidiary
Cash (paid) β
c/d
b/d
Disposal of subsidiary
Increase/(decrease) β
c/d
TT2020 661
661
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
3 Disclosure
There are additional disclosure requirements in respect of acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries
or other business units during the period. The following amounts should be disclosed (in aggregate):
Total purchase/disposal consideration
Portion of purchase/disposal consideration discharged by means of cash/cash equivalents
Amount of cash/cash equivalents in the subsidiary or business unit disposed of
Amount of assets and liabilities other than cash/cash equivalents in the subsidiary or business
unit acquired or disposed of, summarised by major category (IAS 7: paras. 39–40, 42)
662
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
17: Group statements of cash flows
Activity answer
$m
(a) Cash flows from investing activities
Disposal of subsidiary net of cash disposed of (420 – 20) 400
Workings
1 Purchase of property, plant and equipment
PPE
$m
b/d 3,909
SPLOCI –
Depreciation (800)
Non-cash additions –
Disposal of subsidiary (370)
Cash paid β 1,328
c/d 4,067
*NCI at acquisition 44
NCI share of post acq'n reserves ((340 – 80) 20%) 52
96
TT2020 663
663
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Trade Trade
Inventories receivables payables
$m $m $m
b/d 535 417 408
Disposal of subsidiary (46) (42) (38)
Increase/(decrease) β 247 230 10
c/d 736 605 380
664
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Interpreting financial
statements for different
stakeholders
Essential reading
TT2020 665
1 Ratio analysis
Ratio analysis involves comparing one figure against another to produce a ratio, assessing
whether that ratio indicates a weakness or strength in the company's affairs and identifying a reason
for that change based on information provided for that company or the market in which it operates.
You are unlikely to be asked to calculate many ratios in the SBR exam, or not directly at any rate. If,
say, you were asked to comment on a company's past or potential future performance, you would be
expected to select your own ratios in order to do so. The skill here is picking appropriate ratios in
the context of the question. For example, non-current asset turnover will be more relevant to a
company in the manufacturing sector than the services sector.
A question could also ask for the impact on a specified ratio of certain accounting
treatments or you may be required to correct errors then recalculate the specified ratio.
Ratios are commonly categorised into the following types.
Financial performance
Financial position
1.1 Profitability
1.1.1 Return on capital employed (ROCE)
Return on capital employed measures how efficiently a company uses its capital to
generate profits. A potential investor or lender should compare the return to a target return or a
return on other investments/loans.
1.1.2 Return on equity (ROE)
Profit after tax and preference dividends
ROE = %
Ordinary share capital + reserves
While the return on capital employed looks at the overall return on the long-term sources of finance,
return on equity focuses on the return for the ordinary shareholders.
666
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Gross profit
Gross profit margin = 100%
Revenue
The gross profit margin measures how well a company is running its core operations.
1.1.4 Operating profit margin
Profit before interest and tax
Operating profit margin = 100%
Revenue
Profit before interest and taxation (PBIT) is used because it avoids distortion when comparisons are
made between two different companies where one is heavily financed by means of loans, and the
other is financed entirely by ordinary share capital. The extra consideration for the operating margin
over the gross margin is how well the company is controlling its non-production
overheads.
1.1.5 Net profit margin
1.2 Efficiency
1.2.1 Asset turnover
Revenue Revenue
Asset turnover =
Capital employed Total assets less current liabilities
This ratio shows how much revenue is produced per unit of capital invested. Therefore, it is a
measure of how efficiently the entity is using its capital to generate revenue.
1.2.2 Total asset turnover
Revenue
Total asset turnover =
Total assets
Total asset turnover is an indication of how efficiently the entity is using its assets to
generate revenue.
1.2.3 Non-current asset turnover
Revenue
Non-current asset turnover =
Non - current assets
This ratio specifically examines the productivity of non-current assets in generating sales. It is
suitable for a capital-intensive entity, for example, a manufacturing company.
1.2.4 Making sense of profitability and efficiency ratios
Listed below are possible reasons for changes in the above ratios year on year or differences
between two entities.
Return on capital employed (ROCE) and asset turnover ratios
(a) Type of industry (eg a manufacturing company will typically have higher assets and therefore
lower ROCE/asset turnover than a services or knowledge based company)
(b) Age of assets (eg old asset = low carrying amount (CA) = low capital employed and high
ROCE/asset turnover)
TT2020
667
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
This is a measure of the amount of profit available for each share held.
Earnings per share is considered in more detail in section 2 as it has its own accounting standard
(IAS 33 Earnings per Share).
1.3.2 Price/earnings (P/E ratio)
Current market price per share
P/E ratio =
EPS
The P/E ratio is a measure of the market's confidence in the future of an entity.
668
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
This is a useful ratio for an investor seeking capital growth and it shows the portion of the profit
to be reinvested into the business for future growth (rather than being paid out as dividends).
1.3.3 Dividend payout rate
Cash dividend per share
Dividend payout rate = 100%
EPS
This ratio is useful for an income-seeking investor as it shows portion of profit paid out to
investors in the form of a dividend.
1.3.4 Dividend yield
Dividend per share
Dividend yield = 100%
Market price per share
This ratio gives the cash return on the investment (valued at current market value). It is useful
for an income-seeking investor.
1.3.5 Dividend cover
EPS
Dividend cover =
Dividend per share
This ratio shows how easily an entity can allocate dividends out of its profits. It does not
consider whether there is cash available to pay dividends.
1.4 Liquidity
1.4.1 Current ratio
Current assets
Current ratio =
Current liabilities
This ratio measures a company's ability to pay its current liabilities out of its current
assets. The industry the company operates in should be taken into consideration. For example, a
supermarket has low receivables (mainly cash sales), low inventory (as perishable) and high
payables (superior bargaining power) so overall will have a low current ratio.
1.4.2 Quick ratio
Current assets – Inventory
Quick ratio (acid test) =
Current liabilities
This is similar to the current ratio except that it omits the inventories figure from current assets.
This is because inventories are the least liquid current asset that a company has, as it has to be
sold, turned into receivables and then the cash has to be collected. This is a more reliable measure
as businesses will not be able to use inventories to pay off payables quickly.
This ratio shows, on average, how long it takes for the trade receivables to settle their
account with the company. The average credit term granted to customers should be taken into
account as well as the efficiency of the credit control function within the company.
1.5.2 Inventory holding period
Inventories
Inventory holding period = 365 days*
Cost of sales
This ratio measures the number of days inventories are held by a company on average
before they are sold. This figure will depend on the type of goods sold by the company. A company
selling fresh fruit and vegetables should have low inventory holding periods as these goods will
quickly become inedible. A manufacturer of aged wine will by default have very long inventory
holding periods. It is important for a company to keep its inventory days as low as possible, subject
of course to being able to meet its customers' demands.
1.5.3 Payables payment period
Trade payables
Payables payment period = 365
Purchases
Use cost of sales if purchases are not disclosed.
This ratio is measuring the time it takes the company to settle its trade payable
balances. Trade payables provide the company with a valuable source of short-term finance, but
delaying payment for too long a period of time can cause operational problems as suppliers may
stop providing goods and services until payment is received.
1.5.4 Working capital cycle
The working capital cycle (also known as the 'cash operating cycle') includes cash, receivables,
inventories and payables. It effectively represents the time between payment of cash for inventories
and eventual receipt of cash from sale of the inventories.
It shows the number of days for which finance is required. Therefore, ideally the shorter it is, the
better. However, it will vary from industry to industry.
The length of the cycle is determined using the working capital management ratios:
Inventory Receivables
Buy holding period Sell collection period Receive
inventories inventories cash from
receivables
Payables
Working capital
payment period
cycle
Pay
payables
670
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Long-term debt
Debt/(Debt + Equity) = 100%
Long-term debt Equity
Note. What to include in 'long-term debt' is subjective and will often vary from company to
company. Typically, interest-bearing borrowings such as bank loans and lease liabilities are
included. An overdraft should also be included if it is being used as a source of long-term finance.
Pension liabilities and preference shares classified as a financial liability may also be included.
Gearing is concerned with the long-term financial stability of the company. It looks at how
much the company is financed by debt. The advantage of debt is that it is a cheaper source of
finance than equity as interest is tax deductible. However, the higher the gearing ratio, the less
secure will be the financing of the company and possibly the company's future.
1.6.2 Interest cover
PBIT
Interest cover =
Interest expense
The interest cover ratio considers the number of times a company could pay its interest
payments using its profit from operations. The main concern is that a company should not
have so much debt finance that it risks not being able to settle the debt as it falls due.
Eg: Profitability has deteriorated because the entity has used a new higher priced supplier in
the period. Consider whether there are any non-financial consequences – does the new
supplier have a higher ethical standard or does it offer a higher quality product that is more
reliable for customers?
TT2020
671
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
(d) You should consider the implication of ratios on the entity and other stakeholders.
(e) Consider whether the entity has undertaken any transactions/events in the year that
have a significant impact on ratios.
Eg: An issue of debt in the year will impact gearing and interest cover ratios. Why did the
entity issue the debt – is it restructuring? Is it investing in assets? Don't just assume that an
increase in gearing is necessarily a 'bad' thing if there will be other benefits for the entity.
(f) Consider the impact of different accounting policies and of different types of
entity on ratios.
Eg: An entity that revalues its land and buildings regularly might have a lower return on assets
than a very similar entity that holds its land and buildings at historical cost.
A wholesale sofa manufacturer with a 30-day credit period will have a much lower
receivables collection period than a retailer of sofas that offers three years' interest-free credit.
An entity that offers digital services will have relatively high employee costs, low property,
plant and equipment and low inventory levels compared to a manufacturing company.
Note that ratios disclosed in annual reports, other than EPS which is required by IAS 33, are
considered to be additional performance measures.
672
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
20X7 20X6
$'000 $'000
Current liabilities
Payables (4,660) (2,890)
Bank overdraft (280) (40)
Wheels secured a large new contract to supply goods to a large department store across a two year
period from 1 April 20X7. Wheels normally offers wholesale customers 30 days' credit, but the
department store would only agree to the contract with 90 days credit terms. The directors of Wheels
agreed to this as they believed it was worth it to have their products placed with this department
store. Wheels has an average 45 day credit from its suppliers. Wheels uses its bank overdraft to
fund working capital and currently has a limit of $300,000.
Required
(a) Calculate the relevant ratios in respect of the liquidity of Wheels.
(b) Analyse the liquidity of Wheels from the entity's perspective.
Limitation Example
Change in nature of the business or The launch of a new product or entry into a new
geographical areas in which the entity geographical market
operates
Increasing costs or a change in the Rising energy costs, agreeing to pay staff the living wage
value of the currency or a weakening of the home currency making foreign
imports more expensive; can make a simple comparison
difficult as these factors would mean that inconsistencies
would exist between periods
Changes in accounting policies A change from using the FIFO method to the average cost
method under IAS 2; is likely to reduce the cost of closing
inventories and increase cost of sales which has an
impact on gross and net profit margins and the inventory
holding period
Limitation Example
Different accounting policies An entity that revalues PPE will have higher depreciation
than one that does not revalue, reducing its margins and
return on capital employed.
Operating at different ends of the sector Low price/high volume versus luxury items with high sales
prices resulting in different profit margins.
Slightly different range of activities Supermarkets now often operate in food, retail clothing
within the business and financial services. The product mix and therefore
margins will vary from entity to entity.
Difference in size of entities Larger entities may benefit from economies of scale and
better margins.
The age of the business This could impact the P/E ratio. A new entity may have a
lower P/E ratio than an established entity as it may be
perceived to be higher risk.
Age of assets The older the assets, the lower the capital employed and
the lower the depreciation which could result in a higher
ROCE for an entity with older assets.
P/E ratio often impacted by factors Some entities might be impacted more than others by
outside the control of the entity factors influencing the market generally (eg recession) or
macro-economic factors (eg interest rate changes).
674
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Limitation Example
Different economic environments with Examples: minimum wage, quotas, local taxes on goods
different cultural pressures shipped in or out of country, environmental legislation.
Listed on stock markets with different A small illiquid market may have lower share prices as
levels of liquidity there is less activity in the market, causing a lower P/E
ratio.
The major intragroup comparison organisations (whose results are intended for the use of
participating companies and are not generally available) go to considerable length to adjust
accounts to comparable bases.
The external user will rarely be in a position to make such adjustments. Although the position is
improved by increases in disclosure requirements, direct comparisons between companies will
inevitably, on occasion, continue to give rise to misleading results.
Ordinary share: An equity instrument that is subordinate to all other classes of equity instruments.
Key terms Potential ordinary share: A financial instrument or other contract that may entitle its holder to
ordinary shares.
Options, warrants and their equivalents: Financial instruments that give the holder the right
to purchase ordinary shares.
Contingently issuable ordinary shares: Ordinary shares issuable for little or no cash or other
consideration upon the satisfaction of certain conditions in a contingent share agreement.
Contingent share agreement: An agreement to issue shares that is dependent on the
satisfaction of specified conditions.
Dilution: A reduction in earnings per share or an increase in loss per share resulting from the
assumption that convertible instruments are converted, that options or warrants are exercised, or that
ordinary shares are issued upon the satisfaction of certain conditions.
Antidilution: An increase in earnings per share or a reduction in loss per share resulting from the
assumption that convertible instruments are converted, that options or warrants are exercised, or that
ordinary shares are issued upon the satisfaction of certain conditions.
(IAS 33: paras. 5–7)
TT2020
675
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Basic EPS should be calculated by dividing the net profit or loss for the period attributable to
ordinary equity holders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding
during the period (para. 10).
Net profit or loss attributable to ordinary equity holders of the patent entity
EPS = cents
Weighed average no. of ordinary equity shares outstanding during the period
3.2.1 Earnings
The net profit or loss attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent is the consolidated profit
after:
Income taxes
Non-controlling interests
Preference dividends (on preference shares which have been classified as equity)
Note. Preference dividends on preference shares which have been classified as a financial liability
do not need to be deducted as they will already have been reported in the profit figure as a finance
cost.
(paras. 12–14).
3.2.2 Number of shares
The number of ordinary shares used should be the weighted average number of ordinary shares
during the period. This figure (for all periods presented) should be adjusted for events (other than
the conversion of potential ordinary shares) which have changed the number of shares outstanding
without a corresponding change in resources (para. 19).
676
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
(c) Any other changes in income or expenses (fees and discount, premium accounted for
as yield adjustments) that would result from the conversion of the dilutive potential ordinary
shares, or changes in for example employee bonuses if linked to profit
3.3.2 Diluted number of shares
The number of ordinary shares is the weighted average number of ordinary shares calculated for
basic EPS plus the weighted average number of ordinary shares that would be issued on the
conversion of all the dilutive potential ordinary shares into ordinary shares (para. 36).
It should be assumed that dilutive ordinary shares were converted into ordinary shares at the
beginning of the period or, if later, at the actual date of issue.
The computation assumes the most advantageous conversion rate or exercise rate from the
standpoint of the holder of the potential ordinary shares.
TT2020
677
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
There are two basic approaches for using the GRI Standards:
(a) Using the GRI Standards as a set to prepare a sustainability report in accordance with the
Standards.
(b) Using selected Standards, or parts of their content, to report specific information.
(GRI 101: Foundation, p21)
There are three universal standards (known as the '100 series') that apply to every organisation
which prepares a sustainability report, followed by a series of topic-specific standards. The universal
standards are:
Standard Description
GRI 101: Foundation GRI 101sets out the reporting principles that an organisation must
apply if it wishes to claim its sustainability report has been prepared
in accordance with GRI Standards. There are principles for defining
the report content and principles for defining the report quality. More
detail on the reporting principles is given in section 4.1. GRI 101 is
used alongside GRI 102 and GRI 103.
GRI 102: General GR1 102 sets out the general disclosures required in respect of an
Disclosures organisation's:
Profile, such as the type of activities in which engages, the
location in which its headquarters are based and where it
operates, the type of industry and market in which it operates,
information relating to its employees and its supply chain.
Strategy including the risks and opportunities it is exposed to.
Ethics and integrity which includes the entity's corporate values,
the standards it sets for itself and how it deals with concerns and
issues regarding ethics.
Governance such as the senior management structure and
remuneration policies in place, the process for risk identification
and management and how conflicts of interest are managed.
Stakeholder engagement practices including how stakeholders
and their needs are identified and the approach to stakeholder
engagement.
Reporting process which defines the report content, the reporting
period covered, any changes in reported information from one
period to the next and any external assurance offered.
GRI 103: Management An organisation's management approach refers to the policies and
Approach actions in respect of specific topics. Topics come under the headings
economic, environmental or social and there are various sub-topics
within these headings.
GRI 103 reports information about how an organisation manages a
material topic and is applied for all topics within an organisation's
sustainability report. It allows the organisation to provide a narrative
explanation of why the topic is material, where the impacts occur (the
topic 'Boundary'), and how the organisation manages the impacts.
678
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Stakeholder 'The reporting organisation shall identify its stakeholders, and explain
inclusiveness how it has responded to their reasonable expectations and interests.'
(GRI 101: Foundation, p8)
Traditional financial reporting focuses on shareholders and the
maximisation of shareholder wealth. This GRI reporting principle not
only acknowledges other stakeholders but considers what their interest
in the entity is and how they expect the entity to conduct itself. This
should encourage an entity to consider the impact of its actions on its
key stakeholders.
Sustainability context 'The report shall present the reporting organisation's performance in
the wider context of sustainability.' (GRI 101: Foundation, p9)
Traditional financial reporting is often criticised for focusing on
short-term profitability. The GRI principles promote sustainability in a
wider context, including economic sustainability but also environmental
and social sustainability. The GRI principles focus on the longer term,
encouraging entities to consider the risks and opportunities they will
face.
Completeness 'The report shall include coverage of material topics and their
Boundaries, sufficient to reflect significant economic, environmental,
and social impacts, and to enable stakeholders to assess the reporting
organisation's performance in the reporting period.' (GRI 101:
Foundation, p12)
The notion of completeness considers scope (economic, social and
environmental), boundary (whether internal or external to the
organisation) and time (the reporting period and future impacts).
Completeness is judgemental but reports should contain sufficient
information for a user to understand the impact of an organisation's
activities on its performance.
TT2020
679
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Benefit Explanation
680
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Benefit Explanation
Increased focus and One of the Framework's aims is for an integrated report to
awareness by senior provide insight into how an organisation creates value
management on the long over the short, medium and long term. This should encourage
term sustainability of the management to focus on the financial stability and long
business term prospects of the company.
Better articulation of the The Framework identifies eight content elements in relation to
strategy and business model which the integrated report should answer a question. Two of
these elements with their related questions include:
Business model - what is the organisation's business
model?
Strategy and resource allocation - where does the
organisation want to go and how does it intend to get there?
Answering these questions when preparing an integrated report
would provide management with an opportunity to clearly
articulate the organisation's strategy and business model.
Improved performance One of the content elements of an integrated report per the
Framework is 'outlook' which requires the organisation to
consider the challenges and uncertainties is likely to encounter
and the potential implications for its business model and future
performance. This forward-looking approach will allow
management to identify ways of improving its performance in
future years.
Limitation Explanation
Time and cost of preparing an Preparation of an integrated report in accordance with the
integrated report Framework is likely to take a considerable amount of time
(particularly from senior management) and effort.
An integrated report might also require implementation of
new systems and procedures at a cost to the business.
TT2020
681
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Limitation Explanation
It can be challenging to articulate Although the Framework identifies six possible capitals,
what an entity's capitals are and to not all of these may be appropriate to all entities.
determine appropriate measures of Equally alternative capitals not mentioned in the Framework
these capitals may be relevant. Therefore, it can be challenging for
management to identify what their organisation's capitals are.
Furthermore, the Framework requires significant
movements in capital to be quantified and
disclosed where possible but gives no guidance on how
to measure these movements.
7 Management commentary
7.1 Elements of management commentary
IFRS Practice Statement 1: Management Commentary has provided a table relating the five elements
(given in Chapter 18 section 4.4) to its assessments of the needs of the primary users of a
management commentary (existing and potential investors, lenders and creditors).
Nature of the business The knowledge of the business in which an entity is engaged and the
external environment in which it operates
Objectives and To assess the strategies adopted by the entity and the likelihood that those
strategies strategies will be successful in meeting management's stated objectives
Resources, risks and A basis for determining the resources available to the entity as well as
relationships obligations to transfer resources to others; the ability of the entity to
generate long-term sustainable net inflows of resources; and the risks to
which those resource-generating activities are exposed, both in the near
term and in the long term
Results and prospects The ability to understand whether an entity has delivered results in line with
expectations and, implicitly, how well management has understood the
entity's market, executed its strategy and managed the entity's resources,
risks and relationships
Performance measures The ability to focus on the critical performance measures and indicators that
and indicators management uses to assess and manage the entity's performance against
stated objectives and strategies
Advantages Disadvantages
Entity Entity
Promotes the entity, and attracts investors, Costs may outweigh benefits
lenders, customers and suppliers Risk that investors may ignore the financial
Communicates management plans and statements
outlook
682
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Advantages Disadvantages
Users Users
Financial statements not enough to make Subjective
decisions (financial information only) Not normally audited
Financial statements backward looking Could encourage companies to de-list
(need forward looking information) (to avoid requirement to produce MC)
Highlights risks Different countries have different needs
Useful for comparability to other entities
8 Segment reporting
8.1 Aggregation of segments
Two or more operating segments may be aggregated if the segments have similar economic
characteristics, and the segments are similar in each of the following respects (IFRS 8: para. 12):
The nature of the products or services
The nature of the production process
The type or class of customer for their products or services
The methods used to distribute their products or provide their services
If applicable, the nature of the regulatory environment
TT2020
683
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
(a) Revenues from segments below the quantitative thresholds are attributable to four operating
segments of the company. These segments include a small property business, an electronics
equipment rental business, a software consulting practice and a warehouse leasing operation.
None of these segments has ever met any of the quantitative thresholds for determining
reportable segments.
(b) The finance segment derives a majority of its revenue from interest. Management primarily
relies on net interest revenue, not the gross revenue and expense amounts, in managing that
segment. Therefore, as permitted by IFRS 8, only the net amount is disclosed.
684
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Accounting policies Same as annual financial statements, except for accounting policy
changes made since the date of the most recent financial
statements
Revenues received seasonally, Not anticipated or deferred if anticipation or deferral would not be
cyclically, or occasionally appropriate at the year end
Costs incurred unevenly Anticipated or deferred if, and only if, it is also appropriate to
anticipate or defer that type of cost at the year end
TT2020
685
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
Activity answers
Conclusion
It is recommended that Wheels contacts its bank to renegotiate the bank overdraft
as it is likely to breach the overdraft limit in the near future. It should also consider
renegotiating credit terms with key suppliers.
686
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18: Interpreting financial statements for different stakeholders
Entity A has a much stronger gross profit margin than entity B. There may be less competitive
pressure on pricing in its markets, or it may face lower costs for materials and labour.
Comparing their net profit margins, entity B appears stronger. This could be due to the effect of
interest charges on the profits of entity A, which has higher gearing, but could also be due to the
fixed elements of operating expenses having less impact on the profits of the larger company. The
larger company is in a better position to benefit from economies of scale.
Gearing
Entity A has significantly higher gearing than either entity B or LOP. This is probably because of the
low rate of interest available in Frontland (5%). High gearing is quite usual in the construction
industry as debt finance is needed to fund heavy investment in assets. These assets then provide
security for the entity's borrowings, making it easier to raise finance.
The higher gearing makes entity A a riskier investment than entity B. Interest commitments must be
paid irrespective of trading conditions and profitability, unlike equity dividends which are
discretionary. Also, if the borrowings are at variable rates, there is a risk that increases in the interest
rates could damage profits in future.
P/E ratio
The higher P/E ratio of entity B suggests that investors have more confidence in entity B than entity A.
However, both entities have lower P/E ratios than LOP so if LOP wishes to maintain or improve its
P/E ratio, it might wish to seek an alternative target.
Impact on LOP's financial statements
Revenue
Entity B would have the more significant effect on LOP's revenue, increasing it by 60%.
Gross margin
Both entities would decrease the overall gross margin of LOP. Entity A would have only a marginal
effect, but in combination with entity B it would result in a gross margin of 24% (the total gross
margins of LOP and B ((28% × 500) + (17% × 300)) over the combined revenue of $800m).
Net margin
Both entities would have an adverse effect on LOP's net profit margin. Here entity A would have the
more significant effect, reducing the net margin to 14% (the total net margins of LOP and A ((16% ×
500) + (9% 160)) over the combined revenue of $660m).
Gearing
Entity A would increase LOP's gearing and risk exposure. Entity B would decrease LOP's gearing
and risk exposure.
However, investing in entity A would decrease the average rates of interest suffered by the group as
a whole.
P/E ratio
It would appear that both entities would be likely to decrease the P/E ratio of LOP although this
would depend on the market's view of the benefits of the respective purchases and the consequent
change in price post purchase.
Conclusion
Both entities would have an adverse effect on the financial indicators of LOP, so it may be wiser not
to invest in either of them.
If LOP wishes to expand in size, is most interested in profitability in terms of the 'bottom line' net
profit, and is risk averse, then entity B is the more attractive proposition.
TT2020
687
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
688
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Reporting requirements
of small and
medium-sized entities
Essential reading
TT2020 689
1 Background
1.1 Big GAAP/little GAAP divide
In most countries the majority of companies or other types of entity are very small. The owners
have invested their own money in the business and there are no outside shareholders to protect.
Large entities, by contrast, particularly companies listed on a stock exchange, may have
shareholders who have invested their money, possibly through a pension fund, with no knowledge
whatsoever of the company. These shareholders need protection, and the regulations for such
companies need to be more stringent.
It could therefore be argued that company accounts should be of two types:
(a) 'Simple' ones for small companies with fewer regulations and disclosure requirements; and
(b) 'Complicated' ones for larger companies with extensive and detailed requirements.
This is sometimes called the big GAAP/little GAAP divide.
690
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
19: Reporting requirements of small and medium-sized entities
2.2.2 Disadvantages
(a) It does not focus on the smallest companies.
(b) The scope extends to 'non-publicly accountable' entities. Potentially, the scope is too wide.
(c) The standard is still onerous for small companies.
Further simplifications could be made. These might include:
(i) No requirement to value intangibles separately from goodwill on a business combination;
(ii) No recognition of deferred tax;
(iii) No measurement rules for equity-settled share-based payment;
(iv) No requirement for consolidated accounts (as for EU-based small and medium-sized entities
currently); and
(v) Fair value measurement when readily determinable without undue cost or effort.
TT2020
691
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Appendix 2 – Essential reading
692
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
694
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
$320 million and in return acquired Purple's mobile phone business in the other country.
Camel paid $980 million to Purple in addition to the legal transfer of its fixed line ADSL
business. Purple did not make any payment other than the transfer of its mobile business.
Under the terms of the agreement, the mobile phone business will remain under the name
Purple for up to one year, after which Camel time intends to re-brand the business under its
own national and international mobile brand Mobistar. (5 marks)
(e) An embarrassing incident occurred in February 20X8 where a laptop containing details of all
of Camel's national customers and the expiry date of their contracts was stolen. The details
subsequently fell into the hands of competitors who have been contacting Camel's clients
when their Mobistar contracts are up for renewal.
As a result of this Camel has realised that the value of the client details is significant and
proposes to recognise a value determined by Valyou in its financial statements. This valuation
of $44 million takes into account business expected to be lost as a result of the incident.
(4 marks)
Required
Discuss, with suitable computations, how the above transactions should be accounted for in the
financial statements of the Camel Telecom Group under IFRS for the year ended 30 June 20X8.
All amounts are considered material to the group financial statements.
Professional marks for clarity and expression (2 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
5 Acquirer 49 mins
Acquirer is an entity that regularly purchases new subsidiaries. On 30 June 20X0, the entity acquired
all the equity shares of Prospects for a cash payment of $260 million. The net assets of Prospects on
30 June 20X0 were $180 million and no fair value adjustments were necessary upon consolidation
of Prospects for the first time.
On 31 December 20X0, Acquirer carried out a review of the goodwill on consolidation of Prospects
for evidence of impairment. The review was carried out despite the fact that there were no obvious
indications of adverse trading conditions for Prospects. The review involved allocating the net asset
of Prospects into three cash-generating units and computing the value in use of each unit. The
carrying values of the individual units before any impairment adjustments are given below.
Unit A Unit B Unit C
$m $m $m
Patents 5 – –
Property, plant and equipment 60 30 40
Net current assets 20 25 20
85 55 60
Value in use of unit 72 60 65
It was not possible to meaningfully allocate the goodwill on consolidation to the individual
cash-generating units, but all other net assets of Prospects are allocated in the table shown above.
The patents of Prospects have no ascertainable market value but all the current assets have a market
value that is above carrying value. The value in use of Prospects as a single cash-generating unit at
31 December 20X1 is £205 million.
TT2020
695
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Required
(a) Explain what is meant by a cash-generating unit. (5 marks)
(b) Explain why it was necessary to review the goodwill on consolidation of Prospects for
impairment at 31 December 20X0. (3 marks)
(c) Explain briefly the purpose of an impairment review and why the net assets of Prospects were
allocated into cash-generating units as part of the review of goodwill for impairment.
(5 marks)
(d) Demonstrate how the impairment loss in unit A will affect the carrying value of the net assets of
unit A in the consolidated financial statements of Acquirer. (5 marks)
(e) Explain and calculate the effect of the impairment review on the carrying value of the goodwill
on consolidation of Prospects at 31 December 20X0. (7 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
6 Lambda 29 mins
Lambda is a listed entity that prepares consolidated financial statements. Lambda measures assets
using the revaluation model wherever this is possible under IFRS. During its financial year ended
31 March 20X9 Lambda entered into the following transactions:
(a) On 1 October 20X7 Lambda began a project to investigate a more efficient production
process. Expenses relating to the project of $2 million were charged in the statement of profit
or loss and other comprehensive income in the year ended 31 March 20X8. Further costs of
$1.5 million were incurred in the three-month period to 30 June 20X8. On that date it became
apparent that the project was technically feasible and commercially viable. Further
expenditure of $3 million was incurred in the six-month period from 1 July 20X8 to 31
December 20X8. The new process, which began on 1 January 20X9, was expected to
generate cost savings of at least $600,000 per annum over the ten-year period commencing
1 January 20X9.
(b) On 1 April 20X8 Lambda acquired a new subsidiary, Omicron. The directors of Lambda
carried out a fair value exercise as required by IFRS 3 Business Combinations and concluded
that the brand name of Omicron had a fair value of $10 million and would be likely to
generate economic benefits for a ten-year period from 1 April 20X8. They further concluded
that the expertise of the employees of Omicron contributed $5m to the overall value of
Omicron. The estimated average remaining service lives of the Omicron employees was eight
years from 1 April 20X8.
(c) On 1 October 20X8 Lambda renewed its licence to extract minerals that are needed as part
of its production process. The cost of renewal of the licence was $200,000 and the licence is
for a five-year period starting on 1 October 20X8. There is no active market for this type of
licence. However, the directors of Lambda estimated that at 31 March 20X9 the fair value less
costs to sell of the licence was $175,000. They further estimated that over the remaining
54 months of its duration the licence would generate net cash flows for Lambda that had a
present value at 31 March 20X9 of $185,000.
Required
Explain how Lambda should treat the above transactions in its consolidated financial statements for
the year to 31 March 20X9. (You are not required to discuss the goodwill arising on acquisition of
Omicron.) (15 marks)
696
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
7 Kalesh 10 mins
Kalesh is preparing its financial statements for the year to 31 March 20X2. Kalesh is engaged in a
research and development project which it hopes will generate a new product. In the year to
31 March 20X1 the company spent $120,000 on research that concluded there were sufficient
grounds to carry the project on to its development stage and a further $75,000 was spent on
development. At 31 March 20X1, management had decided that they were not sufficiently confident
in the ultimate profitability of the project and wrote off all the expenditure to date to the statement of
profit or loss. In the current year further development costs have been incurred of $80,000 and it is
estimated than an additional $10,000 of development costs will be incurred in the future. Production
is expected to commence within the next few months. Unfortunately the total trading profit from sales
of the new product is not expected to be as good as market research data originally forecast and is
estimated at only $150,000. As the future benefits are greater than the remaining future costs, the
project will be completed but, due to the overall deficit expected, the directors have again decided to
write off all the development expenditure.
Required
Explain how Kalesh should treat the above transaction in its financial statements for the year to
31 March 20X2. (5 marks)
8 Burdock 10 mins
Burdock, a public limited company, operates in the fashion industry and has a financial year end of
31 May 20X6. Burdock owns a number of prestigious apartments which it leases to famous persons
who are under a contract of employment to promote its fashion clothing. The apartments are let at
below the market rate. The lease terms are short and are normally for six months. The leases
terminate when the contracts for promoting the clothing terminate. Burdock wishes to account for the
apartments as investment properties with the difference between the market rate and actual rental
charged to be recognised as an employee benefit expense.
Required
Discuss how the above should be dealt with in the financial statements of Burdock for the year ended
31 May 20X6. (5 marks)
9 Epsilon 20 mins
On 1 June 20X8 Epsilon opened a new factory in an area designated by the Government as an
economic development area. On that day the Government provided Epsilon with a grant of $30 million
to assist it in the development of the factory. This grant was in three parts:
(a) $6 million of the grant was a payment by the Government as an inducement to Epsilon to
begin developing the factory. No conditions were attached to this part of the grant.
(b) $15 million of the grant related to the construction of the factory at a cost of $60 million. The
land was leased so the whole of the $60 million is depreciable over the estimated 40 year
useful life of the factory.
(c) The remaining $9 million was received subject to keeping at least 200 employees working at
the factory for a period of at least five years. If the number drops below 200 at any time in
any financial year in this five year period then 20% of the grant is repayable in that year.
From 1 June 20X8 220 workers were employed at the factory and estimates are that this
number is unlikely to fall below 200 over the relevant five year period.
Required
Explain how the grant of $30 million should be reported in the financial statements of Epsilon for the
year ended 30 September 20X8. Where IFRSs allow alternative treatments of any part of the grant
you should explain both treatments. (10 marks)
TT2020
697
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
10 Zenzi 6 mins
Zenzi Co had the following loans in place at the beginning and end of 20X8.
1 January 31 December
20X8 20X8
$m $m
10.0% Bank loan repayable 20Y3 120 120
9.5% Bank loan repayable 20Y1 80 80
On 1 January 20X8, Zenzi Co began construction of a qualifying asset, a piece of machinery for a
hydro-electric plant, using existing borrowings. Expenditure drawn down for the construction was:
$30 million on 1 January 20X8, $20 million on 1 October 20X8.
Required
Calculate the borrowing costs to be capitalised for the machinery. (3 marks)
11 Radost 23 mins
Radost, a public limited company, has a defined benefit pension plan for its staff. Staff are eligible
for an annual pension between the date of their retirement and the date of their death equal to:
698
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
12 Cleanex 49 mins
Cleanex prepares its financial statements in accordance with IFRS. On 25 June 20X0, Cleanex made
a public announcement of its decision to reduce the level of emissions of harmful chemicals from its
factories. The average useful lives of the factories on 30 June 20X0 was 20 years. The depreciation
of the factories is computed on a straight-line basis and charged to cost of sales. The directors
formulated the proposals for emission reduction following agreement in principle earlier in the year.
The directors prepared detailed estimates of the costs of their proposals and these showed that the
following expenditure would be required.
$30 million on 30 June 20X1
$30 million on 30 June 20X2
$40 million on 30 June 20X3
All estimates were for the actual anticipated cash payments. No contracts were entered into until
after 1 July 20X0. The estimate proved accurate as far as the expenditure due on 30 June 20X1 was
concerned. When the directors decided to proceed with this project, they used discounted cash flow
techniques to appraise the proposed investment. The annual discount rate they used was 8%. The
entity has a reputation of fulfilling its financial commitments after it has publicly announced them.
Cleanex included a provision for the expected costs of its proposal in its financial statements for the
year ended 30 June 20X0.
Required
(a) Explain why there was a need for an accounting standard dealing with provisions, and
summarise the criteria that need to be satisfied before a provision is recognised. (10 marks)
(b) Explain the decision of the directors of Cleanex to recognise the provision in the statement of
financial position at 30 June 20X0. (5 marks)
(c) Compute the appropriate provision in the statements of financial position in respect of the
proposed expenditure at 30 June 20X0 and 30 June 20X1. (4 marks)
(d) Compute the two components of the charge to profit or loss in respect of the proposal for the
year ended 30 June 20X1. You should explain how each component arises and identify
where in the statements of profit or loss and other comprehensive income each component is
reported. (6 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
13 DT Group 49 mins
(a) IAS 12 Income Taxes focuses on the statement of financial position in accounting for deferred
taxation, which is calculated on the basis of temporary differences. The methods used in
IAS 12 can lead to accumulation of large tax assets or liabilities over a prolonged period and
this could be remedied by discounting these assets or liabilities. There is currently international
disagreement over the discounting of deferred tax balances.
Required
(i) Explain what the terms 'focus on the statement of financial position' and 'temporary
differences' mean in relation to deferred taxation. (6 marks)
(ii) Discuss the arguments for and against discounting long-term deferred tax balances.
(6 marks)
TT2020
699
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b) DT, a public limited company, has decided to adopt IFRSs for the first time in its financial
statements for the year ending 30 November 20X1. The amounts of deferred tax provided as
set out in the notes of the group financial statements for the year ending 30 November 20X0
were as follows:
$m
Tax depreciation in excess of accounting depreciation 38
Other temporary differences 11
Liabilities for health care benefits (12)
Losses available for offset against future taxable profits (34)
3
The following notes are relevant to the calculation of the deferred tax liability as at
30 November 20X1:
(i) DT acquired a 100% holding in a foreign company on 30 November 20X1. The
subsidiary does not plan to pay any dividends for the financial year to 30 November
20X1 or in the foreseeable future. The carrying amount in DT's consolidated financial
statements of its investment in the subsidiary at 30 November 20X1 is made up as
follows:
$m
Carrying value of net assets acquired excluding deferred tax 76
Goodwill (before deferred tax and impairment losses) 14
Carrying amount/cost of investment 90
The tax base of the net assets of the subsidiary at acquisition was $60 million. No
deduction is available in the subsidiary's tax jurisdiction for the cost of the goodwill.
Immediately after acquisition on 30 November 20X1, DT had supplied the subsidiary
with inventories amounting to $30 million at a profit of 20% on selling price. The
inventories had not been sold by the year end and the tax rate applied to the
subsidiary's profit is 25%. There was no significant difference between the fair values
and carrying values on the acquisition of the subsidiary.
(ii) The carrying amount of the property, plant and equipment (excluding that of the
subsidiary) is $2,600 million and their tax base is $1,920 million. Tax arising on the
revaluation of properties of $140 million, if disposed of at their revalued amounts, is the
same at 30 November 20X1 as at the beginning of the year. The revaluation of the
properties is included in the carrying amount above.
Other taxable temporary differences (excluding the subsidiary) amount to $90 million as
at 30 November 20X1.
(iii) The liability for health care benefits in the statement of financial position had risen to
$100 million as at 30 November 20X1 and the tax base is zero. Health care benefits
are deductible for tax purposes when payments are made to retirees. No payments
were made during the year to 30 November 20X1.
(iv) DT Group incurred $300 million of tax losses in the year ended 30 November 20X0.
Under the tax law of the country, tax losses can be carried forward for three years only.
The taxable profit for the year ending 30 November 20X1 was $110 million. In the
years ending 30 November, taxable profits were anticipated to be:
20X2 20X3
$m $m
100 130
700
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
The auditors are unsure about the availability of taxable profits in 20X3 as the amount
is based upon the projected acquisition of a profitable company. It is anticipated that
there will be no future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences until after
30 November 20X3.
(v) Income tax of $165 million on a property disposed of in 20X0 becomes payable on
30 November 20X4 under the deferral relief provisions of the tax laws of the country.
There had been no sales or revaluations of property during the year to 30 November
20X1.
(vi) Income tax is assumed to be 30% for the foreseeable future in DT's jurisdiction and the
company wishes to discount any deferred tax liabilities at a rate of 4% if allowed by
IAS 12.
(vii) There are no other temporary differences other than those set out above. The directors
of DT have calculated the opening balance of deferred tax using IAS 12 to be
$280 million.
Required
Calculate the liability for deferred tax required by the DT Group at 30 November 20X1 and
the deferred tax expense in profit or loss for the year ending 30 November 20X1 using
IAS 12, commenting on the effect that the application of IAS 12 will have on the financial
statements of the DT Group. (13 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
TT2020
701
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$'000
Non-current liabilities
Long term borrowings 10,000
Deferred tax liability 3,600
Employee benefit liability 4,000
Total non-current liabilities 17,600
Current liabilities
Current tax liability 3,070
Trade and other payables 5,000
Total current liabilities 8,070
Total liabilities 25,670
Total equity and liabilities 48,300
702
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
15 PQR 20 mins
PQR has the following financial instruments in its financial statements for the year ended
31 December 20X5:
(a) An investment in the debentures of STU, nominal value $40,000, purchased on their issue on
1 January 20X5 at a discount of $6,000 and carrying a 4% coupon. PQR plans to hold these
until their redemption on 31 December 20X8. The internal rate of return of the debentures is
8.6%.
(b) A foreign currency forward contract purchased to hedge the commitment to purchase a
machine in foreign currency six months after the year end.
(c) 100,000 redeemable preference shares issued in 20X0 at $1 per share with an annual
dividend payment of 6 cents per share, redeemable in 20X8 at their nominal value.
Required
Advise the directors (insofar as the information permits) about the accounting for the financial
instruments stating the effect of each on the gearing of the company. Your answer should be
accompanied by calculations where appropriate.
(Total = 10 marks)
16 Sirus 49 mins
Sirus is a large national public limited company (plc). The directors' service agreements require each
director to purchase 'B' ordinary shares on becoming a director and this capital is returned to the
director on leaving the company. Any decision to pay a dividend on the 'B' shares must be
approved in a general meeting by a majority of all of the shareholders in the company. Directors are
the only holders of 'B' shares.
Sirus would like advice on how to account under International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs)
for the following events in its financial statements for the year ended 30 April 20X8.
(a) The capital subscribed to Sirus by the directors and shareholders is shown as follows in the
statement of financial position as at 30 April 20X8:
Equity $m
Ordinary 'A' shares 100
Ordinary 'B' shares 20
Retained earnings 30
Total equity 150
On 30 April 20X8 the directors had recommended that $3 million of the profits should be
paid to the holders of the ordinary 'B' shares, in addition to the $10 million paid to directors
under their employment contracts. The payment of $3 million had not been approved in a
general meeting. The directors would like advice as to whether the capital subscribed by the
directors (the ordinary 'B' shares) is equity or a liability and how to treat the payments out of
profits to them. (6 marks)
(b) When a director retires, amounts become payable to the director as a form of retirement
benefit as an annuity. These amounts are not based on salaries paid to the director under an
employment contract. Sirus has contractual or constructive obligations to make payments to
former directors as at 30 April 20X8 as follows:
(i) Certain former directors are paid a fixed annual amount for a fixed term beginning on
the first anniversary of the director's retirement. If the director dies, an amount
representing the present value of the future payment is paid to the director's estate.
TT2020
703
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(ii) In the case of other former directors, they are paid a fixed annual amount which ceases
on death.
The rights to the annuities are determined by the length of service of the former directors
and are set out in the former directors' service contracts. (6 marks)
(c) On 1 May 20X7 Sirus acquired another company, Marne plc. The directors of Marne, who
were the only shareholders, were offered an increased profit share in the enlarged business
for a period of two years after the date of acquisition as an incentive to accept the purchase
offer. After this period, normal remuneration levels will be resumed. Sirus estimated that this
would cost them $5 million at 30 April 20X8, and a further $6 million at 30 April 20X9.
These amounts will be paid in cash shortly after the respective year ends. (6 marks)
(d) Sirus raised a loan with a bank of $2 million on 1 May 20X7. The market interest rate of 8%
per annum is to be paid annually in arrears and the principal is to be repaid in 10 years'
time. The terms of the loan allow Sirus to redeem the loan after seven years by paying the
interest to be charged over the seven year period, plus a penalty of $200,000 and the
principal of $2 million. The effective interest rate of the repayment option is 9.1%. The
directors of Sirus are currently restructuring the funding of the company and are in initial
discussions with the bank about the possibility of repaying the loan within the next financial
year. Sirus is uncertain about the accounting treatment for the current loan agreement and
whether the loan can be shown as a current liability because of the discussions with the bank.
(7 marks)
Required
Discuss the principles and nature of the accounting treatment of the above elements under
International Financial Reporting Standards in the financial statements for the year ended 30 April
20X8.
(Total = 25 marks)
Each executive will be entitled to 1,000 options if the cumulative profit in the three-year period
from 1 October 20X1 to 30 September 20X4 exceeds $30 million. If the cumulative profit for
this period is between $35 million and $40 million, then 1,500 options will vest. If the
cumulative profit for the period exceeds $40 million, then 2,000 options will vest.
If an executive leaves during the three-year vesting period, then that executive would forfeit
any rights to share options.
Notwithstanding the above, no options will vest unless the share price at 30 September 20X4
exceeds $5.
704
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
Details of the fair values of the shares and share options at relevant dates are as follows:
Fair value of
Date Omega share Option
$ $
1 October 20X1 4.00 0.50
30 September 20X2 4.40 0.60
30 September 20X3 4.60 0.75
The estimate of the cumulative profit for the three-year period ending 30 September 20X4 was
revised each year as follows:
Expected profit
Date for the three-year period
$m
1 October 20X1 32
30 September 20X2 39
30 September 20X3 45
On 1 October 20X1, none of the relevant executives were expected to leave in the three-year period
from 1 October 20X1 to 30 September 20X4 and none left in the year ended 30 September 20X2.
However, ten executives left unexpectedly on 30 June 20X3. None of the other executives are
expected to leave before 30 September 20X4.
Required
Prepare relevant extracts from the statement of financial position of Omega at 30 September 20X3 and
its statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the year ended 30 September 20X3.
You should give appropriate explanations to support your extracts. (10 marks)
19 Lowercroft 39 mins
In recent years it has become increasingly common for entities to enter into transactions with third
parties that are settled by means of a share-based payment. IFRS 2 Share-based Payment was issued
in order to provide a basis of accounting for such transactions. Share-based payments can be equity
settled or cash settled.
Required
(a) Explain the accounting treatment of both equity-settled and cash-settled share-based payment
transactions with employees. (8 marks)
Lowercroft prepares financial statements to 30 September each year. Lowercroft has a number of
highly skilled employees that it wishes to retain and has put two schemes in place to discourage
employees from leaving:
Scheme A
On 1 October 20X7 Lowercroft granted share options to 200 employees. Each employee was
entitled to 500 options to purchase equity shares at $10 per share. The options vest on
30 September 20Y0 if the employees continue to work for Lowercroft throughout the three-year
period. Relevant data is as follows:
Expected number of
employees for whom
Share price Fair value of option 500 options will vest
$ $
1 October 20X7 10 2.40 190
30 September 20X8 11 2.60 185
30 September 20X9 12 2.80 188
TT2020
705
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Scheme B
On 1 October 20X6 Lowercroft granted two share appreciation rights to 250 employees. Each right
gave the holder a cash payment of $100 for every 50 cent increase in the share price from the
1 October 20X6 value to the date the rights vest. The rights vest on 30 September 20X9 for those
employees who continue to work for Lowercroft throughout the three-year period. Payment is due on
31 January 20Y0. Relevant data is as follows:
Expected number of
employees for whom
Share price Fair value of option two rights will vest
$ $
1 October 20X6 9 500 240
30 September 20X7 10 520 235
30 September 20X8 11 540 240
30 September 20X9 12 600 238*
*actual number for
whom two rights vested
Required
(b) (i) For both schemes, compute the charge to the statement or profit or loss for the year
ended 30 September 20X9. (8 marks)
(ii) For both schemes, compute the amount that will appear in the statement of financial
position of Lowercroft at 30 September 20X9 and state where in the statement the
relevant amount will appear.
(4 marks)
(Total = 20 marks)
20 Highland 35 mins
Highland owns two subsidiaries, acquired as follows:
1 July 20X1 80% of Aviemore for $5 million when the book value of the net assets of
Aviemore was $4 million.
30 November 20X7 65% of Buchan for $2.6 million when the book value of the net assets of
Buchan was $3.35 million.
The companies' statements of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the year ended
31 March 20X8 were:
Highland Aviemore Buchan
$'000 $'000 $'000
Revenue 5,000 3,000 2,910
Cost of sales (3,000) (2,300) (2,820)
Gross profit 2,000 700 90
Administrative expenses (1,000) (500) (150)
Other income 230 – –
Finance costs (50) (210)
Profit/(loss) before tax 1,230 150 (270)
Income tax expense (300) (50) –
Profit/(loss) for the year 930 100 (270)
Other comprehensive income that will not be
reclassified to profit or loss, net of tax 130 40 120
Total comprehensive income for the year 1,060 140 (150)
Dividends paid during the year 200 50 –
706
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
Additional information
(a) On 1 April 20X7, Buchan issued $2.1 million 10% loan stock to Highland. Interest is payable
twice yearly on 1 October and 1 April. Highland has accounted for the interest received on
1 October 20X7 only.
(b) On 1 July 20X7, Aviemore sold a freehold property to Highland for $800,000 (land element –
$300,000). The property originally cost $900,000 (land element – $100,000) on 1 July 20W7.
The property's total useful life was 50 years on 1 July 20W7 and there has been no change in the
useful life since. Aviemore has credited the profit on disposal to 'Administrative expenses'.
(c) The property, plant and equipment of Buchan on 30 November 20X7 was valued at $500,000
(book value $350,000) and was acquired in April 20X7. The property, plant and equipment has
a total useful life of ten years. Buchan has not adjusted its accounting records to reflect fair values.
The group accounting policy to measure non-controlling interests at the proportionate share of the
fair value of net identifiable assets at acquisition.
(d) All companies use the straight-line method of depreciation and charge a full year's depreciation in
the year of acquisition and none in the year of disposal. Depreciation on fair value adjustments is
time apportioned from the date of acquisition.
(e) Highland charges Aviemore an annual fee of $85,000 for management services and this has
been included in 'Other income'.
(f) Highland has accounted for its dividend received from Aviemore in 'Other income'.
(g) Impairment tests conducted at the year end revealed recoverable amounts of $7.04 million for
Aviemore and $3.7 million for Buchan versus book values of net assets of $4.45 million and
$3.3 million in the separate financial statements of Aviemore and Buchan respectively (adjusted for
the effects of group fair value adjustments). No impairment losses had previously been recognised.
Required
Prepare the consolidated statements of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for
Highland for the year ended 31 March 20X8. (Total = 18 marks)
21 Investor 49 mins
Investor is a listed company with a number of subsidiaries located throughout the UK. Investor
currently appraises investment opportunities using a cost of capital of 10%.
On 1 April 20X9 Investor purchased 80% of the equity share capital of Cornwall for a total cash
price of $60 million. Half the price was payable on 1 April 20X9; the balance was payable on
1 April 20Y1. The net identifiable assets that were actually included in the statement of financial
position of Cornwall had a carrying value totalling $55 million at 1 April 20X9. With the exception
of the pension provision (see below), you discover that the fair values of the net identifiable assets of
Cornwall at 1 April 20X9 are the same as their carrying values. When performing the fair value
exercise at 1 April 20X9, you discover that Cornwall has a defined benefit pension scheme that was
actuarially valued three years ago and found to be in deficit. As a result of that valuation, a provision of
$6 million has been built up in the statement of financial position. The fair value exercise indicates that on
1 April 20X9, the pension scheme was in deficit by $11 million. This information became available on
31 July 20X9.
Assume that today's date is 31 October 20X9. You are in the process of preparing the consolidated
financial statements of the group for the year ended 30 September 20X9. Intangible assets are normally
written off on a pro-rata basis over 20 years. Your Financial Director is concerned that profits for the year
will be lower than originally anticipated. She is therefore wondering about changing the accounting
policy used by the group, so that all intangible assets are treated as having an indefinite useful life.
TT2020
707
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Required
(a) Calculate the value of goodwill on acquisition of Cornwall in the consolidated accounts of
Investor for the year ended 30 September 20X9. You should fully explain and justify all parts
of the calculation. (10 marks)
(b) Write a memorandum to your Financial Director.
(i) Evaluate the policy of writing off all intangible assets over 20 years.
(ii) Explain whether it is ever permissible to select a longer write-off period for intangible
assets, and describe the future implications of selecting such a period. (10 marks)
(c) Cornwall has purchased some valuable brands, which are included in the statement of
financial position. Explain the justification for including purchased brands in the statement of
financial position and how non-purchased brands should be treated. (5 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
Non-current liabilities
5% bonds 20X6 (note 2) 3,900 –
Current liabilities 8,100 2,000
Total liabilities 12,000 2,000
Total equity and liabilities 39,850 8,000
Additional information
(a) ROB acquired a 15% investment in PER on 1 May 20X2 for $600,000. ROB treated this
investment at fair value through profit or loss in the financial statements to 30 September
20X2, remeasuring it to $650,000. However, ROB has not recognised any remeasurement
gains or losses on the investment in the year ended 30 September 20X3. The fair value of the
15% investment at 1 April 20X3 was $800,000.
On 1 April 20X3, ROB acquired an additional 60% of the equity share capital of PER at a
cost of $3.2 million. At that date, the fair value of PER's net assets was equivalent to their book
value.
708
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
(b) ROB issued 4 million $1 5% redeemable bonds on 1 October 20X2 at par. The associated
costs of issue were $100,000 and the net proceeds of $3.9 million have been recorded
within non-current liabilities. The bonds are redeemable at $4.4 million on 30 September
20X6 and the effective interest rate associated with them is approximately 8%. The interest on
the bonds is payable annually in arrears and the amount due has been paid in the year to
30 September 20X3 and charged to the statement of profit or loss.
(c) An impairment review conducted at the year end revealed an impairment of the goodwill of
PER of $60,000.
(d) ROB wishes to measure non-controlling interests at fair value at the date of acquisition. The fair
value of the non-controlling interests in PER at 1 April 20X3 was $1 million.
(e) The profit for the year of PER was $3 million, and profits are assumed to accrue evenly
throughout the year.
(f) PER sold goods to ROB on 5 August 20X3 for $400,000. Half of these goods remained in
inventories at 30 September 20X3. PER makes 20% margin on all sales.
(g) No dividends were paid by either entity in the year to 30 September 20X3.
Required
(a) Explain how the investment in PER should be accounted for in the consolidated financial
statements of ROB, following the acquisition of the additional 60% shareholding. (5 marks)
(b) Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position as at 30 September 20X3 for the ROB
Group. (20 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
23 Gaze 20 mins
Gaze acquired 60% of the equity interests of Trek on 1 January 20X3.
On 1 May 20X5, Gaze acquired a further 10% interest in Trek.
There has been no impairment of goodwill since acquisition.
Profits of both entities can be assumed to accrue evenly throughout the year.
SUMMARISED STATEMENTS OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X3
Gaze Trek
$m $m
Revenue 2,500 1,500
Cost of sales and expenses (1,900) (1,200)
Profit before tax 600 300
Income tax expense (180) (90)
Profit for the year 420 210
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gain on property valuation, net of tax 80 30
Total comprehensive income for the year 500 240
Required
Prepare the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income of the Gaze
Group for the year ended 31 December 20X5. (10 marks)
TT2020
709
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
24 Holmes & Deakin 43 mins
Holmes, a public limited company, has owned 85% of the ordinary share capital of Deakin, a public
limited company, for some years. The shares were bought for $255 million and Deakin's reserves at
the time of purchase were $20 million.
On 28 February 20X3 Holmes sold 40m of the Deakin shares for $160 million. The only entry made
in respect of this transaction has been the receipt of the cash, which was credited to the 'investment
in subsidiary' account. No dividends were paid by either entity in the period.
The following draft summarised financial statements are available:
STATEMENTS OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR TO 31 MAY 20X3
Holmes Deakin
$m $m
Profit before tax 130 60
Income tax expense (40) (20)
Profit for the year 90 40
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 20 10
Total comprehensive income for the year 110 50
No impairment losses have been necessary in the group financial statements to date.
Assume that the gain as calculated in the parent's separate financial statements will be subject to
corporate income tax at a rate of 30% and that profit and other comprehensive income accrue
evenly throughout the year.
710
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
Holmes elected to measure the non-controlling interests in Deakin at fair value at the date of
acquisition. The fair value of the non-controlling interests in Deakin was $45 million at the date of
acquisition. No control premium was paid on acquisition.
Required
Prepare:
(a) The statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income and a statement of changes in
equity (total) of Holmes for the year ended 31 May 20X3 (5 marks)
(b) The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income of Holmes for the
same period (6 marks)
(c) A consolidated statement of financial position as at 31 May 20X3 (9 marks)
(d) A consolidated statement of changes in equity (total) for the year ended 31 May 20X3
(2 marks)
(Total = 22 marks)
25 Burley 49 mins
Burley, a public limited company, operates in the energy industry. It has entered into several
arrangements with other entities as follows:
(a) Burley and Slite, a public limited company, jointly control an oilfield. Burley has a 60%
interest and Slite a 40% interest, and the companies are entitled to extract oil in these
proportions. An agreement was signed on 1 December 20X8, which allowed for the net cash
settlement of any over/under extraction by one company. The net cash settlement would be at
the market price of oil at the date of settlement. Both parties have used this method of
settlement before. 200,000 barrels of oil were produced up to 1 October 20X9 but none
were produced after this up to 30 November 20X9 due to production difficulties. The oil was
all sold to third parties at $100 per barrel. Burley has extracted 10,000 barrels more than the
company's quota and Slite has under extracted by the same amount. The market price of oil at
the year end of 30 November 20X9 was $105 per barrel. The excess oil extracted by Burley
was settled on 12 December 20X9 under the terms of the agreement at $95 per barrel.
Burley had purchased oil from another supplier because of the production difficulties at $98
per barrel and has oil inventory of 5,000 barrels at the year end, purchased from this source.
Slite had no inventory of oil. Neither company had oil inventory at 1 December 20X8. Selling
costs are $2 per barrel.
Burley wishes to know how to account for the recognition of revenue, the excess oil extracted
and the oil inventory at the year end. (9 marks)
(b) Burley also entered into an agreement with Jorge, a public limited company, on 1 December
20X8. Each of the companies holds one half of the equity in an entity, Wells, a public limited
company, which operates offshore oil rigs. The contractual arrangement between Burley and
Jorge establishes joint control of the activities that are conducted in Wells. The main feature of
Wells's legal form is that Wells, not Burley or Jorge, has rights to the assets, and obligations
for the liabilities, relating to the arrangement.
The terms of the contractual arrangement are such that:
(i) Wells owns the oil rigs. The contractual arrangement does not specify that Burley and
Jorge have rights to the oil rigs.
(ii) Burley and Jorge are not liable in respect of the debts, liabilities or obligations of Wells.
If Wells is unable to pay any of its debts or other liabilities or to discharge its
obligations to third parties, the liability of each party to any third party will be limited to
the unpaid amount of that party's capital contribution.
TT2020
711
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(iii) Burley and Jorge have the right to sell or pledge their interests in Wells.
(iv) Each party receives a share of the income from operating the oil rig in accordance with
its interest in Wells.
Burley wants to account for the interest in Wells by using the equity method, and wishes for
advice on the matter.
The oil rigs of Wells started operating on 1 December 20W8, ie ten years before the
agreement was signed, and are measured under the cost model. The useful life of the rigs is
40 years. The initial cost of the rigs was $240 million, which included decommissioning costs
(discounted) of $20 million. At 1 December 20X8, the carrying amount of the
decommissioning liability has grown to $32.6 million, but the net present value of
decommissioning liability has decreased to $18.5 million as a result of the increase in the
risk-adjusted discount rate from 5% to 7%. Burley is unsure how to account for the oil rigs in
the financial statements of Wells for the year ended 30 November 20X9.
Burley owns a 10% interest in a pipeline, which is used to transport the oil from the offshore
oilrig to a refinery on the land. Burley has joint control over the pipeline and has to pay its
share of the maintenance costs. Burley has the right to use 10% of the capacity of the
pipeline. Burley wishes to show the pipeline as an investment in its financial statements to
30 November 20X9. (10 marks)
(c) Burley has purchased a transferable interest in an oil exploration licence. Initial surveys of the
region designated for exploration indicate that there are substantial oil deposits present, but
further surveys will be required in order to establish the nature and extent of the deposits.
Burley also has to determine whether the extraction of the oil is commercially viable. Past
experience has shown that the licence can increase substantially in value if further information
becomes available as to the viability of the extraction of the oil. Burley wishes to capitalise the
cost of the licence but is unsure whether the accounting policy is compliant with International
Financial Reporting Standards. (4 marks)
Required
Discuss, with suitable computations where necessary, how the above arrangements and events would
be accounted for in the financial statements of Burley.
Professional marks will be awarded in this question for clarity and expression. (2 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
26 Harvard 35 mins
The draft financial statements of Harvard, a public limited company, and its subsidiary, Krakow are
set out below.
STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION AT 31 DECEMBER 20X5
Harvard Krakow
$'000 PLN'000
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment 2,870 4,860
Investment in Krakow 840 –
3,710 4,860
Current assets
Inventories 1,990 8,316
Trade receivables 1,630 4,572
Cash 240 2,016
3,860 14,904
7,570 19,764
712
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
TT2020
713
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Required
(a) Prepare the consolidated statement of financial position at 31 December 20X5. (9 marks)
(b) Prepare the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income for the
year ended 31 December 20X5. (9 marks)
Ignore deferred tax on translation differences. Round your answer to the nearest $'000.
(Total = 18 marks)
27 Porter 49 mins
The following consolidated financial statements relate to Porter, a public limited company:
PORTER GROUP
STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT 31 MAY 20X6
20X6 20X5
$m $m
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment 958 812
Goodwill 15 10
Investment in associate 48 39
1,021 861
Current assets
Inventories 154 168
Trade receivables 132 112
Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss 16 0
Cash and cash equivalents 158 48
460 328
1,481 1,189
Equity attributable to owners of the parent
Share capital ($1 ordinary
shares) 332 300
Share premium account 212 172
Retained earnings 188 165
Revaluation surplus 101 54
833 691
Non-controlling interests 84 28
917 719
Non-current liabilities
Long-term borrowings 380 320
Deferred tax liability 38 26
418 346
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables 110 98
Interest payable 8 4
Current tax payable 28 22
146 124
1,481 1,189
714
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
PORTER GROUP
STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MAY 20X6
$m
Revenue 956
Cost of sales (634)
Gross profit 322
Other income 6
Distribution costs (97)
Administrative expenses (115)
Finance costs (16)
Share of profit of associate 12
Profit before tax 112
Income tax expense (34)
Profit for the year 78
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss:
Gains on property revaluation 58
Share of gain on property revaluation of associate 8
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified (17)
Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 49
Total comprehensive income for the year 127
TT2020
715
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$m
Share capital ($1 shares) 80
Reserves 40
120
Trade payables 12
Income taxes payable 4
136
The fair value of the net assets was equal to their carrying amount at the date of acquisition.
An impairment test conducted at the year end resulted in a write-down of goodwill relating to
another wholly owned subsidiary. This was charged to cost of sales.
Group policy is to value non-controlling interests at the date of acquisition at the proportionate
share of the fair value of the acquiree's identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed.
2 Depreciation charged to the consolidated profit or loss amounted to $44 million. There were
no disposals of property, plant and equipment during the year.
3 Other income represents gains on financial assets at fair value through profit or loss. The
financial assets are investments in quoted shares. They were purchased shortly before the year
end with surplus cash, and were designated at fair through profit or loss as they are expected
to be sold after the year end. No dividends have yet been received.
4 Included in 'trade and other payables' is the $ equivalent of an invoice for 102 million
shillings for some equipment purchased from a foreign supplier. The asset was invoiced on
5 March 20X6, but had not been paid for at the year end, 31 May 20X6.
Exchange gains or losses on the transaction have been included in administrative expenses.
Relevant exchange rates were as follows:
Shillings to $1
5 March 20X6 6.8
31 May 20X6 6.0
5 Movement on retained earnings was as follows:
$m
At 31 May 20X5 165
Total comprehensive income 68
Dividends paid (45)
At 31 May 20X6 188
Required
Prepare a consolidated statement of cash flows for Porter for the year ended 31 May 20X6 in
accordance with IAS 7 Statements of Cash Flows, using the indirect method.
Notes to the statement of cash flows are not required.
(Total = 25 marks)
716
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
TT2020
717
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
A B
$'000 $'000 $'000 $'000
Non-current liabilities
Interest bearing borrowings 16,000 18,000
Current liabilities
Trade payables 5,000 5,000
Income tax 1,500 1,000
Short-term borrowings 4,000 6,000
10,500 12,000
50,000 52,050
Notes
1 Sale by A to X
On 31 December 20X1, A supplied goods, at the normal selling price of $2.4 million, to
another entity, X. A's normal selling price is at a mark-up of 60% on cost. X paid for the goods
in cash on the same day. The terms of the selling agreement were that A repurchase these
goods on 30 June 20X2 for $2.5 million. A has accounted for the transaction as a sale. The
amount payable reflects the capital repayment plus market interest rates for the six-month
period.
2 Revaluation of non-current assets by B
B revalued its non-current assets for the first time on 1 January 20X1. The non-current assets of
A are very similar in age and type to the non-current assets of B. However, A has a policy of
maintaining all its non-current assets at depreciated historical cost. Both entities charge
depreciation of non-current assets to cost of sales. B has transferred the excess depreciation on
the revalued assets from the revaluation reserve to retained earnings as permitted in IAS 16
Property, Plant and Equipment.
Expand uses ratio analysis to appraise potential investment opportunities. It is normal practice to
base the appraisal on four key ratios:
Return on capital employed Asset turnover
Gross profit margin Debt/Equity
For the purposes of the ratio analysis, Expand computes:
(a) Capital employed as capital and reserves plus borrowings
(b) Borrowings as interest–bearing borrowings plus short-term borrowings
Your assistant has computed the four key ratios for the two entities from the financial statements
provided and the results are summarised below.
Ratio A B
Return on capital employed 18.4% 13.1%
Gross profit margin 38.2% 30.4%
Asset turnover 1.72 1.65
Debt/Equity 0.85:1 1.09:1
Your assistant has informed you that, on the basis of the ratios calculated, the performance of A is
superior to that of B in all respects and is therefore a more attractive investment. Therefore, Expand should
carry out a more detailed review of A with a view to making a bid to acquire it. However, you are unsure
whether this is necessarily the correct conclusion given the information provided in notes 1 and 2.
718
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
Required
(a) Explain and compute the adjustments that would be appropriate in respect of notes 1 and 2 so
as to make the financial statements of A and B comparable for analysis.
(b) Recalculate the four key ratios mentioned in the question for both A and B after making the
adjustments you have recommended in your answer to part (a). You should provide
appropriate workings to support your calculations.
(c) In the light of the work that you have carried out in answer to parts (a) and (b), evaluate your
assistant's conclusion that A appears to be the more attractive investment. Comment on any
additional financial and non-financial information that may be useful in considering the investment.
(Total = 25 marks)
29 Ghorse 49 mins
Ghorse, a public limited company, operates in the fashion sector and had undertaken a group
re-organisation during the current financial year to 30 September 20X7. As a result the following events
occurred.
(a) Ghorse identified two manufacturing units, Cee and Gee, which it had decided to dispose of
in a single transaction. These units comprised non-current assets only. One of the units, Cee,
had been impaired prior to the financial year end on 30 September 20X7 and it had been
written down to its recoverable amount of $35 million. The criteria in IFRS 5 Non-current
Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations, for classification as held for sale had been
met for Cee and Gee at 30 September 20X7. The following information related to the assets
of the cash generating units at 30 September 20X7:
Fair value less
costs of disposal
Depreciated and recoverable Carrying value
historical cost amount under IFRS
$m $m $m
Cee 50 35 35
Gee 70 90 70
120 125 105
The fair value less costs of disposal had risen at the year end to $40 million for Cee and
$95 million for Gee. The increase in the fair value less costs of disposal had not been taken
into account by Ghorse. (6 marks)
(b) As a consequence of the re-organisation, and a change in government legislation, the tax
authorities have allowed a revaluation of the non-current assets of the holding company for tax
purposes to market value at 31 October 20X7. There has been no change in the carrying
values of the non-current assets in the financial statements. The tax base and the carrying
values after the revaluation are as follows:
Carrying amount Tax base at Tax base at
at 31 October 31 October 20X7 31 October 20X7
20X7 after revaluation before revaluation
$m $m $m
Property 50 65 48
Vehicles 30 35 28
Other taxable temporary differences amounted to $5 million at 31 October 20X7. Assume
income tax is paid at 30%. The deferred tax provision at 31 October 20X7 had been
calculated using the tax values before revaluation. (5 marks)
TT2020
719
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(c) A subsidiary company had purchased computerised equipment for $4 million on 31 October
20X6 to improve the manufacturing process. Whilst re-organising the group, Ghorse had
discovered that the manufacturer of the computerised equipment was now selling the same
system for $2.5 million. The projected cash flows from the equipment are:
Cash flows
$m
Year ended 31 October 20X8 1.3
20X9 2.2
20Y0 2.3
The residual value of the equipment is assumed to be zero. The company uses a discount rate
of 10%. The directors think that the fair value less costs of disposal of the equipment is
$2 million. The directors of Ghorse propose to write down the non-current asset to the new
selling price of $2.5 million. The company's policy is to depreciate its computer equipment by
25% per annum on the straight line basis. (5 marks)
(d) The manufacturing property of the group, other than the head office, was held on an
operating lease over eight years in accordance with IAS 17, the predecessor of IFRS 16
Leases. On re-organisation on 31 October 20X7, the lease has been renegotiated and is held
for 12 years at a rent of $5 million per annum paid in arrears. IFRS 16 has also come into
force. The fair value of the property is $35 million and its remaining economic life is 13
years. The lease relates to the buildings and not the land. The factor to be used for an annuity
at 10% for 12 years is 6.8137. (4 marks)
The directors are worried about the impact that the above changes will have on the value of its non-
current assets and its key performance indicator which is 'return on capital employed' (ROCE). ROCE
is defined as operating profit before interest and tax divided by share capital, other reserves and
retained earnings. The directors have calculated ROCE as $30 million divided by $220 million, ie
13.6% before any adjustments required by the above.
Marks will be awarded in this question for your formation of opinion on the impact on ROCE.
(2 marks)
Required
(i) Discuss the accounting treatment of the above transactions and the impact that the resulting
adjustments to the financial statements would have on ROCE.
Note. Your answer should include appropriate calculations where necessary and a discussion
of the accounting principles involved.
(ii) The directors of Ghorse have historically focused on financial performance indicators. They are
under pressure from stakeholder groups to measure non-financial performance. Recommend
three relevant non-financial performance indicators that Ghorse could use.
(3 marks)
(Total = 25 marks)
720
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
30 German competitor
You are the chief accountant of Tone plc, a UK company. The Managing Director has provided you
with the financial statements of Tone plc's main competitor, Hilde GmbH, a German company. He
finds difficulty in reviewing these statements in their non-UK format, presented below.
HILDE GmbH
STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT 31 MARCH 20X5 (in € million)
HILDE GmbH
STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MARCH 20X5 (in € million)
20X5 20X4 20X5 20X4
Expenses Income
Operating expenses Operating income
Purchase of raw materials 740 400 Sale of goods produced 1,890 1,270
Variation in inventories Variation in inventory of
thereof 90 40 finished goods and WIP 120 80
Taxation 190 125 Other operating income 75 50
Wages 500 285 Total operating income 2,085 1,400
Valuation adjustment
on non-current assets
Depreciation 200 150
Valuation adjustment
on current assets
Amounts written off 30 20
Other operating
expenses 50 40
Total operating
expenses 1,800 1,060
TT2020
721
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
20X5 20X4 20X5 20X4
Financial expenses
Interest 100 50
Total financial expenses
100 50
Total expenses 1,900 1,110 Total income 2,085 1,400
Required
Prepare a report for the Managing Director:
(a) Analysing the performance of Hilde GmbH using the financial statements provided.
(b) Explaining why a direct comparison of the results of Tone plc and Hilde GmbH may be
misleading.
(c) Hilde GmbH reports on its commitment to be carbon neutral within the next ten years and
discloses information relating to its carbon footprint, emissions from its delivery vehicles and its
recycling targets. Tone plc has similar commitments but does not publicly report on them.
Briefly explain to the directors of Tone plc the potential benefits of reporting social and
environmental information.
31 Peter Holdings
Peter Holdings is a large investment conglomerate.
Required
Explain how divisional performance should be measured in the interest of the group's shareholders.
32 Jay 29 mins
(a) Jay is a public limited company which is preparing its financial statements for the year ended
31 May 20X6. Jay purchased goods from a foreign supplier for €8 million on 28 February
20X6. At 31 May 20X6, the trade payable was still outstanding and the goods were still held
by Jay. Similarly Jay has sold goods to a foreign customer for €4 million on 28 February 20X6
and it received payment for the goods in euros on 31 May 20X6.
Jay had purchased an investment property on 1 June 20X5 for €28 million. At 31 May 20X6,
the investment property had a fair value of €24 million. The company uses the fair value
model in accounting for investment properties.
Jay's functional and presentation currency is the dollar.
Average rate (€: $)
Exchange rates €: $ for year to
1 June 20X5 1.4
28 February 20X6 1.6
31 May 20X6 1.3 1.5
Required
Advise Jay on how to treat these transactions in the financial statements for the year ended
31 May 20X6. (8 marks)
(b) Jay has a reputation for responsible corporate behaviour and sees the workforce as the key
factor in the profitable growth of the business. The company is also keen to provide detailed
disclosures relating to environmental matters and sustainability.
722
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
Required
Discuss what matters should be disclosed in Jay's annual report in relation to the nature of
corporate citizenship, in order that there might be a better assessment of the performance of
the company. (7 marks)
(Total = 15 marks)
34 Taupe 31 mins
One of your colleagues has recently inherited investments in several listed entities and she frequently
asks for your advice on accounting issues. She has recently received the consolidated financial
statements of Taupe, an entity that provides haulage and freight services in several countries. She has
noticed that Note 3 to the financial statements is headed 'Segment information'.
Note 3 explains that Taupe's primary segment reporting format is business segments of which there
are three: in addition to road and air freight, the entity provides secure transportation services for
smaller items of high value. Taupe's Operating and Financial Review provides further background
information: the secure transport services segment was established only three years ago. This new
operation required a sizeable investment in infrastructure which was principally funded through
borrowing. However, the segment has experienced rapid revenue growth in that time, and has
become a significant competitor in the industry sector.
TT2020
723
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Extracts from Taupe's segment report for the year ended 31 August 20X5 are as follows:
Secure
Road haulage Air freight transport Group
20X5 20X4 20X5 20X4 20X5 20X4 20X5 20X4
$m $m $m $m $m $m $m $m
Revenue 653 642 208 199 98 63 959 904
Segment result 169 168 68 62 6 (16) 243 214
Unallocated corporate expenses (35) (37)
Operating profit 208 177
Interest expense (22) (21)
Share of profits of associates 16 12 16 12
Profit before tax 202 168
Income tax (65) (49)
Profit 137 119
Other information
Segment assets 805 796 306 287 437 422 1,548 1,505
Investment in equity method
associates 85 84 85 84
Unallocated corporate assets 573 522
Consolidated total assets 2,206 2,111
Segment liabilities 345 349 176 178 197 184 718 711
Unallocated corporate
liabilities 37 12
Consolidated total liabilities 755 723
724
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice
35 Restructuring
Omega is an entity that prepares financial statements to 31 March each year. On 1 July 20X9 the
directors decided to terminate production at one of the company's divisions. This decision was
publicly announced on 31 July 20X9. The activities of the division were gradually reduced from
1 October 20X9 and closure is expected to be complete by 31 March 20Y0. At 31 July 20X9 the
directors prepared the following estimates of the financial implications of the closure as follows:
(i) Redundancy costs were initially estimated at $2 million. Further expenditure of $800,000 will
be necessary to retrain employees who will be affected by the closure but will remain with
Omega in different divisions. This retraining will begin in early January 20Y0. The latest
estimates are that redundancy costs will be $1.9 million, with retraining costs of $850,000.
(ii) Plant and equipment having an expected carrying amount at 30 September 20X9 of $8
million will have a recoverable amount $1.5 million. These estimates remain valid.
(iii) The division is under contract to supply a customer for the next three years at a pre-determined
price. It will be necessary to pay compensation of $600,000 to this customer. The
compensation actually paid, on 30 November 20X9, was $550,000.
(iv) The division will make operating losses of $300,000 per month in the last three months of
20X9 and $200,000 per month in the first three months of 20Y0. This estimate proved
accurate for October and November 20X9.
Required
Compute and discuss the amounts that will be included in the statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income for the year ended 30 September 20X9 in respect of the decision to close the
division. Where financial information provided above does not result in a charge to profit or loss,
you should explain why this is so. (8 marks)
TT2020
725
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
726
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
1 Revenue recognition
The Managing Director wishes to recognise the sale as early as possible. However, following
IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers, revenue from the sale should only be recognised
when the performance obligations in the contract have been satisfied.
Performance obligations in the contract
The contract contains a promise to deliver the caravan and a promise to deliver additional services
free of charge. These are distinct promises and therefore the contract contains two performance
obligations.
Transaction price
The transaction price is made up of three elements.
A significant financing component must be considered where consideration is received more than
12 months before or after the date on which revenue is recognised (being the delivery date,
1 August 20X7). Therefore, the payment on 31 July 20X9 must be discounted to present value at
1 August 20X7.
$
Deposit 3,000
Payment on 1 August 20X7 (the delivery date) 15,000
Payment on 31 July 20X9 ($12,000/1.1 )
2
9,917
27,917
TT2020
727
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Year ended 31 July 20X8
Journal entries are as follows:
1 August 20X7
Revenue is recognised together with payment of the $15,000. The contract liability is transferred to
revenue:
DEBIT Bank $15,000
DEBIT Contract liability $3,000
DEBIT Receivable $8,588
CREDIT Revenue $26,588
Interest accrued on receivable for period 1 August 20X7 – 31 July 20X8:
DEBIT Receivable (8,588 10%) $859
CREDIT Interest income $859
Satisfaction of performance obligation for servicing on 31 July 20X8:
DEBIT Receivable (1,329 1.1) $1,462
(needs to be recognised compounded up one year as was previously measured at 1 August 20X7)
CREDIT Revenue $1,462
Tutorial note
Here are the entries for the final year of the contract (proving that the receivable is fully eliminated).
2 Fundamental principles
Tutorial note
Don't let this scenario panic you in the long list of details it gives you. Deal with each point as it
arises. Also, don't be afraid to draw a conclusion about the facts given to you, but remember to back
your opinions up with justification. Consider what the fundamental principles and general guidance
of the ACCA say, but also think about practical issues, such as ease of modern communication. Deal
with the two issues raised in the scenario (the individual partner issue and the firm split) separately,
there is no need to assume any connection between them. However, you may feel there is a point to
be made about the juxtaposition of the two events.
Independence
It is important that auditors are, and are seen to be, independent. Independence is at the heart of the
auditing profession as auditors claim to give an impartial, objective opinion on the truth and fairness
of the financial statements.
728
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
Objectivity
A family relationship between an auditor and the client can substantially affect the
objectivity of the audit, so auditors are advised not to build close personal relationships with audit
clients and should not audit a company where family are employed in a capacity which is sensitive
to the accounts, for example, in the finance department, although this is not prohibited by law.
In this instance, the partner was not the reporting partner for the audit client in which his
brother-in-law was a financial controller. According to generally accepted ethical practice then, the
firm appeared to be independent of the audit client if the related partner did not have anything to do
with the audit.
Resolution?
The regulatory body required the audit partner to move 400 miles. This presumably implies that the
partner was requested to change offices within the firm by which he was employed. Given current
levels of computer networking and other communications common in business, this would appear
to be an arbitrary distinction, as a partner in an office 400 miles away could have similar
access and influence over a single audit carried out by the firm as a partner in the locality.
Independence in appearance
However, in this situation, the regulatory body appear to be concerned about the appearance of
independence. They appear to be concerned that the public will not perceive the distinction between
a partner and a partner who reports on a specific engagement. This may or may not be fair.
Arguably, it is only in publicising the problem that the public are likely to have a perception at all.
Also, given the comments made about modern communications above, the public are unlikely to be
convinced that moving a member of staff to a different office will solve this independence problem, if
they perceive that there is one.
Split of audit firm
The decision of the firm to split into three divisions could enhance the public perception of the
independence of the audit department. While there might be underlying scepticism
relating to the reasons behind the split (which could merely be for marketing purposes or to enable
non-audit divisions to raise capital more easily), the underlying benefit for objectivity still
exists.
However, some audit clients will be unhappy with the move of the firm as it will entail their
appointing several different service providers to gain the services they previously got from the one
audit firm.
3 Ace
Year ended 31 March 20X2
Relationship
Ace Co has a 75% subsidiary (Deuce Co) and an 80% subsidiary (Trey Co).
Ace is a related party of Deuce and Trey and vice versa.
Deuce and Trey are also related parties because they are subject to 'common control'. Any
transactions between Ace, Deuce and Trey need not be disclosed in Ace's consolidated accounts
as they are eliminated.
Disclosures
Ace Co
Intragroup sale of machine for $25,000 at profit of $5,000; no balances outstanding
Management services provided to Deuce (nil charge) and Trey (nil charge)
TT2020
729
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
No disclosure is required in the group accounts of Ace of these items as they are eliminated.
Deuce
Parent (and ultimate controlling party) is Ace Co
Machine purchased from parent $25,000 (original cost $20,000) and depreciation charge
$5,000. No amounts outstanding at year end.
Purchase of management services from Ace (nil charge)
Trey
Parent (and ultimate controlling party) is Ace Co
Purchase of management services from Ace (nil charge)
For all transactions the nature of the related party relationship (ie parent, subsidiary, fellow
subsidiary) should be disclosed.
Year ended 31 March 20X3
Relationship
Ace Co has a 100% subsidiary (Deuce Co) and an 80% subsidiary (Trey Co).
Ace is a related party of Deuce and Trey and vice versa. Deuce and Trey are related because they
remain under common control. Any transactions between Ace, Deuce and Trey need not be
disclosed in Ace's consolidated accounts as they are eliminated.
Disclosures
Ace Co
Management services provided to Deuce (nil charge) and Trey ($10,000 outstanding)
No disclosure is required in the group accounts of Ace of these items as they are eliminated.
Deuce
Parent (and ultimate controlling party) is Ace Co
Disclosures of intragroup transactions is still required even though Deuce is a wholly-owned
subsidiary:
Sale of inventories to Trey for $15,000 (original cost $12,000) all sold on, no amounts
outstanding at year end
Purchase of management services from Ace (nil charge)
Trey
Parent (and ultimate controlling party) is Ace Co
Purchase of inventories from Deuce $15,000 (original cost $12,000) all sold, no amounts
outstanding at year end
Purchase of management services from Ace costing $10,000. All outstanding at year end
For all transactions the nature of the related party relationship (ie parent, subsidiary, fellow
subsidiary) should be disclosed.
4 Camel Telecom
(a) The licence is an intangible asset accounted for under IAS 38 Intangible Assets.
Given that the market value on the date of acquisition was more than the amount paid by
Camel, a government grant has been given.
Two accounting treatments are acceptable under IAS 20.
730
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
(i) The asset is recognised initially at its market value of $370 million, and the government
grant of $26 million (being the difference between the market value and the cost of the
asset) is recognised as deferred income.
(ii) Alternatively the government grant can be deducted from the market value of the asset
to give a carrying amount of $344 million.
The licence should be amortised over the ten year licence period to a zero residual value.
Any deferred income will be amortised over the same period and presented as a current and
non-current liability in the statement of financial position.
Either way the annual effect on profit or loss is a charge of $34.4 million (either $344m/10
or $370m/10 less a credit of $26m/10).
The lower take up of 5G services is an impairment indicator and so an impairment test must
be undertaken at the year end. However, after taking into account amortisation for the period,
the carrying amount of the asset at the year end is either $309.6 million ($344m – $34.4m) if
the grant is deducted from the asset value or $333 million ($370m – $37m) if the asset is
initially measured at market value and the grant is recognised separately. Therefore the asset
is not impaired.
The asset cannot be revalued upwards to $335 million because IAS 38 requires an active
market to exist for revaluation of intangible assets and, despite the fact that the licence can be
sold, there is no active market in these four licences due to their nature. An active market is
defined as a market in which transactions for the particular asset take place with sufficient
frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis. This is not the case
as there are only four licences.
(b) Camel's intention is to use the land for its new head office. Therefore it does not meet the
definition of investment property under IAS 40 Investment Property:
'Property held to earn rentals or for capital appreciation or both, rather than for:
Use in the production or supply of goods or services or for administrative purposes; or
Sale in the ordinary course of business.' (IAS 40: para. 5)
Therefore the land is held under IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment and is initially recorded
at its cost of $10.4 million. Being land, ordinarily it would not be depreciated.
The land can either be held under the cost model or revaluation model depending on Camel's
accounting policy which applies to all of its land as a class.
If revalued, the fair value measurement of the land should take into account a market
participant's ability to generate economic benefits by using the asset in its highest and best
use or by selling it to another market participant that would use the asset in its highest and
best use.
The highest and best use of an asset takes into account the use that is physically possible,
legally permissible and financially feasible. At the current year end, even though planning
permission has not been granted, the fact that the lawyer expects it to be granted soon
indicates that the proposed development of the land is not legally prohibited, and
therefore under IFRS 13 (para. BC69) the value of $14.3 million can be used. If Camel's
policy is to revalue its land, it can be revalued to $14.3 million at the year end, ie its value as
land for development. The gain of $3.9 million ($14.3m – $10.4m) would be reported in
other comprehensive income.
(c) The land is also used for the supply of services and therefore meets the definition of property,
plant and equipment. However, if the portion leased to other parties is separate and could be
sold separately, that portion could be treated separately as investment property.
TT2020
731
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Camel therefore has the option of using the cost model (for both property, plant and
equipment and investment property portions) or the revaluation model (for the property, plant
and equipment portion) or the fair value model (for the investment property portion). This
depends on Camel's underlying accounting policy.
Given that the sites have increased substantially in value, this would result in gains in other
comprehensive income (for the property, plant and equipment portion) or profit or loss (for the
investment property portion) if the revaluation/fair value models are used. Any rental income
is credited to profit or loss (assuming that they are operating leases under IFRS 16 Leases as it
applies to lessors).
(d) An exchange transaction has occurred here. Under IAS 16 and IAS 38 which cover
exchanges of tangible and intangible assets, the cost of the new asset is measured at fair
value, unless the transaction lacks commercial substance, which does not appear to be the
case here, as the assets given up relate to different products to those acquired, ie landline vs
mobile businesses.
The best indication of the fair value of the assets acquired is the fair value of the non-monetary
assets given up ($320m) plus the monetary consideration of $980 million. A gain or loss is
therefore reported in Camel's financial statements on derecognition of its fixed line ADSL
business comparing the selling price ($320m) with its carrying amount.
Part of the $980 million paid to Purple includes the value of the Purple brand (ie its customer
base and their loyalty and the brand recognition in the market). The brand must be given up
after one year it will have no value to Camel in that country at that time. However, during the
period of re-branding from Purple to Mobistar, the brand still has a value.
Consequently a fair value should be attributed to the brand during the acquisition accounting
and the brand should be amortised to a residual value of zero over the next year.
(e) The Mobistar brand is internally generated as it developed the brand itself. Therefore, under
IAS 38, the brand cannot be recognised in the financial statements of Camel as its value is
deemed not to be able to be measured on a reliable basis.
Camel should analyse further the impact of the stolen customer details. An impairment test
may be necessary on Camel's national business if customers are leaving beyond what had
been expected in normal market conditions. Further, a provision may be necessary for a fine
over the loss of private data under national law since the event occurred before the year end,
which would be considered the obligating event for fines under IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent
Liabilities and Contingent Assets. Disclosure would also need to be made of the nature of the
incident/provision and uncertainty over the amount of any fine accrued.
5 Acquirer
Top tips. This question tests students' ability to apply the principles of IFRS 3 and IAS 36. In Part (d)
you should have computed the value in use of the relevant net assets. This involved allocating assets
into cash generating units. In Part (e) you needed to allocate this impairment loss by computing the
carrying value of the goodwill and therefore of the total carrying value of the individual subsidiary.
The whole impairment loss was allocated to goodwill. Remember that the impairment review has to
be done in two stages.
732
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
TT2020
733
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(e) The goodwill on consolidation is:
$m
Cost of investment 260
Net assets acquired 180
80
This goodwill cannot be allocated to individual units, so the impairment review must be carried
out in two stages:
Stage 1: Review individual units for impairment.
It is clear that the assets of unit A have suffered impairment, since the value in use of $72 million
is less than the carrying value of $85 million. The assets of unit A must therefore be written
down to $72 million.
Stage 2: Compare the adjusted carrying value of the net assets of Prospects,
including goodwill, with the value in use of the whole business.
The carrying value is as follows.
$m
Goodwill 80
Unit A 72
Unit B 55
Unit C 60
Total 267
The value in use of the whole business is $205m, so an additional impairment loss of $267m
– $205m = $62m must be provided for. This is allocated first to goodwill, reducing the
goodwill to $80m – $62m = $18m.
6 Lambda
(a) Costs are capitalised from 30 June 20X8 onwards (when commercial feasibility and
technical viability were demonstrated). Hence the $3.5 million incurred before this point is
expensed.
The $3 million incurred from 1 July to 31 December 20X8 is capitalised. Amortisation is
charged over the ten-year useful life, giving an annual charge of $300,000.
Amortisation is charged from when the process begins to be exploited commercially; here this
is 1 January 20X9. Amortisation charged in the year-ended 20X9 is $300,000 3/12 =
$75,000.
The carrying amount is thus:
Cost 3,000,000
Amortisation (75,000)
Carrying amount 2,925,000
(b) The brand name is capitalised at its fair value of $10 million. It is amortised over its useful
life of ten years, resulting in an expense of $1 million. The carrying amount at the year end
is thus $9 million.
In accordance with IAS 38, no asset may be recognised in respect of the employees'
expertise, as Lambda/Omicron does not exercise 'control' over them – they could leave
their jobs. The amount will be recognised as part of any goodwill on acquisition of
Omicron.
734
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
(c) The licence is initially recognised at its cost of $200,000. Its useful life is five years, so
amortisation is charged of $200,000 ÷ 5 6 months = $20,000. The carrying amount is then
$180,000.
The asset is then reviewed for impairment. It is impaired if its carrying amount is higher than its
recoverable amount. This is the higher of value in use ($185,000) and fair value less costs to
sell ($175,000) – the higher being $185,000. Since the carrying amount is lower than this, it
is not impaired.
7 Kalesh
The treatment of the research and development costs in the year to 31 March 20X1 was correct due to
the element of uncertainty at the date. The development costs of $75,000 written off in that same period
should not be capitalised at a later date even if the uncertainties leading to its original
write off are favourably resolved. The treatment of the development costs in the year to 31 March 20X2 is
incorrect. The directors' decision to continue the development is logical as (at the time of the decision) the
future costs are estimated at only $10,000 and the future revenues are expected to be $150,000.
However, at 31 March 20X2 the unexpensed development costs of $80,000 are expected to be
recovered. Provided the other criteria in IAS 38 Intangible Assets are met, these costs of $80,000 should
be recognised as an asset in the statement of financial position and amortised across the expected life of
the product in order to 'match' the development costs to the future earnings of the new product. Thus the
directors' logic of writing off the $80,000 development cost at 31 March 20X2 because of an expected
overall loss is flawed. The directors do not have the choice to write off the development expenditure.
8 Burdock
The apartments are leased to persons who are under contract to the company. Therefore they
cannot be classified as investment property. IAS 40 Investment Property specifically states
that property occupied by employees is not investment property. The apartments must be
treated as property, plant and equipment, carried at cost or fair value and depreciated over
their useful lives.
Although the rent is below the market rate, the difference between the actual rent and the market rate
is simply income foregone (or an opportunity cost). In order to recognise the difference as an
employee benefit cost it would also be necessary to gross up rental income to the market rate.
The financial statements would not present fairly the financial performance of the company.
Therefore the company cannot recognise the difference as an employee benefit cost.
9 Epsilon
The basic principle of IAS 20 is that grants should be recognised as income in whichever periods the
costs they are intended to compensate occur.
(a) There are no conditions attached to the $6 million, so there are no costs to match the money
to. Hence the $6 million should be recognised as income straight away.
(b) The $15 million relates to the costs of the factory and should be matched to them. The costs
occur over the 40 year useful life, and IAS 20 allows the grant to be matched to them in two ways:
(i) The grant could be used to reduce the cost of the asset and subsequent depreciation
charges. The cost would have been $60m with $0.5m depreciation (= $60m/40 years
4/12 months), but this would be reduced by the grant to $45m cost less $0.375m
depreciation (= $45m/40 years 4/12 months) to a carrying amount of $44.625m.
(ii) The other treatment would be to show the grant separately as deferred income,
matching the income to the depreciation of the factory. The factory would remain at
$60m cost with $0.5m depreciation. Income of $0.125m (= $15m/40 years
4/12 months) would be recognised in the statement of profit or loss, with the remaining
$14.875m being shown as deferred in the statement of financial position. Of this,
$0.375m would be shown within current liabilities as it would be released during the
TT2020
735
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
next year (= $15m/40 years), and the remaining $14.5m (= $14.875m – $0.375m)
would be in non-current liabilities.
(c) The question here is how likely it is that the grant will have to be repaid. In this case, it is
possible but unlikely, so no liability needs to be recognised for it being repaid. The grant
should therefore be treated as deferred income over the five years, of which $0.6m (= $9m/
5 years 4/12 months) is recognised as income this year. The doubt over possible repayment
of the grant in future should then be disclosed as a contingent liability in line with IAS 37, as
repayment is possible but not probable.
If it had been probable that the $9 million would have to be repaid, then no income would
have been recognised in the statement of profit or loss and the full amount would be shown as
a separate liability in the statement of financial position, reducing the amount of deferred
income. If there was not enough deferred income to make up the amount of the liability (eg if
some had already been recognised in the statement of profit or loss), then the deficit should be
charged to the statement of profit or loss as an expense.
10 Zenzi
120 80
Capitalisation rate = weighted average rate = (10% ) + (9.5% ) = 9.8%
120 +80 120 +80
11 Radost
(a) Notes to the statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
Defined benefit expense recognised in profit or loss
$m
Current service cost 3.75
Past service cost – plan amendment (6.00)
Net interest income (from SOFP: 4.5 – 5.2) (0.70)
Profit or loss expense/(credit) (2.95)
Other comprehensive income (items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss):
Remeasurements of defined benefit plans
$m
Actuarial gain/(loss) on defined benefit obligation (4.75)
Return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest) 2.97
(1.78)
Notes to the statement of financial position
Net defined benefit asset recognised in the statement of financial position
$m
Fair value of plan assets 64.17
Present value of defined benefit obligation (44.00)
Net asset 20.17
736
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
(b) Legally the assets of the Radost pension plan do not belong to Radost once the contributions are
made. This is because to meet the definition of plan assets of a post-employment benefit plan
under IAS 19 Employee Benefits they must be held by an entity/fund that is legally separate
from the reporting entity. This provides the employees with a measure of protection should the
entity go bankrupt or should the directors fraudulently attempt to plunder the assets of the
pension plan. Nevertheless, the substance of the arrangement is that the assets are held
exclusively to pay the company's future defined benefit obligation and it is therefore logical that
they should be shown in the company's statement of financial position reducing that liability. In
the case of plan assets that exceed the value of the associated obligation (as in Radost's case), a
net asset would normally be recognised in the company's statement of financial position on the
grounds that the definition of an asset ('a resource controlled by the entity as a result of past
events and from which future economic benefits are expected to flow to the entity') is met. In this
case the 'benefits' are reduced future contributions as the plan is in surplus.
12 Cleanex
(a) Why there was a need for an accounting standard dealing with provisions
IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets was issued to prevent entities
from using provisions for creative accounting. It was common for entities to recognise material
provisions for items such as future losses, restructuring costs or even expected future
expenditure on repairs and maintenance of assets. These could be combined in one large
provision (sometimes known as the 'big bath'). Although these provisions reduced profits in the
period in which they were recognised (and were often separately disclosed on grounds of
materiality), they were then released to enhance profits in subsequent periods. To make
matters worse, provisions were often recognised where there was no firm commitment to incur
expenditure. For example, an entity might set up a provision for restructuring costs and then
withdraw from the plan, leaving the provision available for profit smoothing.
Criteria for recognition
TT2020
737
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
IAS 37 states that a provision shall be recognised when:
An entity has a present obligation to transfer economic benefits as a result of a past
transaction or event;
It is probable that a transfer of economic benefits will be required to settle the
obligation; and
A reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.
An obligation can be legal or constructive. An entity has a constructive obligation if:
It has indicated to other parties that it will accept certain responsibilities (by an
established pattern of past practice or published policies); and
As a result, it has created a valid expectation on the part of those other parties that it
will discharge those responsibilities.
(b) Two of the three conditions in IAS 37 are very clearly met. Cleanex will incur expenditure
(transfer of economic benefits is virtually certain) and the directors have prepared detailed
estimates of the amount.
Although Cleanex is not legally obliged to carry out the project, it appears that it has a
constructive obligation to do so. IAS 37 states that an entity has a constructive obligation
if both of the following apply.
(i) It has indicated to other parties that it will accept certain responsibilities (by an
established pattern of past practice or published policies).
(ii) As a result, it has created a valid expectation on the part of those other parties that
it will discharge those responsibilities.
Cleanex has a reputation of fulfilling its financial commitments once they have been publicly
announced. Therefore the obligating event is the announcement of the proposal on 25 June
20X0, the obligation exists at 30 June 20X0 (the year-end) and Cleanex is required to
recognise a provision.
(c) Provision at 30 June 20X0:
$'000
Expenditure on:
30 June 20X1 30,000 0.926 27,780
30 June 20X2 30,000 0.857 25,710
30 June 20X3 40,000 0.794 31,760
85,250
(d) The charge to profit or loss for the year ended 30 June 20X1 consists of:
738
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
Alternative calculation
$'000
Expenditure on:
30 June 20X1 (30,000 – 27,780) 2,220
30 June 20X2 (27,780 – 25,710) 2,070
30 June 20X3 (34,280 – 31,760) 2,520
6,810
13 DT Group
(a) (i) IAS 12 focuses on the statement of financial position in accounting for deferred
taxation. It is based on the principle that a deferred tax liability or asset should be
recognised if the recovery of the carrying amount of the asset or the settlement of the
liability will result in higher or lower tax payments in the future than would be the case if
that recovery or settlement were to have no tax consequences. Future tax consequences
of past events determine the deferred tax liabilities or assets. (IAS 12 gives certain
exceptions to this general rule, eg deferred tax is not provided on goodwill.) The
calculation of deferred tax balances is determined by looking at the difference between
the tax base of an asset and its statement of financial position carrying value. Thus the
calculation is focused on the statement of financial position.
Differences between the carrying amount of the asset and liability and its tax base are
called 'temporary differences'. The word 'temporary' is used because the IASB's
Conceptual Framework assumes that an enterprise will realise its assets and settle its
liabilities over time at which point the tax consequences will crystallise.
The objective of the temporary difference approach is to recognise the future tax
consequences inherent in the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the statement
of financial position. The approach looks at the tax payable if the assets and liabilities
were realised for the pre tax amounts recorded in the statement of financial position.
The presumption is that there will be recovery of statement of financial position items out
of future revenues and tax needs to be provided in relation to such a recovery. This
involves looking at temporary differences between the carrying values of the assets and
liabilities and the tax base of the elements. The standard recognises two types of
temporary differences, which are described as 'taxable' and 'deductible' temporary
differences.
(ii) By definition, deferred tax involves the postponement of the tax liability and it is
possible, therefore, to regard the deferred liability as equivalent to an interest free loan
from the tax authorities. Thus it could be argued that it is appropriate to reflect this
benefit of postponement by discounting the liability and recording a lower tax charge.
This discount is then amortised over the period of deferment. The purpose of discounting
is to measure future cash flows at their present value and, therefore, deferred tax
balances can only be discounted if they can be viewed as future cash flows that are not
already measured at their present value.
TT2020
739
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Some temporary differences clearly represent future tax cash flows. For example, where
there is an accrual for an expense that is to be paid in the future and tax relief will only
be given when the expense is paid. Some expenses are already measured on a
discounted basis (eg retirement benefits), and it is not appropriate to discount the
resulting deferred tax. However, there is controversy over whether it is valid to discount
deferred tax when tax cash flows have already occurred as in the case of accelerated
tax depreciation. It is argued that this temporary difference does not give rise to a future
cash flow and there is no basis for discounting. An alternative view is that accelerated
tax depreciation is a liability that will be repaid in the form of higher tax assessments in
the future. It can be argued that there are two cash flows, with the second cash flow
occurring on the reversal of the temporary difference, as the tax payment will be higher.
Discounting, however, makes the deferred tax computation more difficult to calculate
and more subjective. Also there will be an additional cost in scheduling and calculating
deferred taxation, as well as the problem of the determination of the discount rate.
IAS 12 specifically prohibits discounting.
(b) Calculation of deferred tax liability
Carrying Tax Temporary
amount base differences
$m $m $m
Goodwill (note 1) 14 – –
Subsidiary (note 1) 76 60 16
Inventories (note 2) 24 30 (6)
Property, plant and equipment (note 3) 2,600 1,920 680
Other temporary differences 90
Liability for health care benefits (100) 0 (100)
Unrelieved tax losses (note 4) (100)
Property sold – tax due 30.11.20X4 (165/30%) 550
Temporary differences 1,130
Deferred tax liability 1,320 at 30% 396
(680 + 90 + 550)
Deferred tax liability 16 at 25% 4.0
Deferred tax asset (200) at 30% (60.0)
Deferred tax asset (6) at 25% (1.5)
1,130 338.5
Notes
1 As no deduction is available for the cost of goodwill in the subsidiary's tax jurisdiction,
then the tax base of goodwill is zero. Paragraph 15(a) of IAS 12, states that DT Group
should not recognise a deferred tax liability of the temporary difference associated in
B's jurisdiction with the goodwill. Goodwill will be increased by the amount of the
deferred tax liability of the subsidiary ie $4 million.
2 Unrealised group profit eliminated on consolidation are provided for at the receiving
company's rate of tax (ie at 25%).
740
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
3 The tax that would arise if the properties were disposed of at their revalued amounts
which was provided at the beginning of the year will be included in the temporary
difference arising on the property, plant and equipment at 30 November 20X1.
4 DT Group has unrelieved tax losses of $300 million. This will be available for offset
against current year's profits ($110m) and against profits for the year ending 30
November 20X2 ($100m). Because of the uncertainty about the availability of taxable
profits in 20X3, no deferred tax asset can be recognised for any losses which may be
offset against this amount. Therefore, a deferred tax asset may be recognised for the
losses to be offset against taxable profits in 20X2. That is $100m 30% ie $30m.
Comment
The deferred tax liability of DT Group will rise in total by $335.5 million ($338.5m – $3m),
thus reducing net assets, distributable profits, and post-tax earnings. The profit for the year will
be reduced by $54.5 million which would probably be substantially more under IAS 12 than
the old method of accounting for deferred tax. A prior period adjustment will occur of $280m
– $3m as IAS are being applied for the first time (IFRS 1) ie $277m. The borrowing position of
the company may be affected and the directors may decide to cut dividend payments.
However, the amount of any unprovided deferred tax may have been disclosed under the
previous GAAP standard used. IAS 12 brings this liability into the statement of financial
position but if the bulk of the liability had already been disclosed the impact on the share price
should be minimal.
14 Kesare Group
(a) (i) Tax base
The tax base of an asset is the tax deduction which will be available in future
when the asset generates taxable economic benefits, which will flow to the
entity when the asset is recovered. If the future economic benefits will not be taxable,
the tax base of an asset is its carrying amount.
The tax base of a liability is its carrying amount, less the tax deduction which will be
available when the liability is settled in future periods. For revenue received in advance
(or deferred income), the tax base is its carrying amount, less any amount of
the revenue which will not be taxable in future periods.
(ii) Temporary differences
Temporary differences occur when items of revenue or expense are included in both
accounting profits and taxable profits, but not for the same accounting period.
A taxable temporary difference arises when the carrying amount of an asset
exceeds its tax base or the carrying amount of a liability is less than its tax base. All
taxable temporary differences give rise to a deferred tax liability.
A deductible temporary difference arises in the reverse circumstance (when the
carrying amount of an asset is less than its tax base or the carrying amount of a liability
is greater than its tax base). All deductible temporary differences give rise to a deferred
tax asset.
(iii) Recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities
The general requirements of IAS 12 are that deferred tax liabilities should be
recognised on all taxable temporary differences (with specific exceptions).
IAS 12 states that a deferred tax asset should be recognised for deductible temporary
differences if it is probable that a taxable profit, or sufficient taxable temporary
differences will arise in future against which the deductible temporary
difference can be utilised.
TT2020
741
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b)
Adjustments Adjusted
to financial financial Temporary
statements statements Tax base difference
$'000 $'000 $'000 $'000 $'000
Property, plant and 10,000 10,000 2,400 7,600
equipment
Goodwill 6,000 6,000 6,000
Other intangible assets 5,000 5,000 0 5,000
Financial assets (cost) 9,000 1,500 10,500 9,000 1,500
Total non-current assets 30,000 31,500
Notes on adjustments
1 The investments in equity instruments are shown at cost. However, per IFRS 9, they
should instead be valued at fair value, with the increase ($10,500 – $9,000 = $1,500)
going to other comprehensive income (items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss)
as per the irrevocable election.
742
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
2 IAS 32 states that convertible bonds must be split into debt and equity components. This
involves reducing debt and increasing equity by $400.
3 The defined benefit plan needs to be adjusted to reflect the change. The liability must be
increased by $520,000. The same amount is charged to retained earnings.
4 The development costs have already been allowed for tax, so the tax base is nil. No
deferred tax is recognised on goodwill.
5 The accrual for compensation is to be allowed when paid, ie in a later period. The tax
base relating to trade and other payables should be reduced by $1 million.
15 PQR
Investment in debentures
Given that these debentures are planned to be held until redemption, under IFRS 9 Financial
Instruments they would be held at amortised cost, on the assumption that:
(a) The objective of the business model within which the asset is held is to hold assets in order to
collect contractual cash flows; and
(b) The contractual terms of the financial asset give rise on specified dates to cash flows that are
solely payments of principal and interest on the principal outstanding.
This means that they are initially shown at their cost (including any transaction costs) and their value
increased over time to the redemption value by applying a constant effective interest rate which takes
into account not only the annual income due from the coupon, but also amortisation of the
redemption premium. Their value is reduced by distributions received, ie the coupon.
Consequently the amortised cost valuation of these debentures at the year end would be:
$
Cost (40,000 – 6,000) 34,000
Effective interest at 8.6% 2,924 shown as finance income
Coupon received (4% 40,000) (1,600) Debited to cash
35,324
The debentures are an asset belonging to the equity holders and so as the increase in value is
recognised until redemption, the equity of the business will increase, marginally reducing gearing.
Forward contract
Providing the forward meets the following criteria it qualifies for hedge accounting:
(a) The hedging relationship consists only of eligible hedging instruments and eligible
hedged items.
(b) It was designated at its inception as a hedge with full documentation of how this
hedge fits into the company's strategy.
(c) The hedging relationship meets all of the following hedge effectiveness requirements:
(i) There is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging
instrument, ie the hedging instrument and the hedged item have values that generally
move in the opposite direction because of the same risk, which is the hedged risk;
(ii) The effect of credit risk does not dominate the value changes that result from
that economic relationship, ie the gain or loss from credit risk does not frustrate the
effect of changes in the underlyings on the value of the hedging instrument or the
hedged item, even if those changes were significant; and
TT2020
743
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(iii) The hedge ratio of the hedging relationship (quantity of hedging instrument vs
quantity of hedged item) is the same as that resulting from the quantity of the hedged
item that the entity actually hedges and the quantity of the hedging instrument that
the entity actually uses to hedge that quantity of hedged item.
A foreign currency forward contract can be argued to be either a hedge of the future cash flow or a
hedge of the fair value of the machine to be purchased. IFRS 9 Financial Instruments therefore allows
foreign currency hedges of firm commitments to be classed as either a cash flow hedge or a fair
value hedge.
If the contract is classed as a cash flow hedge, given that the machine is not yet recognised in the
books, any gain or loss on the hedging instrument is split into two components:
The effective portion of the hedge (which matches the change in expected cash flow) is
recognised initially in other comprehensive income (and in the cash flow hedge reserve). It is
transferred out of the cash flow hedge reserve when the asset is recognised (adjusting the
asset base and future depreciation). This applies the accruals concept.
The ineffective portion of the hedge is recognised in profit or loss immediately as it has not
hedged anything.
If the contract is classed as a fair value hedge, all gains and losses on the hedging instrument must
be recognised immediately in profit or loss. However, in order to match those against the asset
hedged, the gain or loss on the fair value of the asset hedged is also recognised in profit or loss (and
as an asset or liability in the statement of financial position). This is arguably less transparent as it
results in part of the asset value (the change in fair value) being recognised in the statement of
financial position until the purchase actually occurs – consequently, IFRS 9 allows the option to treat
foreign currency forward contracts as a cash flow hedge.
Gearing will be different depending on whether the forward contract is accounted for as a cash flow
hedge or a fair value hedge (and whether a gain or loss on the hedging instrument occurs). Gearing
will be less volatile if a fair value hedge is used as the change in fair value of the hedged asset is
also recognised offsetting gains or losses on the hedging instrument, whereas this is not the case until
the asset is purchased (and recognised) for the cash flow hedge.
Redeemable preference shares
Redeemable preference shares, although called shares, are not, in substance, equity, they are a debt
instrument, ie a loan made to the company which receives interest and is paid back at a later date.
Consequently, IAS 32 requires them to be classed as such, ie as a non-current liability in the
statement of financial position. The 'dividends' paid will be shown in profit or loss as finance costs
and accrued at the end of the year if outstanding, whether declared or not.
The shares are consequently a financial liability held at amortised cost. In this case, given that the
shares are issued and redeemed at the same value, the effective interest rate and nominal coupon
rate will be the same (6%) and each year $6,000 will be shown as a finance cost in profit or loss
and the balance outstanding under non-current liabilities at each year end will be $100,000 as
follows:
$
Cash received/ b/d value 100,000
Effective interest at 6% 6,000 shown as finance cost
Coupon paid (6% 100,000) (6,000) credited to cash
100,000
In the financial statements for the year ending 31 December 20X7, the shares will need to be
reclassified as a current liability given that they will be repaid within one year.
Given that these shares are classed as a financial liability, gearing will be higher (as they are treated
as debt) than if they were ordinary shares (which would be treated as equity).
744
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
16 Sirus
Marking scheme
Marks
(a) Definition of financial liability and equity 3
Principle in IAS 32 1
Discussion 2
(b) IAS 19 1
Financial liability 2
Provision 1
Build up over service period 1
Recalculate annually 1
(c) Purchase method 1
Cost of business combinations 2
Future payment 1
Remuneration versus cost of acquisition 2
(d) Not exercised 2
Expected exercise 2
IFRS 9 1
Current v non-current 2
Maximum 25
TT2020
745
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
In contrast, the payment of $3 million to holders of 'B' shares, is discretionary in that it
must be approved in a general meeting by a majority of all shareholders. This approval may
be refused, and so it would not be correct to show the $3 million as a liability in the statement
of financial position at 30 April 20X8. Instead, it should be recognised when approved. The
dividend when recognised will be treated as interest expense. This is because IAS 32
(para 35–36) requires the treatment of dividends to follow the treatment of the instrument, ie
because the instrument is treated as a liability, the dividends are treated as an expense.
(b) Directors' retirement benefits
These are unfunded defined benefit plans, which are likely to be governed by IAS 19
Employee Benefits, but IAS 32 and IFRS 9 on financial instruments, and IAS 37 Provisions,
Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets also apply.
Sirus has contractual or constructive obligations to make payments to former directors. The
treatment and applicable standard depends on the obligation.
(i) Fixed annuity with payment to director's estate on death. This meets the
definition of a financial liability under IAS 32, because there is a contractual
obligation to deliver cash or a financial asset. The firm does not have the option to
withhold the payment. The rights to these annuities are earned over the directors' period
of service, so it follows that the costs should also be recognised over this service period.
(ii) Fixed annuity ceasing on death
The timing of the death is clearly uncertain, which means that the annuities have a
contingent element with a mortality risk to be calculated by an actuary. It meets the
definition of an insurance contract, which is outside the scope of IFRS 9, as are
employers' obligations under IAS 19. However, insofar as there is a constructive
obligation, these annuities fall within the scope of IAS 37, because these are liabilities
of uncertain timing or amount. The amount of the obligation should be measured in a
manner similar to a warranty provision: that is the probability of the future cash
outflow of the present obligation should be measured for the class of all such
obligations. An estimate of the costs should include any liability for post retirement
payments that directors have earned so far. The liability should be built up over the
service period and will in practice be calculated on an actuarial basis as under
IAS 19 Employee Benefits. If the effect is material, the liability will be discounted. It
should be re-calculated every year to take account of directors joining or leaving,
or any other changes.
(c) Acquisition of Marne
An increased profit share is payable to the directors of Marne if the purchase offer is
accepted. The question arises of whether this additional payment constitutes remuneration
or consideration for the business acquired. Because the payment is for two years only, after
which time remuneration falls back to normal levels, the payment should be seen as part of the
purchase consideration.
The second issue is the treatment of this consideration. IFRS 3 (revised January 2008) Business
Combinations requires that an acquirer must be identified for all business combinations. In this
case Sirus is the acquirer. The cost of the combination must be measured as the sum of the fair
values, at the date of exchange, of assets given or liabilities assumed in exchange for control.
IFRS 3 recognises that, by entering into an acquisition, the acquirer becomes obliged to make
additional payments. Not recognising that obligation means that the consideration recognised
at the acquisition date is not fairly stated.
The revised IFRS 3 requires recognition of contingent consideration, measured at
fair value, at the acquisition date. This is, arguably, consistent with how other forms of
consideration are fair valued.
746
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
The acquirer may be required to pay contingent consideration in the form of equity or of a
debt instrument or cash. In this case, it is in the form of cash, or increased remuneration.
Accordingly, the cost of the combination must include the full $11m, measured at
net present value at 1 May 20X7. The payment of $5 million would be discounted for one
year and the payment of $6 million for two years.
(d) Repayment of bank loan
The bank loan is to be repaid in ten years' time, but the terms of the loan state that Sirus can
pay it off in seven years. The issue arises as to whether the early repayment option is
likely to be exercised.
If, when the loan was taken out on 1 May 20X7 the option of early repayment was not
expected to be exercised, then at 30 April 20X8 the normal terms apply. The loan would
be stated at $2 million in the statement of financial position, and the effective interest would be
8% $2 million = $160,000, the interest paid.
If at 1 May 20X7 it was expected that the early repayment option would be
exercised, then the effective interest rate would be 9.1%, and the effective interest
9.1% $2 million = $182,000. The cash paid would still be $160,000, and the difference of
$22,000 would be added to the carrying amount of the financial liability in the statement of
financial position, giving $2,022,000.
IFRS 9 Financial Instruments requires that the carrying amount of a financial asset or liability
should be adjusted to reflect actual cash flows or revised estimates of cash flows. This means
that, even if it was thought at the outset that early repayment would not take place, if
expectations then change, the carrying amount must be revised to reflect future
estimated cash flows using the effective interest rate.
The directors of Sirus are currently in discussion with the bank regarding repayment in the next
financial year. However, these discussions do not create a legal obligation to repay the loan
in 12 months, and Sirus has an unconditional right to defer settlement for longer than
12 months. Accordingly, it would not be correct to show the loan as a current
liability on the basis of the discussions with the bank.
17 Debt vs equity
Most ordinary shares are treated as equity as they do not contain a contractual obligation to deliver
cash.
However, in the case of the directors' shares, a contractual obligation to deliver cash exists on a
specific date as the shares are redeemable at the end of the service contract.
The redemption is not discretionary, and Scott has no right to avoid it. The mandatory nature of the
repayment makes this capital a financial liability. The financial liability will initially be recognised at
its fair value, ie the present value of the payment at the end of the service contract. It will be
subsequently measured at amortised cost and effective interest will be applied over the period of the
service contract.
Dividend payments on the shares are discretionary as they must be ratified at the annual general
meeting. Therefore, no liability should be recognised for any dividend until it is ratified. When
recognised, the classification of the dividend should be consistent with the classification of the shares
and therefore any dividends are classified as a finance cost rather than as a deduction from retained
earnings.
TT2020
747
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
18 Vesting conditions
STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 30 SEPTEMBER 20X3 (Extract)
Employee expense $76,667
STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AT 30 SEPTEMBER 20X3 (Extract)
Equity (IFRS 2 reserve) $126,667
Explanation
The impact of the expected share price is a market-based vesting condition and is ignored in
calculating the IFRS 2 expense. The grant date fair value of the options is used in the calculation. The
number of options vesting for each executive is dependent on the expected cumulative profit over the
three year period. This is a non-market based performance condition and is taken into account in the
calculation of the IFRS 2 expense. At 30 September 20X2, the expected cumulative profit is $39 million,
so 1,500 options per director are expected to vest. At 30 September 20X3, the expected cumulative
profit is increased to $45 million, so 2,000 options per director are expected to vest. The expense
should be spread over the three year vesting period and be based on the latest estimate of the
number of directors expected to be in employment on the vesting date.
The calculations are as follows:
19 Lowercroft
(a) Equity-settled
In this case, the fair value of the share-based payment to be recognised is the fair value of the
equity instruments at the grant date.
This is not all recognised in the financial statements at once, however, but is built up gradually
over the vesting period. This is the period between the grant date and the vesting date (the
vesting date is when the employee is entitled to receive the equity instruments).
Therefore each year the statement of profit or loss shows the amount of fair value that has
been built up during the year – the difference between the fair value of the SBP recognised in
the opening and closing statements of financial position.
The statement of financial position shows the fair value of the SBP that has been recognised to
date, within equity.
One complication is that the vesting may be subject to certain conditions, so it is not certain
what the fair value of the SBP will be. In this case, an estimate should be made based on the
information available.
748
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
Cash-settled
The liability should be measured at its fair value at the end of the reporting period. The liability
should be recognised as the employees render their service.
(b) Scheme A – equity-settled
The vesting period is three years (1 October 20X7 – 30 September 20Y0).
The fair value of the scheme brought forward is 500 185 $2.40 = $222,000. The amount
that would have been recognised in the statement of financial position for 20X8 was therefore
$222,000 1/3 = $74,000.
The fair value of the scheme carried forward at 30 September 20X9 is 500 188 $2.40 =
$225,600.
The amount recognised in the statement of financial position for 20X9 was therefore
$225,600 2/3 = $150,400. This is recognised within equity.
The statement of profit or loss charge for 20X9 is therefore $150,400 – $74,000 = $76,400.
Scheme B – cash-settled
The employees render their services over the period from 1 October 20X6 to 30 September
20X9 – 3 years.
The fair value of the final liability as at 30 September 20X8 would have been 2 240
$540 = $259,200. The amount that would have been recognised in the statement of financial
position for 20X8 was therefore $259,200 2/3 = $172,800.
The fair value of the final liability as at 30 September 20X9 would have been 2 238
$600 = $285,600.
This is recognised in the statement of financial position for 20X9 as a current liability, as it is
payable within one year of the period end, on 31 January 20Y0.
The statement of profit or loss charge for 20X9 is therefore $285,600 – $172,800 =
$112,800.
20 Highland
HIGHLAND GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MARCH 20X8
$'000
Revenue (5,000 + 3,000 + (2,910 4 )) 8,970
12
Cost of sales (3,000 + 2,300 + (2,820 4 )) (6,240)
12
Gross profit 2,730
Administrative expenses (1,000 + 500 + (150 4 ) + (W4) 63.5 + (W5) 5 – (1,599)
12
(W6) 85 + (W8) 65)
Finance income* (230 + (W3) 35 – (W6) 85 – (W6) 40) 140
Finance costs (50 + (210 4 ) – (W3) 70) (50)
12
Profit before tax 1,221
Income tax expense (300 + 50) (350)
PROFIT FOR THE YEAR 871
Other comprehensive income, net of tax (130 + 40 + (120 4 )) 210
12
TOTAL COMPREHENSIVE INCOME FOR THE YEAR 1,081
TT2020
749
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
$'000
Aviemore Buchan
80% 65% (owned for 4 months)
2 Non-controlling interests
Aviemore Buchan Aviemore Buchan
$'000 $'000 $'000 $'000
Profit/(loss) for the year
4 100.0 (90)
(B: 270 loss × )
12
Total comp income for the year
4
(B: 150 loss × )
140.0 (50)
12
Unrealised profit on disposal (W4) (63.5) (63.5)
FV depreciation (W5) (5) (5)
36.5 (95) 76.5 (55)
(26.0) CR (4.0) CR
Hence, rounding to nearest $'000, NCI increases profit/total comprehensive income
attributable to owners of the parent.
750
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
3 Interest income/payable
$'000
Interest income: $2,100,000 10% 6/12 105 recorded on 1 October 20X7
6/12 105 to be recorded
210
Pre-acquisition Post-acquisition
TT2020
751
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
CREDIT Administrative expenses $85,000
Cancel dividend income from Aviemore:
DEBIT Other income (50 80%) $40,000
CREDIT Aviemore's retained earnings $40,000
7 Goodwill
Aviemore Buchan
$'000 $'000 $'000 $'000
Consideration transferred 5,000 2,600
Non-controlling interests (4,000 80%) 800 (3,500 35%) 1,225
21 Investor
(a) The recognition and measurement of goodwill on acquisition is governed by IFRS 3. Where
the purchase price is paid in instalments, the cost of the investment is calculated on a
discounted cash basis and the fair value is based on present values.
Goodwill arising on acquisitions
$m $m
30 m 54.793
Cost of Cornwall 30 m 2
1.10
Net assets 55
Add back pension provision 6
Deduct pension scheme deficit (11)
50
Fair value of assets acquired (80% $50m) 40.000
Goodwill 14.793
752
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
Goodwill recognised in a business acquisition is not amortised, but reviewed for impairment
annually.
(b) MEMORANDUM
To: The financial director
From: The accountant
Subject: Intangible assets
1 Introduction
It is group policy to write off all intangible assets over 20 years. This complies with the
requirements of IAS 38.
However it is possible to select a longer period.
2 Determining the useful life of an intangible asset
IAS 38 states that an entity should assess the useful life of its intangible assets. Assets
with a finite useful life are amortised over that useful life.
The useful life of an intangible asset depends on many factors. For example, many
computer related assets have short lives because they are susceptible to technological
obsolescence. Where an asset arises from contractual or legal rights, the period of the
rights normally determines the useful life. However, some types of asset, such as brand
names, may have very long lives or indefinite lives.
An intangible asset has an indefinite useful life when there is no foreseeable limit to
the period over which the asset is expected to generate net cash inflows for the entity.
IAS 38 allows intangible assets to be treated as having indefinite lives. An intangible
asset with an indefinite life is not amortised.
However, it is clearly not appropriate to treat assets as having an indefinite useful life
unless this can be demonstrated to be the case. IAS 38 requires that the useful life of an
asset should be realistic; it is not acceptable to select a useful life simply on the basis of
practical simplicity or expediency.
Therefore, it is possible to avoid amortising intangible assets in theory; but the
intangible assets needs to be able to be continually measured, so that impairment
reviews can be carried out.
3 Future implications
Where an intangible asset is assessed as having an indefinite useful life, IAS 38
requires an impairment review to be carried out annually. In addition, the useful life of
the asset should be reviewed each period to determine whether events and
circumstances continue to support this assessment.
If an asset is assessed as having a finite useful life, then an impairment review is only
required if there are indications that the carrying value is not recoverable.
Therefore adopting your proposals would mean carrying out an annual impairment
review, which could be costly both in time and staff.
(c) Arguments for capitalisation
(i) The statement of financial position reflects commercial reality if brands are included,
provided they meet fully the IAS 38 definition of a purchased intangible asset.
(ii) IAS 38 does not permit non purchased or internally generated brands to be recognised.
This may be unfair since predator entities could acquire entities with valuable brand
names at less than true value.
TT2020
753
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(iii) Many entities would argue that the inclusion of non-purchased brands might provide
valuable information to users. However, the difficulties associated with revaluation and
assigning an appropriate amortisation period may negate these benefits.
22 ROB Group
(a) Treatment of PER in the consolidated financial statements of ROB
The acquisition of the additional 60% shareholding on 1 April 20X3 brings ROB's total
investment in PER to 75% (15% + 60%), giving ROB control of PER, making PER a subsidiary.
Therefore, PER must be consolidated.
This is a mid-year acquisition so the results of PER would have to be pro-rated and only
the post-acquisition 6 months' results included in the consolidated statement of profit or loss
and other comprehensive income and in group retained earnings.
In the consolidated statement of financial position, 100% of PER's assets and liabilities
must be consolidated with a 25% non-controlling interest.
This step acquisition involves a change in status for PER from an investment (where ROB
had no significant influence or control) to a subsidiary. The change in investment from 15%
to 75% crosses the 50% control boundary, so:
The substance of the transaction is that the 15% investment has been 'sold', so it must
be remeasured to its fair value at the date of the change in status. Since the investment
has been treated at fair value through profit or loss, this gain or loss must be recognised
in profit or loss.
In substance, ROB has 'purchased' a 75% subsidiary on 1 April 20X3. Goodwill should
be calculated as if the full 75% were acquired on that date.
(b) ROB GROUP CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AS AT
30 SEPTEMBER 20X3
$'000 $'000
ASSETS
Non-current assets
754
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
$'000 $'000
Non-current liabilities
5% bonds 20X6 (3,900 + 112 (W6)) 4,012
Current liabilities (8,100 + 2,000) 10,100
44,400
Workings
1 Group structure
ROB
2 Goodwill
$'000 $'000
Consideration transferred (for 60%) 3,200
Non-controlling interest (at fair value) 1,000
Fair value of previously held investment (for 15%) 800
Less: fair value of net assets
Share capital 1,000
Retained earnings (W1) 3,500
(4,500)
500
Impairment (60)
440
TT2020
755
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
5 Gain on remeasurement of investment
$'000
Fair value at date control was achieved (1 April 20X3) 800
Less: Carrying amount (fair value at 30 September 20X2) (650)
Gain on remeasurement 150
Note. Prior to PER becoming a subsidiary, the 15% investment was treated at fair value
through profit or loss. Therefore, the original cost of $600,000 was revalued to a fair
value of $650,000 at the previous year end of 30 September 20X2. On achieving
control on 1 April 20X3, in substance, ROB has 'sold' a 15% investment and 'purchased'
a 75% subsidiary. The 15% investment is therefore remeasured to its fair value of
$800,000 on 1 April 20X3 and then derecognised. As it had a carrying amount of
$650,000 at that date, this results in a remeasurement gain of $150,000 and since
ROB has been treating the investment at fair value through profit or loss, this gain of
$150,000 must be recognised in profit or loss (P/L). This will then feed through to
retained earnings. (If ROB had taken up the irrevocable election under IFRS 9 to
measure the investment at fair value through other comprehensive income (OCI), the
gain would have been recognised in OCI rather than P/L).
6 Bonds
$'000
1.10.X2 Net proceeds 3,900
Finance cost (3,900 8%) 312
Interest paid (4,000 5%) (200)
30.9.X3 Balance c/d 4,012
The adjustment required to recognise the full effective finance cost (312,000 −
200,000) is:
DEBIT (↑ ) Finance costs ((↓ ) Retained earnings) $112,000
CREDIT (↑ ) Non-current liability $112,000
Note. These bonds are a financial liability. As they are neither 'held for trading' nor
derivatives, they should be initially be measured at fair value less transaction costs of
$3.9 million ($4 million less $100,000 issue costs) and subsequently measured at
amortised cost.
7 Provision for unrealised profit
PER (subsidiary) sold to ROB (parent).
Unrealised profit = $400,000 20% margin ½ in inventory = $40,000
The adjustment required is:
DEBIT (↓ ) PER's retained earnings $40,000
CREDIT (↓ ) Inventories $40,000
756
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
23 Gaze
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X5
$m
Revenue (2,500 + 1,500) 4,000
Cost of sales and expenses (1,900 + 1,200) (3,100)
Profit before tax 900
Income tax expense (180 + 90) (270)
Profit for the year 630
Other comprehensive income
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
Gains on property revaluation, net of tax (80 + 30) 110
Total comprehensive income for the year 740
Workings
1 Group structure
Gaze
1.1.X3 60%
1.5.X5 10%
80%
Trek
2 Non-controlling interests
Profit for the year
1.1.X5 1.5.X5
– 30.4.X5 – 31.12.X5
$m $m
Per question (PFY 210 4/12) (TCI 210 8/12) 70 140
NCI% 40% 30%
= 28 = 42
70
Total comprehensive income
1.1.X5 1.5.X5
– 30.4.X5 – 31.12.X5
$m $m
Per question (PFY 240 × 4/12) (TCI 240 × 8/12) 80 160
NCI% 40% 30%
= 32 = 48
80
TT2020
757
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Tutorial note
As Trek was a subsidiary for the full year, no pro-rating is required and a full year of Trek's income
and expenses have been consolidated on a line by line basis.
However, as the group shareholding in the subsidiary changed partway through the year, the
non-controlling interest (NCI) percentage also changed. Therefore, profit for the year and total
comprehensive income must be pro-rated then the relevant percentages applied when calculating
NCI.
Note that there is no gain or loss on remeasurement of the previously held investment because no
accounting boundary has been crossed. Instead an adjustment to equity would be recorded in the
consolidated statement of financial position.
758
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
$m
Total comprehensive income attributable to:
Owners of the parent 150
9 3
Non-controlling interests [(50 15%) + (50 35%)]
10
12 12
160
TT2020
759
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Workings
1 Timeline
SPLOCI
Subsidiary – all year
760
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
25 Burley
Marking scheme
Marks
(a) Revenue recognition 3
Inventory 3
Events after reporting period 3
9
TT2020
761
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(a) Revenue from the sale of goods should only be recognised when all the following
conditions are satisfied.
(i) The entity has transferred the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the
goods to the buyer
(ii) The entity has no continuing managerial involvement to the degree usually
associated with ownership, and no longer has effective control over the goods sold
(iii) The amount of revenue can be measured reliably
(iv) It is probable that the economic benefits associated with the transaction will flow to
the enterprise
(v) The costs incurred in respect of the transaction can be measured reliably
The transfer of risks and rewards can only be decided by examining each transaction. In the
case of the oil sold to third parties, all the revenue should be recognised as all the criteria
have been met.
IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers requires revenue to be recognised when (or
as) a performance obligation is satisfied ie when an entity transfers a promised good or
service to a customer. The good or service is considered transferred when (or as) the customer
obtains control of that good or service (ie the ability to direct the use of, and obtain
substantially all of the remaining benefits from, the asset).
The sale of oil results in satisfaction of an obligation at a point in time. To determine the point
in time when a customer obtains control of a promised asset and an entity satisfies a
performance obligation, the entity would consider indicators of the transfer of control that
include, but are not limited to, the following.
(i) The entity has a present right to payment for the asset.
(ii) The customer has legal title to the asset.
(iii) The entity has transferred physical possession of the asset.
(iv) The customer has the significant risks and rewards of ownership of the asset.
(v) The customer has accepted the asset.
These criteria need to be assessed on a transaction by transaction basis. In the case of the oil
sold to third parties, revenue should be recognised as the performance obligation is the
delivery of the oil to the customers which took place prior to the year end. Control has been
transferred as the customers can now obtain the benefits of the oil either through use or resale.
Revenue up to 1 October 20X9
The arrangement between Burley and Slite is a joint arrangement under IFRS 11 Joint
Arrangements, since both entities jointly control an asset – the oilfield. However, the
arrangement is not structured as a separate entity, so it is a joint operation not a joint
venture. This means that each company accounts for its share of revenue in respect
of oil produced up to 1 October 20X9, calculated, using the selling price to third parties of
$100 per barrel, as:
Burley: 60%
Slite: 40%
Excess oil extracted
Burley has over-extracted and Slite under-extracted by 10,000 barrels of oil. The substance
of the transaction is that Burley has purchased the oil from Slite at the point of
production at the market value ruling at that point, namely $100 per barrel. Burley should
therefore recognise a purchase from Slite in the amount of 10,000 × $100 = $1m.
762
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
TT2020
763
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
A joint arrangement is an arrangement, as here, of which two or more parties have joint
control. A joint venture is a joint arrangement whereby the parties that have control of the
arrangement have rights to the net assets of the arrangement.
Wells is a separate vehicle. As such, it could be either a joint operation or joint venture, so
other facts must be considered.
There are no facts that suggest that Burley and Jorge have rights to substantially all the benefits
of the assets of Wells nor an obligation for its liabilities.
Each party's liability is limited to any unpaid capital contribution.
As a result, each party has an interest in the net assets of Wells and should account for it as
a joint venture using the equity method.
Decommissioning costs
Decommissioning costs are not payable until some future date, therefore the amount of
costs that will be incurred is generally uncertain. IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment
requires that management should record its best estimate of the entity's obligations. Since
the cash flows are delayed, discounting is used. The estimate of the amount payable is
discounted to the date of initial recognition and the discounted amount is capitalised. A
corresponding credit is recorded in provisions. Changes in the liability and resulting from
changes in the discount rate adjust the cost of the related asset in the current period.
The decommissioning costs of Wells are accounted for as follows:
$m
Cost ten years ago 240.0
Depreciation: 240 10/40 (60.0)
Decrease in decommissioning costs:
32.6 – 18.5 (14.1)
Carrying value at 1 December 20X8 165.9
Less depreciation: 165.9 ÷ 30 years (5.5)
Carrying amount at 30 November 20X9 160.4
764
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
(iv) Its share of the revenue from the sale of the output by the joint operation;
and
(v) Its expenses, including its share of any expenses incurred jointly.
This treatment is applicable in both the separate and consolidated financial statements of the
joint operator.
(c) Intangible asset
The relevant standard here is IAS 38 Intangible Assets. An intangible asset may be recognised
if it meets the identifiability criteria in IAS 38, if it is probable that future economic
benefits attributable to the asset will flow to the entity and if its fair value can be
measured reliably. For an intangible asset to be identifiable, the asset must be separable,
or it must arise from contractual or other legal rights.
It appears that these criteria have been met. The licence has been acquired separately,
and its value can be measured reliably at the purchase price.
Burley does not yet know if the extraction of oil is commercially viable, and does not know for
sure whether oil will be discovered in the region. If, on further exploration, some or all
activities must be discontinued, then the licence must be tested for impairment following
IAS 36 Impairment of Assets. (IAS 36 has a number of impairment indicators, both internal
and external.)
It is possible that the licence may increase in value if commercial viability is proven.
However, IAS 38 does not allow revaluation unless there is an active market for the asset.
26 Harvard
(a) HARVARD GROUP
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION AT 31 DECEMBER 20X5
$'000
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment (2,870 + (W2) 1,350) 4,220
Goodwill (W4) 183
4,403
Current assets
Inventories (1,990 + (W2) 2,310) 4,300
Trade receivables (1,630 + (W2) 1,270) 2,900
Cash at bank and in hand (240 + (W2) 560) 800
8,000
12,403
Equity attributable to owners of the parent
Share capital ($1) 118
Retained earnings (W5) 2,607
Other components of equity – translation reserve (W7) 410
3,135
Non-controlling interests (W6) 1,108
4,243
Non-current liabilities
Loans 1,920
Current liabilities
Trade payables (5,030 + (W2) 1,210) 6,240
12,403
TT2020
765
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(b) CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE
INCOME FOR YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 20X5
$'000
Revenue (40,425 + (W3) 25,900) 66,325
Cost of sales (35,500 + (W3) 20,680) (56,180)
Gross profit 10,145
Distribution and administrative expenses (4,400 + (W3) 1,560) (5,960)
Profit before tax 4,185
Income tax expense (300 + (W3) 1,260) (1,560)
PROFIT FOR THE YEAR 2,625
Other comprehensive income:
Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss:
Exchange differences on translating foreign operations (W8) 320
Other comprehensive income for the year 320
TOTAL COMPREHENSIVE INCOME FOR THE YEAR 2,945
Workings
1 Group structure
Harvard
766
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
4 Goodwill
PLN'000 PLN'000 Rate $'000
Consideration transferred (840 4.40) 3,696 840
Non-controlling interests (at FV: 270 4.40) 1,188 270
TT2020
767
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
6 Non-controlling interests (SOFP)
$'000
NCI at acquisition (given in the question) 270
NCI share of post-acquisition retained earnings ((W5) 2,807 25%) 702
NCI share of exchange difference on net assets ((W2) 513 25%) 128
NCI share of exchange differences on goodwill (((W4) 15 + 18) 25%) 8
1,108
27 Porter
PORTER GROUP
STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 MAY 20X6
$m $m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit before taxation 112
Adjustments for:
Depreciation 44
Impairment losses on goodwill (W1) 3
Foreign exchange loss (W7) 2
Investment income – share of profit of associate (12)
Investment income – gains on financial assets at fair value through
profit or loss (6)
Interest expense 16
159
768
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
$m $m
Increase in trade receivables (W4) (4)
Decrease in inventories (W4) 34
Decrease in trade payables (W4) (17)
Cash generated from operations 172
Interest paid (W5) (12)
Income taxes paid (W3) (37)
Workings
1 Assets
Property,
plant and Financial
equipment Goodwill Associate asset
$m $m $m $m
b/d 812 10 39 –
P/L 12 6
OCI 58 8
Depreciation/ Impairment (44) (3)
Acquisition of sub/assoc 92 8 (W6)
Additions on credit (W7) 15
Cash paid/(rec'd) 25 – (11) 10
c/d 958 15 48 16
Note. The share of the associate's profit, recognised in the consolidated statement of profit or
loss and other comprehensive income, is not a cash item so is added back on the face of the
statement of cash flows in the section that calculates the cash generated from operations. The
dividend received from the associate is the cash item and appears in the investing activities
section.
TT2020
769
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
2 Equity
Non-
Share Share Retained controlling
capital premium earnings interest
$m $m $m $m
b/d 300 172 165 28
TCI 68 12
Acquisition of subsidiary 24 30 48 (W6)
Cash (paid)/rec'd 8 10 (45)* (4)*
c/d 332 212 188 84
*80 60%/2 SC, 80 60%/2 1.25 SP
**Dividend paid is given in question but working shown for clarity.
3 Liabilities
Tax
Loans payable
$m $m
(22 + 26)
b/d 320 48
P/L 34
OCI 17
Acquisition of subsidiary 4
Cash (paid)/rec'd 60 (37)
c/d 380 66
(28 + 38)
770
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
28 Grow by acquisition
(a) Note 1
The substance of this transaction is that X has made a loan of $2.4m to A. All aspects of the
'sale' should be eliminated, as follows.
(i) Reduce revenue by $2,400,000
(ii) Reduce cost of sales by $2,400,000 100/160 = $1,500,000
(iii) Reduce gross profit by ($2,400,000 – $1,500,000) = $900,000
(iv) Increase loans by $2,400,000
Note 2
To be comparable, the non-current assets of A and B should either both be shown at cost or
both at a revalued amount, with the revaluation done on the same basis. It is not feasible to
'revalue' A's non-current assets for purposes of comparison. However, B's non-current assets
can be shown at cost by reversing out the revaluation, as follows.
(i) Reduce non-current assets by $5,000,000
(ii) Reduce the revaluation reserve to nil
(iii) Reduce cost of sales by $1,000,000 – this is the excess depreciation no longer
required (being the $6,000,000 revaluation less the $5,000,000 remaining in the
reserve at year end)
(iv) Increase gross profit, operating profit, profit for the year and profit before tax by
$1,000,000
Summary
A
Item Per original
f/s Adjustment New figure
$'000 $'000 $'000
Revenue 68,000 (2,400) 65,600
Cost of sales 42,000 (1,500) 40,500
Gross profit 26,000 (900) 25,100
Profit from operations 8,000 (900) 7,100
Inventory 6,000 1,500 7,500
Short term borrowing 4,000 2,400 6,400
Total borrowings (4,000 + 16,000) 20,000 2,400 22,400
Shareholders' funds 23,500 (900) 22,600
TT2020
771
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
B
Item Per original
f/s Adjustment New figure
$'000 $'000 $'000
Non-current assets 35,050 (5,000) 30,050
Revaluation reserve 5,000 (5,000) Nil
Cost of sales 45,950 (1,000) 44,950
Gross profit 20,050 1,000 21,050
Profit from operations 6,050 1,000 7,050
Profit before tax 2,050 1,000 3,050
Profit for the year 1,050 1,000 2,050
Shareholders' funds 22,050 (5,000) 17,050
(b) All monetary amounts in $'000
Ratio A B
Return on capital 7,100 7,050
employed = 15.8% = 17.2%
22, 600 + 22, 400 17,050 + 6,000 +18,000
Gross profit 25,100 21, 050
margin = 38.3% = 31.9%
65, 600 66, 000
Asset 65, 600 66, 000
turnover = 1.7 = 1.9
50, 000 +1, 500 – 10, 500 + 2, 400 52, 050 – 5, 000 – 12, 000
BPP note. The effective loan of $2.4m could arguably be excluded from borrowings as it is short
term.
(c) The adjustments carried out to make the financial statements of the two entities comparable
make it far less easy to decide which entity to target. A has a higher gross profit and
gross profit margin. However, the return on capital employed is lower. The main
reason for this is that A's other operating expenses are higher than B's. The revenue figures
are not significantly different following the elimination of the 'sale' from the accounts of A.
The asset turnover ratio is slightly in favour of company B but there is not significant difference
between the two companies
Where A has an advantage over B is in the adjusted debt/equity ratio. Whether this
influences the directors' decision depends on whether they intend to change the financial
structure of the company.
As it is very difficult to make a decision based purely on the ratios, it is important to consider
additional factors that may help the directors to decide. They should consider the reputation of
each company, researching media publications may give insight into any public matters the
directors need to be aware of. Reviewing non-financial elements of A and B's annual report
may help to reveal for example each company's environmental policies, the importance it
places on staff wellbeing, the commitments it has to reducing emissions. The directors may
wish to consider the management structure of A and B and the personalities in place in order
to assess how easy it will be to integrate the investment into Expand. It is highly likely the
directors of Expand will want to look at the statements of cash flows of each company in order
to understand how they generate and use cash and whether cash injections are likely to be
needed. Using four ratios for investment appraisal is very narrow and a wider set of
information should be considered.
772
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
29 Ghorse
Marking scheme
Marks
(a) Discontinuance 6
(b) Deferred tax asset 5
(c) Impairment 5
(d) Lease 4
Formation of opinion of impact on ROCE 2
Non-financial performance indicators 3
Maximum 25
(a) The criteria in IFRS 5 Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations have
been met for Cee and Gee. As the assets are to be disposed of in a single transaction, Cee
and Gee together are deemed to be a disposal group under IFRS 5.
The disposal group as a whole is measured on the basis required for non-current
assets held for sale. Any impairment loss reduces the carrying amount of the non-current
assets in the disposal group, the loss being allocated in the order required by IAS 36
Impairment of Assets. Before the manufacturing units are classified as held for sale, impairment
is tested for on an individual cash generating unit basis. Once classified as held for sale, the
impairment testing is done on a disposal group basis.
A disposal group that is held for sale should be measured at the lower of its carrying
amount and fair value less costs to sell. Immediately before classification of a disposal
group as held for sale, the entity must recognise impairment in accordance with applicable
IFRS. Any impairment loss is generally recognised in profit or loss, but if the asset has been
measured at a revalued amount under IAS 16 Property, Plant and Equipment or IAS 38
Intangible Assets, the impairment will be treated as a revaluation decrease. Once the disposal
group has been classified as held for sale, any impairment loss will be based on the
difference between the adjusted carrying amounts and the fair value less cost
to sell. The impairment loss (if any) will be recognised in profit or loss.
A subsequent increase in fair value less costs to sell may be recognised in profit or loss
only to the extent of any impairment previously recognised. To summarise:
Step 1 Calculate carrying value under the individual standard, here given as $105 million.
Step 2 Classified as held for sale. Compare the carrying amount ($105m) with fair value
less costs to sell ($125m). Measure at the lower of carrying value and fair value
less costs to sell, here $105 million.
Step 3 Determine fair value less costs to sell at the year-end (see below) and compare
with carrying value of $105 million.
Ghorse has not taken account of the increase in fair value less cost to sell, but
only part of this increase can be recognised, calculated as follows.
$m
Fair value less costs to sell: Cee 40
Fair value less costs to sell: Gee 95
135
Carrying value (105)
Increase 30
Impairment previously recognised in Cee: $15 million ($50m – $35m)
TT2020
773
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Step 4 The change in fair value less cost to sell is recognised but the gain recognised
cannot exceed any impairment losses to date. Here the gain recognised is $50m
– $35m = $15m
Therefore carrying value can increase by $15m to $120m as loss reversals are limited to
impairment losses previously recognised (under IFRS 5 or IAS 36).
These adjustments will affect ROCE.
(b) IAS 12 Income Taxes requires that deferred tax liabilities must be recognised for all taxable
temporary differences. Deferred tax assets should be recognised for deductible temporary
differences but only to the extent that taxable profits will be available against which the
deductible temporary differences may be utilised.
The differences between the carrying amounts and the tax base represent temporary
differences. These temporary differences are revised in the light of the revaluation for
tax purposes to market value permitted by the government.
Deferred tax liability before revaluation
Carrying Temporary
amount Tax base difference
$m $m $m
Property 50 48 2
Vehicles 30 28 2
4
Other temporary differences 5
9
Provision: 30% $9m = $2.7m
Deferred tax asset after revaluation
Carrying Temporary
amount Tax base difference
$m $m $m
Property 50 65 15
Vehicles 30 35 5
Other temporary differences (5)
15
Deferred tax asset: $15m 30% = $4.5m
This will have a considerable impact on ROCE. While the release of the provision of
$2.7 million and the creation of the asset of $4.5 million will not affect the numerator, profit
before interest and tax (although it will affect profit or loss for the year), it will significantly
affect the capital employed figure.
(c) IAS 36 Impairment of Assets requires that no asset should be carried at more than its
recoverable amount. At each reporting date, Ghorse must review all assets for
indications of impairment, that is indications that the carrying value may be higher than
the recoverable amount. Such indications include fall in the market value of an asset or
adverse changes in the technological, economic or legal environment of the business. (IAS 36
has an extensive list of criteria.) If impairment is indicated, then the asset's recoverable
amount must be calculated. The manufacturer has reduced the selling price, but this does not
automatically mean that the asset is impaired.
The recoverable amount is defined as the higher of the asset's fair value less
disposal of disposal and its value in use. If the recoverable amount is less than the
774
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
carrying amount, then the resulting impairment loss should be charged to profit or loss as an
expense.
Value in use is the discounted present value of estimated future cash flows expected to arise
from the continuing use of an asset and from its disposal at the end of its useful life. The value
in use of the equipment is calculated as follows:
Year ended 31 October Cash flows Discounted (10%)
$m $m
20X8 1.3 1.2
20X9 2.2 1.8
20Y0 2.3 1.7
Value in use 4.7
The fair value less disposal costs of the asset is estimated at $2 million. The recoverable
amount must be the value in use of $4.7 million, as this is higher. Since the recoverable
amount is higher than the carrying value of $3 million, the asset is not
impaired. Consequently there will be no effect on ROCE.
(d) The manufacturing property was held under an operating lease. IAS 17 Leases required that
operating lease payments are charged to profit or loss over the term of the lease, generally on
straight line basis.
The renegotiation of the lease means that its terms have changed significantly. In addition,
IFRS 16 now requires that all leases of more than 12 months (other than leases of low-
value assets) must be recognised in the statement of financial position.
Since the IFRS 16 is now in force, it will be shown in the statement of financial position. The
entity must measure the lease liability at present value of the remaining lease
payments ($(5 × 6.8137)m = $34.1m), ie at $34.1 million. The entity must also
recognise a right-of-use asset of $34.1 million.
However, since both assets and liabilities would increase, this reclassification would not
affect ROCE.
Recalculation of ROCE
$m
Profit before interest and tax 30.0
Add increase in value of disposal group 15.0
45.0
30 German competitor
Tutorial note
You do not need to know about German accounting practice to answer this question, just a basic
knowledge of the differences between the European and UK models and your common sense! Think
of this as an interpretation of accounts questions.
776
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
860
778
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
Effective self-regulation minimises risk of regulatory intervention and can ensure that if for
example the government made cutting emissions mandatory, the company would be well
placed to demonstrate commitment to this.
It may improve access to lists of 'preferred suppliers' of buyers with green procurement
policies.
The benefits should however always be weighed up against the additional costs of preparing the
information and the potential loss of competitive advantage that can come from additional
disclosure.
31 Peter Holdings
Divisional performance should be measured, in the interests of the group's shareholders, in such
a way as to indicate what sort of return each subsidiary is making on the shareholder's
investment. Shareholders themselves are likely to be interested in the performance of the group as
a whole, measured in terms of return on shareholders' capital, earnings per share, dividend yield,
and growth in earnings and dividends. These performance ratios cannot be used for subsidiaries in
the group, and so an alternative measure has to be selected, which compares the return from the
subsidiary with the value of the investment in the subsidiary.
Two performance measures could be used. Both would provide a suitable indication of performance
from the point of view of the group's shareholders.
(a) Return on capital employed, which from the shareholders' point of view would be:
32 Jay
Marking scheme
(a) Inventory 4
Investment property 4
TT2020
779
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
(a) The initial transaction of the purchase of goods from the foreign supplier would be recorded
in the ledger accounts at $5 million (€8/1.6). Both the purchase and the payables
balance would be recorded at this amount. At the year end the payables balance is
restated to the closing rate as it is a monetary liability, but the inventories are
non-monetary and therefore remain at $5 million. Therefore the payable is restated to
$6.2 million (€8m/1.3) and an exchange loss is taken to profit or loss of $1.2 million
($6.2m – 5m).
On the sale, the original transaction is recorded at $2.5 million (€4m/1.6) as both a sale
and a receivable. When payment is made the amount actually received is $3.1 million
(€4m/1.3) and an exchange gain is recognised in profit or loss of $0.6 million ($3.1 –
2.5m).
When the investment property was first purchased it should have been recognised in the
statement of financial position at $20 million (€28m/1.4). At the year end the investment
property has fallen in value to €24 million and the exchange rate has changed to 1.3.
Therefore at 31 May 20X6 the property would be valued at $18.5 million (€24m/1.3).
The fall in value of $1.5 million ($20 – 18.5m) is recognised in profit or loss. The loss is
a mixture of a fall in value of the property and a gain due to the exchange rate movement.
However, as the investment property is a non-monetary asset the foreign currency
element is not recognised separately.
(b) Nature of corporate citizenship
Increasingly businesses are expected to be socially responsible as well as profitable.
Strategic decisions by businesses, particularly global businesses nearly always have wider
social consequences. It could be argued, as Henry Mintzburg does, that a company produces
two outputs: goods and services, and the social consequences of its activities, such as
pollution.
One major development in the area of corporate citizenship is the environmental report.
While this is not a legal requirement, a large number of major companies produce them.
Worldwide there are around 20 award schemes for environmental reporting, notably the
ACCA's.
Jay might be advised to adopt the guidelines on sustainability given in the Global
Reporting Initiative. These guidelines cover a number of areas (economic, environmental
and social). The GRI specifies key performance indicators for each area. For environmental
reporting, the indicators are:
(i) Energy
(ii) Water
(iii) Biodiversity
(iv) Emissions
(v) Energy and waste
(vi) Products and services
(vii) Compliance
(viii) Transport
Another environmental issue which the company could consider is emission levels from
factories. Many companies now include details of this in their environmental report.
The other main aspect of corporate citizenship where Jay scores highly is in its treatment of
its workforce. The company sees the workforce as the key factor in the growth of its
business. The car industry had a reputation in the past for restrictive practices, and the
annual report could usefully discuss the extent to which these have been eliminated.
Employees of a businesses are stakeholders in that business, along with shareholders and
customers. A company wishing to demonstrate good corporate citizenship will therefore be
780
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
concerned with employee welfare. Accordingly, the annual report might usefully contain
information on details of working hours, industrial accidents and sickness of employees.
In conclusion, it can be seen that the annual report can, and should go far beyond the
financial statements and traditional ratio analysis.
TT2020
781
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Conclusion
The IASB believes that the advantages for SMEs of having a separate simplified set of IFRSs
outweigh the disadvantages. They believe that both preparers and users of SME accounts will
benefit.
(b) Examples of full IFRSs with choice
(i) Under IAS 40 Investment Property, either the cost model or fair value model (through
profit or loss) are permitted. The IFRS for SMEs requires the fair value model (through
profit or loss) to be used as long as fair value can be measure without undue cost or
effort. This promotes consistency in the treatment of investment properties between SMEs
financial statements.
(ii) IAS 38 Intangible Assets allows either the cost model or revaluation model (where there
is an active market). The IFRS for SMEs does not permit the revaluation model to be
used. This eliminates the use of other comprehensive income, simplifying financial
reporting and the need for costly revaluations.
(iii) IFRS 3 Business Combinations allows an entity to adopt the full or partial goodwill
method in its consolidated financial statements. The IFRS for SMEs only allows the
partial goodwill method, ie excluding non-controlling interests in goodwill. This avoids
the need for SMEs to determine the fair value of the non-controlling interests not
purchased when undertaking a business combination.
The IFRS for SMEs does not eliminate choice completely but disallows the third of the
above options. It is one of the rare uses of other comprehensive income under the IFRS
for SMEs.
Examples of IFRSs with complex recognition and measurement requirements
(iv) IAS 38 Intangible Assets requires internally generated assets to be capitalised if certain
criteria (proving future economic benefits) are met. In reality, it is an onerous exercise to
test these criteria for each type of internally generated asset and leads to inconsistency
with some items being expensed and some capitalised.
The IFRS for SMEs removes these capitalisation criteria and requires all internally
generated research and development expenditure to be expensed through profit or loss.
(v) IFRS 3 Business Combinations requires goodwill to be tested annually for impairment. In
reality, it is very difficult to ascertain the recoverable amount for goodwill so instead the
assets of the business need to be combined into cash-generating units or even a group
of cash-generating units in order to determine any impairment loss. The impairment then
needs to be allocated to goodwill and the other individual assets. This is a complex
exercise.
The IFRS for SMEs requires goodwill to be amortised instead. This is a much simpler
approach and the IFRS for SMEs specifies that if an entity is unable to make a reliable
estimate of the useful life, it is presumed to be ten years, simplifying things even further.
(vi) IAS 20 Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance
requires grants to be recognised only when it is reasonably certain that the entity will
comply with the conditions attached to the grant and the grants will be received. Grants
relating to income are recognised in profit or loss over the period the related costs are
recognised in profit or loss. Grants relating to assets are either netted off the cost of the
asset (reducing depreciation by the amount of the grant over the asset's useful life) or
presented as deferred income (and released to profit or loss as income over the useful
life of the asset).
The IFRS for SMEs simplifies this and specifies that where there are no specified future
performance conditions, the grant should be recognised as income when it is
782
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
34 Taupe
(a) REPORT
To: Investor
From: Accountant
Date: November 20X5
Subject: Segment analysis of Taupe
I have looked at the segment analysis note from Taupe's financial statements and have made
the following analysis of the figures shown which may be of use to you. The detailed
calculations upon which this analysis has been based are included in the appendix to this
report.
From the segment analysis we can add more information to our overview of the results of the
organisation.
Profit margin
The overall profit margin of the group has increased slightly from 24% in 20X4 to
25% in 20X5. We can also see that this is nothing to do with road haulage as its profit
margin has stayed the same but is in fact due to a 2% increase from 31% to 33% for airfreight
and the change from an operating loss in 20X4 of 25% for the new secure transport business
to an operating profit in 20X5 of 6%.
ROCE
Similarly with return on capital employed the overall figure is an increase from 27% in
20X4 in 29% in 20X5. However, this is solely due to the performance of the secure
transport activities. Road haulage shows a slight decrease in ROCE but air freight shows a
decrease from 57% to 52%.
TT2020
783
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Summary
Although the figures for the secure transport business are still small with low profit margins it is
clearly improving as the investment in the infrastructure starts to feed through to the profits.
However for the other two divisions the position is either only slightly better than last year or
worse.
I hope that this additional information has been of use to you.
APPENDIX
Key ratios
20X5 20X4
Profit margin
Road haulage 169/653 26%
168/642 26%
Air freight 68/208 33%
62/199 31%
Secure transport 6/98 6%
(16)/63 -25%
Group 243/959 25%
214/904 24%
Return on capital employed
Road haulage 169/(805 – 345) 37%
168/(796 – 349) 38%
Air freight 68/(306 – 176) 52%
62/(287 – 178) 57%
Secure transport 6/(437 – 197) 2.5%
(16)/(422 – 184) -6.7%
Group 243/(1,548 – 718) 29%
214/(1,505 – 711) 27%
Note. When the group ratios were calculated the figures did not include unallocated
expenses or assets/liabilities in order to be able to compare directly with the segmental
figures.
(b) Even though segment reporting can be very useful to investors it does also have some
limitations.
Defining segments
IFRS 8 Operating Segments does not define segment revenue and expense, segment results or
segment assets and liabilities. It does, however, require an explanation of how segment profit
or loss, segment assets and segment liabilities are measured for each operating segment.
IFRS 8 requires operating segments to be identified on the basis of internal reports about
components of the entity that are regularly reviewed by the chief operating decision maker in
order to allocate resources to the segment or assess performance.
Consequently, entities have discretion in determining what is included under segment results,
which is limited only by their reporting practices.
Although this should mean that the analysis is comparable over time, it is unlikely to be
comparable with that of another business.
Common costs
In many cases it will not be possible to allocate an expense to a segment and therefore they
will be shown as unallocated expenses as in Taupe's segmental analysis. If these unallocated
costs are material it can distort the segment results and make comparison with the overall
784
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Further question practice solutions
group results misleading. Also if costs are allocated to segments on an arbitrary basis then this
can distort the segment results.
Unallocated assets/liabilities
In a similar way to common costs it may be that some of the entity's assets and/or liabilities
cannot be allocated to a particular segment and must be shown as unallocated
assets/liabilities as in Taupe. Again this can make the results and comparisons misleading.
Finance costs
Finance is normally raised centrally and allocated to divisions as required therefore the normal
treatment for finance costs is to show them as an unallocated expense. However if some areas
of the business rely more heavily on debt finance than others then this exclusion of finance
costs could be misleading.
Tax costs
As with finance costs the effects of tax are normally shown as a total rather than split between
the segments. If however a segment had a significantly different tax profile to other segments
again this information would be lost.
35 Restructuring
IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets states that a provision can be created
for restructuring where the entity:
Has a detailed formal plan
Has raised a valid expectation in those affected that it will carry out the restructuring
Omega clearly has a detailed formal plan, and has publicly announced its decision. A provision
should therefore be created. The following amounts will be included in its statement of profit or loss
for 20X9:
(i) Redundancy costs are provided for as they are necessarily entailed by the restructuring and do
not relate to Omega's ongoing activities. IAS 37 requires provisions to be measured at the
best estimate of the expenditure required. This would qualify as an adjusting even in line with
IAS 10 Events After the Reporting Period. Profit is therefore reduced by $1.9 million.
The $800,000 required to retrain employees will not be provided for and will not affect profit,
as it relates to Omega's ongoing activities.
(ii) Although not part of the restructuring, plant and equipment with a carrying amount of $8
million but a recoverable amount of $1.5 million are clearly impaired. IAS 36 Impairment of
Assets requires that they be restated at recoverable amount of $1.5 million, resulting in the
recognition of an impairment loss of $6.5 million in profit and loss.
(iii) The statement of profit or loss will recognise an expense of $550,000. In line with IAS 10, this
would qualify as an adjusting even after the reporting period, which the financial statements
should reflect.
(iv) IAS 37 does not permit a provision to include amounts in respect of future operating losses, as
they relate to the ongoing activities of the entity. There will be no charge to the statement of
profit or loss in respect of these losses for the year ended 30 September 20X9. Provisions
should only be made for events that took place in the past, whereas these expected losses take
place in the future.
TT2020
785
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
786
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Glossary
Glossary
Chapter 3 Revenue
Contract: An agreement between two or more parties that creates enforceable rights and
obligations.
Contract asset: An entity's right to consideration in exchange for goods or services that the entity
has transferred to a customer when that right is conditioned on something other than the passage of
time (for example the entity's future performance).
Contract liability: An entity's obligation to transfer goods or services to a customer for which the
entity has received consideration (or the amount is due) from the customer.
Customer: A party that has contracted with an entity to obtain goods or services that are an output
of the entity's ordinary activities in exchange for consideration.
Income: Increases in economic benefits during the accounting period in the form of inflows or
enhancements of assets or decreases of liabilities that result in an increase in equity, other than those
relating to contributions from equity participants.
Performance obligation: A promise in a contract with a customer to transfer to the customer
either:
(a) A good or service (or a bundle of goods or services) that is distinct; or
(b) A series of distinct goods or services that are substantially the same and that have the same
pattern of transfer to the customer.
Receivable: An entity's right to consideration that is unconditional – ie only the passage of time is
required before payment is due.
Revenue: Income arising in the course of an entity's ordinary activities.
Stand-alone selling price: The price at which an entity would sell a promised good or service
separately to a customer.
Transaction price: The amount of consideration to which an entity expects to be entitled in
exchange for transferring promised goods or services to a customer, excluding amounts collected on
behalf of third parties. (IFRS 15: Appendix A)
788
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Glossary
TT2020
789
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Chapter 6 Provisions, contingencies and events after the
reporting period
Contingent asset: A possible asset that arises from past events and whose existence will be
confirmed by the occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the entity's
control. (IAS 37: para. 10)
Contingent liability:
Either:
(a) A possible obligation arising from past events whose existence will be confirmed only by
the occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the
entity; or
(b) A present obligation that arises from past events but is not recognised because:
(i) It is not probable that an outflow of economic benefit will be required to settle the
obligation; or
(ii) The amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability.
(IAS 37: para. 10)
Events after the reporting period: Those events, both favourable and unfavourable, that occur
between the year end and the date on which the financial statements are authorised for issue (IAS
10: para. 3).
Provision: A liability of uncertain timing or amount. (IAS 37: para. 10)
790
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Glossary
Equity instrument: Any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of an entity after
deducting all of its liabilities. (IAS 32: para. 11)
Effective interest rate: The rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash payments or receipts
through the expected life of the financial asset or financial liability to the gross carrying amount of a
financial asset or to the amortised cost of a financial liability.
Expected credit losses: The weighted average of credit losses with the respective risks of a
default occurring as the weights. (IFRS 9: Appendix A)
Financial asset (IAS 32: para. 11): Any asset that is:
(a) Cash;
(b) An equity instrument of another entity;
(c) A contractual right:
(i) To receive cash or another financial asset from another entity; or
(ii) To exchange financial assets or financial liabilities with another entity under conditions
that are potentially favourable to the entity; or
(d) A contract that will or may be settled in the entity's own equity instruments. (IAS 32: para. 11)
Financial guarantee contract: A contract that requires the issuer to make specified payments to
reimburse the holder for a loss it incurs because a specified debtor fails to make payment when due
in accordance with the original or modified terms of the debt instrument. (IFRS 9: Appendix A)
Financial instrument: Any contract that gives rise to both a financial asset of one entity and a
financial liability or equity instrument of another entity. (IAS 32: para. 11)
Financial liability (IAS 32: para. 11): Any liability that is:
(a) A contractual obligation:
(i) To deliver cash or another financial asset to another entity; or
(ii) To exchange financial assets or financial liabilities with another entity under conditions
that are potentially unfavourable to the entity; or
(b) A contract that will or may be settled in an entity's own equity instruments. (IAS 32: para. 11)
Held for trading: A financial asset or financial liability that:
(a) Is acquired or incurred principally for the purpose of selling or repurchasing it in the near
term;
(b) On initial recognition is part of a portfolio of identified financial instruments that are managed
together and for which there is evidence of a recent actual pattern of short-term profit-taking;
or
(c) Is a derivative (except for a derivative that is a financial guarantee contract or a designated
and effective hedging instrument). (IFRS 9: Appendix A)
Loss allowance: The allowance for expected credit losses on financial assets.
(IFRS 9: Appendix A)
Chapter 9 Leases
Finance lease: A lease that transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental
to ownership of an underlying asset.
Lease: A contract, or part of a contract, that conveys the right to use an asset (the underlying
asset) for a period of time in exchange for consideration. (IFRS 16: Appendix A)
TT2020
791
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Lease term: The lease term is 'the non-cancellable period for which a lessee has the right to
use an underlying asset, together with both:
(a) Periods covered by an option to extend the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain to
exercise that option; and
(b) Periods covered by an option to terminate the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain
not to exercise that option.'
Operating lease: A lease that does not transfer substantially all the risks and rewards
incidental to ownership of an underlying asset. (IFRS 16: Appendix A)
792
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Glossary
Power: Existing rights that give the current ability to direct the relevant activities of the investee.
(IFRS 10: Appendix A)
Subsidiary: An entity that is controlled by another entity. (IFRS 10: Appendix A)
TT2020
793
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Presentation currency: The currency in which the financial statements are presented.
Spot exchange rate: The exchange rate for immediate delivery. (IAS 21: para. 8)
794
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Glossary
TT2020
795
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
796
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Bibliography
Bibliography
ACCA (2019) Rulebook. [Online]. Available from:
http://www.accaglobal.com/uk/en/member/standards/rules-and-standards/rulebook.html
[Accessed 30 October 2019].
ACCA (2019) Strategic Business Reporting Syllabus and Study Guide. [Online]. Available from
https://www.accaglobal.com/uk/en/student/exam-support-resources/professional-exams-study-
resources/strategic-business-reporting/syllabus-and-study-guide.html [Accessed 30 October 2019].
ACCA (no date) What is the examiner asking? [Online]. Available from
https://www.accaglobal.com/uk/en/student/sa/study-skills/questions.html [Accessed
23 November 2019].
ACCA (no date) The conceptual framework and ethical dilemmas [Online]. Available from:
www.accaglobal.com/lk/en/about-us/regulation/ethics/conceptual-framework-ethical-
dilemmas.html [Accessed 29 October 2019].
Barker, Richard and McGeachin, Anne, (2011) The Recognition and Measurement of Liabilities in
IFRS [Online]. Available from https://ssrn.com/abstract=1952739 [Accessed 14 December 2018]
Deloitte (2017) Deloitte iGAAP 2017: Volume A: A guide to IFRS reporting. London: Wolters Kluwer.
EFRAG (2018) FICE – Joint Outreach Summary Report Frankfurt 20 November 2018. [Online].
Available from https://www.efrag.org/News/Meeting-146/Summary-Report-on-the-joint-outreach-
event-on-FICE [Accessed 1 February 2019].
ESMA (2015) ESMA Guidelines on Alternative Performance Measures. [Online]. Available from:
https://www.esma.europa.eu/press-news/esma-news/esma-publishes-final-guidelines-alternative-
performance-measures [Accessed 9 November 2018].
Ernst & Young (2015) Accounting for share-based payments under IFRS 2: the essential guide.
[Online] Available from:
http://www.ey.com/Publication/vwLUAssets/Applying_IFRS:_Accounting_for_share-
based_payments_under_IFRS_2_-_the_essential_guide./$File/Applying-SBP-April2015.pdf [Accessed
11 January 2019].
Ernst & Young (2018) IFRS (#) Accounting for crypto-assets [Online] Available from:
https://www.ey.com/Publication/vwLUAssets/EY-IFRS-Accounting-for-crypto-assets/$File/EY-IFRS-
Accounting-for-crypto-assets.pdf [Accessed 11 January 2019].
Global Reporting Initiative (2016) GRI 101: Foundation. [Online] Available from
https://www.globalreporting.org/standards/gri-standards-download-center/ [Accessed 11 January
2019].
Global Reporting Initiative (No date) About sustainability reporting. [Online] Available from
https://www.globalreporting.org/information/sustainability-reporting/Pages/default.aspx [Accessed
16 October 2019].
IFRS Foundation (2019) Project Summary Disclosure Initiative—Principles of Disclosure [Online].
Available at: https://www.ifrs.org/-/media/project/disclosure-initative/disclosure-initiative-principles-
of-disclosure/project-summary/di-principles-of-disclosure-project-summary.pdf [Accessed 21 October
2019].
IFRS Foundation (2019) IFRS [Online]. Available at: http://eifrs.ifrs.org [Accessed 11 January 2020].
IFRS Foundation (2016) Agenda Decision: To what extent can an impairment loss be allocated to
non-current assets within a disposal group? (IFRS 5) [Online]. Available at:
https://www.ifrs.org/supporting-implementation/supporting-materials-by-ifrs-standard/ifrs-
5/#agenda [Accessed 9 November 2018].
TT2020
797
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
IFRS Foundation (2016) Agenda Decision: Scope, measurement and presentation issues (IFRS 5)
[Online]. Available at: https://www.ifrs.org/supporting-implementation/supporting-materials-by-ifrs-
standard/ifrs-5/#agenda [Accessed 9 November 2018].
IFRS Foundation (2015) Summary Report of the EFRAG, EFFAS, AIAF and IASB Joint Investor
Outreach Event on profit or loss and the role of other comprehensive income. [Online]. Available
from: http://www.ifrs.org/news-and-events/2015/12/summary-report-joint-investor-outreach-event/
[Accessed 11 January 2019].
IIRC (2013) The International <IR> Framework. [Online] Available from:
http://integratedreporting.org/resource/international-ir-framework/[Accessed 11 January 2019].
International Accounting Standards Board (2018) Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting.
[Online]. Available from: http://eifrs.ifrs.org [Accessed 11 January 2019].
International Accounting Standards Board (2010) Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting.
[Online]. Available from: http://eifrs.ifrs.org [Accessed 11 January 2019].
International Accounting Standards Board (1989) Framework for the Preparation and Presentation of
Financial Statements. [Online]. Available from: http://eifrs.ifrs.org [Accessed 11 January 2019].
International Accounting Standards Board (2011) IFRS Practice Statement 1: Management
Commentary A framework for presentation. [Online]. Available from: http://eifrs.ifrs.org [Accessed
9 November 2018].
International Accounting Standards Board (2017) IFRS Practice Statement 2: Making Materiality
Judgements. [Online]. Available from: http://eifrs.ifrs.org [Accessed 9 November 2018].
ITV (2015), Annual Report and Accounts [Online] Available from:
https://www.itvplc.com/investors/results-centre/reports-and-results-archive/2015 [Accessed
25 September 2018].
KPMG (2012) Integrated Reporting Performance insight through Better Business Reporting Issue 2.
[Online]. Available from: http://integratedreporting.org/wp-content/uploads/2012/06/KPMG-
Integrated-Reporting-Performance-Insight-Through-Better-Business-Reporting-Issue-2.pdf [Accessed 17
October 2019].
Rightmove plc (2019) Annual Report 2018 [Online]. Available from
https://plc.rightmove.co.uk/~/media/Files/R/Rightmove/2019/Rightmove_plc_2018_Annual_Rep
ort.pdf [Accessed 30 October 2019].
UN (no date) About the Sustainable Development Goals [Online]. Available from:
https://www.un.org/sustainabledevelopment/sustainable-development-goals/ [Accessed 17
October 2019].
UN (2019) Global Sustainable Development Report 2019 [Online]. Available from
https://sustainabledevelopment.un.org/content/documents/24797GSDR_report_2019.pdf
[Accessed 17 October 2019].
Walton, C. (1977) The Ethics of Corporate Conduct. Oxford, Prentice-Hall
798
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Mathematical tables
Mathematical tables
6 0.942 0.888 0.837 0.790 0.746 0.705 0.666 0.630 0.596 0.564
7 0.933 0.871 0.813 0.760 0.711 0.665 0.623 0.583 0.547 0.513
8 0.923 0.853 0.789 0.731 0.677 0.627 0.582 0.540 0.502 0.467
9 0.914 0.837 0.766 0.703 0.645 0.592 0.544 0.500 0.460 0.424
10 0.905 0.820 0.744 0.676 0.614 0.558 0.508 0.463 0.422 0.386
11 0.896 0.804 0.722 0.650 0.585 0.527 0.475 0.429 0.388 0.350
12 0.887 0.788 0.701 0.625 0.557 0.497 0.444 0.397 0.356 0.319
13 0.879 0.773 0.681 0.601 0.530 0.469 0.415 0.368 0.326 0.290
14 0.870 0.758 0.661 0.577 0.505 0.442 0.388 0.340 0.299 0.263
15 0.861 0.743 0.642 0.555 0.481 0.417 0.362 0.315 0.275 0.239
16 0.853 0.728 0.623 0.534 0.458 0.394 0.339 0.292 0.252 0.218
17 0.844 0.714 0.605 0.513 0.436 0.371 0.317 0.270 0.231 0.198
18 0.836 0.700 0.587 0.494 0.416 0.350 0.296 0.250 0.212 0.180
19 0.828 0.686 0.570 0.475 0.396 0.331 0.277 0.232 0.194 0.164
20 0.820 0.673 0.554 0.456 0.377 0.312 0.258 0.215 0.178 0.149
6 0.535 0.507 0.480 0.456 0.432 0.410 0.390 0.370 0.352 0.335
7 0.482 0.452 0.425 0.400 0.376 0.354 0.333 0.314 0.296 0.279
8 0.434 0.404 0.376 0.351 0.327 0.305 0.285 0.266 0.249 0.233
9 0.391 0.361 0.333 0.308 0.284 0.263 0.243 0.225 0.209 0.194
10 0.352 0.322 0.295 0.270 0.247 0.227 0.208 0.191 0.176 0.162
11 0.317 0.287 0.261 0.237 0.215 0.195 0.178 0.162 0.148 0.135
12 0.286 0.257 0.231 0.208 0.187 0.168 0.152 0.137 0.124 0.112
13 0.258 0.229 0.204 0.182 0.163 0.145 0.130 0.116 0.104 0.093
14 0.232 0.205 0.181 0.160 0.141 0.125 0.111 0.099 0.088 0.078
15 0.209 0.183 0.160 0.140 0.123 0.108 0.095 0.084 0.074 0.065
16 0.188 0.163 0.141 0.123 0.107 0.093 0.081 0.071 0.062 0.054
17 0.170 0.146 0.125 0.108 0.093 0.080 0.069 0.060 0.052 0.045
18 0.153 0.130 0.111 0.095 0.081 0.069 0.059 0.051 0.044 0.038
19 0.138 0.116 0.098 0.083 0.070 0.060 0.051 0.043 0.037 0.031
20 0.124 0.104 0.087 0.073 0.061 0.051 0.043 0.037 0.031 0.026
TT2020
799
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Cumulative present value table
This table shows the present value of £1 per annum, receivable or payable at the end of each year
for n years.
Periods Discount rates (r)
(n) 1% 2% 3% 4% 5% 6% 7% 8% 9% 10%
1 0.990 0.980 0.971 0.962 0.952 0.943 0.935 0.926 0.917 0.909
2 1.970 1.942 1.913 1.886 1.859 1.833 1.808 1.783 1.759 1.736
3 2.941 2.884 2.829 2.775 2.723 2.673 2.624 2.577 2.531 2.487
4 3.902 3.808 3.717 3.630 3.546 3.465 3.387 3.312 3.240 3.170
5 4.853 4.713 4.580 4.452 4.329 4.212 4.100 3.993 3.890 3.791
6 5.795 5.601 5.417 5.242 5.076 4.917 4.767 4.623 4.486 4.355
7 6.728 6.472 6.230 6.002 5.786 5.582 5.389 5.206 5.033 4.868
8 7.652 7.325 7.020 6.733 6.463 6.210 5.971 5.747 5.535 5.335
9 8.566 8.162 7.786 7.435 7.108 6.802 6.515 6.247 5.995 5.759
10 9.471 8.983 8.530 8.111 7.722 7.360 7.024 6.710 6.418 6.145
11 10.37 9.787 9.253 8.760 8.306 7.887 7.499 7.139 6.805 6.495
12 11.26 10.58 9.954 9.385 8.863 8.384 7.943 7.536 7.161 6.814
13 12.13 11.35 10.63 9.986 9.394 8.853 8.358 7.904 7.487 7.103
14 13.00 12.11 11.30 10.56 9.899 9.295 8.745 8.244 7.786 7.367
15 13.87 12.85 11.94 11.12 10.38 9.712 9.108 8.559 8.061 7.606
16 14.71 13.578 12.561 11.652 10.838 10.106 9.447 8.851 8.313 7.824
8
17 15.56 14.292 13.166 12.166 11.274 10.477 9.763 9.122 8.544 8.022
2
18 16.39 14.992 13.754 12.659 11.690 10.828 10.059 9.372 8.756 8.201
8
19 17.22 15.678 14.324 13.134 12.085 11.158 10.336 9.604 8.950 8.365
6
20 18.04 16.351 14.877 13.590 12.462 11.470 10.594 9.818 9.129 8.514
6
6 4.231 4.111 3.998 3.889 3.784 3.685 3.589 3.498 3.410 3.326
7 4.712 4.564 4.423 4.288 4.160 4.039 3.922 3.812 3.706 3.605
8 5.146 4.968 4.799 4.639 4.487 4.344 4.207 4.078 3.954 3.837
9 5.537 5.328 5.132 4.946 4.772 4.607 4.451 4.303 4.163 4.031
10 5.889 5.650 5.426 5.216 5.019 4.833 4.659 4.494 4.339 4.192
11 6.207 5.938 5.687 5.453 5.234 5.029 4.836 4.656 4.486 4.327
12 6.492 6.194 5.918 5.660 5.421 5.197 4.988 4.793 4.611 4.439
13 6.750 6.424 6.122 5.842 5.583 5.342 5.118 4.910 4.715 4.533
14 6.982 6.628 6.302 6.002 5.724 5.468 5.229 5.008 4.802 4.611
15 7.191 6.811 6.462 6.142 5.847 5.575 5.324 5.092 4.876 4.675
16 7.379 6.974 6.604 6.265 5.954 5.668 5.405 5.162 4.938 4.730
17 7.549 7.120 6.729 6.373 6.047 5.749 5.475 5.222 4.990 4.775
18 7.702 7.250 6.840 6.467 6.128 5.818 5.534 5.273 5.033 4.812
19 7.839 7.366 6.938 6.550 6.198 5.877 5.584 5.316 5.070 4.843
20 7.963 7.469 7.025 6.623 6.259 5.929 5.628 5.353 5.101 4.870
800
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
ndex
ndex
12 month expected credit losses usiness model approach, 168, 169
credit losses, 176
C
Calculating deferred tax, 139
CC Co e of thics an Con uct, 21 Cancellation (share based payment), 232
ccounting estimates, 31 Cancellation of share options, 232
accounting mismatch, 169, 172, 171 Cancellations (share based payment), 23
ccounting policies, 0 Capital appreciation, 72
ccrual accounting, 4 Cash, ,
cquisition method, 27 Cash equivalents, ,
cquisitions where control is retained, 315 Cash flow hedge, 181
cquisitions where significant influence or Cash flows, ,
control is achieved, 296, 3 1 Cash flows on acquisition or disposal of a
cquisitions where significant influence or subsidiary, 394
control is achieved, 628 Cash receipts basis, 138
ctive market, , 71 Cash-generating unit, 2
ctuarial assumptions, 9 Closing rate,
ctuary, 89 Commitments to provide a loan at a below
d ustment to equity, 3 2, 3 3, 326 market interest rate, 172
gricultural produce, Comparability,
griculture ( S 41), 75 Component of an entity, 1
lternative S figure, 677 Compound financial instruments, 164
lternative performance measure ( M), 438, Conceptual framework, 3
446 Consolidated, 387
lternative performance measures ( Ms), Consolidated cash flow, 39
438 dividends received from associates and
mortisation, 72 joint ventures, 392
mortised cost, 1 , 171, 175 indirect method, 387
ntidilution, Consolidated financial statements, 495
' sset Ceiling' test, 96 Consolidated retained earnings, 272
ssets held for sale, 491 Consolidated statement of cash flows, 389
ssociate, 2 Consolidated statement of financial position,
ssociate to investment, 329 271
vailable for use, 72 Consolidated statement of profit or loss and
other comprehensive income, 274, 275
Consolidation technique, 268
alanced scorecard, 442 Consolidation
argain purchase, 28 consideration transferred, 28
asic S, 436 Constructive obligation, 121
earer plants, 75 Contingent assets, 126
est estimate, 122 Contingent liability, 125
ig data, 444 Contingent share agreement,
iological assets, Contingently issuable ordinary shares,
iological transformation,
orrowing costs, 75, 491 Contract, 1
usiness FR definition of , 2 Contract asset, 1
usiness combination, 2 Contract costs, 48
usiness combination achieved in Contract liability, 1
stages, 2 Control, 47, 2 , 265
TT2020
8 1
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Corporate assets, 63 Disposals where control or significant
Cost, 489 influence is lost, 315
Cost constraint, 12
Costs versus benefits, 489
Credit loss, 175
E
Earnings per share, 435, 490
Credit risk, 172
Economic value added (EVA), 439
Credit-impaired financial assets, 179
ED/2018/1 Accounting Policy Changes, 32
Current cost of a liability, 11
Effective interest rate, 168
Current cost of an asset, 11
Embedded derivatives
Current service cost, 90
Derivatives, 174
Current tax, 135
Employee benefits,85
Current value, 10
Enhancing qualitative characteristics, 5
Curtailment, 92
Equity instrument, 162
Customer, 41
Equity instrument granted, 218
Equity method, 264, 277
D Ethics, 21
Deemed disposals, 328 Events after the reporting period, 126
Deferred tax Exchange differences, 366, 371
group financial statements, 145 Exchanges of assets, 59
measurement, 145 Exclusion of a subsidiary from the
presentation, 153 consolidated financial statements, 266
recognition, 143 Exemption from presenting consolidated
share-based payment, 234 financial statements, 264
unrealised profits on intragroup trading, Expected credit losses, 175
147 credit losses, 175, 178
Deferred tax calculation, 138, 139
Deferred tax on leases, 201
Deferred tax principles, 135
F
Fair value, 66, 10, 218
Defined benefit plans, 89, 604
Fair value hedge, 181
Defined contribution plans, 88, 604
Fair value hierarchy, 67
Depreciation, 58 Fair value less costs of disposal, 61
Derecognition, 10, 611
Fair value measurement, 66
Derecognition of financial assets, 611
Fair value of a liability, 68, 69
Derecognition of financial liabilities, 614
Faithful representation, 5
Derivative, 162
Finance lease, 202, 203
Development costs, 491
Financial asset, 162, 168
Development phase, 70
Financial guarantee contract, 168
Digital business, 444
Financial guarantee contracts, 172
Diluted EPS, 436
Financial instrument, 162, 175, 492
Dilution, 675
Financial liability, 162, 171
Direct method, 662
Financial performance measures, 435
Discontinued operation, 341, 342, 343,
Financing activities, 646, 648
346
Finite useful life, 72
Discounting, 90
Foreign operation, 378, 369
Discounting of provisions, 122
Fulfilment value, 11
Disposal group, 337, 339
Full disposal, 315
Disposal of foreign operations, 378
Functional currency, 365, 366, 369
Disposal where control is retained,
Fundamental qualitative characteristics, 5
325
Future operating losses, 122
Disposals, 315
Disposals where control is retained, 325
802
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Index
TT2020
803
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Non-refundable upfront fees, 49
K
Key management personnel, 27
O
L Obligation, 8
Offsetting, 173
Lease, 178, 195
Onerous contracts, 123
Lease liability, 197
Operating activities, 646, 647
Lease term, 197
Operating lease, 202, 206
Lessee accounting, 195, 202
Operating segment, 454
Lessor accounting, 202, 617
Options, 675
Lifetime expected credit losses, 175, 176,
Ordinary share, 675
178, 179
Liquidity analysis, 672
Loss allowance, 175 P
Low-value assets, 199 Partial disposal, 315
Past service cost, 92
M Pension actuarial gains and losses, 492
Performance conditions
Management commentary, 453
(share-based payment), 228
Manufacturer or dealer lessors, 205
Performance measures, 435
Market conditions (share-based payment),
Performance obligation, 41, 47
228
Piecemeal acquisition, 295
Market-based measure, 67
Plan assets, 91
Material, 489, 508
Potential ordinary share, 675
Materiality judgements, 508
Power, 265
Measurement, 10
Present obligation, 121
Measurement inconsistency, 11
Presentation currency, 368
Measurement period, 280
Primary users, 4
Measurement uncertainty, 5, 11
Principal market, 67
Modifications (share-based payment), 230
Principal versus agent, 49
Monetary items, 365
Prior period errors, 31
Monetary items forming part of a net
Profitability ratios, 493
investment in a foreign operation, 378
Projected unit credit method, 89
Most advantageous market, 67
Property, plant and equipment, 57, 600
Multi-employer plans, 604
Provision, 121
Multiple components of a lease contract, 619
N Q
Qualifying asset, 75
Net investment in a foreign operation,
Qualitative characteristics, 5
378
Qualitative factors, 510
Non-controlling interests, 270
Quantitative factors, 509
measuring, 270
Non-current assets held for sale, 337, 339,
340 R
Non-current assets to be abandoned, 341 Ratio analysis, 435, 666, 673, 686
Non-current assets Receivable, 41
depreciation, 58 Reclassification of financial assets, 171
measurement at recognition, 58 Recognition, 8
recognition, 57 Recoverable amount, 60
revaluations, 58 Reimbursements, 122
Non-financial performance indicators (NFPIs), Related party (IAS 24), 27
441
804
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Index
TT2020
805
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
428
BPP Tutor Toolkit Copy
Notes
TT2020
TT2020
TT2020
TT2020
TT2020
How have you used this Workbook? During the past six months do you recall
(Tick one box only) seeing/receiving any of the following?
(Tick as many boxes as are relevant)
Home study (book only)
Our advertisement in Student Accountant
On a course: college
Our advertisement in Pass
With 'correspondence' package
Our advertisement in PQ
Other
Our brochure with a letter through the post
Why did you decide to purchase this
Workbook? Our website www.bpp.com
(Tick one box only) Which (if any) aspects of our advertising
Have used other BPP products in the past do you find useful?
(Tick as many boxes as are relevant)
Recommendation by friend/colleague
Prices and publication dates of new editions
Recommendation by a lecturer at college
Information on product content
Saw advertising
Facility to order books off-the-page
Other
None of the above
Your ratings, comments and suggestions would be appreciated on the following areas.
Very useful Useful Not useful
Passing SBR
Skills Checkpoints
Activities
Essential Reading
Overall opinion of this Workbook Excellent Good Adequate Poor
TT2020